US20200237512A1 - Valve repair devices for repairing a native valve of a patient - Google Patents
Valve repair devices for repairing a native valve of a patient Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20200237512A1 US20200237512A1 US16/847,577 US202016847577A US2020237512A1 US 20200237512 A1 US20200237512 A1 US 20200237512A1 US 202016847577 A US202016847577 A US 202016847577A US 2020237512 A1 US2020237512 A1 US 2020237512A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- paddles
- coaption element
- valve
- cap
- portions
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Granted
Links
- 230000008439 repair process Effects 0.000 title claims description 103
- 239000000463 material Substances 0.000 claims description 258
- 230000033001 locomotion Effects 0.000 claims description 90
- 230000014759 maintenance of location Effects 0.000 claims description 23
- 229910052751 metal Inorganic materials 0.000 claims description 21
- 239000002184 metal Substances 0.000 claims description 20
- 239000008280 blood Substances 0.000 abstract description 41
- 210000004369 blood Anatomy 0.000 abstract description 41
- 210000003709 heart valve Anatomy 0.000 abstract description 19
- 125000006850 spacer group Chemical group 0.000 description 170
- 210000001519 tissue Anatomy 0.000 description 152
- 210000004115 mitral valve Anatomy 0.000 description 108
- 239000010410 layer Substances 0.000 description 86
- 230000007246 mechanism Effects 0.000 description 83
- 239000004744 fabric Substances 0.000 description 67
- 238000002513 implantation Methods 0.000 description 48
- 230000008878 coupling Effects 0.000 description 43
- 238000010168 coupling process Methods 0.000 description 43
- 238000005859 coupling reaction Methods 0.000 description 43
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 description 41
- 210000005246 left atrium Anatomy 0.000 description 36
- 210000005240 left ventricle Anatomy 0.000 description 33
- 206010067171 Regurgitation Diseases 0.000 description 28
- 229910001000 nickel titanium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 21
- HLXZNVUGXRDIFK-UHFFFAOYSA-N nickel titanium Chemical compound [Ti].[Ti].[Ti].[Ti].[Ti].[Ti].[Ti].[Ti].[Ti].[Ti].[Ti].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni].[Ni] HLXZNVUGXRDIFK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 20
- 210000000591 tricuspid valve Anatomy 0.000 description 19
- 230000008901 benefit Effects 0.000 description 18
- 210000003698 chordae tendineae Anatomy 0.000 description 17
- 229910001285 shape-memory alloy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 16
- 238000011010 flushing procedure Methods 0.000 description 15
- 239000000853 adhesive Substances 0.000 description 14
- 230000001070 adhesive effect Effects 0.000 description 14
- 230000001746 atrial effect Effects 0.000 description 14
- 230000017531 blood circulation Effects 0.000 description 14
- 230000008569 process Effects 0.000 description 14
- 230000007704 transition Effects 0.000 description 14
- 230000002861 ventricular Effects 0.000 description 14
- MWCLLHOVUTZFKS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Methyl cyanoacrylate Chemical compound COC(=O)C(=C)C#N MWCLLHOVUTZFKS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 13
- 210000001765 aortic valve Anatomy 0.000 description 12
- 238000003466 welding Methods 0.000 description 12
- 230000009467 reduction Effects 0.000 description 11
- 238000007789 sealing Methods 0.000 description 11
- 238000013459 approach Methods 0.000 description 10
- 210000002414 leg Anatomy 0.000 description 10
- 230000007257 malfunction Effects 0.000 description 10
- 206010027727 Mitral valve incompetence Diseases 0.000 description 9
- 239000004698 Polyethylene Substances 0.000 description 9
- -1 polyethylene Polymers 0.000 description 9
- 229920000573 polyethylene Polymers 0.000 description 9
- 229920000642 polymer Polymers 0.000 description 9
- 230000036316 preload Effects 0.000 description 9
- 239000003381 stabilizer Substances 0.000 description 9
- 210000003484 anatomy Anatomy 0.000 description 8
- 238000005452 bending Methods 0.000 description 8
- 239000011248 coating agent Substances 0.000 description 8
- 238000000576 coating method Methods 0.000 description 8
- 239000011295 pitch Substances 0.000 description 8
- 230000000717 retained effect Effects 0.000 description 8
- 210000005245 right atrium Anatomy 0.000 description 8
- 210000005241 right ventricle Anatomy 0.000 description 8
- 239000002356 single layer Substances 0.000 description 8
- 208000031481 Pathologic Constriction Diseases 0.000 description 7
- 230000007423 decrease Effects 0.000 description 7
- 230000006870 function Effects 0.000 description 7
- 239000007943 implant Substances 0.000 description 7
- 238000009434 installation Methods 0.000 description 7
- 150000002739 metals Chemical class 0.000 description 7
- 210000003540 papillary muscle Anatomy 0.000 description 7
- 210000003102 pulmonary valve Anatomy 0.000 description 7
- 229910001220 stainless steel Inorganic materials 0.000 description 7
- 239000010935 stainless steel Substances 0.000 description 7
- 230000036262 stenosis Effects 0.000 description 7
- 208000037804 stenosis Diseases 0.000 description 7
- 241001465754 Metazoa Species 0.000 description 6
- 238000004088 simulation Methods 0.000 description 6
- 229920002614 Polyether block amide Polymers 0.000 description 5
- 230000008859 change Effects 0.000 description 5
- 230000006378 damage Effects 0.000 description 5
- 201000010099 disease Diseases 0.000 description 5
- 208000037265 diseases, disorders, signs and symptoms Diseases 0.000 description 5
- RVTZCBVAJQQJTK-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxygen(2-);zirconium(4+) Chemical compound [O-2].[O-2].[Zr+4] RVTZCBVAJQQJTK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 239000004033 plastic Substances 0.000 description 5
- 229920003023 plastic Polymers 0.000 description 5
- 238000001356 surgical procedure Methods 0.000 description 5
- 239000002131 composite material Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000001419 dependent effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000003205 diastolic effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000012530 fluid Substances 0.000 description 4
- 238000004519 manufacturing process Methods 0.000 description 4
- 210000003205 muscle Anatomy 0.000 description 4
- 229920001296 polysiloxane Polymers 0.000 description 4
- 230000002829 reductive effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000012781 shape memory material Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000010959 steel Substances 0.000 description 4
- 238000011282 treatment Methods 0.000 description 4
- 210000005166 vasculature Anatomy 0.000 description 4
- 208000012287 Prolapse Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 229910000831 Steel Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 230000010339 dilation Effects 0.000 description 3
- 206010014665 endocarditis Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 210000003191 femoral vein Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 210000002837 heart atrium Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 230000002439 hemostatic effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 210000003127 knee Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 230000000670 limiting effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000007935 neutral effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000007480 spreading Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000003892 spreading Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000002966 stenotic effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 229910000851 Alloy steel Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- FAPWRFPIFSIZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-M Sodium chloride Chemical compound [Na+].[Cl-] FAPWRFPIFSIZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 2
- 238000004873 anchoring Methods 0.000 description 2
- 210000000709 aorta Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 238000010276 construction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000002950 deficient Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000002716 delivery method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229910003460 diamond Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000010432 diamond Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000004064 dysfunction Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000000945 filler Substances 0.000 description 2
- 208000015181 infectious disease Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 230000002458 infectious effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000004054 inflammatory process Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000011900 installation process Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000003698 laser cutting Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000007769 metal material Substances 0.000 description 2
- 208000010125 myocardial infarction Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 230000036961 partial effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229920001343 polytetrafluoroethylene Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000004810 polytetrafluoroethylene Substances 0.000 description 2
- 210000003492 pulmonary vein Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 230000003134 recirculating effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000000284 resting effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 102200121808 rs1085307177 Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 239000007787 solid Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000000126 substance Substances 0.000 description 2
- 210000001631 vena cava inferior Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 206010007559 Cardiac failure congestive Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000031229 Cardiomyopathies Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010010356 Congenital anomaly Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000010496 Heart Arrest Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010019280 Heart failures Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010020772 Hypertension Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000025747 Rheumatic disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000009471 action Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001154 acute effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003570 air Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000002399 angioplasty Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000010009 beating Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000006399 behavior Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000004763 bicuspid Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 238000009954 braiding Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003683 cardiac damage Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000000748 cardiovascular system Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 238000004891 communication Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000006835 compression Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000007906 compression Methods 0.000 description 1
- 208000029078 coronary artery disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000012937 correction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000002788 crimping Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003247 decreasing effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000007812 deficiency Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000003412 degenerative effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000013461 design Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003745 detangling effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000006073 displacement reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000009826 distribution Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002526 effect on cardiovascular system Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000013013 elastic material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920001971 elastomer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000006260 foam Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000006261 foam material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000005187 foaming Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000000499 gel Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000010247 heart contraction Effects 0.000 description 1
- 208000019622 heart disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000018578 heart valve disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000000017 hydrogel Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000006872 improvement Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000003780 insertion Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000037431 insertion Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000004971 interatrial septum Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 230000002427 irreversible effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000004072 lung Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 230000036244 malformation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000011159 matrix material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000203 mixture Substances 0.000 description 1
- 208000015122 neurodegenerative disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000000149 penetrating effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000035515 penetration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000004417 polycarbonate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920000515 polycarbonate Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000002861 polymer material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000004321 preservation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 210000001147 pulmonary artery Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 230000002685 pulmonary effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002441 reversible effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 208000004124 rheumatic heart disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229920000431 shape-memory polymer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 238000007493 shaping process Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002459 sustained effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003356 suture material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000035488 systolic blood pressure Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000002435 tendon Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N water Substances O XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000009941 weaving Methods 0.000 description 1
Images
Classifications
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61B—DIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
- A61B17/00—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets
- A61B17/00234—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets for minimally invasive surgery
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61B—DIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
- A61B17/00—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets
- A61B17/04—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets for suturing wounds; Holders or packages for needles or suture materials
- A61B17/0401—Suture anchors, buttons or pledgets, i.e. means for attaching sutures to bone, cartilage or soft tissue; Instruments for applying or removing suture anchors
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61B—DIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
- A61B17/00—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets
- A61B17/04—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets for suturing wounds; Holders or packages for needles or suture materials
- A61B17/0469—Suturing instruments for use in minimally invasive surgery, e.g. endoscopic surgery
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61B—DIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
- A61B17/00—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets
- A61B17/34—Trocars; Puncturing needles
- A61B17/3468—Trocars; Puncturing needles for implanting or removing devices, e.g. prostheses, implants, seeds, wires
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2/00—Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
- A61F2/02—Prostheses implantable into the body
- A61F2/24—Heart valves ; Vascular valves, e.g. venous valves; Heart implants, e.g. passive devices for improving the function of the native valve or the heart muscle; Transmyocardial revascularisation [TMR] devices; Valves implantable in the body
- A61F2/2412—Heart valves ; Vascular valves, e.g. venous valves; Heart implants, e.g. passive devices for improving the function of the native valve or the heart muscle; Transmyocardial revascularisation [TMR] devices; Valves implantable in the body with soft flexible valve members, e.g. tissue valves shaped like natural valves
- A61F2/2415—Manufacturing methods
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2/00—Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
- A61F2/02—Prostheses implantable into the body
- A61F2/24—Heart valves ; Vascular valves, e.g. venous valves; Heart implants, e.g. passive devices for improving the function of the native valve or the heart muscle; Transmyocardial revascularisation [TMR] devices; Valves implantable in the body
- A61F2/2442—Annuloplasty rings or inserts for correcting the valve shape; Implants for improving the function of a native heart valve
- A61F2/2445—Annuloplasty rings in direct contact with the valve annulus
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2/00—Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
- A61F2/02—Prostheses implantable into the body
- A61F2/24—Heart valves ; Vascular valves, e.g. venous valves; Heart implants, e.g. passive devices for improving the function of the native valve or the heart muscle; Transmyocardial revascularisation [TMR] devices; Valves implantable in the body
- A61F2/2442—Annuloplasty rings or inserts for correcting the valve shape; Implants for improving the function of a native heart valve
- A61F2/2445—Annuloplasty rings in direct contact with the valve annulus
- A61F2/2448—D-shaped rings
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2/00—Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
- A61F2/02—Prostheses implantable into the body
- A61F2/24—Heart valves ; Vascular valves, e.g. venous valves; Heart implants, e.g. passive devices for improving the function of the native valve or the heart muscle; Transmyocardial revascularisation [TMR] devices; Valves implantable in the body
- A61F2/2442—Annuloplasty rings or inserts for correcting the valve shape; Implants for improving the function of a native heart valve
- A61F2/246—Devices for obstructing a leak through a native valve in a closed condition
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2/00—Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
- A61F2/02—Prostheses implantable into the body
- A61F2/24—Heart valves ; Vascular valves, e.g. venous valves; Heart implants, e.g. passive devices for improving the function of the native valve or the heart muscle; Transmyocardial revascularisation [TMR] devices; Valves implantable in the body
- A61F2/2442—Annuloplasty rings or inserts for correcting the valve shape; Implants for improving the function of a native heart valve
- A61F2/2463—Implants forming part of the valve leaflets
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2/00—Filters implantable into blood vessels; Prostheses, i.e. artificial substitutes or replacements for parts of the body; Appliances for connecting them with the body; Devices providing patency to, or preventing collapsing of, tubular structures of the body, e.g. stents
- A61F2/02—Prostheses implantable into the body
- A61F2/24—Heart valves ; Vascular valves, e.g. venous valves; Heart implants, e.g. passive devices for improving the function of the native valve or the heart muscle; Transmyocardial revascularisation [TMR] devices; Valves implantable in the body
- A61F2/2442—Annuloplasty rings or inserts for correcting the valve shape; Implants for improving the function of a native heart valve
- A61F2/2466—Delivery devices therefor
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61L—METHODS OR APPARATUS FOR STERILISING MATERIALS OR OBJECTS IN GENERAL; DISINFECTION, STERILISATION OR DEODORISATION OF AIR; CHEMICAL ASPECTS OF BANDAGES, DRESSINGS, ABSORBENT PADS OR SURGICAL ARTICLES; MATERIALS FOR BANDAGES, DRESSINGS, ABSORBENT PADS OR SURGICAL ARTICLES
- A61L27/00—Materials for grafts or prostheses or for coating grafts or prostheses
- A61L27/02—Inorganic materials
- A61L27/04—Metals or alloys
- A61L27/06—Titanium or titanium alloys
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61L—METHODS OR APPARATUS FOR STERILISING MATERIALS OR OBJECTS IN GENERAL; DISINFECTION, STERILISATION OR DEODORISATION OF AIR; CHEMICAL ASPECTS OF BANDAGES, DRESSINGS, ABSORBENT PADS OR SURGICAL ARTICLES; MATERIALS FOR BANDAGES, DRESSINGS, ABSORBENT PADS OR SURGICAL ARTICLES
- A61L27/00—Materials for grafts or prostheses or for coating grafts or prostheses
- A61L27/14—Macromolecular materials
- A61L27/16—Macromolecular materials obtained by reactions only involving carbon-to-carbon unsaturated bonds
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61L—METHODS OR APPARATUS FOR STERILISING MATERIALS OR OBJECTS IN GENERAL; DISINFECTION, STERILISATION OR DEODORISATION OF AIR; CHEMICAL ASPECTS OF BANDAGES, DRESSINGS, ABSORBENT PADS OR SURGICAL ARTICLES; MATERIALS FOR BANDAGES, DRESSINGS, ABSORBENT PADS OR SURGICAL ARTICLES
- A61L27/00—Materials for grafts or prostheses or for coating grafts or prostheses
- A61L27/50—Materials characterised by their function or physical properties, e.g. injectable or lubricating compositions, shape-memory materials, surface modified materials
- A61L27/56—Porous materials, e.g. foams or sponges
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61B—DIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
- A61B17/00—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets
- A61B17/00234—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets for minimally invasive surgery
- A61B2017/00238—Type of minimally invasive operation
- A61B2017/00243—Type of minimally invasive operation cardiac
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61B—DIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
- A61B17/00—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets
- A61B2017/00526—Methods of manufacturing
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61B—DIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
- A61B17/00—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets
- A61B2017/00535—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets pneumatically or hydraulically operated
- A61B2017/00557—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets pneumatically or hydraulically operated inflatable
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61B—DIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
- A61B17/00—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets
- A61B2017/00743—Type of operation; Specification of treatment sites
- A61B2017/00778—Operations on blood vessels
- A61B2017/00783—Valvuloplasty
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61B—DIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
- A61B17/00—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets
- A61B2017/00831—Material properties
- A61B2017/00867—Material properties shape memory effect
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61B—DIAGNOSIS; SURGERY; IDENTIFICATION
- A61B17/00—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets
- A61B17/04—Surgical instruments, devices or methods, e.g. tourniquets for suturing wounds; Holders or packages for needles or suture materials
- A61B17/0401—Suture anchors, buttons or pledgets, i.e. means for attaching sutures to bone, cartilage or soft tissue; Instruments for applying or removing suture anchors
- A61B2017/0464—Suture anchors, buttons or pledgets, i.e. means for attaching sutures to bone, cartilage or soft tissue; Instruments for applying or removing suture anchors for soft tissue
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2210/00—Particular material properties of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
- A61F2210/0014—Particular material properties of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof using shape memory or superelastic materials, e.g. nitinol
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2220/00—Fixations or connections for prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
- A61F2220/0008—Fixation appliances for connecting prostheses to the body
- A61F2220/0016—Fixation appliances for connecting prostheses to the body with sharp anchoring protrusions, e.g. barbs, pins, spikes
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2220/00—Fixations or connections for prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
- A61F2220/0025—Connections or couplings between prosthetic parts, e.g. between modular parts; Connecting elements
- A61F2220/0041—Connections or couplings between prosthetic parts, e.g. between modular parts; Connecting elements using additional screws, bolts, dowels or rivets, e.g. connecting screws
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2220/00—Fixations or connections for prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
- A61F2220/0025—Connections or couplings between prosthetic parts, e.g. between modular parts; Connecting elements
- A61F2220/0091—Connections or couplings between prosthetic parts, e.g. between modular parts; Connecting elements connected by a hinged linkage mechanism, e.g. of the single-bar or multi-bar linkage type
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2230/00—Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
- A61F2230/0063—Three-dimensional shapes
- A61F2230/0091—Three-dimensional shapes helically-coiled or spirally-coiled, i.e. having a 2-D spiral cross-section
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2230/00—Geometry of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
- A61F2230/0063—Three-dimensional shapes
- A61F2230/0093—Umbrella-shaped, e.g. mushroom-shaped
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2240/00—Manufacturing or designing of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
- A61F2240/001—Designing or manufacturing processes
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61F—FILTERS IMPLANTABLE INTO BLOOD VESSELS; PROSTHESES; DEVICES PROVIDING PATENCY TO, OR PREVENTING COLLAPSING OF, TUBULAR STRUCTURES OF THE BODY, e.g. STENTS; ORTHOPAEDIC, NURSING OR CONTRACEPTIVE DEVICES; FOMENTATION; TREATMENT OR PROTECTION OF EYES OR EARS; BANDAGES, DRESSINGS OR ABSORBENT PADS; FIRST-AID KITS
- A61F2250/00—Special features of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof
- A61F2250/0003—Special features of prostheses classified in groups A61F2/00 - A61F2/26 or A61F2/82 or A61F9/00 or A61F11/00 or subgroups thereof having an inflatable pocket filled with fluid, e.g. liquid or gas
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61L—METHODS OR APPARATUS FOR STERILISING MATERIALS OR OBJECTS IN GENERAL; DISINFECTION, STERILISATION OR DEODORISATION OF AIR; CHEMICAL ASPECTS OF BANDAGES, DRESSINGS, ABSORBENT PADS OR SURGICAL ARTICLES; MATERIALS FOR BANDAGES, DRESSINGS, ABSORBENT PADS OR SURGICAL ARTICLES
- A61L2430/00—Materials or treatment for tissue regeneration
- A61L2430/20—Materials or treatment for tissue regeneration for reconstruction of the heart, e.g. heart valves
Definitions
- the native heart valves i.e., the aortic, pulmonary, tricuspid, and mitral valves
- These heart valves can be damaged, and thus rendered less effective, by congenital malformations, inflammatory processes, infectious conditions, disease, etc. Such damage to the valves can result in serious cardiovascular compromise or death. Damaged valves can be surgically repaired or replaced during open heart surgery. However, open heart surgeries are highly invasive and complications may occur. Transvascular techniques can be used to introduce and implant prosthetic devices in a manner that is much less invasive than open heart surgery.
- a transseptal technique could be used, e.g., comprising inserting a catheter into the right femoral vein, up the inferior vena cava and into the right atrium, puncturing the septum, and passing the catheter into the left atrium.
- a healthy heart has a generally conical shape that tapers to a lower apex.
- the heart is four-chambered and comprises the left atrium, right atrium, left ventricle, and right ventricle.
- the left and right sides of the heart are separated by a wall generally referred to as the septum.
- the native mitral valve of the human heart connects the left atrium to the left ventricle.
- the mitral valve has a very different anatomy than other native heart valves.
- the mitral valve includes an annulus portion, which is an annular portion of the native valve tissue surrounding the mitral valve orifice, and a pair of cusps, or leaflets, extending downward from the annulus into the left ventricle.
- the mitral valve annulus can form a “D”-shaped, oval, or otherwise out-of-round cross-sectional shape having major and minor axes.
- the anterior leaflet can be larger than the posterior leaflet, forming a generally “C”-shaped boundary between the abutting sides of the leaflets when they are closed together.
- the anterior leaflet and the posterior leaflet function together as a one-way valve to allow blood to flow only from the left atrium to the left ventricle.
- the left atrium receives oxygenated blood from the pulmonary veins.
- the muscles of the left atrium contract and the left ventricle dilates (also referred to as “ventricular diastole” or “diastole”), the oxygenated blood that is collected in the left atrium flows into the left ventricle.
- ventricular systole When the muscles of the left atrium relax and the muscles of the left ventricle contract (also referred to as “ventricular systole” or “systole”), the increased blood pressure in the left ventricle urges the sides of the two leaflets together, thereby closing the one-way mitral valve so that blood cannot flow back to the left atrium and is instead expelled out of the left ventricle through the aortic valve.
- chordae tendineae tether the leaflets to papillary muscles in the left ventricle.
- Mitral regurgitation occurs when the native mitral valve fails to close properly and blood flows into the left atrium from the left ventricle during the systolic phase of heart contraction. Mitral regurgitation is one of the most common forms of valvular heart disease. Mitral regurgitation can have many different causes, such as leaflet prolapse, dysfunctional papillary muscles, stretching of the mitral valve annulus resulting from dilation of the left ventricle, more than one of these, etc. Mitral regurgitation at a central portion of the leaflets can be referred to as central jet mitral regurgitation and mitral regurgitation nearer to one commissure (i.e., location where the leaflets meet) of the leaflets can be referred to as eccentric jet mitral regurgitation. Central jet regurgitation occurs when the edges of the leaflets do not meet in the middle and thus the valve does not close, and regurgitation is present.
- a technique for treating mitral and other valvular regurgitation in patients may include securing edges of the native valve leaflets directly to one another.
- a catheter delivered clip may be used to attempt to clip the sides of the leaflets together at the end portions of the leaflets.
- An example implantable prosthetic device has a coaption element (while the term coaption element is used throughout this application, this can also be referred to as a coaptation element, a spacer, etc.) and at least one anchor.
- the coaption element is configured to be positioned within the native heart valve orifice to help fill a space where the native valve is regurgitant and form a more effective seal.
- the coaption element can have a structure that is impervious to blood.
- the coaption element can be connected to leaflets of the native valve by the anchor.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a strip of material, and a pair of paddles.
- a coaption element is formed from or comprises the strip of material.
- the pair of paddles is formed from or comprises the strip of material and are connected to the coaption element. The pair of paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- strip of material in the various embodiments described throughout this disclosure can be a single unitary strip or piece of a material. However, in some embodiments, the “strip of material” can be formed of multiple smaller discreet pieces of one or more materials combine into a larger composite strip of material.
- a strip of material is folded to form a coaption element and a pair of paddles connected to the coaption element.
- the paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient.
- a portion of the strip of material forming the coaption element is attached to a collar.
- a portion of the strip of material forming the paddles is attached to a cap. Movement of the cap toward the collar causes the pair of paddles to move to the closed position. Movement of the cap away from the collar causes the pair of paddles to move to the open position.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient has a coaption element and a pair of paddles.
- the coaption element has four layers.
- the pair of paddles is connected to the coaption element.
- the paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a strip of material and a collar.
- a coaption element is formed from the strip of material.
- a collar is connected to the coaption element.
- a pair of paddles is formed from the strip of material and connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position by moving the collar toward and away from the paddles.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a collar, a coaption element, and a pair of paddles.
- the collar has a plurality of engagement portions configured to releasably engage a delivery apparatus.
- the coaption element is attached to the collar.
- the pair of paddles are connected to the coaption element are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- the paddles are circumferentially disposed between the engagement portions.
- the paddles are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a coaption element, a pair of paddles, and a covering.
- the pair of paddles is connected to the coaption element.
- the paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- a catch point e.g., a point that might snag or catch on a portion of the delivery system and interfere with deployment and/or recapture of the device
- a cover connected to the coaption element and the paddles that covers the catch point.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a coaption element, a pair of paddles, a first cover, and a second cover.
- the pair of paddles is connected to the coaption element and are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- a first cover extends from a distal end of the device and covers at least a portion of the paddles.
- a second cover extending from a proximal end of the device and covers at least a portion of the coaption element.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient is made from a strip of material.
- the strip of material has first and second edges surrounding a central portion.
- a coaption element is formed from the strip of material.
- a pair of paddles is formed from the strip of material. The pair of paddles are connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a strip of material, a pair of attachment portions, a pair of extension members, and a cap.
- a coaption element is formed from the strip of material.
- the pair of extension members have attachment portions.
- a pair of paddles are formed from the strip of material.
- the pair of paddles are connected to the coaption element.
- the paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- the paddles are disposed over the extension members.
- the cap is attached to the paddles. Movement of the cap toward the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the closed position. Movement of the cap away from the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the open position.
- the cap includes a retention body, a retaining nut, and a retaining bolt.
- the retention body has a locking aperture for receiving the attachment portions of the extension members.
- the retaining nut is inserted into the locking aperture.
- the retaining bolt for secures the retaining nut within the locking aperture.
- a strip of material is folded to form a coaption element and a pair of paddles connected to the coaption element.
- the paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient.
- the portion of the strip of material forming the paddles is attached to a cap. Movement of the cap toward the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the closed position. Movement of the cap away from the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the open position.
- the cap includes a retention body, a retaining nut, and a retaining bolt.
- the retention body has a locking aperture for receiving attachment portions of extension members.
- the retaining nut is configured to insert into the locking aperture.
- the retaining bolt secures the retaining nut within the locking aperture.
- a pair of extension members are attached to the retention body of the cap via the attachment portions of the extension members such that the paddles are disposed over the extension members. The retaining bolt and the retaining nut are assembled to secure the cap to the strip of material.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a strip of material, a cap, and a pair of extension members.
- a coaption element is formed from the strip of material.
- a pair of paddles are formed from the strip of material and are connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient.
- a cap is attached to the paddles. Movement of the cap toward the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the closed position. Movement of the cap away from the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the open position.
- the pair of extension members are connected to the cap and are moveable between an open position and a closed position. In the closed position the extension members are biased in a closing direction.
- a strip of material formed from shape-memory alloy is folded around a jig to form both a coaption element and a pair of paddles connected to the coaption element.
- the paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient.
- the strip of shape memory material is heat treated to shape-set the strip of material in the shape of the coaption element and paddles.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a strip of material, a cap, and a pair of extension members.
- a coaption element is formed from the strip of material.
- a pair of paddles is formed from the strip of material and is connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient.
- the cap is attached to the paddles. Movement of the cap toward the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the closed position. Movement of the cap away from the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the open position.
- the pair of extension members is connected to the cap and the paddles. The extension members extend from attachment portions for attaching the extension members to the cap to end portions that are attached to the strip material forming the paddles. The end portions of the extension members extend beyond the strip of material.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a main coaption element, at least one auxiliary coaption element, and a pair of paddles.
- the at least one auxiliary coaption element is connected to the coaption element.
- the pair of paddles is connected to the main coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a coaption element, a pair of paddles connected to the coaption element, and a pair of paddle frames.
- the paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- the paddles are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient.
- the first and second first paddle frames have spaced apart frame portions that are parallel or substantially parallel when the paddles are in a closed position to form rectangular shaped leaflet engagement areas.
- first and second repair devices are installed on a pair of leaflets of the native heart valve.
- the repair devices each have a frame with a rectangular or substantially rectangular shape.
- the paddle frames of the installed repair devices are adjacent to one another and are parallel or substantially parallel to one another.
- the foregoing method and other treatment methods herein can be performed on a living animal or on a simulation, such as on a cadaver, cadaver heart, simulator (e.g. with the body parts, tissue, etc. being simulated), etc.
- a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a pair of paddles and a pair of clasps.
- the paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- Each clasp has at least one barb, a barb support portion, a moveable arm, and a flexible portion between the barb support portion and the moveable arm.
- the flexible portion is configured to allow the barb support portion to flex away from the moveable arm.
- FIG. 1 illustrates a cutaway view of the human heart in a diastolic phase
- FIG. 2 illustrates a cutaway view of the human heart in a systolic phase
- FIG. 2A is another cutaway view of the human heart in a systolic phase
- FIG. 2B is the cutaway view of FIG. 2A annotated to illustrate a natural shape of mitral valve leaflets in the systolic phase;
- FIG. 3 illustrates a cutaway view of the human heart in a diastolic phase, in which the chordae tendineae are shown attaching the leaflets of the mitral and tricuspid valves to ventricle walls;
- FIG. 4 illustrates a healthy mitral valve with the leaflets closed as viewed from an atrial side of the mitral valve
- FIG. 5 illustrates a dysfunctional mitral valve with a visible gap between the leaflets as viewed from an atrial side of the mitral valve
- FIG. 6 illustrates a mitral valve having a wide gap between the posterior leaflet and the anterior leaflet
- FIG. 6A illustrates a coaption element in the gap of the mitral valve as viewed from an atrial side of the mitral valve
- FIG. 6B illustrates a valve repair device attached to mitral valve leaflets with the coaption element in the gap of the mitral valve as viewed from a ventricular side of the mitral valve;
- FIG. 6C is a perspective view of a valve repair device attached to mitral valve leaflets with the coaption element in the gap of the mitral valve shown from a ventricular side of the mitral valve;
- FIG. 6D is a schematic view illustrating a path of mitral valve leaflets along each side of a coaption element of an example mitral valve repair device
- FIG. 6E is a top schematic view illustrating a path of mitral valve leaflets around a coaption element of an example native valve repair device
- FIG. 7 illustrates a tricuspid valve viewed from an atrial side of the tricuspid valve
- FIGS. 8-14 show an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device, in various stages of deployment
- FIG. 11A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device that is similar to the device illustrated by FIG. 11 , but where the paddles are independently controllable;
- FIGS. 15-20 show the implantable prosthetic device of FIGS. 8-14 being delivered and implanted within the native valve
- FIG. 21 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device or frame of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 22 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device or frame of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 23-25 show example embodiments of an implantable prosthetic device or component of an implantable medical device
- FIGS. 26 and 27 show an example embodiment of a barbed clasp for use in an implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 28-32 show example embodiments of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 32A and 32B are perspective views of a cap and a coaption element insert of the implantable prosthetic device of FIGS. 28-32 in sealed and spaced apart positions, respectively;
- FIG. 33 shows a barbed clasp for use in an implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 34 shows a portion of native valve tissue grasped by a barbed clasp
- FIGS. 35-46 show an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device being delivered and implanted within the native valve
- FIG. 47 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a closed position
- FIG. 47A shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a closed position
- FIG. 48 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device with barbed clasps in a closed position
- FIG. 48A shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device with barbed clasps in a closed position
- FIG. 48B shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device with barbed clasps in a closed position, the device being attached to a deployment device;
- FIG. 48C shows a side view of the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 48B , the device being provided with a cover;
- FIG. 48D shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 48B , the device being attached to a deployment device;
- FIG. 48E shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 48D , the device being provided with a cover;
- FIG. 48F shows a side view of the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 48B with barbed clasps in the closed position;
- FIG. 48G shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 48F ;
- FIG. 48H shows a bottom view of the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 48F ;
- FIG. 49 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a partially-open position
- FIG. 50 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a partially-open position with barbed clasps in an open position
- FIG. 51 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a partially-open position with barbed clasps in a closed position
- FIG. 52 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a half-open position
- FIG. 53 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a half-open position with barbed clasps in a closed position
- FIG. 53A shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a half-open position with barbed clasps in a closed position
- FIG. 53B shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 53A ;
- FIG. 53C shows a side view the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 53A , the device being provided with a cover;
- FIG. 53D shows a front view the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 53A , the device being provided with a cover;
- FIG. 54 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a half-open position with barbed clasps in an open position
- FIG. 54A shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a half-open position with barbed clasps in an open position
- FIG. 54B shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 54A ;
- FIG. 54C shows a side view the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 54A , the device being provided with a cover;
- FIG. 54D shows a front view the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 54A , the device being provided with a cover;
- FIG. 55 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a three-quarters-open position
- FIG. 56 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a three-quarters-open position with barbed clasps in a closed position
- FIG. 57 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a three-quarters-open position with barbed clasps in an open position
- FIG. 58 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps near a full bailout position or near a fully-open position
- FIG. 59 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a full bailout position or a fully-open position
- FIG. 60 shows a side view of an example implantable in a full bailout position with barbed clasps in a closed position
- FIG. 60A shows a side view of an example implantable in a full bailout position with barbed clasps in a closed position
- FIG. 60B shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 60A ;
- FIG. 60C shows a side view the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 60A , the device being provided with a cover;
- FIG. 60D shows a front view the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 60A , the device being provided with a cover;
- FIG. 61 shows a side view of an example implantable in a full bailout position with barbed clasps in an open position
- FIG. 61A shows a side view of an example implantable in a full bailout position with barbed clasps in an open position
- FIG. 61B shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 61A ;
- FIG. 61C shows a side view the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 61A , the device being provided with a cover;
- FIG. 61D shows a front view the example implantable prosthetic device according to FIG. 61A , the device being provided with a cover;
- FIGS. 62A-62B illustrate the movement of the paddles of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 63A-63C illustrate the movement of the paddles of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 64A-64C illustrate the movement of the paddles of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 65 shows a perspective view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a closed position
- FIG. 65A shows a perspective view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a closed position
- FIG. 66 shows a perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 66A shows a perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A ;
- FIG. 67 shows a front view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 67A shows a front view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A ;
- FIG. 68 shows a front view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 with additional components
- FIG. 68A shows a front view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A with additional components
- FIG. 69 shows a side view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 70 shows a top view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 70A shows a top view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A ;
- FIG. 71 shows a top view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 with a collar component
- FIG. 71A shows a top view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A with a collar component
- FIG. 72 shows a bottom view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 72A shows a bottom view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A ;
- FIG. 73 shows a bottom view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 with a cap component
- FIG. 73A shows a bottom view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A with a cap component
- FIG. 74 shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 sectioned by cross-section plane 75 ;
- FIG. 74A shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A sectioned by cross-section plane 75 A;
- FIG. 75 shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 74 ;
- FIG. 75A shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 74A ;
- FIG. 76 shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 sectioned by cross-section plane 77 ;
- FIG. 76A shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A sectioned by cross-section plane 77 A;
- FIG. 77 shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 76 ;
- FIG. 77A shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 76A ;
- FIG. 78 shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 sectioned by cross-section plane 77 ;
- FIG. 78A shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A sectioned by cross-section plane 77 A;
- FIG. 79 shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 78 ;
- FIG. 79A shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 78A ;
- FIG. 80 shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 sectioned by cross-section plane 81 ;
- FIG. 80A shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A sectioned by cross-section plane 81 A;
- FIG. 81 shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 80 ;
- FIG. 81A shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 80A ;
- FIG. 82 shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 sectioned by cross-section plane 83 ;
- FIG. 82A shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A sectioned by cross-section plane 83 A;
- FIG. 83 shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 82 ;
- FIG. 83A shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 82A ;
- FIG. 84 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs
- FIG. 85 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs
- FIG. 86 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs
- FIG. 86A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs
- FIG. 87 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs
- FIG. 87A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs
- FIG. 88 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs
- FIG. 88A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs
- FIG. 89 shows a perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 89A shows a perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65A ;
- FIG. 90 shows a perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 90A shows a perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65A ;
- FIG. 91 shows a front view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 91A shows a front view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65A ;
- FIG. 92 shows a side view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 92A shows a side view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65A ;
- FIG. 93 shows a top view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 93A shows a top view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65A ;
- FIG. 94 shows a bottom view of a coapting portion and portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 94A shows a bottom view of a coapting portion and portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65A ;
- FIG. 95 shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65 with the section taken across plane 96 ;
- FIG. 95A shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65A with the section taken across plane 96 A;
- FIG. 96 shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions of FIG. 95 ;
- FIG. 96A shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions of FIG. 95A ;
- FIG. 97 shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65 with the section taken across plane 98 ;
- FIG. 97A shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65A with the section taken across plane 98 A;
- FIG. 98 shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions of FIG. 97 ;
- FIG. 98A shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions of FIG. 97A ;
- FIG. 99 shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65 with the section taken across plane 100 ;
- FIG. 99A shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65A with the section taken across plane 100 A;
- FIG. 100 shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions of FIG. 99 ;
- FIG. 100A shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions of FIG. 99A ;
- FIG. 101 shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65 with the section taken across plane 102 ;
- FIG. 101A shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated by FIG. 65A with the section taken across plane 102 A;
- FIG. 102 shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions of FIG. 101 ;
- FIG. 102A shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions of FIG. 101A ;
- FIG. 103 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 104 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 105 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 106 shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition
- FIG. 106A shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition
- FIG. 106B shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition
- FIG. 106C shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition
- FIG. 106D shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition
- FIG. 106E shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition
- FIG. 106F shows an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element
- FIG. 106G shows an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element
- FIG. 106H shows an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element
- FIG. 106I shows an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element
- FIG. 107 shows an end view of the expandable coaption element of FIG. 106 ;
- FIG. 108 shows the expandable coaption element of FIG. 106 in an expanded condition
- FIG. 108A shows the expandable coaption element of FIG. 106A in an expanded condition
- FIG. 108B shows the expandable coaption element of FIG. 106B in an expanded condition
- FIG. 108C shows the expandable coaption element of FIG. 106C in an expanded condition
- FIG. 108D shows the expandable coaption element of FIG. 106D in an expanded condition
- FIG. 108E shows the expandable coaption element of FIG. 106E in an expanded condition
- FIG. 109 shows an end view of the coaption element of FIG. 108 ;
- FIG. 110 shows a side view of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 111 shows an end view of a coaption element of the example prosthetic device of FIG. 110 , taken along lines 111 .
- FIGS. 112-114 show perspective views of an example embodiment of a paddle frame for the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65 ;
- FIG. 112A shows a perspective view of an example embodiment of a paddle frame for the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 65A ;
- FIG. 114A shows a side view of the paddle frame of FIG. 112A ;
- FIG. 115 shows a front view of the paddle frame of FIGS. 112-114 ;
- FIG. 115A shows a top view of the paddle frame of FIG. 112A ;
- FIG. 116 shows a top view of the paddle frame of FIGS. 112-114 ;
- FIG. 116A shows a front view of the paddle frame of FIG. 112A ;
- FIG. 117 shows a side view of the paddle frame of FIGS. 112-114 ;
- FIG. 117A shows a rear view of the paddle frame of FIG. 112A ;
- FIG. 118 shows a bottom view of the paddle frame of FIGS. 112-114 ;
- FIG. 118A shows a bottom view of the paddle frame of FIG. 112A ;
- FIG. 119 shows a front view of the paddle frame of FIGS. 112-114 ;
- FIG. 120 shows a front view of the paddle frame of FIGS. 112-114 in a compressed condition inside a delivery device
- FIG. 121 shows a side view of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device in a closed condition
- FIG. 122 shows a front view of a paddle frame of the example prosthetic device of FIG. 121 ;
- FIG. 123 shows a side view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 121 in an open condition
- FIG. 124 shows a front view of the paddle frame of the open prosthetic device of FIG. 123 ;
- FIG. 125 shows a side view of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device in a closed condition
- FIG. 126 shows a front view of a paddle frame of the example prosthetic device of FIG. 125 ;
- FIG. 127 shows a side view of the implantable prosthetic device of FIG. 125 in a closed condition
- FIG. 128 shows a front view of the paddle frame of the open prosthetic device of FIG. 127 ;
- FIG. 129 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 130-131 show an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 132 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 133-134 show an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 135-136 show an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 137 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 138-143 show use of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 144 shows an example embodiment of a delivery assembly including a delivery device and an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 145 shows a perspective view of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device releasably coupled to a delivery device
- FIG. 146 shows the embodiment of FIG. 145 with the implantable prosthetic device released from to the delivery device
- FIG. 147 shows a cross-sectional view of the coupler of FIG. 145 ;
- FIG. 148 shows a perspective view of the delivery assembly of FIG. 144 with the prosthetic device shown in partial cross-section and some components of the delivery apparatus shown schematically;
- FIG. 149 shows a plan view of a shaft of the delivery device of FIG. 144 ;
- FIG. 150 shows a side elevation view of a proximal end portion of the delivery device of FIG. 144 ;
- FIG. 151 shows a cross-sectional view of the proximal end portion of the delivery device of FIG. 144 , taken along the line 150 - 150 shown in FIG. 150 ;
- FIG. 152 shows an exploded view of the proximal end portion of the delivery device of FIG. 144 ;
- FIGS. 153-160 show an example procedure used to repair a native valve of a heart, which is partially shown;
- FIG. 161 shows an example embodiment of a handle for the delivery apparatus of FIG. 144 ;
- FIG. 162 is an exploded view of the handle of FIG. 161 ;
- FIG. 163 shows an example embodiment of a coupler and a proximal collar for the delivery assembly of FIG. 144 , showing the coupler releasably coupled to the proximal collar;
- FIG. 164 shows a perspective view of the coupler and proximal collar of FIG. 163 , showing the coupler released from the proximal collar;
- FIG. 165 shows example embodiments of a cap, actuation element or means of actuating, and release wire for the delivery assembly of FIG. 144 , showing the cap releasably coupled to the actuation element or means of actuating by the release wire.
- FIG. 166 shows a perspective view of the cap, actuation element or means of actuating, and the release wire of FIG. 163 , showing the cap released from the actuation element or means of actuating and the release wire;
- FIG. 167 shows example embodiments of a coupler, a proximal collar, a cap, and an actuation element or means of actuating of the delivery assembly of FIG. 144 ;
- FIG. 168 shows a perspective view of the coupler and proximal collar of FIG. 167 ;
- FIG. 169 shows an example embodiment of a clasp control member of the delivery apparatus of FIG. 144 ;
- FIG. 170 shows a detail view of the clasp control member of FIG. 169 , taken from the perspective 170 shown in FIG. 169 ;
- FIG. 171 shows an example embodiment of a guide rail for the clasp control member of FIG. 169 ;
- FIG. 172 shows an example embodiment of a shaft of the delivery device of FIG. 144 ;
- FIG. 173 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device
- FIG. 174 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device
- FIG. 174A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device
- FIG. 175 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device
- FIG. 175A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device
- FIG. 176 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device
- FIGS. 177-178 show an example embodiment of a coupler for an example implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 179-181 show an example embodiment of a coupler for an example implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 182-183 show an example embodiment of a coupler for an example implantable prosthetic device
- FIGS. 184-185 show an example embodiment of a coupler for an example implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 186 shows an example embodiment of an actuation element or means of actuating for an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 187 shows an actuation mechanism for an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 188 shows an actuation mechanism for an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 188A shows an actuation mechanism for an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 189 shows an actuation mechanism for an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 190 shows an actuation mechanism for an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 191 is a perspective view of a blank used to make a paddle frame
- FIG. 192 is a perspective view of the blank of FIG. 191 bent to make a paddle frame
- FIG. 193 is a perspective view of a shape-set paddle frame attached to a cap of a valve repair device
- FIG. 194 is a perspective view of the paddle frame of FIG. 193 flexed and attached to inner and outer paddles at a closed position;
- FIG. 195 is a perspective view of two of the paddle frames of FIG. 112A showing the paddle frames in a shape-set position;
- FIG. 196 is a perspective view of the paddle frames of FIG. 195 showing the paddle frames in a loaded position
- FIG. 197 is an enlarged side view of device of FIG. 60C showing the cover
- FIG. 198 is an enlarged side view of the device of FIG. 60C showing the cover
- FIG. 199 shows an exploded view of an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 200 shows an enlarged perspective view of the collar of an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 201 shows an enlarged perspective view of the cap of an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 202 shows an exploded view of the cap of FIG. 206 ;
- FIG. 203 shows a plan view of an inner cover for an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 204 shows a plan view of an outer cover for an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 205 shows an enlarged view of a strip of material for an example prosthetic device
- FIG. 206 shows an end view of the material of FIG. 205 ;
- FIG. 207 shows an end view of the material of FIG. 205 arranged in a plurality of layers
- FIG. 208A shows an example implantable prosthetic device in the gap of the native valve as viewed from an atrial side of the native valve during diastole, with example inflatable spacers in a deflated condition;
- FIG. 208B shows the device of FIG. 208A during systole, with example inflatable spacers in a deflated condition
- FIG. 209A shows the device of FIG. 208A during diastole, with example inflatable spacers in an inflated condition
- FIG. 209B shows the device of FIG. 208A during systole, with example inflatable spacers in an inflated condition
- FIG. 210A shows an example expandable spacer in a compressed condition
- FIG. 210B shows the expandable spacer of FIG. 210A in an expanded condition
- FIG. 211A shows an example implantable prosthetic device, with example inflatable spacers in a deflated condition
- FIG. 211B shows the device of FIG. 211B , with example inflatable spacers in an inflated condition
- FIG. 212A is a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 212B is a front/back view of the device of FIG. 212A ;
- FIG. 213A is a top view of an example auxiliary spacer for attaching to the device of FIG. 212A ;
- FIG. 213B is a side view of the spacer of FIG. 213A ;
- FIG. 214 is a side view of the spacer of FIGS. 213A, 213B being assembled to the device of FIGS. 212A, 212B ;
- FIG. 215A is a side view of the spacer of FIGS. 213A, 213B assembled to the device of FIGS. 212A, 212B ;
- FIG. 215B is a top view of the assembly of FIG. 215A ;
- FIG. 216A is a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 216B is a front/back view of the device of FIG. 216A ;
- FIG. 217A is a top view of an example auxiliary spacer for attaching to the device of FIG. 216A ;
- FIG. 217B is a side view of the spacer of FIG. 217A ;
- FIG. 218 is an example auxiliary spacer
- FIG. 219A is a top view of an example implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 219B is a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device
- FIG. 220A is a top view of example auxiliary spacers
- FIG. 220B is a top view of example auxiliary spacers
- FIG. 220C is a top view of example auxiliary spacers
- FIG. 220D is a top view of example auxiliary spacers
- FIG. 220E is a top view of example auxiliary spacers
- FIG. 221 is a plan view of an example implantable prosthetic device cut from a flat sheet of material
- FIG. 222 is a perspective view of the device of FIG. 221 ;
- FIG. 223 shows the device of FIGS. 221-222 in the gap of the native valve as viewed from an atrial side of the native valve;
- FIG. 224 is a plan view of an example implantable prosthetic device cut from a flat sheet of material
- FIG. 225 is a perspective view of the device of FIG. 224 ;
- FIG. 226 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover
- FIG. 227 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover
- FIG. 228 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover
- FIG. 229 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover
- FIG. 230 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover
- FIG. 231 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover
- FIG. 232A is a front view of an implantable prosthetic device including barbed clasps and substantially parallel paddle frame elements according to an example embodiment
- FIG. 232B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated by lines 232 B- 232 B in FIG. 232A ;
- FIG. 233A is a view similar to FIG. 232A with an annotation of the space between substantially parallel sections of the paddle frame elements;
- FIG. 233B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated by lines 233 B- 233 B in FIG. 233A ;
- FIG. 234A is a view similar to FIG. 232A illustrating engagement of a portion native valve leaflets between the substantially parallel paddle frame elements;
- FIG. 234B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated by lines 234 B- 234 B in FIG. 234A ;
- FIG. 235A is a view similar to the view of FIG. 234A illustrating misaligned native valve leaflets
- FIG. 235B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated by lines 235 B- 235 B in FIG. 235A ;
- FIG. 236 is a side view of an implantable prosthetic device according to an example embodiment
- FIG. 237 is a side view of two adjacent implantable prosthetic devices according to an example embodiment
- FIG. 238A is a side view of an implantable prosthetic device installed on a native valve according to an example embodiment
- FIG. 238B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated by lines 238 B- 238 B in FIG. 238A ;
- FIG. 239A is a side view of two adjacent implantable prosthetic devices installed on a mitral valve according to an example embodiment
- FIG. 239B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated by lines 239 B- 239 B in FIG. 239A ;
- FIG. 240A is a view similar to the view of FIG. 239A illustrating two adjacent but misaligned implantable prosthetic devices
- FIG. 240B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated by lines 240 B- 240 B in FIG. 240A ;
- FIG. 241 is a perspective view of a portion of a clasp with a flexible barb support according to an example embodiment
- FIG. 242 is the portion of a clasp of FIG. 241 where the barb support is bent back to illustrate the flexible nature of the barb support in an example embodiment
- FIGS. 243A-243H are schematic illustrations of the clasp with a flexible barb support of FIG. 242 releasing from a valve leaflet;
- FIGS. 244A-244E are schematic illustrations of an implantable prosthetic device with a clasp and flexible barb support releasing from a valve leaflet;
- FIGS. 245A-245E are illustrations of an implantable prosthetic device with a clasp and flexible barb support releasing from a valve leaflet
- FIG. 246 is an illustration of an implantable device exerting force on a single leaflet to illustrate a circumstance in which a clasp may be released from a native valve leaflet.
- Example embodiments of the present disclosure are directed to devices and methods for repairing a defective heart valve. It should be noted that various embodiments of native valve reparation devices and systems for delivery are disclosed herein, and any combination of these options can be made unless specifically excluded. In other words, individual components of the disclosed devices and systems can be combined unless mutually exclusive or otherwise physically impossible.
- interconnection when one or more components are described as being connected, joined, affixed, coupled, attached, or otherwise interconnected, such interconnection may be direct as between the components or may be indirect such as through the use of one or more intermediary components.
- reference to a “member,” “component,” or “portion” shall not be limited to a single structural member, component, or element but can include an assembly of components, members, or elements.
- the terms “substantially” and “about” are defined as at least close to (and includes) a given value or state (preferably within 10% of, more preferably within 1% of, and most preferably within 0.1% of).
- FIGS. 1 and 2 are cutaway views of the human heart H in diastolic and systolic phases, respectively.
- the right ventricle RV and left ventricle LV are separated from the right atrium RA and left atrium LA, respectively, by the tricuspid valve TV and mitral valve MV; i.e., the atrioventricular valves.
- the aortic valve AV separates the left ventricle LV from the ascending aorta AA
- the pulmonary valve PV separates the right ventricle from the pulmonary artery PA.
- Each of these valves has flexible leaflets (e.g., leaflets 20 , 22 shown in FIGS.
- the native valve repair systems of the present application are described primarily with respect to the mitral valve MV. Therefore, anatomical structures of the left atrium LA and left ventricle LV will be explained in greater detail. It should be understood that the devices described herein may also be used in repairing other native valves, e.g., the devices can be used in repairing the tricuspid valve TV, the aortic valve AV, and the pulmonary valve PV.
- the left atrium LA receives oxygenated blood from the lungs.
- the blood that was previously collected in the left atrium LA moves through the mitral valve MV and into the left ventricle LV by expansion of the left ventricle LV.
- the left ventricle LV contracts to force the blood through the aortic valve AV and ascending aorta AA into the body.
- the leaflets of the mitral valve MV close to prevent the blood from regurgitating from the left ventricle LV and back into the left atrium LA, and blood is collected in the left atrium from the pulmonary vein.
- the devices described by the present application are used to repair the function of a defective mitral valve MV. That is, the devices are configured to help close the leaflets of the mitral valve to prevent blood from regurgitating from the left ventricle LV and back into the left atrium LA.
- the devices described in the present application are designed to easily grasp and secure the native leaflets around a coaption element that acts as a filler in the regurgitant orifice.
- the mitral valve MV includes two leaflets, the anterior leaflet 20 and the posterior leaflet 22 .
- the mitral valve MV also includes an annulus 24 , which is a variably dense fibrous ring of tissues that encircles the leaflets 20 , 22 .
- the mitral valve MV is anchored to the wall of the left ventricle LV by chordae tendineae 10 .
- the chordae tendineae 10 are cord-like tendons that connect the papillary muscles 12 (i.e., the muscles located at the base of the chordae tendineae and within the walls of the left ventricle) to the leaflets 20 , 22 of the mitral valve MV.
- the papillary muscles 12 serve to limit the movements of the mitral valve MV and prevent the mitral valve from being reverted.
- the mitral valve MV opens and closes in response to pressure changes in the left atrium LA and the left ventricle LV.
- the papillary muscles do not open or close the mitral valve MV. Rather, the papillary muscles brace the mitral valve MV against the high pressure needed to circulate blood throughout the body.
- the papillary muscles and the chordae tendineae are known as the subvalvular apparatus, which functions to keep the mitral valve MV from prolapsing into the left atrium LA when the mitral valve closes.
- Various disease processes can impair proper function of one or more of the native valves of the heart H.
- These disease processes include degenerative processes (e.g., Barlow's Disease, fibroelastic deficiency), inflammatory processes (e.g., Rheumatic Heart Disease), and infectious processes (e.g., endocarditis).
- degenerative processes e.g., Barlow's Disease, fibroelastic deficiency
- inflammatory processes e.g., Rheumatic Heart Disease
- infectious processes e.g., endocarditis
- damage to the left ventricle LV or the right ventricle RV from prior heart attacks i.e., myocardial infarction secondary to coronary artery disease
- other heart diseases e.g., cardiomyopathy
- valve stenosis occurs when a native valve does not open completely and thereby causes an obstruction of blood flow.
- valve stenosis results from buildup of calcified material on the leaflets of a valve, which causes the leaflets to thicken and impairs the ability of the valve to fully open to permit forward blood flow.
- valve regurgitation occurs when the leaflets of the valve do not close completely thereby causing blood to leak back into the prior chamber (e.g., causing blood to leak from the left ventricle to the left atrium).
- a Carpentier type I malfunction involves the dilation of the annulus such that normally functioning leaflets are distracted from each other and fail to form a tight seal (i.e., the leaflets do not coapt properly). Included in a type I mechanism malfunction are perforations of the leaflets, as are present in endocarditis.
- a Carpentier's type II malfunction involves prolapse of one or more leaflets of a native valve above a plane of coaption.
- a Carpentier's type III malfunction involves restriction of the motion of one or more leaflets of a native valve such that the leaflets are abnormally constrained below the plane of the annulus.
- Leaflet restriction can be caused by rheumatic disease (Ma) or dilation of a ventricle (IIIb).
- a healthy mitral valve MV when a healthy mitral valve MV is in a closed position, the anterior leaflet 20 and the posterior leaflet 22 coapt, which prevents blood from leaking from the left ventricle LV to the left atrium LA.
- regurgitation occurs when the anterior leaflet 20 and/or the posterior leaflet 22 of the mitral valve MV is displaced into the left atrium LA during systole. This failure to coapt causes a gap 26 between the anterior leaflet 20 and the posterior leaflet 22 , which allows blood to flow back into the left atrium LA from the left ventricle LV during systole.
- a leaflet e.g. leaflets 20 , 22 of mitral valve MV
- may malfunction which can thereby lead to regurgitation.
- the mitral valve MV of a patient can have a wide gap 26 between the anterior leaflet 20 and the posterior leaflet 22 when the mitral valve is in a closed position (i.e., during the systolic phase).
- the gap 26 can have a width W between about 2.5 mm and about 17.5 mm, such as between about 5 mm and about 15 mm, such as between about 7.5 mm and about 12.5 mm, such as about 10 mm.
- the gap 3002 can have a width W greater than 15 mm.
- a valve repair device is desired that is capable of engaging the anterior leaflet 20 and the posterior leaflet 22 to close the gap 26 and prevent regurgitation of blood through the mitral valve MV.
- stenosis or regurgitation can affect any valve
- stenosis is predominantly found to affect either the aortic valve AV or the pulmonary valve PV
- regurgitation is predominantly found to affect either the mitral valve MV or the tricuspid valve TV.
- Both valve stenosis and valve regurgitation increase the workload of the heart H and may lead to very serious conditions if left un-treated; such as endocarditis, congestive heart failure, permanent heart damage, cardiac arrest, and ultimately death.
- the left side of the heart i.e., the left atrium LA, the left ventricle LV, the mitral valve MV, and the aortic valve AV
- the mitral valve MV or the aortic valve AV is particularly problematic and often life threatening. Accordingly, because of the substantially higher pressures on the left side of the heart, dysfunction of the mitral valve MV or the aortic valve AV is often more problematic.
- Malfunctioning native heart valves may either be repaired or replaced. Repair typically involves the preservation and correction of the patient's native valve. Replacement typically involves replacing the patient's native valve with a biological or mechanical substitute. Typically, the aortic valve AV and pulmonary valve PV are more prone to stenosis. Because stenotic damage sustained by the leaflets is irreversible, the most conventional treatments for a stenotic aortic valve or stenotic pulmonary valve are removal and replacement of the valve with a surgically implanted heart valve, or displacement of the valve with a transcatheter heart valve.
- the mitral valve MV and the tricuspid valve TV are more prone to deformation of leaflets, which, as described above, prevents the mitral valve or tricuspid valve from closing properly and allows for regurgitation or back flow of blood from the ventricle into the atrium (e.g., a deformed mitral valve MV may allow for regurgitation or back flow from the left ventricle LV to the left atrium LA).
- the regurgitation or back flow of blood from the ventricle to the atrium results in valvular insufficiency.
- Deformations in the structure or shape of the mitral valve MV or the tricuspid valve TV are often repairable.
- chordae tendineae 10 can become dysfunctional (e.g., the chordae tendineae may stretch or rupture), which allows the anterior leaflet 20 and the posterior leaflet 22 to be reverted such that blood is regurgitated into the left atrium LA.
- the problems occurring due to dysfunctional chordae tendineae 10 can be repaired by repairing the chordae tendineae or the structure of the mitral valve (e.g., by securing the leaflets 20 , 22 at the affected portion of the mitral valve).
- any of the devices and concepts provided herein can be used to repair the tricuspid valve TV.
- any of the devices and concepts provided herein can be used between any two of the anterior leaflet 30 , septal leaflet 32 , and posterior leaflet 34 to prevent regurgitation of blood from the right ventricle into the right atrium.
- any of the devices and concepts provided herein can be used on all three of the leaflets 30 , 32 , 34 together to prevent regurgitation of blood from the right ventricle to the right atrium. That is, the valve repair devices provided herein can be centrally located between the three leaflets 30 , 32 , 34 .
- An example implantable prosthetic device has a coaption element and at least one anchor.
- the coaption element is configured to be positioned within the native heart valve orifice to help fill the space and form a more effective seal, thereby reducing or preventing regurgitation described above.
- the coaption element can have a structure that is impervious or resistant to blood and that allows the native leaflets to close around the coaption element during ventricular systole to block blood from flowing from the left or right ventricle back into the left or right atrium, respectively.
- the prosthetic device can be configured to seal against two or three native valve leaflets; that is, the device may be used in the native mitral (bicuspid) and tricuspid valves.
- the coaption element is sometimes referred to herein as a spacer because the coaption element can fill a space between improperly functioning native mitral or tricuspid leaflets that do not close completely.
- the coaption element (e.g., spacer, coaptation element, etc.) can have various shapes.
- the coaption element can have an elongated cylindrical shape having a round cross-sectional shape.
- the coaption element can have an oval cross-sectional shape, a crescent cross-sectional shape, a rectangular cross-sectional shape, or various other non-cylindrical shapes.
- the coaption element can have an atrial portion positioned in or adjacent to the left atrium, a ventricular or lower portion positioned in or adjacent to the left ventricle, and a side surface that extends between the native mitral leaflets.
- the atrial or upper portion is positioned in or adjacent to the right atrium, and the ventricular or lower portion is positioned in or adjacent to the right ventricle, and the side surface that extends between the native tricuspid leaflets.
- the anchor can be configured to secure the device to one or both of the native mitral leaflets such that the coaption element is positioned between the two native leaflets.
- the anchor is configured to secure the device to one, two, or three of the tricuspid leaflets such that the coaption element is positioned between the three native leaflets.
- the anchor can attach to the coaption element at a location adjacent the ventricular portion of the coaption element.
- the anchor can attach to an actuation element, such as a shaft or actuation wire, to which the coaption element is also attached.
- the anchor and the coaption element can be positioned independently with respect to each other by separately moving each of the anchor and the coaption element along the longitudinal axis of the shaft or actuation wire. In some embodiments, the anchor and the coaption element can be positioned simultaneously by moving the anchor and the coaption element together along the longitudinal axis of the shaft or actuation wire.
- the anchor can be configured to be positioned behind a native leaflet when implanted such that the leaflet is grasped by the anchor.
- the prosthetic device can be configured to be implanted via a delivery sheath.
- the coaption element and the anchor can be compressible to a radially compressed state and can be self-expandable to a radially expanded state when compressive pressure is released.
- the device can be configured for the anchor to be expanded radially away from the still-compressed coaption element initially in order to create a gap between the coaption element and the anchor. A native leaflet can then be positioned in the gap.
- the coaption element can be expanded radially, closing the gap between the coaption element and the anchor and capturing the leaflet between the coaption element and the anchor.
- the anchor and coaption element are optionally configured to self-expand.
- the disclosed prosthetic devices can be configured such that the anchor is connected to a leaflet, taking advantage of the tension from native chordae tendineae to resist high systolic pressure urging the device toward the left atrium. During diastole, the devices can rely on the compressive and retention forces exerted on the leaflet that is grasped by the anchor.
- the device 100 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the device 100 can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- any suitable valve repair system e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application.
- the device 100 is deployed from a delivery sheath or means for delivery 102 and includes a coaptation portion 104 and an anchor portion 106 .
- the coaptation portion 104 of the device 100 includes a coaption element or means for coapting 110 that is adapted to be implanted between the leaflets of a native valve (e.g., a native mitral valve, tricuspid valve, etc.) and is slidably attached to an actuation element 112 (e.g., actuation wire, actuation shaft, actuation tube, etc.).
- the anchor portion 106 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like.
- Actuation of the actuation element or means for actuating 112 opens and closes the anchor portion 106 of the device 100 to grasp the native valve leaflets during implantation.
- the actuation element 112 e.g., wire, shaft, tube, screw, line, etc.
- the actuation element can take a wide variety of different forms.
- the actuation element can be threaded such that rotation of the actuation element (e.g., wire, shaft, tube, screw, etc.) moves the anchor portion 106 relative to the coaption portion 104 .
- the actuation element can be unthreaded, such that pushing or pulling the actuation element 112 moves the anchor portion 106 relative to the coaption portion 104 .
- the anchor portion 106 of the device 100 includes outer paddles 120 and inner paddles 122 that are connected between a cap 114 and the coaption element or means for coapting 110 by portions 124 , 126 , 128 .
- the portions 124 , 126 , 128 can be jointed and/or flexible to move between all of the positions described below.
- the interconnection of the outer paddles 120 , the inner paddles 122 , the coaption element or means for coapting 110 , and the cap 114 by the portions 124 , 126 , and 128 can constrain the device to the positions and movements illustrated herein.
- the actuation element or means for actuating 112 extends through the delivery sheath and the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to the cap 114 at the distal connection of the anchor portion 106 . Extending and retracting the actuation element or means for actuating 112 increases and decreases the spacing between the coaption element or means for coapting 110 and the cap 114 , respectively.
- a collar or other attachment element removably attaches the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to the delivery sheath or means for delivery 102 so that the actuation element or means for actuating 112 slides through the collar or other attachment element and through the coaption element or means for coapting 110 during actuation to open and close the paddles 120 , 122 of the anchor portion 106 .
- the anchor portion 106 includes attachment portions or gripping members.
- the illustrated gripping members comprise barbed clasps 130 that include a base or fixed arm 132 , a moveable arm 134 , barbs or means for securing 136 , and a joint portion 138 .
- the fixed arms 132 are attached to the inner paddles 122 , with the joint portion 138 disposed proximate the coaption element or means for coapting 110 .
- the barbed clasps have flat surfaces and do not fit in a recess of the paddle. Rather, the flat portions of the barbed clasps are disposed against the surface of the inner paddle 122 .
- the joint portion 138 provides a spring force between the fixed and moveable arms 132 , 134 of the barbed clasp 130 .
- the joint portion 138 can be any suitable joint, such as a flexible joint, a spring joint, a pivot joint, or the like.
- the joint portion 138 is a flexible piece of material integrally formed with the fixed and moveable arms 132 , 134 .
- the fixed arms 132 are attached to the inner paddles 122 and remain stationary relative to the inner paddles 122 when the moveable arms 134 are opened to open the barbed clasps 130 and expose the barbs or means for securing 136 .
- the barbed clasps 130 are opened by applying tension to actuation lines 116 attached to the moveable arms 134 , thereby causing the moveable arms 134 to articulate, flex, or pivot on the joint portions 138 .
- Other actuation mechanisms are also possible.
- the paddles 120 , 122 can be opened and closed, for example, to grasp the native leaflets or native mitral valve leaflets between the paddles 120 , 122 and the coaption element or means for coapting 110 .
- the barbed clasps 130 can be used to grasp and/or further secure the native leaflets by engaging the leaflets with barbs or means for securing 136 and pinching the leaflets between the moveable and fixed arms 134 , 132 .
- the barbs or means for securing 136 of the barbed clasps 130 increase friction with the leaflets or may partially or completely puncture the leaflets.
- the actuation lines 116 can be actuated separately so that each barbed clasp 130 can be opened and closed separately.
- the barbed clasps 130 can be opened and closed relative to the position of the inner paddle 122 (as long as the inner paddle is in an open position), thereby allowing leaflets to be grasped in a variety of positions as the particular situation requires.
- the barbed clasps 130 can be opened separately by pulling on an attached actuation line 116 that extends through the delivery sheath or means for delivery 102 to the barbed clasp 130 .
- the actuation line 116 can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, a line, a suture, a wire, a rod, a catheter, or the like.
- the barbed clasps 130 can be spring loaded so that in the closed position the barbed clasps 130 continue to provide a pinching force on the grasped native leaflet. This pinching force remains constant regardless of the position of the inner paddles 122 .
- Barbs or means for securing 136 of the barbed clasps 130 can pierce the native leaflets to further secure the native leaflets.
- the device 100 is shown in an elongated or fully open condition for deployment from the delivery sheath.
- the device 100 is loaded in the delivery sheath in the fully open position, because the fully open position takes up the least space and allows the smallest catheter to be used (or the largest device 100 to be used for a given catheter size).
- the cap 114 is spaced apart from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 such that the paddles 120 , 122 of the anchor portion 106 are fully extended.
- an angle formed between the interior of the outer and inner paddles 120 , 122 is approximately 180 degrees.
- the barbed clasps 130 are kept in a closed condition during deployment through the delivery sheath or means for delivery 102 so that the barbs or means for securing 136 ( FIG. 11 ) do not catch or damage the sheath or tissue in the patient's heart.
- the device 100 is shown in an elongated detangling condition, similar to FIG. 8 , but with the barbed clasps 130 in a fully open position, ranging from about 140 degrees to about 200 degrees, to about 170 degrees to about 190 degrees, or about 180 degrees between fixed and moveable portions of the barbed clasps 130 .
- Fully opening the paddles 120 , 122 and the clasps 130 has been found to improve ease of detanglement or detachment from anatomy of the patient during implantation of the device 100 .
- the device 100 is shown in a shortened or fully closed condition.
- the compact size of the device 100 in the shortened condition allows for easier maneuvering and placement within the heart.
- the actuation element or means for actuating 112 is retracted to pull the cap 114 towards the coaption element or means for coapting 110 .
- the joints or flexible connections 126 between the outer paddle 120 and inner paddle 122 are constrained in movement such that compression forces acting on the outer paddle 120 from the cap 114 being retracted towards the coaption element or means for coapting 110 cause the paddles or gripping elements 120 , 122 to move radially outward.
- the outer paddles 120 During movement from the open to closed position, the outer paddles 120 maintain an acute angle with the actuation element or means for actuating 112 .
- the outer paddles 120 can optionally be biased toward a closed position.
- the inner paddles 122 during the same motion move through a considerably larger angle as they are oriented away from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 in the open condition and collapse along the sides of the coaption element or means for coapting 110 in the closed condition.
- the inner paddles 122 are thinner and/or narrower than the outer paddles 120 , and the joint or flexible portions 126 , 128 connected to the inner paddles 122 can be thinner and/or more flexible.
- this increased flexibility can allow more movement than the joint or flexible portion 124 connecting the outer paddle 124 to the cap 114 .
- the outer paddles 120 are narrower than the inner paddles 122 .
- the joint or flexible portions 126 , 128 connected to the inner paddles 122 can be more flexible, for example, to allow more movement than the joint or flexible portion 124 connecting the outer paddle 124 to the cap 114 .
- the inner paddles 122 can be the same or substantially the same width as the outer paddles (See for example, FIG. 65A ).
- the device 100 is shown in a partially open, grasp-ready condition.
- the actuation element or means for actuating 112 is extended to push the cap 114 away from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 , thereby pulling on the outer paddles 120 , which in turn pulls on the inner paddles 122 , causing the anchor portion 106 to partially unfold.
- the actuation lines 116 are also retracted to open the clasps 130 so that the leaflets can be grasped.
- the pair of inner and outer paddles 122 , 120 are moved in unison, rather than independently, by a single actuation element or means for actuating 112 .
- the positions of the clasps 130 are dependent on the positions of the paddles 122 , 120 . For example, referring to FIG. 10 closing the paddles 122 , 120 also closes the clasps.
- FIG. 11A illustrates an example embodiment where the paddles 120 , 122 are independently controllable.
- the device 100 A illustrated by FIG. 11A is similar to the device illustrated by FIG. 11 , except the device 100 A includes an actuation element that is configured as two independent actuation elements 112 A, 112 B, which are coupled to two independent caps 114 A, 114 B.
- the actuation element or means for actuating 112 A is extended to push the cap 114 A away from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 , thereby pulling on the outer paddle 120 , which in turn pulls on the inner paddle 122 , causing the first anchor portion 106 to partially unfold.
- the actuation element or means for actuating 112 B is extended to push the cap 114 away from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 , thereby pulling on the outer paddle 120 , which in turn pulls on the inner paddle 122 , causing the second anchor portion 106 to partially unfold.
- the independent paddle control illustrated by FIG. 11A can be implemented on any of the devices disclosed by the present application.
- one of the actuation lines 116 is extended to allow one of the clasps 130 to close.
- the other actuation line 116 is extended to allow the other clasp 130 to close. Either or both of the actuation lines 116 can be repeatedly actuated to repeatedly open and close the barbed clasps 130 .
- the device 100 is shown in a fully closed and deployed condition.
- the delivery sheath or means for delivery 102 and actuation element or means for actuating 112 is/are retracted and the paddles 120 , 122 and clasps 130 remain in a fully closed position.
- the device 100 can be maintained in the fully closed position with a mechanical latch or can be biased to remain closed through the use of spring materials, such as steel, other metals, plastics, composites, etc. or shape-memory alloys such as Nitinol.
- jointed or flexible portions 124 , 126 , 128 , 138 , and/or the inner and outer paddles 122 , and/or an additional biasing component can be formed of metals such as steel or shape-memory alloy, such as Nitinol—produced in a wire, sheet, tubing, or laser sintered powder—and are biased to hold the outer paddles 120 closed around the coaption element or means for coapting 110 and the barbed clasps 130 pinched around native leaflets.
- the fixed and moveable arms 132 , 134 of the barbed clasps 130 are biased to pinch the leaflets.
- the attachment or joint portions 124 , 126 , 128 , 138 , and/or the inner and outer paddles 122 , and/or an additional biasing component can be formed of any other suitably elastic material, such as a metal or polymer material, to maintain the device in the closed condition after implantation.
- the implantable device 100 is shown provided with a cover 140 .
- the cover 140 can be a cloth material such as polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh.
- the cloth cover can provide a blood seal on the surface of the spacer, and/or promote rapid tissue ingrowth.
- the cover 140 includes first and second cover portions 142 , 144 that each cover different portions of the device 100 . In some embodiments, a portion of one of the first and second cover portions 142 , 144 overlaps a portion of the other of the first and second cover portion 142 , 144 .
- the first and second cover portions 142 , 144 can be arranged in various ways, and in some embodiments, can include an overlapping portion 146 that overlaps one of the first and second cover portions 142 , 144 .
- first and second cover portions 142 , 144 are shown without overlapping portions 146 .
- first cover portion 142 (represented by thin line cross-hatching), which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from the cap 114 to cover the cap 114 , outer paddles 120 , inner paddles 122 , and the fixed arms 132 of the clasps 130 .
- the second cover 144 (represented by thick line cross-hatching), which can be a single piece of material, covers the coaption element or means for coapting 110 .
- the first cover portion 142 which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from the cap 114 to cover the cap 114 , outer paddles 120 , inner paddles 122 , the fixed arms 132 and moveable arms 134 of the clasps 130 .
- the second cover 144 covers the coaption element or means for coapting 110 .
- the first cover portion 142 which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from the cap 114 to cover the cap 114 , outer paddles 120 , inner paddles 122 , and the fixed arms 132 of the clasps 130 .
- the second cover 144 which can be made from a single piece of material, covers the coaption element or means for coapting 110 and extends from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to cover the moveable arms 134 of the clasps 130 .
- the first cover portion 142 which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from the cap 114 to cover the cap 114 and outer paddles 120 .
- the second cover 144 which can be made from a single piece of material, covers the coaption element or means for coapting 110 and extends from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to cover the inner paddles 122 , and the fixed arms 132 and moveable arms 134 of the clasps 130 .
- the first cover portion 142 which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from the cap 114 to cover the cap 114 , outer paddles 120 , inner paddles 122 , and the fixed arms 132 and moveable arms 134 of the clasps 130 .
- the second cover 144 which can be made from a single piece of material, covers the coaption element or means for coapting 110 and includes overlapping portions 146 that extend from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to overlap a portion of the moveable arms 134 that are covered by the first cover 142 .
- the first cover portion 142 which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from the cap 114 to cover the cap 114 , outer paddles 120 , inner paddles 122 , and the fixed arms 132 of the clasps 130 .
- the second cover 144 which can be made from a single piece of material, covers the coaption element or means for coapting 110 and moveable arms 134 of the clasps 130 .
- the first cover 142 also includes overlapping portions 146 that extend from the fixed arms 132 and inner paddles 122 to overlap a portion of the moveable arms 134 and coaption element or means for coapting 110 that are covered by the second cover 144 .
- the implantable device 100 of FIGS. 8-14 is shown being delivered and implanted within the native mitral valve MV of the heart H.
- the methods and steps shown and/or discussed can be performed on a living animal or on a simulation, such as on a cadaver, cadaver heart, simulator (e.g. with the body parts, heart, tissue, etc. being simulated), etc.
- the delivery sheath is inserted into the left atrium LA through the septum and the device 100 is deployed from the delivery sheath in the fully open condition.
- the actuation element or means for actuating 112 is then retracted to move the device 100 into the fully closed condition shown in FIG. 16 .
- the device 100 is moved into position within the mitral valve MV into the ventricle LV and partially opened so that the leaflets 20 , 22 can be grasped.
- an actuation line 116 is extended to close one of the clasps 130 , capturing a leaflet 20 .
- FIG. 19 shows the other actuation line 116 being then extended to close the other clasp 130 , capturing the remaining leaflet 22 .
- the delivery sheath or means for delivery 102 and actuation element or means for actuating 112 and actuation lines 116 are then retracted and the device 100 is fully closed and deployed in the native mitral valve MV.
- the device 200 includes an annular spacer member 202 , a fabric cover (not shown), and anchors 204 extending from the spacer member 202 .
- the ends of each anchor 204 can be coupled to respective struts of the spacer member 202 by respective sleeves 206 that can be crimped or welded around the connection portions of the anchors 206 and the struts of the spacer member 202 .
- a latching mechanism can bind the spacer member 202 to the anchor 204 within the sleeve 206 .
- the sleeve can be machined to have an interior shape that matches or is slightly smaller than the exterior shape of the ends of the spacer member 202 and the anchor 204 , so that the sleeve can be friction fit on the connection portions.
- One or more barbs or projections 208 can be mounted on the frame of the spacer member 202 .
- the free ends of the barbs or projections 208 can comprise various shapes including rounded, pointed, barbed, or the like.
- the projections 208 can exert a retaining force against native leaflets by virtue of the anchors 204 , which are shaped to force the native leaflets inwardly into the spacer member 202 .
- the prosthetic spacer device 300 includes an annular spacer member 302 , a fabric cover (not shown), and anchors 304 extending from the spacer member 302 and can be configured similar to the prosthetic spacer device 200 .
- One or more barbs or projections 306 can be mounted on the frame of the spacer member 302 .
- the ends of the projections 306 can comprise stoppers 308 .
- the stoppers 308 of the projections can be configured in a wide variety of different ways.
- the stoppers 308 can be configured to limit the extent of the projections 306 that can engage and/or penetrate the native leaflets and/or the stoppers can be configured to prevent removal of the projections 306 from the tissue after the projections 306 have penetrated the tissue.
- the anchors 304 of the prosthetic spacer device 300 can be configured similar to the anchors 204 of the prosthetic spacer device 200 except that the curve of each anchor 304 comprises a larger radius than the anchors 204 . As such, the anchors 304 cover a relatively larger portion of the spacer member 302 than the anchors 204 . This can, for example, distribute the clamping force of the anchors 304 against the native leaflets over a relatively larger surface of the native leaflets in order to further protect the native leaflet tissue.
- the devices 200 , 300 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the device 200 , 300 can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- the device 400 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the device 400 can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- the prosthetic spacer or coaption device 400 can include a coaption portion 404 and an anchor portion 406 , the anchor portion 406 including a plurality of anchors 408 .
- the coaption portion 404 includes a coaption or spacer member 410 .
- the anchor portion 406 includes a plurality of paddles 420 (e.g., two in the illustrated embodiment), and a plurality of clasps 430 (e.g., two in the illustrated embodiment).
- a first or proximal collar 411 , and a second collar or cap 414 are used to move the coaption portion 404 and the anchor portion 406 relative to one another.
- first connection portions 425 of the anchors 408 can be coupled to and extend from a first portion 417 of the coaption or spacer member 410
- second connection portions 421 of the anchors 408 can be coupled to the first collar 414
- the proximal collar 411 can be coupled to a second portion 419 of the coaption member 410 .
- the coaption member 410 and the anchors 408 can be coupled together in various ways.
- the coaption member 410 and the anchors 408 can be coupled together by integrally forming the coaption member 410 and the anchors 408 as a single, unitary component. This can be accomplished, for example, by forming the coaption member 410 and the anchors 408 from a braided or woven material, such as braided or woven nitinol wire.
- the coaption member 410 and the anchors 408 can be coupled together by welding, fasteners, adhesive, joint connections, sutures, friction fittings, swaging, and/or other means for coupling.
- the anchors 408 can comprise first portions or outer paddles 420 and second portions or inner paddles 422 separated by joint portions 423 .
- the anchors 408 are configured similar to legs in that the inner paddles 422 are like upper portions of the legs, the outer paddles 420 are like lower portions of the legs, and the joint portions 423 are like knee portions of the legs.
- the inner paddle portion 422 , the outer paddle portion 420 , and the joint portion 423 are formed from a continuous strip of a fabric, such as a metal fabric.
- the strip of fabric is a composite strip of fabric.
- the anchors 408 can be configured to move between various configurations by axially moving the cap 414 relative to the proximal collar 411 and thus the anchors 408 relative to the coaption member 410 along a longitudinal axis extending between the first or distal and second or proximal portions 417 , 419 of the coaption member 410 .
- the anchors 408 can be positioned in a straight configuration by moving the cap 414 away from the coaption member 410 .
- the paddle portions are aligned or straight in the direction of the longitudinal axis of the device and the joint portions 423 of the anchors 408 are adjacent the longitudinal axis of the coaption member 410 (e.g., similar to the configuration shown in FIG. 59 ).
- the anchors 408 can be moved to a fully folded configuration (e.g., FIG. 23 ) by moving the toward the coaption member 410 .
- the anchors 408 bend at the joint portions 423 , 425 , 421 and the joint portions 423 move radially outwardly relative to the longitudinal axis of the coaption member 410 and axially toward the first portion 414 of the coaption member 410 , as shown in FIGS. 24-25 .
- the joint portions 423 move radially inwardly relative to the longitudinal axis of the coaption member 410 and axially toward the proximal portion 419 of the coaption member 410 , as shown in FIG. 23 .
- an angle between the inner paddles 422 of the anchors 408 and the coaption member 410 can be approximately 180 degrees when the anchors 408 are in the straight configuration (see, e.g., FIG. 59 ), and the angle between the inner paddles 422 of the anchors 408 and the coaption member 410 can be approximately 0 degrees when the anchors 408 are in the fully folded configuration (See FIG. 23 ).
- the anchors 408 can be positioned in various partially folded configurations such that the angle between the inner paddles 422 of the anchors 408 and the coaption member 410 can be approximately 10-170 degrees or approximately 45-135 degrees.
- Configuring the prosthetic spacer device 400 such that the anchors 408 can extend to a straight or approximately straight configuration can provide several advantages. For example, this can reduce the radial crimp profile of the prosthetic spacer device 400 . It can also make it easier to grasp the native leaflets by providing a larger opening in which to grasp the native leaflets. Additionally, the relatively narrow, straight configuration can prevent or reduce the likelihood that the prosthetic spacer device 400 will become entangled in native anatomy (e.g., chordae tendineae) when positioning and/or retrieving the prosthetic spacer device 400 into the delivery apparatus.
- native anatomy e.g., chordae tendineae
- the clasps 430 can comprise attachment or fixed portions 432 and arm or moveable portions 434 .
- the attachment or fixed portions 432 can be coupled to the inner paddles 422 of the anchors 408 in various ways such as with sutures, adhesive, fasteners, welding, stitching, swaging, friction fit and/or other means for coupling or fastening.
- the moveable portions 434 can articulate, flex, or pivot relative to the fixed portions 432 between an open configuration (e.g., FIG. 24 ) and a closed configuration ( FIGS. 23 and 25 ).
- the clasps 430 can be biased to the closed configuration.
- the fixed portions 432 and the moveable portions 434 in the open configuration, flex or pivot away from each other such that native leaflets can be positioned between the fixed portions 432 and the moveable portions 434 .
- the fixed portions 432 and the moveable portions 434 in the closed configuration, the fixed portions 432 and the moveable portions 434 flex or pivot toward each other, thereby clamping the native leaflets between the fixed portions 432 and the moveable portions 434 .
- the fixed portions 432 (only one shown in FIGS. 26-27 ) can comprise one or more openings 433 (e.g., three in the illustrated embodiment). At least some of the openings 433 can be used to couple the fixed portions 432 to the anchors 408 .
- sutures and/or fasteners can extend through the openings 433 to couple the fixed portions 432 to the anchors 408 or other attachments, such as welding, adhesives, etc. can be used.
- the moveable portions 434 can comprise one or more side beams 431 . When two side beams are included as illustrated, the side beams can be spaced apart to form slots 431 A. The slots 431 A can be configured to receive the fixed portions 432 .
- the moveable portions 434 can also include spring portions 434 A that are coupled to the fixed portions 432 and barb support portions 434 B disposed opposite the spring portions 434 A.
- the barb support portions 434 B can comprise gripper or attachment elements such as barbs 436 and/or other means for frictionally engaging native leaflet tissue.
- the gripper elements can be configured to engage and/or penetrate the native leaflet tissue to help retain the native leaflets between the fixed portions 432 and moveable portions 434 of the clasps 430 .
- the barb support portions 434 B can also comprise eyelets 435 , which can be used to couple the barb support portions 434 B to an actuation mechanism configured to flex or pivot the moveable portions 434 relative to the fixed portions 432 . Additional details regarding coupling the clasps 430 to the actuation mechanism are provided below.
- the clasps 430 can be formed from a shape memory material such as nitinol, stainless steel, and/or shape memory polymers.
- the clasps 430 can be formed by laser-cutting a piece of flat sheet material (e.g., nitinol) or a tube in the configuration shown in FIG. 26 or a similar or different configuration and then shape-setting the clasp 430 in the configuration shown in FIG. 27 .
- Shape-setting the clasps 430 in this manner can provide several advantages.
- the clasps 430 can optionally be compressed from the shape-set configuration (e.g., FIG. 27 ) to the flat configuration (e.g., FIG. 26 ), or another configuration which reduces the radial crimp profile of the clasps 430 .
- the barbs can optionally be compressed to a flat configuration. Reducing the radial crimp profile can improve trackability and retrievability of the prosthetic spacer device 400 relative to a catheter shaft of a delivery apparatus because barbs 440 are pointing radially inwardly toward the anchors 408 when the prosthetic spacer device 400 is advanced through or retrieved into the catheter shaft (see, e.g., FIG. 33 ). This can prevent or reduce the likelihood that the clasps 430 may snag or skive the catheter shaft.
- shape-setting the clasps 430 in the configuration shown in FIG. 27 can increase the clamping force of the clasps 430 when the clasps 430 are in the closed configuration.
- the moveable portions 434 are shape-set relative to the fixed portions 432 to a first position (e.g., FIG. 27 ) which is beyond the position the moveable portions 434 can achieve when the clasps 430 are attached to the anchors 408 (e.g., FIG. 25 ) because the anchors 408 prevent the moveable portions 434 from further movement toward the shape-set configuration.
- shape-setting the clasps 430 in the FIG. 27 configuration can increase the clamping force of the clasps 430 compared to clasps that are shape-set in the closed configuration.
- the magnitude of the preload of the clasps 430 can be altered by adjusting the angle in which the moveable portions 434 are shape-set relative to the fixed portions 432 . For example, increasing the relative angle between the moveable portions 434 and the fixed portions 432 increases the preload, and decreasing the relative angle between the moveable portions 434 and the fixed portions 432 decreases the preload. It can also be adjusted in other ways, such as based on the configuration of the joint, hinge, materials, etc.
- the proximal collar 411 and/or the coaption member 410 can comprise a hemostatic seal 413 configured to reduce or prevent blood from flowing through the proximal collar 411 and/or the coaption member 410 .
- the hemostatic seal 413 can comprise a plurality of flexible flaps 413 A, as shown in FIG. 23 .
- the flaps 413 A can be configured to pivot from a sealed configuration to an open configuration to allow a shaft of a delivery apparatus to extend through the second collar 410 .
- the flaps 413 A form a seal around the shaft of the delivery apparatus. When the shaft of the delivery apparatus is removed, the flaps 413 A can be configured to return to the sealed configuration from the open configuration.
- the device 400 A can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the device 400 A can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- any suitable valve repair system e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application.
- the prosthetic spacer or coaption device 400 A can include a coaption portion 404 A and an anchor portion 406 A, the anchor portion 406 A including a plurality of anchors 408 A.
- the coaption portion 404 A includes a coaption member or spacer 410 A.
- the anchor portion 406 A includes a plurality of paddles 420 A (e.g., two in the illustrated embodiment), and a plurality of clasps 430 A (e.g., two in the illustrated embodiment).
- a first or proximal collar 411 A, and a second collar or cap 414 A are used to move the coaption portion 404 A and the anchor portion 406 A relative to one another.
- the coaption member 410 A extends from a proximal portion 419 A assembled to the collar 411 A to a distal portion 417 A that connects to the anchors 408 A.
- the coaption member 410 A and the anchors 408 A can be coupled together in various ways.
- the coaption member 410 A and the anchors 408 A can be coupled together by integrally forming the coaption member 410 A and the anchors 408 A as a single, unitary component. This can be accomplished, for example, by forming the coaption member 410 A and the anchors 408 A from a continuous strip 401 A of a braided or woven material, such as braided or woven nitinol wire.
- the anchors 408 A are attached to the coaption member 410 A by hinge portions 425 A and to the cap 414 A by hinge portions 421 A.
- the anchors 408 A can comprise first portions or outer paddles 420 A and second portions or inner paddles 422 A separated by joint portions 423 A.
- the joint portions 423 A are attached to paddle frames 424 A that are hingably attached to the cap 414 A.
- the anchors 408 A are configured similar to legs in that the inner paddles 422 A are like upper portions of the legs, the outer paddles 420 A are like lower portions of the legs, and the joint portions 423 A are like knee portions of the legs.
- the inner paddle portion 422 A, the outer paddle portion 420 A, and the joint portion 423 A are formed from the continuous strip of fabric 401 A, such as a metal fabric.
- the anchors 408 A can be configured to move between various configurations by axially moving the cap 414 A relative to the proximal collar 411 A and thus the anchors 408 A relative to the coaption member 410 A along a longitudinal axis extending between the cap 414 A and the proximal collar 411 A.
- the anchors 408 can be positioned in a straight configuration (see FIG. 60A ) by moving the cap 414 A away from the coaption member 410 A.
- the paddle portions 420 A, 422 A are aligned or straight in the direction of the longitudinal axis of the device and the joint portions 423 A of the anchors 408 A are adjacent the longitudinal axis of the coaption member 410 A (e.g., similar to the configuration shown in FIG. 60A ).
- the anchors 408 can be moved to a fully folded configuration (e.g., FIG. 23A ) by moving the toward the coaption member 410 A.
- the anchors 408 A bend at joint portions 421 A, 423 A, 425 A, and the joint portions 423 A move radially outwardly relative to the longitudinal axis of the device 400 A and axially toward the distal portion 417 A of the coaption member 410 A, as shown in FIGS. 53A and 54A .
- the joint portions 423 A move radially inwardly relative to the longitudinal axis of the device 400 A and axially toward the proximal portion 419 A of the coaption member 410 A, as shown in FIG. 23A .
- an angle between the inner paddles 422 A of the anchors 408 A and the coaption member 410 A can be approximately 180 degrees when the anchors 408 A are in the straight configuration (see, e.g., FIG. 60A ), and the angle between the inner paddles 422 A of the anchors 408 A and the coaption member 410 A can be approximately 0 degrees when the anchors 408 A are in the fully folded configuration (see FIG. 23A ).
- the anchors 408 A can be positioned in various partially folded configurations such that the angle between the inner paddles 422 A of the anchors 408 A and the coaption member 410 A can be approximately 10-170 degrees or approximately 45-135 degrees.
- Configuring the prosthetic spacer device 400 A such that the anchors 408 A can extend to a straight or approximately straight configuration can provide several advantages. For example, this can reduce the radial crimp profile of the prosthetic spacer device 400 A. It can also make it easier to grasp the native leaflets by providing a larger opening in which to grasp the native leaflets. Additionally, the relatively narrow, straight configuration can prevent or reduce the likelihood that the prosthetic spacer device 400 A will become entangled in native anatomy (e.g., chordae tendineae) when positioning and/or retrieving the prosthetic spacer device 400 A into the delivery apparatus.
- native anatomy e.g., chordae tendineae
- the clasps 430 A can comprise attachment or fixed portions 432 C and arm or moveable portions 434 C.
- the attachment or fixed portions 432 C can be coupled to the inner paddles 422 A of the anchors 408 A in various ways such as with sutures, adhesive, fasteners, welding, stitching, swaging, friction fit, and/or other means for coupling.
- the clasps 430 A are similar to the clasps 430 .
- the moveable portions 434 C can articulate, flex, or pivot relative to the fixed portions 432 C between an open configuration (e.g., FIG. 54A ) and a closed configuration ( FIG. 53A ).
- the clasps 430 A can be biased to the closed configuration.
- the fixed portions 432 C and the moveable portions 434 C articulate, pivot, or flex away from each other such that native leaflets can be positioned between the fixed portions 432 C and the moveable portions 434 C.
- the fixed portions 432 C and the moveable portions 434 C articulate, pivot, or flex toward each other, thereby clamping the native leaflets between the fixed portions 432 C and the moveable portions 434 C.
- the strip 401 A is attached the collar 411 A, cap 414 A, paddle frames 424 A, clasps 430 A to form both the coaption portion 404 A and the anchor portion 406 A of the device 400 A.
- the coaption member 410 A, hinge portions 421 A, 423 A, 425 A, outer paddles 420 A, and inner paddles 422 A are formed from the continuous strip 401 A.
- the continuous strip 401 A can be a single layer of material or can include two or more layers.
- portions of the device 400 A have a single layer of the strip of material 401 A and other portions are formed from multiple overlapping or overlying layers of the strip of material 401 A. For example, FIG.
- the single continuous strip of material 401 A can start and end in various locations of the device 400 A.
- the ends of the strip of material 401 A can be in the same location or different locations of the device 400 A.
- the strip of material begins and ends in the location of the inner paddles 422 A.
- the example implantable prosthetic device 400 A is shown covered with a cover 440 A.
- the cover 440 A is disposed on the coaption member 410 A, the collar 411 A, the cap 414 A, the paddles 420 A, 422 A, the paddle frames 424 A, and the clasps 430 A.
- the cover 440 A can be configured to prevent or reduce blood-flow through the prosthetic spacer device 400 A and/or to promote native tissue ingrowth.
- the cover 440 A can be a cloth or fabric such as PET, velour, or other suitable fabric.
- the cover 440 A can include a coating (e.g., polymeric material, silicone, etc.) that is applied to the prosthetic spacer device 400 A.
- an implantable prosthetic device 500 e.g., a prosthetic spacer device
- the implantable device 500 is one of the many different configurations that the device 100 that is schematically illustrated in FIGS. 8-20 can take.
- the device 500 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the device 500 can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can comprise a coaption element or spacer member 510 , a plurality of anchors 508 that include outer paddles 520 , inner paddles 522 , clasps 530 , a first or proximal collar 511 , and a second collar or cap 514 . These components of the prosthetic spacer device 500 can be configured the same or substantially similar to the corresponding components of the prosthetic spacer device 400 .
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can also include a plurality of paddle extension members or paddle frames 524 .
- the paddle frames 524 can be configured with a round three-dimensional shape with first connection portions 526 coupled to and extending from the cap 514 and second connection portions 528 disposed opposite the first connection portions 526 .
- the paddle frames 524 can be configured to extend circumferentially farther around the coaption member 510 than the outer paddles 520 .
- each of the paddle frames 524 extend around approximately half of the circumference of the coaption member 510 (as shown in FIG. 29 ), and the outer paddles 520 extend around less than half of the circumference of the coaption member 510 (as shown in FIG. 28 ).
- the paddle frames 524 can also be configured to extend laterally (i.e., perpendicular to a longitudinal axis of the coaption member 510 ) beyond an outer diameter of the coaption member 510 .
- the inner paddle portions 522 and the outer paddle portions 520 can formed from a continuous strip of fabric that are connected to the paddle frames 524 .
- the inner paddle portions and the outer paddle portions can be connected to the connection portion of the paddle frame at the flexible connection between the inner paddle portion and the outer paddle portion.
- the paddle frames 524 can further be configured such that connection portions 528 of the paddle frames 524 are connected to or axially adjacent a joint portion 523 .
- the connection portions of the paddle frames 534 can be positioned between outer and inner paddles 520 , 522 , on the outside of the paddle portion 520 , on the inside of the inner paddle portion, or on top of the joint portion 523 when the prosthetic spacer device 500 is in a folded configuration (e.g., FIGS. 28-30 ).
- the connections between the paddle frames 524 , the single strip that forms the outer and inner paddles 520 , 522 , the cap 514 , and the coaption element can constrain each of these parts to the movements and positions described herein.
- joint portion 523 is constrained by its connection between the outer and inner paddles 520 , 522 and by its connection to the paddle frame.
- paddle frame 524 is constrained by its attachment to the joint portion 523 (and thus the inner and outer paddles) and to the cap.
- Configuring the paddle frames 524 in this manner provides increased surface area compared to the outer paddles 520 alone. This can, for example, make it easier to grasp and secure the native leaflets.
- the increased surface area can also distribute the clamping force of the paddles 520 and paddle frames 524 against the native leaflets over a relatively larger surface of the native leaflets in order to further protect the native leaflet tissue.
- the increased surface area of the paddle frames 524 can also allow the native leaflets to be clamped to the prosthetic spacer device 500 , such that the native leaflets coapt entirely around the coaption member 510 . This can, for example, improve sealing of the native leaflet and thus prevent or further reduce mitral regurgitation.
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can also include a cover 540 .
- the cover 540 can be disposed on the coaption member 510 , the paddles 520 , 522 , and/or the paddle frames 524 .
- the cover 540 can be configured to prevent or reduce blood-flow through the prosthetic spacer device 500 and/or to promote native tissue ingrowth.
- the cover 540 can be a cloth or fabric such as PET, velour, or other suitable fabric.
- the cover 540 in lieu of or in addition to a fabric, can include a coating (e.g., polymeric, silicone, etc.) that is applied to the prosthetic device 500 .
- FIGS. 31-32 illustrate the implantable prosthetic device 500 of FIGS. 28 and 29 with anchors 508 of an anchor portion 506 and clasps 530 in open positions.
- the device 500 is deployed from a delivery sheath (not shown) and includes a coaption portion 504 and the anchor portion 506 .
- the device 500 is loaded in the delivery sheath in the fully extended or bailout position, because the fully extended or bailout position takes up the least space and allows the smallest catheter to be used (See FIG. 35 ). Or, the fully extended position allows the largest device 500 to be used for a given catheter size.
- the coaption portion 504 of the device includes a coaption element 510 for implantation between the native leaflets of a native valve (e.g., mitral valve, tricuspid valve, etc.).
- An insert 516 A is disposed inside the coaption element 510 .
- the insert 516 A and the coaption element 510 are slidably attached to an actuation element 512 (e.g., actuation wire, rod, shaft, tube, screw, suture, line, etc.).
- the anchors 508 of the device 500 include outer paddles 520 and inner paddles 522 that are flexibly connected to the cap 514 and the coaption element 510 . Actuation of the actuation element or means for actuation 512 opens and closes the anchors 508 of the device 500 to grasp the native valve leaflets during implantation.
- the actuation element 512 extends through the delivery sheath (not shown), the proximal collar 511 , the coaption element 510 , the insert 516 A, and extends to the cap 514 . Extending and retracting the actuation element 512 increases and decreases the spacing between the coaption element 510 and the cap 514 , respectively. This changing of the spacing between the coaption element 510 and the cap 514 causes the anchor portion 506 of the device to move between different positions.
- the proximal collar 511 optionally includes a collar seal 513 that forms a seal around the actuation element or means for actuation 512 during implantation of the device 500 , and that seals shut when the actuation element 512 is removed to close or substantially close the proximal end of the device 500 to blood flow through the interior of the coaption element 510 after implantation.
- a coupler or means for coupling 2214 (see FIG. 145 ) removably engages and attaches the proximal collar 511 and the coaption element 500 to the delivery sheath.
- coupler or means for coupling 2214 is held closed around the proximal collar 511 by the actuation element 512 , such that removal of the actuation element 512 allows fingers (see FIG. 145 ) of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 to open, releasing the proximal collar 511 .
- the cap 514 optionally includes a sealing projection 516 that sealingly fits within a sealing opening 517 of the insert 516 A.
- the cap 514 includes a sealing opening and the insert 516 A includes a sealing projection.
- the insert 516 A can sealingly fit inside a distal opening 515 of the coaption element 510 , the coaption element 510 having a hollow interior.
- the sealing projection 516 of the cap 514 sealingly engages the opening 517 in the insert 516 A to maintain the distal end of the coaption element 510 closed or substantially closed to blood flow when the device 500 is implanted and/or in the closed position.
- the insert 516 A can optionally include a seal, like the collar seal 513 of the proximal collar, that forms a seal around the actuation element or means for actuation 512 during implantation of the device 500 , and that seals shut when the actuation element 512 is removed.
- a seal can close or substantially close the distal end of the coaption element 510 to blood flow after implantation.
- the coaption element 510 and paddles 520 , 522 are formed from a flexible material that can be a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, or formed in any other suitable way or a laser cut or otherwise cut flexible material.
- the material can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body.
- Paddle frames 524 provide additional pinching force between the inner paddles 522 and the coaption element 510 and assist in wrapping the leaflets around the sides of the coaption element 510 for a better seal between the coaption element 510 and the leaflets.
- the covering 540 illustrated by FIG. 30 extends around the paddle frames 524 .
- the clasps 530 include a base or fixed arm 532 , a moveable arm 534 , barbs 536 , and a joint portion 538 .
- the fixed arms 532 are attached to the inner paddles 522 , with the joint portion 538 disposed proximate the coaption element 510 .
- the barbed clasps have flat surfaces and do not fit in a recess of the paddle. Rather, the flat portion of the barbed clasps are disposed against the surface of the inner paddle 522 .
- the fixed arms 532 are attached to the inner paddles 522 through holes or slots 533 with sutures (not shown).
- the fixed arms 532 can be attached to the inner paddles 522 or another portion of the device with any suitable means, such as screws or other fasteners, crimped sleeves, mechanical latches or snaps, welding, adhesive, or the like.
- the fixed arms 532 remain stationary or substantially stationary relative to the inner paddles 522 when the moveable arms 534 are opened to open the barbed clasps 530 and expose the barbs 536 .
- the barbed clasps 530 are opened by applying tension to actuation lines (not shown) attached to holes 535 in the moveable arms 534 , thereby causing the moveable arms 534 to pivot or flex on the joint portions 538 .
- the anchors 508 are opened and closed to grasp the native valve leaflets between the paddles 520 , 522 and the coaption element 510 .
- the barbed clasps 530 further secure the native leaflets by engaging the leaflets with barbs 536 and pinching the leaflets between the moveable and fixed arms 534 , 532 .
- the barbs 536 of the barbed clasps 530 increase friction with the leaflets or may partially or completely puncture the leaflets.
- the actuation lines can be actuated separately so that each barbed clasp 530 can be opened and closed separately.
- the barbed clasps 530 can open and close when the inner paddle 522 is not closed, thereby allowing leaflets to be grasped in a variety of positions as the particular situation requires.
- an example barbed clasp 600 for use in implantable prosthetic devices such as the devices described above, is shown.
- a wide variety of different barbed clasps can be used.
- Examples of barbed clasps that can be used include but are not limited to any of the barbed clasps disclosed in the present application and any of the applications that are incorporated herein by reference and/or that the present application claims priority to.
- the barbed clasp 600 is formed from a top layer 602 and a bottom layer 604 .
- the two-layer design of the clasp 600 allow thinner sheets of material to be used, thereby improving the flexibility of the clasp 600 over a clasp formed from a single thicker sheet, while maintaining the strength of the clasp 600 needed to successfully retain a native valve leaflet.
- the barbed clasp 600 includes a fixed arm 610 , a jointed portion 620 , and a movable arm 630 having a barbed portion 640 .
- the top and bottom layers 602 , 604 have a similar shape and in certain embodiments are attached to each other at the barbed portion 640 . However, the top and bottom layers 602 , 604 can be attached to one another at other or additional locations.
- the jointed portion 620 is spring-loaded so that the fixed and moveable arms 610 , 630 are biased toward each other when the barbed clasp 600 is in a closed condition.
- the fixed arm 610 When assembled to an implantable prosthetic device, the fixed arm 610 is attached to a portion of the prosthetic device.
- the clasp 600 is opened by pulling on an actuation line attached to the moveable arm 630 until the spring force of the joint portion 620 is overcome.
- the fixed arm 610 is formed from a tongue 611 of material extending from the jointed portion 620 between two side beams 631 of the moveable arm 630 .
- the tongue 611 is biased between the side beams 631 by the joint portion 620 such that force must be applied to move the tongue 611 from a neutral position located beyond the side beams 631 to a preloaded position parallel or substantially parallel with the side beams 631 .
- the tongue 611 is held in the preloaded position by an optional T-shaped cross-bar 614 that is attached to the tongue 611 and extends outward to engage the side beams 631 .
- the cross-bar is omitted and the tongue 611 is attached to the inner paddle 522 , and the inner paddle 522 maintains the clasp in the preloaded position.
- the top and bottom layers 602 , 604 or just the top layer can be attached to the inner paddle.
- the angle between the fixed and moveable arms 610 , 630 when the tongue is in the neutral position is about 30 to about 100 degrees, 30 to about 90 degrees, or about 30 to about 60 degrees, or about 40 to about 50 degrees, or about 45 degrees.
- the tongue 611 includes holes 612 for receiving sutures (not shown) that attach the fixed arm 610 to an implantable device.
- the fixed arm 610 can be attached to an implantable device, such as with screws or other fasteners, crimped sleeves, mechanical latches or snaps, welding, adhesive, or the like.
- the holes 612 are elongated slots or oval-shaped holes to accommodate sliding of the layers 602 , 604 without damaging the sutures attaching the clasp 600 to an implantable device.
- the joint portion 620 is formed by two beam loops 622 that extend from the tongue 611 of the fixed arm 610 to the side beams 631 of the moveable arm 630 .
- the beam loops 622 are narrower than the tongue 611 and side beam 631 to provide additional flexibility.
- the beam loops 622 each include a center portion 624 extending from the tongue 611 and an outer portion 626 extending to the side beams 631 .
- the beam loops 622 are bent into a somewhat spiral or helical shape by bending the center and outer portions 624 , 626 in opposite directions, thereby forming an offset or step distance 628 between the tongue 611 and side beams 631 .
- the step distance 628 provides space between the arms 610 , 630 to accommodate the native leaflet of the native valve after it is grasped.
- the step distance 628 is about 0.5 millimeter to about 1 millimeter, or about 0.75 millimeters.
- the beam loops When viewed in a top plan view, the beam loops have an “omega-like” shape.
- This shape of the beam loops 622 allows the fixed and moveable arms 610 , 630 to move considerably relative to each other without plastically deforming the clasp material.
- the tongue 611 can be flexed or pivoted from a neutral position that is approximately 45 degrees beyond the moveable arm 630 to a fully open position that ranges from about 140 degrees to about 200 degrees, to about 170 degrees to about 190 degrees, or about 180 degrees from the moveable arm 630 without plastically deforming the clasp material.
- the clasp material plastically deforms during opening without reducing or without substantially reducing the pinch force exerted between the fixed and moveable arms in the closed position.
- Preloading the tongue 611 enables the clasp 600 to maintain a pinching or clipping force on the native leaflet when closed.
- the preloading of the tongue 611 provides a significant advantage over prior art clips that provide little or no pinching force when closed.
- closing the clasp 600 with spring force is a significant improvement over clips that use a one-time locking closure mechanism, as the clasp 600 can be repeatedly opened and closed for repositioning on the leaflet while still maintaining sufficient pinching force when closed.
- the spring-loaded clasps also allow for easier removal of the device over time as compared to a device that locks in a closed position (after tissue ingrowth).
- both the clasps and the paddles are spring biased to their closed positions (as opposed to being locked in the closed position), which can allow for easier removal of the device after tissue ingrowth.
- the barbed portion 640 of the moveable arm 630 includes an eyelet 642 , barbs 644 , and barb supports 646 . Positioning the barbed portion of the clasp 600 toward an end of the moveable arm 630 increases the space between the barbs 644 and the fixed arm 610 when the clasp 600 is opened, thereby improving the ability of the clasp 600 to successfully grasp a leaflet during implantation. This distance also allows the barbs 644 to more reliably disengage from the leaflet for repositioning.
- the barbs of the clasps can be staggered longitudinally to further distribute pinch forces and local leaflet stress.
- the barbs 644 are laterally spaced apart at the same distance from the joint portion 620 , providing a superior distribution of pinching forces on the leaflet tissue while also making the clasp more robust to leaflet grasp than barbs arranged in a longitudinal row.
- the barbs 644 can be staggered to further distribute pinch forces and local leaflet stress.
- the barbs 644 are formed from the bottom layer 604 and the barb supports 646 are formed from the top layer. In certain embodiments, the barbs are formed from the top layer 602 and the barb supports are formed from the bottom layer 604 . Forming the barbs 644 only in one of the two layers 602 , 604 allows the barbs to be thinner and therefore effectively sharper than a barb formed from the same material that is twice as thick.
- the barb supports 646 extend along a lower portion of the barbs 644 to stiffen the barbs 644 , further improving penetration and retention of the leaflet tissue. In certain embodiments, the ends of the barbs 644 are further sharpened using any suitable sharpening means.
- the barbs 644 are angled away from the moveable arm 630 such that they easily penetrate tissue of the native leaflets with minimal pinching or clipping force.
- the barbs 644 extend from the moveable arm at an angle of about 45 degrees to about 75 degrees, or about 45 degrees to about 60 degrees, or about 48 to about 56 degrees, or about 52 degrees.
- the angle of the barbs 644 provides further benefits, in that force pulling the implant off the native leaflet will encourage the barbs 644 to further engage the tissue, thereby ensuring better retention. Retention of the leaflet in the clasp 600 can be further improved by the position of the T-shaped cross bar 614 near the barbs 644 when the clasp 600 is closed.
- the tissue pierced by the barbs 644 is pinched against the moveable arm 630 at the cross bar 614 location, thereby forming the tissue into an S-shaped torturous path as it passes over the barbs 644 .
- forces pulling the leaflet away from the clasp 600 will encourage the tissue to further engage the barbs 644 before the leaflets can escape.
- leaflet tension during diastole can encourage the barbs to pull toward the end portion of the leaflet.
- the S-shaped path can utilize the leaflet tension during diastole to more tightly engage the leaflets with the barbs.
- Each layer 602 , 604 of the clasp 600 is laser cut from a sheet of shape-memory alloy, such as Nitinol.
- the top layer 602 is aligned and attached to the bottom layer 604 .
- the layers 602 , 604 are attached at the barbed portion 640 of the moveable arm 630 .
- the layers 602 , 604 can be attached only at the barbed portion 640 , to allow the remainder of the layers to slide relative to one another.
- Portions of the combined layers 602 , 604 such as a fixed arm 610 , barbs 644 and barb supports 646 , and beam loops 622 are bent into a desired position.
- the layers 602 , 604 can be bent and shape-set together or can be bent and shape-set separately and then joined together.
- the clasp 600 is then subjected to a shape-setting process so that internal forces of the material will tend to return to the set shape after being subjected to deformation by external forces.
- the tongue 611 is moved to its preloaded position so that the cross-bar 614 can be attached.
- the clasp 600 can optionally be completely flattened for delivery through a delivery sheath and allowed to expand once deployed within the heart.
- the clasp 600 is opened and closed by applying and releasing tension on an actuation line, suture, wire, rod, catheter, or the like (not shown) attached to the moveable arm 630 .
- he actuation line or suture is inserted through an eyelet 642 near the barbed portion 640 of the moveable arm 630 and wraps around the moveable arm 630 before returning to the delivery sheath.
- an intermediate suture loop is made through the eyelet and the suture is inserted through the intermediate loop.
- An alternate embodiment of the intermediate loop can be composed of fabric or another material attached to the movable arm, instead of a suture loop.
- An intermediate loop of suture material reduces friction experienced by the actuation line/suture relative to the friction between the actuation line/suture and the clasp material.
- both ends of the actuation line/suture extend back into and through a delivery sheath (e.g., FIG. 8 ).
- the suture can be removed by pulling one end of the suture proximally until the other end of the suture pulls through the eyelet or intermediate loop and back into the delivery sheath.
- FIG. 34 a close-up view of one of the leaflets 20 , 22 grasped by a barbed clasp such as clasps 430 , 530 is shown.
- the leaflet 20 , 22 is grasped between the moveable and fixed arms 434 , 534 of the clasp 430 , 530 .
- the tissue of the leaflet 20 , 22 is not pierced by the barbs 436 , 536 , though in some embodiments the barbs 436 , 536 may partially or fully pierce through the leaflet 20 , 22 .
- the angle and height of the barbs 436 , 536 relative to the moveable arm 434 , 534 helps to secure the leaflet 20 , 22 within the clasp 430 , 530 .
- a force pulling the implant off of the native leaflet will encourage the barbs 436 , 536 to further engage the tissue, thereby ensuring better retention.
- Retention of the leaflet 20 , 22 in the clasp 430 , 530 is further improved by the position of fixed arm 432 , 532 near the barbs 436 , 536 when the clasp 430 , 530 is closed.
- the tissue is formed by the fixed arms 432 , 532 and the moveable arms 434 , 534 and the barbs 436 , 536 into an S-shaped torturous path.
- leaflet tension during diastole can encourage the barbs to pull toward the end portion of the leaflet.
- the S-shaped path can utilize the leaflet tension during diastole to more tightly engage the leaflets with the barbs.
- the implantable device 500 is shown being delivered and implanted within the native mitral valve MV of the heart H.
- the methods and steps shown and/or discussed can be performed on a living animal or on a simulation, such as on a cadaver, cadaver heart, simulator (e.g. with the body parts, heart, tissue, etc. being simulated), etc.
- the device 500 has a covering 540 (see FIG. 30 ) over the coaption element 510 , clasps 530 , inner paddles 522 and/or the outer paddles 520 .
- the device 500 is deployed from a delivery sheath 502 and includes a coaption portion 504 and an anchor portion 506 including a plurality of anchors 508 (i.e., two in the illustrated embodiment).
- the coaption portion 504 of the device includes a coaption element 510 for implantation between the leaflets 20 , 22 of the native mitral valve MV that is slidably attached to an actuation element or means for actuation 512 . Actuation of the actuation element or means for actuation 512 opens and closes the anchors 508 of the device 500 to grasp the mitral valve leaflets 20 , 22 during implantation.
- the anchors 508 of the device 500 include outer paddles 520 and inner paddles 522 that are flexibly connected to the cap 514 and the coaption element 510 .
- the actuation element 512 extends through a capture mechanism 503 (see FIG. 41 ), delivery sheath 502 , and the coaption element 510 to the cap 514 connected to the anchor portion 506 . Extending and retracting the actuation element 512 increases and decreases the spacing between the coaption element 510 and the cap 514 , respectively. In the example illustrated by FIGS. 35-46 , the pair of inner and outer paddles 522 , 520 are moved in unison, rather than independently, by a single actuation element 512 .
- the positions of the clasps 530 are dependent on the positions of the paddles 522 , 520 .
- closing the paddles 522 , 520 also closes the clasps.
- the device 500 can be made to have the paddles 520 , 522 be independently controllable in the same manner as the FIG. 11A embodiment.
- Fingers of the capture mechanism 503 removably attach the collar 511 to the delivery sheath 502 .
- the collar 511 and the coaption element 510 slide along the actuation element 512 during actuation to open and close the anchors 508 of the anchor portion 506 .
- the capture mechanism 503 is held closed around the collar 511 by the actuation element 512 , such that removal of the actuation element 512 allows the fingers of the capture mechanism 503 to open, releasing the collar 511 , and thus the coaption element 510 .
- the coaption element 510 and paddles 520 , 522 are formed from a flexible material that can be a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, or formed in any other suitable way or a laser cut or otherwise cut flexible material.
- the flexible material can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body. Other configurations are also possible.
- the barbed clasps 530 include a base or fixed arm 532 , a moveable arm 534 , barbs 536 (see FIG. 41 ), and a joint portion 538 .
- the fixed arms 532 are attached to the inner paddles 522 , with the joint portions 538 disposed proximate the coaption element 510 .
- Sutures (not shown) attach the fixed arms 532 to the inner paddles 522 .
- the fixed arms 532 can be attached to the inner paddles 522 and/or another portion of the device with any suitable means, such as screws or other fasteners, crimped sleeves, mechanical latches or snaps, welding, adhesive, or the like.
- the fixed arms 532 remain stationary or substantially stationary when the moveable arms 534 are opened to open the barbed clasps 530 and expose the barbs 536 .
- the barbed clasps 530 are opened by applying tension to clasp control members or actuation lines 537 attached to the moveable arms 534 , thereby causing the moveable arms 534 to pivot or flex on the joint portions 538 .
- the anchors 508 are opened and closed to grasp the native valve leaflets between the paddles 520 , 522 and the coaption element 510 .
- the outer paddles 520 have a wide curved shape that fits around the curved shape of the coaption element 510 to more securely grip the leaflets 20 , 22 .
- the curved shape and rounded edges of the outer paddle 520 also prohibits tearing of the leaflet tissue.
- the barbed clasps 530 further secure the native leaflets by engaging the leaflets with barbs 536 and pinching the leaflets between the moveable and fixed arms 534 , 532 .
- the barbs 536 of the barbed clasps 530 increase friction with the leaflets or may partially or completely puncture the leaflets.
- the actuation lines can be actuated separately so that each barbed clasp 530 can be opened and closed separately. Separate operation allows one leaflet to be grasped at a time, or for the repositioning of a clasp 530 on a leaflet that was insufficiently grasped, without altering a successful grasp on the other leaflet.
- the barbed clasps 530 can be fully opened and closed when the inner paddle 522 is not closed, thereby allowing leaflets to be grasped in a variety of positions as the particular situation requires.
- the device 500 is loaded in the delivery sheath in the fully open or fully extended position, because the fully open or fully extended position takes up the least space and allows the smallest catheter to be used (or the largest device 500 to be used for a given catheter size).
- the delivery sheath is inserted into the left atrium LA through the septum and the device 500 is deployed from the delivery sheath 502 in the fully open condition.
- the actuation element 512 is then retracted to move the device 500 into the fully closed condition shown in FIGS. 36-37 and then maneuvered towards the mitral valve MV as shown in FIG. 38 .
- FIG. 35 the delivery sheath is inserted into the left atrium LA through the septum and the device 500 is deployed from the delivery sheath 502 in the fully open condition.
- the actuation element 512 is then retracted to move the device 500 into the fully closed condition shown in FIGS. 36-37 and then maneuvered towards the mitral valve MV as shown in FIG. 38 .
- FIGS. 42-44 shows the device 500 with both clasps 530 closed, though the barbs 536 of one clasp 530 missed one of the leaflets 22 .
- the out of position clasp 530 is opened and closed again to properly grasp the missed leaflet 22 .
- the actuation element 512 is retracted to move the device 500 into the fully closed position shown in FIG. 45 .
- the actuation element 512 is withdrawn to release the capture mechanism 503 from the proximal collar 511 .
- the device 500 can be maintained in the fully closed position with a mechanical means such as a latch or can be biased to remain closed through the use of spring material, such as steel, and/or shape-memory alloys such as Nitinol.
- the paddles 520 , 522 can be formed of steel or Nitinol shape-memory alloy—produced in a wire, sheet, tubing, or laser sintered powder—and are biased to hold the outer paddles 520 closed around the inner paddles 522 , coaption element 510 , and the barbed clasps 530 pinched around native leaflets 20 , 22 .
- the device 500 can have a wide variety of different shapes and sizes.
- the coaption element 510 functions as a gap filler in the valve regurgitant orifice, such as the gap 26 in the native valve illustrated by FIG. 6 .
- the coaption element 510 since the coaption element 510 is deployed between two opposing valve leaflets 20 , 22 , the leaflets will not coapt against each other in the area of the coaption element 510 , but coapt against the coaption element 510 instead. This reduces the distance the leaflets 20 , 22 need to be approximated. A reduction in leaflet approximation distance can result in several advantages.
- the coaption element and resulting reduced approximation can facilitate repair of severe mitral valve anatomies, such as large gaps in functional valve disease (See for example, FIG. 6 ).
- the coaption element 510 reduces the distance the native valves have to be approximated, the stress in the native valves can be reduced or minimized. Shorter approximation distance of the valve leaflets 20 , 22 can require less approximation forces which can result in less tension of the leaflets and less diameter reduction of the valve annulus. The smaller reduction of the valve annulus (or no reduction of the valve annulus) can result in less reduction in valve orifice area as compared to a device without a spacer. As a result, the coaption element 510 can reduce the transvalvular gradients.
- the paddle frames 524 conform to the shape of the coaption element 510 .
- a distance (gap) between the opposing leaflets 20 , 22 can be created by the device 500 .
- the paddles are configured to conform to the shape or geometry of the coaption element 510 . As a result, the paddles can mate with both the coaption element 510 and the native valve.
- the paddles 524 surround the coaption element 510 .
- FIGS. 6B and 6C illustrate the valve repair device 500 attached to native valve leaflets 20 , 22 from the ventricular side of the mitral valve.
- FIG. 6A illustrates the valve repair device 500 attached to mitral valve leaflets 20 , 22 from the atrial side of the mitral valve.
- a schematic atrial view/surgeons view depicts the paddle frames (which would not actually be visible from a true atrial view), conforming to the spacer geometry.
- the opposing leaflets 20 , 22 (the ends of which would also not be visible in the true atrial view) being approximated by the paddles, to fully surround or “hug” the coaption element 510 .
- valve leaflets 20 , 22 can be coapted completely around the coaption element by the paddle frames 524 , including on the lateral and medial aspects 601 , 603 of the coaption element 510 .
- This coaption of the leaflets 20 , 22 against the lateral and medial aspects of the coaption element 510 would seem to contradict the statement above that the presence of a coaption element 510 minimizes the distance the leaflets need to be approximated.
- the distance the leaflets 20 , 22 need to be approximated is still minimized if the coaption element 510 is placed precisely at a regurgitant gap and the regurgitant gap is less than the width (medial-lateral) of the coaption element 510 .
- the coaption element 510 can take a wide variety of different shapes.
- the coaption element when viewed from the top (and/or sectional views from the top; see FIGS. 95-102 ), has an oval shape or an elliptical shape.
- the oval or elliptical shape can allow the paddle frames 524 co conform to the shape of the coaption element and/or can reduce lateral leaks (See FIGS. 65-83 ).
- the coaption element 510 can reduce tension of the opposing leaflets by reducing the distance the leaflets need to be approximated to the coaption element 510 at the positions 601 , 603 .
- the reduction of the distance of leaflet approximation at the positions 601 , 603 can result in the reduction of leaflet stresses and gradients.
- the native valve leaflets 20 , 22 can surround or “hug” the coaption element in order to prevent lateral leaks.
- the geometrical characteristics of the coaption element can be designed to preserve and augment these two characteristics of the device 500 . Referring to FIG.
- the anatomy of the leaflets 20 , 22 is such that the inner sides of the leaflets coapt at the free end portions and the leaflets 20 , 22 start receding or spreading apart from each other.
- the leaflets 20 , 22 spread apart in the atrial direction, until each leaflet meets with the mitral annulus.
- the valve repair device 500 and its coaption element 510 are designed to conform to the geometrical anatomy of the valve leaflets 20 , 22 .
- the valve repair device 500 can be designed to coapt the native leaflets to the coaption element, completely around the coaption element, including at the medial 601 and lateral 603 positions of the coaption element 510 . Additionally, a reduction on forces required to bring the leaflets into contact with the coaption element 510 at the positions 601 , 603 can minimize leaflet stress and gradients.
- FIG. 2B shows how a tapered or triangular shape of a coaption element 510 will naturally adapt to the native valve geometry and to its expanding leaflet nature (toward the annulus).
- FIG. 6D illustrates the geometry of the coaption element 510 and the paddle frame 524 from an LVOT perspective.
- the coaption element 510 has a tapered shape being smaller in dimension in the area closer to where the inside surfaces of the leaflets 20 , 22 are required to coapt and increase in dimension as the coaption element extends toward the atrium.
- the depicted native valve geometry is accommodated by a tapered coaption element geometry.
- the tapered coaption element geometry in conjunction with the illustrated expanding paddle frame 524 shape (toward the valve annulus) can help to achieve coaptation on the lower end of the leaflets, reduce stress, and minimize transvalvular gradients.
- remaining shapes of the coaption element 510 and the paddle frames 524 can be defined based on an Intra-Commissural view of the native valve and the device 510 . Two factors of these shapes are leaflet coaptation against the coaption element 510 and reduction of stress on the leaflets due to the coaption. Referring to FIGS.
- the coaption element 510 can have a round or rounded shape and the paddle frame 524 can have a full radius that spans from one leg of the paddles to the other leg of the paddles.
- the round shape of the coaption element and/or the illustrated fully rounded shape of the paddle frame will distribute the stresses on the leaflets 20 , 22 across a large, curved engagement area 607 .
- the force on the leaflets 20 , 22 by the paddle frames is spread along the entire rounded length of the paddle frame 524 , as the leaflets 20 try to open during the diastole cycle.
- the shape of the coaption element in the intra-commissural view follows a round shape.
- the round shape of the coaption element in this view substantially follows or is close to the shape of the paddle frames 524 .
- the overall shape of the coaption element 510 is an elliptical or oval cross section when seen from the surgeon's view (top view—See FIG. 70 ), a tapered shape or cross section when seen from an LVOT view (side view—See FIG. 69 ), and a substantially round shape or rounded shape when seen from an intra-commissural view (See FIG. 68 ).
- a blend of these three geometries can result in the three-dimensional shape of the illustrated coaption element 510 that achieves the benefits described above.
- the dimensions of the coaption element are selected to minimize the number of implants that a single patient will require (preferably one), while at the same time maintaining low transvalvular gradients.
- the anterior-posterior distance X47B at the top of the spacer is about 5 mm
- the medial-lateral distance X67D of the spacer at its widest is about 10 mm.
- the overall geometry of the device 510 can be based on these two dimensions and the overall shape strategy described above. It should be readily apparent that the use of other anterior-posterior distance anterior-posterior distance X47B and medial-lateral distance X67D as starting points for the device will result in a device having different dimensions. Further, using other dimensions and the shape strategy described above will also result in a device having different dimensions.
- Tables A, B, and C provide examples of values and ranges for dimensions of the device and components of the device for some example embodiments. However, the device can have a wide variety of different shapes and sizes and need not have all or any of the dimensional values or dimensional ranges provided in Tables A, B, and C.
- Table A provides examples of linear dimensions X in millimeters and ranges of linear dimensions in millimeters for the device and components of the device.
- Table B provides examples of radius dimensions R in millimeters and ranges of radius dimensions in millimeters for the device and components of the device.
- Table C provides examples of angular dimensions ⁇ in degrees and ranges of angular dimensions in degrees for the device and components of the device. The subscripts for each of the dimensions indicates the drawing in which the dimension first appears.
- an implantable device 500 is shown in various positions and configurations.
- the implantable device 500 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the device 500 can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- the implantable device 500 has a proximal or attachment portion 505 , a coaption element 510 (e.g., spacer, etc.), inner anchor portions or inner paddles 522 , outer anchor portions or outer paddles 520 , anchor extension members or paddle frames 524 , and a distal portion 507 .
- the inner paddles 522 are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) between the coaption element 510 and the outer paddles 520 .
- the outer paddles 520 are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) between the inner paddles 522 and the distal portion 507 .
- the paddle frames 524 are attached to the cap 514 at the distal portion 507 and extend to the joint portion 523 between the inner and outer paddles 522 , 520 .
- the paddle frames 524 are formed of a material that is more rigid and stiff than the material forming the paddles 522 , 520 so that the paddle frames 524 provide support for the paddles 522 , 520 .
- the inner paddles 522 are stiff, relatively stiff, rigid, have rigid portions and/or are stiffened by a stiffening member or the fixed portion of the clasps 530 . The stiffening of the inner paddle allows the device to move to the various different positions shown and described herein.
- the inner paddle 522 , the outer paddle 520 , the coaption can all be interconnected as described herein, such that the device 500 is constrained to the movements and positions shown and described herein.
- the device 500 is shown in a closed position. When closed, the inner paddles 522 are disposed between the outer paddles 520 and the coaption element 510 .
- the device 500 includes clasps or gripping members 530 ( FIG. 48 ) that can be opened and closed to grasp the native leaflets 20 , 22 of the mitral valve MV.
- the clasps 530 are attached to and move with the inner paddles 522 and are disposed between the inner paddles 522 and the coaption element 510 .
- the device 500 is shown in a partially open position.
- the device 500 is moved into the partially open position by an actuation element or means for actuation 512 that passes through the attachment portion 505 and coaption element 510 and can removably engage the distal portion 507 .
- the actuation element 512 is extended through the attachment portion 505 such that a distance D between the attachment portion 505 and distal portion 507 increases as the actuation element 512 is extended.
- the pair of inner and outer paddles 522 , 520 are moved in unison, rather than independently, by a single actuation element 512 .
- the positions of the clasps 530 are dependent on the positions of the paddles 522 , 520 .
- closing the paddles 522 , 520 also closes the clasps.
- the device 500 can be made to have the paddles 520 , 522 be independently controllable in the same manner as the FIG. 11A embodiment.
- Extending the actuation element 512 pulls down on the bottom portions of the outer paddles 520 and paddle frames 524 .
- the outer paddles 520 and paddle frames 524 pull down on the inner paddles 522 , where the inner paddles 522 are connected to the outer paddles 520 and the paddle frames 524 .
- the inner paddles 522 are caused to flex or pivot in an opening direction.
- the inner paddles 522 , the outer paddles 520 , and the paddle frames all flex to the position shown in FIG. 49 . Opening the paddles 522 , 520 and frames 524 forms a gap 520 A between the coaption element 510 and the inner paddle 522 that can receive and grasp the native leaflets 20 .
- some embodiments of the device 500 include clasps or gripping members 530 .
- the clasps 530 When the device 500 is partially opened the clasps 530 are exposed.
- the closed clasps 530 FIG. 50
- the closed clasps 530 FIG. 51
- the extent of the gap 530 A in the clasps 530 is limited to the extent that the inner paddle 522 has spread away from the coaption element 510 .
- the device 500 is shown in a laterally extended or open position.
- the device 500 is moved into the laterally extended or open position by continuing to extend the actuation element 512 described above, thereby increasing the distance D between the attachment portion 505 and distal portion 507 .
- Continuing to extend the actuation element 512 pulls down on the outer paddles 520 and paddle frames 524 , thereby causing the inner paddles 522 to spread apart further from the coaption element 510 .
- the inner paddles 522 extend horizontally more than in other positions of the device 500 and form an approximately 90-degree angle with the coaption element 510 .
- the paddle frames 524 are at their maximum spread position when the device 500 is in the laterally extended or open position.
- the increased gap 520 A formed in the laterally extended or open position allows clasps 530 to open further ( FIG. 54 ) before engaging the coaption element 510 , thereby increasing the size of the gap 530 A.
- the device 500 is shown in a three-quarters extended position.
- the device 500 is moved into the three-quarters extended position by continuing to extend the actuation element 512 described above, thereby increasing the distance D between the attachment portion 505 and distal portion 507 .
- Continuing to extend the actuation element 512 pulls down on the outer paddles 520 and paddle frames 524 , thereby causing the inner paddles 522 to spread apart further from the coaption element 510 .
- the inner paddles 522 are open beyond 90 degrees to an approximately 135-degree angle with the coaption element 510 .
- the paddle frames 524 are less spread than in the laterally extended or open position and begin to move inward toward the actuation element 512 as the actuation element 512 extends further.
- the outer paddles 520 also flex back toward the actuation element 512 .
- the increased gap 520 A formed in the laterally extended or open position allows clasps 530 to open even further ( FIG. 57 ), thereby increasing the size of the gap 530 A.
- the device 500 is shown in an almost fully extended position.
- the device 500 is moved into the almost fully extended position by continuing to extend the actuation element 512 described above, thereby increasing the distance D between the attachment portion 505 and distal portion 507 .
- Continuing to extend the actuation element 512 pulls down on the outer paddles 520 and paddle frames 524 , thereby causing the inner paddles 522 to spread apart further from the coaption element 510 .
- the inner paddles 522 begin to approach an approximately 180-degree angle with the coaption element 510 .
- the outer paddles 520 and the paddle frames 522 never move or flex to or past a ninety-degree angle with respect to the coaption element 510 .
- the inner and outer paddles 522 , 520 can have a somewhat curved shape.
- the device 500 is shown in a fully extended position.
- the device 500 is moved into the fully extended position by continuing to extend the actuation element 512 described above, thereby increasing the distance D between the attachment portion 505 and distal portion 507 to a maximum distance allowable by the device 500 .
- Continuing to extend the actuation element 512 pulls down on the outer paddles 520 and paddle frames 524 , thereby causing the inner paddles 522 to spread apart further from the coaption element 510 .
- the outer paddles 520 and paddle frames 524 move to a position where they are close to the actuation element.
- the inner paddles 522 are open to an approximately 180-degree angle with the coaption element 510 .
- the inner and outer paddles 522 , 520 are stretched straight in the fully extended position to form an approximately 180-degree angle between the paddles 522 , 520 .
- the fully extended position of the device 500 provides the maximum size of the gap 520 A between the paddles, and, in some embodiments, allows clasps 530 to also open fully to approximately 180 degrees ( FIG. 61 ) between portions of the clasp 530 .
- the position of the device 500 is the narrowest configuration.
- the fully extended position of the device 500 may be a desirable position for bailout of the device 500 from an attempted implantation or may be a desired position for placement of the device in a delivery catheter, or the like.
- an implantable device 500 A is shown in various positions and configurations.
- the implantable device 500 A can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the device 500 A can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- the implantable device 500 A has a proximal or attachment portion 505 A, a coaption element 510 A, inner anchor portions or inner paddles 522 A, outer anchor portions or outer paddles 520 A, anchor extension members or paddle frames 524 A, and a distal portion 507 A.
- the inner paddles 522 A are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) between the coaption element 510 A, e.g., by joint portions 525 A and the outer paddles 520 A by joint portions 523 A.
- the outer paddles 520 A are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) between the inner paddles 522 A, e.g., by joint portions 523 A and the distal portion 507 A by joint portions 521 A.
- the paddle frames 524 A are attached to the cap 514 A ( FIG. 48A ) at the distal portion 507 A and extend to the joint portion 523 A between the inner and outer paddles 522 A, 520 A.
- the paddle frames 524 A are formed of a material that is more rigid and stiff than the material forming the paddles 522 A, 520 A so that the paddle frames 524 A provide support for the paddles 522 A, 520 A.
- the paddle frames 524 A include an opening or slot 524 B for receiving the joint portions 523 A ( FIG. 65A ).
- the inner paddles 522 A are stiff, relatively stiff, rigid, have rigid portions and/or are stiffened by a stiffening member or the fixed portion of the clasps 530 C.
- the stiffening of the inner paddle allows the device to move to the various different positions shown and described herein.
- the inner paddle 522 A, the outer paddle 520 A, and the coaption element can all be interconnected as described herein, such that the device 500 A is constrained to the movements and positions shown and described herein.
- the coaption element 510 A, inner paddles 522 A, outer paddles 520 A can be attached together by integrally forming the coaption element 510 A and the paddles 520 A, 522 A as a single, unitary component. This can be accomplished, for example, by forming the coaption element 510 A and the paddles 520 A, 522 A from a continuous strip 501 A of a braided or woven material, such as braided or woven nitinol wire.
- the continuous strip 501 A is attached a collar 511 D, a cap 514 A, paddle frames 524 A, clasps 530 C.
- the coaption element 510 A, hinge portions 521 A, 523 A, 525 A, outer paddles 520 A, and inner paddles 522 A are formed from the continuous strip 501 A.
- the continuous strip 501 A can be a single layer of material or can include two or more layers.
- portions of the device 500 A have a single layer of the strip of material 501 A and other portions are formed from multiple overlapping or overlying layers of the strip of material 501 A. For example, FIG.
- the coaption element 510 A and inner paddles 522 A formed from multiple overlapping or overlying layers of the strip of material 501 A. Consequently, the coaption element 510 A and inner paddle 522 A have an increased stiffness relative to the outer paddles 520 A that are formed from a single layer of material 501 A.
- the single continuous strip of material 501 A can start and end in various locations of the device 500 A.
- the ends of the strip of material 501 A can be in the same location or different locations of the device 500 A.
- the strip of material begins and ends in the location of the inner paddles 522 .
- the clasps 530 C can comprise attachment or fixed portions 532 C, arm or moveable portions 534 C, barbs 536 C, and joint portions 538 C.
- the attachment or fixed portions 532 C can be coupled to the inner paddles 522 A in various ways such as with sutures, adhesive, fasteners, welding, stitching, swaging, friction fit and/or other means for coupling with the joint portions 538 C disposed proximate the coaption element 510 A.
- the clasps 530 C can be similar to clasps 430 ,
- the moveable portions 534 C can pivot or flex relative to the fixed portions 532 C between an open configuration (e.g., FIG. 54A ) and a closed configuration ( FIG. 48A ).
- the clasps 530 C can be biased to the closed configuration.
- the fixed portions 532 C and the moveable portions 534 C pivot or flex away from each other such that native leaflets can be positioned between the fixed portions 532 C and the moveable portions 534 C.
- the fixed portions 532 C and the moveable portions 534 C pivot or flex toward each other, thereby clamping the native leaflets between the fixed portions 532 C and the moveable portions 534 C.
- the fixed arms 532 C remain stationary or substantially stationary when the moveable arms 534 C are opened to open the barbed clasps 530 C and expose the barbs 536 C.
- the barbed clasps 530 C are opened by applying tension to actuation lines 516 A attached to the moveable arms 534 C, thereby causing the moveable arms 534 C to pivot or flex on the joint portions 538 C.
- FIGS. 47A, and 48A-48H the device 500 A is shown in a closed position.
- a side view of the device 500 A is shown in FIGS. 48B, 48C, and 48F , from a front view in Figures FIGS. 48D, 48E, and 48G , and from a bottom view in FIG. 48H .
- the device 500 A is narrower when viewed from the front than the side. From the side, the device 500 A has a generally inverted trapezoidal shape that is rounded and tapers toward the distal portion 507 A of the device 500 A. From the front, the device 500 A has a generally rounded rectangle shape that tapers somewhat toward the distal portion 507 A. As can be seen from the bottom view of the device 500 A shown in FIG. 48H , the device 500 A has a generally rounded rectangle shape when viewed from below (and when viewed from above as can be seen in, for example, FIG. 70A ).
- the inner paddles 522 A are disposed between the outer paddles 520 A and the coaption element 510 A.
- the device 500 A includes clasps or gripping members 530 C ( FIG. 48A ) that can be opened and closed to grasp the native leaflets 20 , 22 of the mitral valve MV.
- the clasps 530 C are attached to and move with the inner paddles 522 A and are disposed between the inner paddles 522 A and the coaption element 510 A.
- the device 500 A is shown attached to a delivery device 502 A.
- the delivery device 502 A has actuatable members or fingers 503 A that releasably engage the attachment portion 505 A.
- An actuation element 512 A extends from the delivery device 502 A to the cap 514 A through the attachment portion 505 A and coaption element 510 A of the prosthetic device 500 A. Extending and retracting the actuation element 512 A causes the device 500 A to open and close, as is described below.
- Actuation lines/sutures 516 A extend from the delivery device 502 A to attach to the clasps 530 C. Tension can be applied to the sutures 516 A to open the clasps 530 C and released to allow the clasps 530 C to close.
- the device 500 A is shown separated from the delivery device 502 A in a deployed condition in FIGS. 48F-48G .
- the cover 540 A can be formed from a single piece of material, or from multiple segments abutting or joined to each other.
- the cover 540 A has an outer or lower cover 541 A and an inner or upper cover 543 A.
- the outer cover 541 A covers the cap 514 A, outer paddles 520 A, inner paddles 522 A, and clasps 530 C.
- the inner cover 543 A covers the coaption element 510 A and the proximal ends of the inner paddles 522 A and clasps 530 C where the coaption element 510 A meets the inner paddles 522 A and clasps 530 C.
- the cover 540 A can be a cloth material such as polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh. The cloth cover can provide a blood seal on the surface of the spacer, and/or promote rapid tissue ingrowth.
- the device 500 A is shown in a laterally extended or open position.
- the device 500 A is moved into the open position by the actuation element or means for actuation 512 A that passes through the attachment portion 505 A and coaption element 510 A and can removably engage the distal portion 507 A.
- the actuation element 512 A is extended through the attachment portion 505 A such that a distance D 2 between the attachment portion 505 A and distal portion 507 A increases as the actuation element 512 A is extended.
- a distance D 2 between the attachment portion 505 A and distal portion 507 A increases as the actuation element 512 A is extended.
- the pair of inner and outer paddles 520 A, 522 A are moved in unison, rather than independently, by a single actuation element 512 A.
- the positions of the clasps 530 C are dependent on the positions of the paddles 520 A, 522 A. For example, referring to FIG. 48A closing the paddles 520 A, 522 A also closes the clasps 530 C.
- the device 500 A can be made to have the paddles 520 A, 522 A be independently controllable in the same manner as the FIG. 11A embodiment.
- Extending the actuation element 512 A pulls down on the bottom portions of the outer paddles 520 A and paddle frames 524 A to transition the device 500 A from a closed to partially open position.
- the outer paddles 520 A and paddle frames 524 A pull down on the inner paddles 522 A where the inner paddles 522 A are connected to the outer paddles 520 A and the paddle frames 524 A.
- the attachment portion 505 A and coaption element 510 A are held in place, the inner paddles 522 A are caused to pivot or flex in an opening direction.
- the inner paddles 522 A, the outer paddles 520 A, and the paddle frames all flex to the position shown in FIG. 53A . Opening the paddles 522 A, 520 A and frames 524 forms a gap 520 D between the coaption element 510 A and the inner paddle 522 A that can receive and grasp the native leaflets 20 .
- the actuation element 512 A pulls down on the outer paddles 520 A and paddle frames 524 A, thereby causing the inner paddles 522 A to spread apart further from the coaption element 510 A.
- the inner paddles 522 A extend horizontally more than in other positions of the device 500 A and form an approximately 90-degree angle with the coaption element 510 A.
- the paddle frames 524 A are at their maximum spread position when the device 500 A is in the laterally extended or open position.
- the increased gap 520 D formed in the laterally extended or open position allows clasps 530 C to open further ( FIG. 54A ) before engaging the coaption element 510 A, thereby increasing the size of the gap 530 D as compared to the partially open position.
- some embodiments of the device 500 A include clasps or gripping members 530 A.
- the clasps 530 C are exposed.
- the closed clasps 530 C FIGS. 53A-53D
- the closed clasps 530 C FIGS. 54A-54D
- the extent of the gap 530 D in the clasps 530 C is limited to the extent that the inner paddle 522 A has spread away from the coaption element 510 A.
- the device 500 A is shown in a fully extended position.
- the device 500 A is moved into the fully extended position by continuing to extend the actuation element 512 A described above, thereby increasing the distance D 2 between the attachment portion 505 A and distal portion 507 A to a maximum distance allowable by the device 500 A.
- Continuing to extend the actuation element 512 A pulls down on the outer paddles 520 A and paddle frames 524 A, thereby causing the inner paddles 522 A to extend further away from the coaption element 510 A.
- the outer paddles 520 A and paddle frames 524 A move to a position where they are close to the actuation element.
- the inner paddles 522 A are open to an approximately 180-degree angle with the coaption element 510 A.
- the inner and outer paddles 522 A, 520 A are stretched straight or substantially straight in the fully extended position to form an approximately 180-degree angle between the paddles 522 A, 520 A.
- the fully extended position of the device 500 A provides the maximum size of the gap 520 D between the paddles, and, in some embodiments, allows clasps 530 C to also open fully to approximately 180 degrees ( FIG. 61A ) between portions of the clasp 530 A.
- the position of the device 500 A is the narrowest configuration.
- the fully extended position of the device 500 A may be a desirable position for bailout of the device 500 A from an attempted implantation or may be a desired position for placement of the device in a delivery catheter, or the like.
- the inner cover 543 A can be seen covering the coaption element 510 A from the proximal portion 519 B to the distal portion 517 A.
- the inner cover 543 A is formed from a flat sheet (see FIG. 201 ) of a cloth material such as polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh and is folded around the coaption element 510 A and held in place by stitches 545 A.
- the outer cover 541 A can be seen covering the clasps 530 C and inner paddles 522 A.
- Collar portions 548 A of inner cover 543 A cover the portion of the clasps 530 C and inner paddles 522 A closest to the coaption element 510 A.
- Transition portions 547 A of the inner cover 543 A extend from the coaption element 510 A to the collar portions 548 A to provide a smooth transition between the coaption element 510 A and the clasps 530 C and inner paddles 522 A so that native tissue is not caught on the device 500 A during implantation.
- the coaption element 510 A, outer paddles 520 A, and inner paddles 522 A are formed from a single strip of material 501 A, as described above.
- the collar 511 D, cap 514 A, paddle frames 524 A, and clasps 530 C are assembled to the strip of material 501 A to form the device 500 A.
- the cap 514 A includes a retention body 560 A with a locking aperture 561 A for receiving a retaining nut 562 A having a threaded bore 564 A that engages a threaded portion 568 A of a retaining bolt 566 A.
- the threaded portion 568 A of the retaining bolt 566 A is inserted through the opening 527 B to engage the retention body and nut 560 A, 562 A to attach the cap 514 A to the strip of material 501 A.
- a stiffening member 539 C is attached to the inner paddle 522 A to stiffen the inner paddle 522 A to maintain the inner paddle in a straight or substantially straight configuration as the inner paddle is moved between the various positions.
- a cutout 539 D in the stiffening member 539 C is shaped to receive the fixed arm 532 C of the clasp 530 C so that the stiffening member 539 C can fit around the fixed arm 532 C when both the stiffening member 539 C and clasp 530 C are attached to the inner paddle 522 A.
- the stiffening member 539 C can be coupled to the inner paddles 522 A in various ways such as with sutures, adhesive, fasteners, welding, stitching, swaging, friction fit and/or other means for coupling.
- the collar 511 A includes protrusions 511 B for releasably engaging the fingers 503 A of the delivery device 502 A.
- An aperture 515 A in the collar 511 A receives the actuation element 512 A.
- the proximal portion 519 B of the coaption element 510 A flares outward to form two loops 519 D that are inserted through the arcuate openings 513 A of the collar 511 D to attach the collar 511 D to the proximal portion 519 B of the coaption element 510 A.
- the loops 519 D are formed by folding the strip of material 501 A to form first and second layers 581 A, 582 A.
- the arcuate openings 513 A include an opening (not shown) similar to the
- FIG. 201 shows an enlarged view of the cap 514 A attached to the distal portion 527 A of the strip of material 501 A is shown.
- the retention body 560 A, retaining nut 562 A, and retaining bolt 566 A cooperate to attach the paddle frames 524 A to the distal portion 527 A of the strip of material 501 A.
- the retaining bolt 566 A is inserted through the opening 527 B of the distal portion 527 A ( FIG. 202 ) to prohibit movement of the cap 514 A along the strip of material 501 A.
- a channel 560 B in the retention body 560 A and a flange 567 A of the bolt 566 A form a passageway 514 B through the cap 514 A for the distal portion 527 A.
- the components of the cap 514 A are shown in an exploded view to better illustrate the features of the components of the cap 514 A and paddle frames 524 A and to show how those features interlock during assembly of the cap 514 A to the distal portion 527 A.
- Forming the cap 514 A from multiple components that can be assembled around the strip of material 501 A allows the cap 514 A to be attached after the strip of material 501 A has been folded to form the coaption element 510 A and paddles 520 A, 522 A and been woven through the collar 511 D and paddle frames 524 A.
- the retention body 560 A includes a locking aperture 561 A for receiving the retaining nut 562 A.
- the locking aperture 561 A has a generally rectangular shape and includes two opposing locking channels 561 B that receive the attachment portions 524 C of the paddle frames 524 A.
- a transverse locking channel 561 C formed in the bottom of the retention body 560 A has the same width as the locking channels 561 B.
- the paddle frames 524 A include notches 524 D in the attachment portions 524 C that form hook portions 524 E that engage the transverse locking channel 561 A to secure the paddle frames 524 A to the cap 514 A.
- the retaining nut 562 A includes a rectangular locking body 563 A extending distally from a flange 563 B.
- the locking body 563 A is configured to slidably engage the locking aperture 561 A of the retention body 560 A while leaving the locking channels 561 B unobstructed.
- the locking body 563 A can be inserted into the locking aperture 561 A to lock the attachment portions 524 C of the paddle frames 524 A within the locking channels 561 B.
- Notches 563 C in the flange 563 B accommodate the attachment portions 524 C of the paddle frames 524 A.
- the threaded bore 564 A is formed through the retaining nut 562 A to receive the retaining bolt 566 A.
- the retaining bolt 566 A includes a threaded portion 568 A extending from the flange 567 A.
- the threaded portion 568 A is inserted through the opening 527 B in the distal portion 527 A to threadedly engage the threaded bore 564 A of the retaining nut 562 A.
- the flange 567 A has a rounded shape that provides a rounded end to the distal portion 505 A of the device 500 A.
- the flange 567 A includes openings 567 B for receiving a tool (not shown) that engages the bolt 566 A so that the bolt 566 A can be turned during assembly to couple the components of the cap 514 A together.
- the paddle frames 524 A and cap 514 A are squeezed to narrow the width of the attachment portion 524 C so that the attachment portions 524 C can be inserted into the locking channels 561 B of the locking aperture 561 A.
- the attachment portions 524 C expand outward so that the notches 524 D engage the retention body 560 A and the hook portions 524 E engage the transverse locking channel 561 C.
- the retaining nut 562 A is then inserted into the locking aperture 561 A with the locking portion 563 A arranged between the two attachment portions 524 C of each paddle frame 524 A, thereby locking the paddle frames 524 A in engagement with the retention body 560 A.
- the assembled paddle frames 524 A, retention body 560 A, and retaining nut 562 A are placed on the distal portion 527 A so that the threaded bore 564 A aligns with the opening 527 B and the threaded portion 568 A of the bolt 566 A is inserted through the opening 527 B to threadedly engage the threaded bore 564 A.
- the bolt 566 A is then tightened until the flange 567 A engages the retention body 560 A and the cap 514 A is securely assembled to the distal portion 527 A.
- the cover 540 A includes the outer cover 541 A and the inner cover 543 A.
- Each of the covers 541 A, 543 A include different shaped segments or portions to attach to different portions of the device 500 A.
- the covers 541 A, 543 A are shaped to smooth transitions between portions of the device 500 A to reduce catch points and provide a smoother exterior to the device 500 .
- the various segments of the covers 541 A, 543 A extend from a middle portion that is shaped to attach to an end of the device 500 A.
- the portion of the cover 541 A, 543 A that attaches to an end of the device 500 A is located at an end of the covers 541 A, 543 A or can be located anywhere between the middle and ends of the covers 541 A, 543 A.
- Various portions of the covers 541 A, 543 A can be shaped to wrap around portions of the device 500 A.
- the cover 540 A can be made of any suitable material, such as a polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh.
- the cover is formed out of a single piece of material.
- the cover can be formed of any number of pieces of material that are attached to the device and/or joined together by any suitable means, such as by stitching, adhesives, welding, or the like.
- the outer cover 541 A extends outward from a middle portion 580 to end portions 588 .
- the middle portion 580 is shaped to be attached to the cap 514 A of the device 500 A.
- Outer paddle portions 582 extend from the middle portion 580 to inner paddle and inside clasp portions 584 .
- the inner paddle and inside clasp portions 584 extend from the outer paddle portions 582 to outside moveable clasp portions 586 .
- the outside moveable clasp portions 586 extend from the inner paddle portions 584 to the end portions 588 .
- the outer paddle portions 582 include wing portions 583 that extend laterally to a width that is wider than the other portions of the outer cover 541 A so that the outer paddle portions 582 can attach to the outer paddles 520 A and paddle frames 524 A of the device 500 A.
- the inner paddle portions 584 attach to the inner paddles 522 A, stationary arms 532 C, and the inside surface (the side with the barbs) of the moveable arms 534 C.
- the outside clasp portions 586 attach to the outside surface (the side without the barbs) of the moveable arms 534 C of the clasps 530 C.
- the ends 588 of the outer cover 541 A terminate near the joint portion 538 C of the clasp 530 C on the outside of the clasps 530 C.
- the inner paddle and inside clasp portions 584 include openings 585 that allow the barbs 536 C of the clasps 530 C to protrude through the outer cover 541 A to engage tissue of the native heart valve.
- the inner cover 543 A extends outward from a middle portion 590 to end portions 598 .
- the middle portion 590 is configured to be attached to the collar 511 D of the device 500 A. Openings 591 in the middle portion 590 expose the protrusions 511 E from the collar 511 D when the middle portion 590 is attached to the collar 511 D so that the protrusions 511 E can be engaged by the delivery device 502 A.
- Coaption portions 592 extend from the middle portion 590 to flexible hinge portions 594 .
- Holes 593 along the edges of the coaption portions 592 allow each of the coaption portions 592 to be joined together after being folded around the coaption element 510 A, such as, for example, by stitches 545 A.
- the flexible hinge portions 594 extend from the coaption portions 592 to transition portions 596 .
- the transition portions 596 extend from the flexible hinge portions 594 to the end portions 598 .
- Holes 597 along the edges of the transition portions 596 allow each of the transition portions 596 to be wrapped around the inner paddle 522 A and ends of the clasp 536 C and secured to itself by stitches or other suitable securing means.
- the flexible hinge portions 594 bridge the gaps between the coaption element 510 A and the clasps 530 C when the device 500 A is opened, as can be seen in FIG. 198 .
- the implantable device 700 has paddles 702 that open and close to grasp leaflets 20 , 22 against barbed clasps or gripping devices 704 .
- the paddles 702 move to create an opening 706 between the paddles 702 and gripping devices 704 in which the leaflets 20 , 22 can be grasped.
- the device 700 can be configured to close a wide gap 26 ( FIG. 6 ) in the native heart valve MV, TV.
- the implantable device 700 can include any other features for a device discussed in the present application, and the device 700 can be positioned to engage valve leaflets 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- the device 700 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the device 700 can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- the paddles 702 of the device 700 are moved, rotated, or pivoted outward in the direction X to create an opening 706 between the paddles 702 and the gripping members 704 having a width W.
- the width W can be, for example, between about 5 mm and about 15 mm, such as between 7.5 mm and about 12.5 mm, such as about 10 mm. In alternative embodiments, the width W can be less than 5 mm or greater than 15 mm.
- the paddles 702 of the device 700 are moved outward in the direction Z such that the opening 706 has a width H.
- the width H can be, for example, between about 10 mm and about 25 mm, such as between about 10 mm and about 20 mm, such as between about 12.5 mm and about 17.5 mm, such as about 15 mm. In some embodiments, the width H can be less than 10 mm or more than 25 mm. In certain embodiments, the ratio between the width H and the width W can be about 5 to 1 or less, such as about 4 to 1 or less such as about 3 to 1 or less, such as about 2 to 1 or less, such as about 1.5 to 1 or less, such as about 1.25 to 1 or less, such as about 1 to 1.
- the device 700 can be configured such that the paddles 702 are moved, rotated, or pivoted outward in the direction X and then moved outward in the direction Z to create the opening 706 having a width H between the paddles 702 and the gripping members 704 .
- the device 700 can be configured such that the paddles are moved outward in the direction Z and then moved or pivoted outward in the direction X to create width H between the paddles 702 and gripping members 704 .
- the device 700 can be configured such that the paddles 702 are moved or pivoted outward in the direction X and moved outward in the direction Z simultaneously to create the width H between the paddles 702 and the gripping members 704 .
- FIGS. 63A-63C illustrate an implantable device 700 in which the paddles 702 are moved, rotated, or pivoted outward in the direction X, and, subsequently, moved outward in the direction Z to create a wider opening 706 .
- FIG. 63A illustrates the implantable device 700 in a closed position, such that the paddles 702 are engaging the gripping members 704 .
- FIG. 63B the paddles 702 are moved or pivoted outward in the direction X to create an opening 706 having a width W for receiving valve tissue.
- the paddles 702 are moved or pivoted outward in the direction X, the paddles 702 are moved outward in the direction Z such that the opening 706 has a width H.
- the valve repair device is moved back to the closed position (as shown in FIG. 63A ) to secure the valve repair device 700 to the valve tissue.
- the implantable device 700 can include any other features for an implantable device discussed in the present application, and the implantable device 700 can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- FIGS. 64A-64C illustrate an implantable device 700 in which the paddles 702 are moved outward in the direction Z, and, subsequently, moved, extended, or pivoted outward in the direction X to create a wider opening 706 .
- FIG. 64A illustrates the implantable device 700 in a closed position, such that the paddles 702 are engaging the gripping members 704 .
- FIG. 64B the paddles 702 are moved outward in the direction Z to create an opening 706 having a width W for receiving valve tissue.
- FIG. 64C after the paddles 702 are moved outward in the direction Z, the paddles 702 are moved or pivoted outward in the direction X such that the opening 706 has a width H.
- the implantable device 700 is moved back to the closed position (as shown in FIG. 64A ) to secure the implantable device 700 to the valve tissue.
- the implantable device 700 can include any other features for an implantable device discussed in the present application, and the implantable device 700 can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- FIGS. 63A-63C illustrate a device 700 in which the paddles 702 are moved or pivoted and then spread apart
- FIGS. 64A-64C illustrate a device 700 in which the paddles 702 are spread apart and then moved or pivoted
- a device 700 can include paddles 702 that can be spread apart and moved or pivoted simultaneously.
- the paddles 702 can be spread apart and moved or pivoted independently of each other. That is, in the embodiments for the valve repair device 700 shown in FIGS. 63A-63C and 64A-64C , as well as the embodiment in which the spreading apart and moving or pivoting of each paddle 702 is completed simultaneously, the paddles 702 can be controlled independently of each other.
- the example implantable device 500 is shown in the closed condition.
- the device 500 extends from a proximal portion 505 to a distal portion 507 and includes a coaption portion 510 , inner paddles 522 , outer paddles 520 , and paddle frames 524 .
- the outer paddles 520 extend to and/or around the paddle frames 524 and can have more than one layer to surround the paddle frames 524 .
- the proximal portion 505 can include a collar 511 for attaching a delivery device (not shown).
- the distal portion 507 can include a cap 514 that is attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) to the outer paddles 520 and is engaged by an actuation element (not shown) to open and close the device 500 to facilitate implantation in the native valve as described in the present application.
- a cap 514 that is attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) to the outer paddles 520 and is engaged by an actuation element (not shown) to open and close the device 500 to facilitate implantation in the native valve as described in the present application.
- the device 500 has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a vertical front-to-back plane 550 and is generally narrower at the distal portion 507 than the proximal portion 505 .
- the shape of the coaption element 510 and paddle frames 524 is rounded or generally rounded to prevent the device 500 from catching or snagging on structures of the heart, such as the chordae tendineae, during implantation. For this reason, the proximal collar 511 ( FIG. 68 ) and cap 514 ( FIG. 68 ) also have round edges.
- the paddle frames 524 When viewed from the front or back, the paddle frames 524 can be seen to have a rounded or generally rounded shape, extending upwards and outwards from the distal portion 507 to approximately coincide with the shape of the coaption element 510 when viewed from the front or back.
- the coaption element 510 and paddle frames 524 generally define the shape of the device 500 when viewed from the front or back.
- the rounded shape of the paddle frames 524 and the corresponding rounded shape of the coaption element can distribute leaflet stress across a wider surface.
- the paddle frames 524 and/or the coaption element 510 can have other shapes.
- the device 500 has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a vertical side-to-side plane 552 when viewed from the side.
- the distal portion 507 is also generally narrower than the proximal portion 505 when the device 500 is viewed from the side.
- the coaption element 510 optionally also has a tapering or generally tapering shape that narrows toward the distal portion 507 of the device 500 . However, in some example embodiments, the coaption element does not taper as it extends from the proximal portion of the device to the distal portion of the device.
- the rounded features of the device 500 are further demonstrated by the round shape of the paddles 520 , 522 where the inner and outer paddles 520 , 522 are joined together and the round shape of the paddle frames 524 .
- the paddles 520 , 522 and paddle frames 524 can take a wide variety of different forms.
- the paddles 520 , 522 and the paddle frames 524 can be rounded along the top edges but be flat or substantially flat on the sides of the paddles 520 , 522 and/or the paddle frames.
- the closed paddles 520 , 522 form gaps 542 between the inner paddles 522 and the coaption element 510 that are configured to receive native tissue.
- the narrowing of the coaption element 510 gives the gaps 542 a somewhat teardrop shape that increases in width as the gaps 542 approach the distal portion 507 of the device. The widening of the gaps 542 toward the distal portion 507 allows the paddles 520 , 522 to contact tissue grasped in the gaps 542 nearer to the proximal portion 505 .
- the paddle frames 524 extend vertically from the distal portion 507 toward the proximal portion 505 until approximately a middle third of the device 500 before bending or flaring outward so that the connection portion of the frames 524 passes through gaps 544 formed by the inner paddles 522 folded inside of the outer paddles 520 .
- the connection of the frames are positioned inside the inner paddles 522 or outside the outer paddles 520 .
- the outer paddles 520 have a rounded shape that is similar to that of the coaption element 510 when viewed from the front or back ( FIGS. 67-68 ).
- the device 500 has a rounded shape or substantially round shape. The round shape of the device 500 is particularly visible when the device 500 is viewed from the top ( FIGS. 70-71 ) or bottom ( FIGS. 72-73 ).
- the device 500 has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a front-to-back plane 550 and is also symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a side-to-side plane 552 when viewed from the top.
- An opening 519 A in the coaption element 510 is visible at the proximal portion 505 of the device 500 .
- the coaption element 510 can be hollow inside.
- the proximal collar 511 shown in FIG. 71 can be secured to the coaption element 510 to close off the coaption element 510 .
- the coaption element is not planar and has all curved surfaces.
- the coaption elements 510 illustrated herein can be formed of a series of blended surfaces have a variety of different radii of curvature.
- the coaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval-shape when viewed from the top.
- the coaption element 510 can have other shapes when viewed from the top.
- the coaption element can have a rectangular, square, diamond, elliptical, or any other shape.
- the paddle frames 224 each have an arcuate shape with a smaller radius than the coaption element 510 so that the gaps 542 formed between the inner paddles 522 and paddle frames 524 and the coaption element 510 taper as they approach left 551 and right 553 sides of the device 500 .
- native tissue such as the leaflets 20 , 22 tend to be pinched between the paddle frames 524 and the coaption element 510 towards the left and right sides 551 , 553 of the device 500 .
- the device 500 has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around the front-to-back plane 550 and is also symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around the side-to-side plane 552 when viewed from the bottom.
- the cap 514 is shown in FIG. 73 and can jointably attach to the outer paddles 520 and the paddle frames 524 .
- the paddle frames 524 extend outward from the distal portion 507 of the device 500 to the left and right sides 551 , 553 at a narrow or slight angle from the side-to-side plane 552 .
- the paddle frames 524 extend further away from the side-to-side plane 552 as the paddle frames 524 extend toward the proximal portion of the device 500 ( FIG. 69 ) to ultimately form the arcuate shape seen in FIGS. 70-71 .
- FIGS. 74-83 perspective and cross-sectional views of the device 500 are shown.
- the device 500 is shown sliced by cross-section plane 75 near the proximal portion of the coaption element 510 .
- FIG. 75 a cross-sectional view of the device 500 is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 75 in FIG. 74 .
- the coaption element 510 has a round or generally round shape with lobes arranged along the front-to-back plane 550 .
- the gaps 542 between the paddle frames 524 and coaption element 510 form a crescent-like shape with a central width 543 . As noted above, the gaps 542 narrow as the gaps 542 approach the left and right sides 551 , 553 .
- the device 500 is shown sliced by cross-section plane 77 positioned about three-quarters of the way between the distal portion 507 and the proximal portion 505 of the coaption element 510 .
- FIG. 77 a cross-sectional view of the device 500 is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 77 in FIG. 76 .
- the coaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552 .
- the gaps 542 between the paddle frames 524 and coaption element 510 form a crescent or crescent-like shape with a central width 543 that is less than the central width 543 seen in FIG. 75 .
- the width 543 of the gaps 542 is narrower towards the center of the device, widens somewhat as the gaps 542 approach the left and right sides 551 , 553 before narrowing again.
- the native tissue is pinched in the center of the gaps 542 about three-quarters of the way up the coaption element 510 .
- the device 500 is shown sliced by cross-section plane 79 positioned about half of the way between the distal portion 507 and the proximal portion 505 of the coaption element 510 .
- FIG. 79 a cross-sectional view of the device 500 is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 79 in FIG. 78 .
- the coaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552 .
- the paddle frames 524 can be seen near the left and right sides 551 , 553 very close to or in contact with the coaption element 510 .
- the gaps 542 are crescent or generally crescent shaped and are wider than the gaps 542 viewed along the plane 77 ( FIG. 77 .)
- the device 500 is shown sliced by cross-section plane 81 positioned about one-quarter of the way between the distal portion 507 and the proximal portion 505 of the coaption element 510 .
- FIG. 81 a cross-sectional view of the device 500 is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 81 in FIG. 80 .
- the coaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552 that is narrower than the oval shape seen in FIG. 77 .
- the paddle frames 524 can be seen near the left and right sides 551 , 553 very close to or in contact with the coaption element 510 .
- the gaps 542 are crescent or generally crescent shaped and are wider than the gaps 542 viewed along the plane 79 ( FIG. 79 .)
- the device 500 is shown sliced by cross-section plane 83 positioned near the distal portion 507 of the coaption element 510 .
- FIG. 83 a cross-sectional view of the device 500 is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 83 in FIG. 82 .
- the coaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552 that is narrower than the oval shape seen in FIG. 79 as the coaption element 510 tapers toward the distal portion 507 of the device 500 .
- the paddle frames 524 can be seen near the left and right sides 551 , 553 very close to or in contact with the coaption element 510 . While the inner paddles 522 are not visible in FIG. 81 , the gaps 542 are crescent or generally crescent shaped and are wider than the gaps 542 viewed along the plane 81 ( FIG. 81 .)
- the example implantable device 500 A is shown in the closed condition.
- the device 500 A extends from a proximal portion 505 A to a distal portion 507 A and includes a coaption portion 510 A, inner paddles 522 A, outer paddles 520 A, and paddle frames 524 A.
- the proximal portion 505 A can include a collar 511 D for attaching a delivery device (not shown).
- the distal portion 507 A can include a cap 514 A that is attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) to the outer paddles 520 A and is engaged by an actuation element (not shown) to open and close the device 500 A to facilitate implantation in the native valve as described in the present application.
- the device 500 A has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a vertical front-to-back plane 550 A and is generally narrower at the distal portion 507 A than along the paddle frames 524 A.
- the shape of the coaption element 510 A and paddle frames 524 A is a generally rounded rectangular shape to prevent the device 500 A from catching or snagging on structures of the heart, such as the chordae tendineae, during implantation. For this reason, the proximal collar 511 D ( FIG. 68A ) and cap 514 A ( FIG. 68A ) can also have round edges.
- the paddle frames 524 A When viewed from the front or back, the paddle frames 524 A can be seen to have a generally rounded rectangular shape, extending upwards and outwards from the distal portion 507 A to a shape that has sides that are wider than and approximately parallel to the coaption element 510 A when viewed from the front or back.
- the paddle frames 524 A generally define the shape of the device 500 A when viewed from the front or back.
- the rounded rectangular shape of the paddle frames 524 A can distribute leaflet stress across a wider surface.
- the paddle frames 524 A and/or the coaption element 510 A can have other shapes.
- the device 500 A has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a vertical side-to-side plane 552 A ( FIG. 70A ) when viewed from the side (e.g., FIG. 47A ).
- the distal portion 507 A is also generally narrower than the proximal portion 505 A when the device 500 A is viewed from the side.
- the coaption element 510 A does not taper as it extends from the proximal portion 505 A of the device 500 A to the distal portion 507 A of the device 500 A. However, in some example embodiments, the coaption element does taper as it extends from the proximal portion of the device to the distal portion of the device (e.g., FIG. 47 ).
- the generally rounded features of the device 500 A are further demonstrated by the rounded shape of the paddles 520 A, 522 A where the inner and outer paddles 520 A, 522 A are joined together.
- the paddles 520 A, 522 A and paddle frames 524 A can take a wide variety of different forms.
- the paddles 520 A, 522 A and the paddle frames 524 A can be rounded along the top edges and be flat or substantially flat on the sides (e.g., the sides of the paddle frames 524 A arranged at the front and back sides of the device 500 A).
- two devices can be implanted side-by-side on the native valve leaflet, with the two devices sitting flush or substantially flush against each other.
- the closed paddles 520 A, 522 A form gaps 542 A between the inner paddles 522 A and the coaption element 510 A that are configured to receive native tissue.
- the proximal end of the coaption element 510 A has an approximately dog-bone shape so that the gaps 542 A are narrower toward the proximal portion 505 A than as the gaps 542 A approach the distal portion 507 A of the device.
- the narrowing of the gaps 542 A toward the attachment portion 507 A allows the paddles 520 A, 522 A to contact tissue grasped in the gaps 542 A nearer to the proximal portion 505 A.
- the paddle frames 524 A extend vertically from the distal portion 507 A toward the proximal portion 505 A until approximately a middle third of the device 500 A before bending or flaring outward so that a connection portion 524 B of the frames 524 A passes through gaps 544 A formed by the inner paddles 522 A folded inside of the outer paddles 520 A.
- the connections of the frames are positioned inside the inner paddles 522 A or outside the outer paddles 520 A.
- the outer paddles 520 A have a rounded rectangular shape that is similar to that of the coaption element 510 A when viewed from the front or back ( FIGS. 67A and 68A ).
- the device 500 A has a rounded rectangular shape.
- the rounded rectangular shape of the device 500 A is particularly visible when the device 500 A is viewed from the top ( FIGS. 70A and 71A ) or bottom ( FIGS. 72A and 73A ).
- the device 500 A has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a front-to-back plane 550 A and is also symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a side-to-side plane 552 A when viewed from the top.
- a proximal opening 519 C in the coaption element 510 A is visible at the proximal portion 505 A of the device 500 A.
- the actuation element 512 A is received through the opening 519 C so that the coaption element 510 A wraps around the actuation element 512 A.
- the opening 519 C is formed by inserting the actuation element 512 A between the folded and overlapping layers of the strip of material 501 A (described in detail below). In other embodiments, the opening 519 C is formed by shape-setting the folded layers of the strip of material 501 A forming the coaption element 510 A around a blank or jig to give the coaption element 510 A a rounded or generally rounded shape.
- the proximal collar 511 D shown in FIG. 71A can be secured to the coaption element 510 A to close off the coaption element 510 A.
- the proximal collar 511 D includes attachment portions 513 A that engage with openings 546 A formed by the folded layers of the strip of material 501 A that form the coaption element 510 A.
- the attachment portions 513 A are holes in the collar 511 D so that the strip of material 501 A must be inserted through the collar 511 D before folding the strip of material 501 A during assembly of the device 500 A.
- the attachment portions 513 A are open slots (e.g., the attachment portions 524 B of the paddle frames 524 A) that receive the strip of material 501 A before or after folding the strip of material 501 A.
- the coaption element 510 A has a generally rectangular shape when viewed from the top.
- the coaption element 510 A can have other shapes when viewed from the top.
- the coaption element can have a round, square, diamond, elliptical, or any other shape.
- the paddle frames 224 A each have a rounded rectangular shape when viewed from the top so that the paddle frames 224 A surround the rectangular coaption element 510 A.
- native tissue such as the leaflets 20 , 22 tend to be pinched or compressed evenly in the gaps 542 A formed between the inner paddles 522 A and paddle frames 524 A and the coaption element 510 A.
- FIGS. 72A and 73A bottom views of the device 500 A are shown.
- the device 500 A has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around the front-to-back plane 550 A and is also symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around the side-to-side plane 552 A when viewed from the bottom.
- a distal portion 527 A of the strip of material 501 A includes an aperture 527 B for receiving the cap 514 A shown in FIG. 73A .
- the paddle frames 524 A extend outward from the distal portion 507 A of the device 500 A to the left and right sides 551 A, 553 A at a narrow or slight angle from the side-to-side plane 552 A.
- the paddle frames 524 A extend further away from the side-to-side plane 552 A while maintaining a generally constant distance relative to the front-to-back plane 550 A as the paddle frames 524 A extend toward the proximal portion 505 A of the device 500 A ( FIG. 65A ) to ultimately form the rounded rectangle shape seen in FIGS. 70A and 71A .
- the dimensions of the device 500 A are selected to minimize the number of implants that a single patient will require (preferably one), while at the same time maintaining low transvalvular gradients.
- the anterior-posterior distance Y47I of the device 500 A at the widest is less than 10 mm
- the medial-lateral distance Y67C of the spacer at its widest is less than 6 mm.
- the overall geometry of the device 500 A can be based on these two dimensions and the overall shape strategy described above. It should be readily apparent that the use of other anterior-posterior distance Y47I and medial-lateral distance Y67C as starting points for the device 500 A will result in a device having different dimensions. Further, using other dimensions and the shape strategy described above will also result in a device having different dimensions.
- Tables D and E provide examples of values and ranges for dimensions of the device 500 A and components of the device 500 A for some example embodiments.
- the device 500 A can have a wide variety of different shapes and sizes and need not have all or any of the dimensional values or dimensional ranges provided in Tables D and E.
- Table D provides examples of linear dimensions Y in millimeters and ranges of linear dimensions in millimeters for the device 500 A and components of the device 500 A.
- Table B provides examples of radius dimensions S in millimeters and ranges of radius dimensions in millimeters for the device 500 A and components of the device 500 A. The subscripts for each of the dimensions indicates the drawing in which the dimension first appears.
- FIGS. 74A, 75A, 76A, 77A, 78A, 79A, 80A, 81A, 82A, and 83A perspective and cross-sectional views of the device 500 A are shown.
- the device 500 A is shown sliced by cross-section plane 75 A near the proximal portion of the coaption element 510 A.
- FIG. 75A a cross-sectional view of the device 500 A is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 75 A in FIG. 74A .
- the coaption element 510 A has a generally rounded rectangular shape.
- the gaps 542 A between the inner paddles 522 A and coaption element 510 A have a width 542 B. As noted above, the gaps 542 A have a consistent or generally consistent width.
- the device 500 A is shown sliced by cross-section plane 77 A positioned about three-quarters of the way between the distal portion 507 A and the proximal portion 505 A of the coaption element 510 A.
- FIG. 77A a cross-sectional view of the device 500 A is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 77 A in FIG. 76A .
- the strip of material 501 A forming the device 500 A is overlapped to form four layers in the area of the coaption element 510 A.
- a single layer of the strip of material 501 A forms each of the inner paddle 522 A and the outer paddle 520 A.
- the coaption element 510 A has a generally rectangular shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552 A.
- the gaps 542 A between the inner paddle 522 A and the coaption element 510 A are visible.
- the gaps 542 A between the inner paddles 522 A and coaption element 510 A have a width 542 B that is greater than the width 542 B seen in FIG. 75A .
- the gaps 544 A between the outer and inner paddles 520 A, 522 A have a consistent or generally consistent width 544 B for receiving the attachment portion 524 B of the paddle frames 524 A.
- the device 500 A is shown sliced by cross-section plane 79 A positioned about half of the way between the distal portion 507 A and the proximal portion 505 A of the device 500 A.
- FIG. 79A a cross-sectional view of the device 500 A is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 79 A in FIG. 78A .
- the strip of material 501 A forming the device 500 A is overlapped to form four layers in the area of the coaption element 510 A, two layers in the area of the inner paddle 522 A, and one layer in the area of the outer paddle 520 A.
- the coaption element 510 A has a generally rectangular shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552 A.
- the gaps 542 A between the inner paddles 522 A and the coaption element 510 A have a width 542 B that is the same or about the same as the width 542 B seen in FIG. 77A .
- the device 500 A is shown sliced by cross-section plane 81 A positioned about one-quarter of the way between the distal portion 507 A and the proximal portion 505 A of the device 500 A.
- FIG. 81A a cross-sectional view of the device 500 A is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 81 A in FIG. 80A .
- the strip of material 501 A forming the device 500 A is overlapped to form four layers in the area of the coaption element 510 A, two layers in the area of the inner paddle 522 A, and the outer paddle 520 A is formed by a single layer.
- the coaption element 510 A has a generally rectangular shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552 A.
- the gaps 542 A between the inner paddle 522 A and coaption element 510 A have a width 542 B that is about the same as the central width 542 B seen in FIG. 79A .
- the device 500 A is shown sliced by cross-section plane 83 A positioned about one-quarter of the way between the distal portion 507 A and the proximal portion 505 A of the device 500 A.
- FIG. 83A a cross-sectional view of the device 500 A is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 83 A in FIG. 82A .
- the strip of material 501 A forming the device 500 A is overlapped to form four layers in the area of the coaption element 510 A, two layers in the area of the inner paddle 522 A, and a single layer forms the outer paddle 520 A.
- the coaption element 510 A has a generally rectangular shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552 A.
- the gaps 542 A between the inner paddles 522 A and coaption element 510 A form an arcuate shape with a width 542 B that is about the same as the central width 542 B seen in FIG. 81A .
- example implantable devices 100 , 500 , 500 A are shown without clasps or articulable gripping members. Rather, the example devices 100 , 500 , 500 A shown in FIGS. 84-88, 86A, 87A, and 88A , have barbs or gripping members 800 / 800 A and/or 802 / 802 A integrated into portions of the coaption element or paddles of the anchor portion of the devices to facilitate grasping of the tissue of the native heart valve.
- an example implantable device 100 that does not include articulable clasps or gripping elements.
- the device 100 is deployed from a delivery sheath or means for delivery 102 and includes a coaption portion 104 and an anchor portion 106 .
- the coaption portion 104 of the device 100 includes a coaption element or means for coapting 110 that is adapted to be implanted between the leaflets 20 , 22 of a native valve (e.g., mitral valve MV, etc.) and is slidably attached to an actuation element or shaft 112 that extends through the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to a distal cap 114 .
- a native valve e.g., mitral valve MV, etc.
- the anchor portion 106 of the device 100 includes outer paddles 120 and inner paddles 122 that are connected between the distal cap 114 and the coaption element or means for coapting 110 .
- the anchor portion 106 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element or means for actuating 112 opens and closes the anchor portion 106 of the device 100 to grasp the native valve leaflets 20 , 22 during implantation.
- the device 100 shown in FIG. 84 includes barbed portions 800 arranged on the coaption element or means for coapting 110 , with each side of the coaption element or means for coapting 110 having at least one barbed portion 800 .
- the barbed portions 800 can be sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from the device 100 .
- the barbed portions 800 are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue.
- the example implantable device 100 is shown without separate articulable clasps.
- the device 100 is deployed from a delivery sheath or means for delivery 102 and includes a coaption portion 104 and an anchor portion 106 .
- the coaption portion 104 of the device 100 includes a coaption element or means for coapting 110 that is adapted to be implanted between the leaflets 20 , 22 of the native valve or mitral valve MV and is slidably attached to an actuation element 112 (e.g., actuation wire, shaft, rod, suture, line, etc.) that extends through the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to a distal cap 114 .
- actuation element 112 e.g., actuation wire, shaft, rod, suture, line, etc.
- the anchor portion 106 of the device 100 includes outer paddles 120 and inner paddles 122 that are connected between the distal cap 114 and the coaption element or means for coapting 110 .
- the anchor portion 106 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element or means for actuating 112 opens and closes the anchor portion 106 of the device 100 to grasp the native valve leaflets 20 , 22 during implantation.
- the device 100 shown in FIG. 85 includes barbed portions 800 arranged on the inner paddles 122 , with each inner paddle 122 having at least one barbed portion 800 .
- each inner paddle 122 has at least one barbed portion 800 .
- the barbed portions 800 are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from the device 100 .
- the barbed portions 800 are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue.
- the example implantable device 500 is shown that does not include articulable clasps or gripping elements.
- the device 500 includes a coaption portion 504 and an anchor portion 506 .
- the coaption portion 504 of the device 500 includes a coaption element 510 that is adapted to be implanted between the leaflets 20 , 22 of the native valve or native mitral valve MV and is slidably attached to an actuation element or means for actuation 512 that extends through the coaption element 510 to a distal cap 514 .
- the anchor portion 506 of the device 500 includes outer paddles 520 and inner paddles 522 that are connected between the distal cap 514 and the coaption element 510 .
- the anchor portion 506 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element 512 opens and closes the anchor portion 506 of the device 500 to grasp the native valve leaflets 20 , 22 during implantation.
- the device 500 includes barbed portions 800 arranged on the inner paddles 522 , with each inner paddle 522 optionally having more than one barbed portion 800 .
- each inner paddle 522 optionally having more than one barbed portion 800 .
- the barbed portions 800 are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from the device 500 .
- the barbed portions 800 are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue.
- the example implantable device 500 A does not include articulable clasps or gripping elements.
- the device 500 A a coaption element 510 A that is adapted to be implanted between the leaflets 20 , 22 of the native valve or native mitral valve MV and is slidably attached to an actuation element or means for actuation (not shown) that extends through the coaption element 510 A to a distal cap 514 A.
- the device 500 A also includes outer paddles 520 A and inner paddles 522 A that are connected between the distal cap 514 A and the coaption element 510 A.
- the device 500 A is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element opens and closes the paddles 520 A, 522 A of the device 500 A to grasp the native valve leaflets 20 , 22 during implantation.
- the device 500 A includes barbed portions 800 A arranged on the inner paddles 522 A, with each inner paddle 522 A optionally having more than one barbed portion 800 A.
- tissue grasped between the inner paddles 522 A and the coaption element 510 A is pressed against the barbed portions 800 A.
- the barbed portions 800 A are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from the device 500 A.
- the barbed portions 800 A are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue.
- the example implantable device 500 is shown that does not include separate articulable clasps or gripping elements.
- the device 500 includes a coaption portion 502 and an anchor portion 504 .
- the coaption portion 502 of the device 500 includes a coaption element 510 that is adapted to be implanted between the leaflets 20 , 22 of the native valve or native mitral valve MV and is slidably attached to an actuation element or means for actuation 512 that extends through the coaption element 510 to a distal cap 514 .
- the anchor portion 506 of the device 500 includes outer paddles 520 and inner paddles 522 that are connected between the distal cap 514 and the coaption element 510 .
- the anchor portion 506 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element 512 opens and closes the anchor portion 506 of the device 500 to grasp the native valve leaflets 20 , 22 during implantation.
- the device 500 includes barbed portions 800 arranged on the coaption element 510 , with each side of the coaption element 510 having more than one barbed portion 800 .
- the anchor portion 506 of the device 500 is closed, tissue grasped between the inner paddles 522 and the coaption element 510 is pressed against the barbed portions 800 .
- the barbed portions 800 are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from the device 500 .
- the barbed portions 800 are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue.
- the example implantable device 500 A is shown that does not include articulable clasps or gripping elements.
- the device 500 A can have a coaption element 510 A that is adapted to be implanted between the leaflets 20 , 22 of the native valve or native mitral valve MV and is slidably attached to an actuation element or means for actuation (not shown) that extends through the coaption element 510 A to a distal cap 514 A.
- the device 500 A also includes outer paddles 520 A and inner paddles 522 A that are connected between the distal cap 514 A and the coaption element 510 A.
- the device 500 A is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element opens and closes the paddles 520 A, 522 A of the device 500 A to grasp the native valve leaflets 20 , 22 during implantation.
- the device 500 A includes barbed portions 800 A arranged on the coaption element 510 A, with each side of the coaption element 510 A having more than one barbed portion 800 A.
- tissue grasped between the inner paddles 522 A and the coaption element 510 A is pressed against the barbed portions 800 A.
- the barbed portions 800 A are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from the device 500 A.
- the barbed portions 800 A are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue.
- the example implantable device 500 is shown that does not include separate articulable clasps or gripping elements.
- the device 500 includes a coaption portion 502 and an anchor portion 504 .
- the coaption portion 502 of the device 500 includes a coaption element 510 that is adapted to be implanted between the leaflets 20 , 22 of the native valve or native mitral valve MV and is slidably attached to an actuation element or means for actuation 512 that extends through the coaption element 510 to a distal cap 514 .
- the anchor portion 506 of the device 500 includes outer paddles 520 and inner paddles 522 that are connected between the distal cap 514 and the coaption element 510 .
- the anchor portion 506 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element 512 opens and closes the anchor portion 506 of the device 500 to grasp the native valve leaflets 20 , 22 during implantation.
- the device 500 includes barbed portions 800 arranged on the coaption element 510 , with each side of the coaption element 510 including at least one barbed portion 800 . Similar to device 1500 described above, the device 500 also includes barbed portions 802 arranged on the inner paddles 522 , with each inner paddle 522 having at least one barbed portion 802 .
- tissue grasped between the inner paddles 522 and the coaption element 510 is pressed against the barbed portions 800 , 802 .
- the barbed portions 800 , 802 are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from the device 500 .
- the barbed portions 800 , 802 are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue.
- the combination of barbed portions 800 on the coaption element 510 and barbed portions 802 on the inner paddles 522 forms the grasped tissue into an S-shaped tortuous path as it passes over the barbed portions 800 , 802 .
- forces pulling the tissue away from the device 500 will encourage the tissue to further engage the barbed portions 800 , 802 before the tissue can escape.
- the example implantable device 500 A is shown that does not include articulable clasps or gripping elements.
- the device 500 A can have a coaption element 510 A that is adapted to be implanted between the leaflets 20 , 22 of the native valve or native mitral valve MV and is slidably attached to an actuation element or means for actuation (not shown) that extends through the coaption element 510 A to a distal cap 514 A.
- the device 500 A also includes outer paddles 520 A and inner paddles 522 A that are connected between the distal cap 514 A and the coaption element 510 A.
- the device 500 A is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element opens and closes the paddles 520 A, 522 A of the device 500 A to grasp the native valve leaflets 20 , 22 during implantation.
- the device 500 A includes barbed portions 800 A arranged on the coaption element 510 A, with each side of the coaption element 510 A including at least one barbed portion 800 A.
- the device 500 A also includes barbed portions 802 A arranged on the inner paddles 522 A, with each inner paddle 522 A having at least one barbed portion 802 A.
- tissue grasped between the inner paddles 522 A and the coaption element 510 A is pressed against the barbed portions 800 A, 802 A.
- the barbed portions 800 A, 802 A are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from the device 500 A.
- the barbed portions 800 A, 802 A are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue.
- the combination of barbed portions 800 A on the coaption element 510 A and barbed portions 802 A on the inner paddles 522 A forms the grasped tissue into an S-shaped tortuous path as it passes over the barbed portions 800 A, 802 A.
- forces pulling the tissue away from the device 500 A will encourage the tissue to further engage the barbed portions 800 A, 802 A before the tissue can escape.
- the coaption element 510 and paddles 520 , 522 of the example device 500 are shown.
- the coaption element 510 and the paddles can be made from a wide variety of different materials.
- the coaption element 510 and paddles 520 , 522 can be formed from one or more of a variety of materials, for example, a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, electrospun, deposited or formed in any other suitable way, laser cut, or otherwise cut material or flexible material.
- the material can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body.
- the coaption element is made from a braided mesh of metal wires, such as a braided mesh of nitinol wires.
- the coaption element 510 is made of a braided mesh of between 25 and 100 wires, such as between 40 and 85 wires, such as between 45 and 60 wires, such as about 48 Nitinol wires or 48 Nitinol wires.
- the coaption element can be covered in a cloth, such as a polyethylene cloth.
- the coaption element 510 can be surrounded in its entirety with a cloth cover, such as a polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh.
- the cloth cover can provide a blood seal on the surface of the spacer, and/or promote rapid tissue ingrowth.
- a shape memory material such as braided Nitinol wire mesh
- the use of a shape memory material, such as braided Nitinol wire mesh, for the construction of the coaption element 510 results in a coaption element that can self-expandable, flexible in all directions, and/or results in low strains when the coaption element is crimped and/or bent.
- the material can be a single piece, two halves joined together, or a plurality of sections or pieces that are fastened or joined together in any suitable manner, such as, by welding, with adhesives, or the like.
- the device 500 extends from a proximal portion 505 to a distal portion 507 and includes a coaption element 510 , inner paddles 522 , and outer paddles 520 .
- the coaption element 510 includes a proximal opening 519 A and a distal opening 515 ( FIGS. 92 and 94 ).
- the proximal opening 519 A of the coaption element 510 is formed in a proximal portion 519 of the coaption element 510 .
- the coaption element 510 is jointably connected to the inner paddles 522 by joint portions 525 .
- the inner paddles 522 are jointably connected to the outer paddles 520 by joint portions 523 .
- the outer paddles 520 are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) to distal portions 527 by joint portions 521 .
- Coaption gaps 542 are formed between the inner paddles 522 and the coaption element 510 .
- Paddle gaps 544 are formed between the inner and outer paddles 520 , 522 when the paddles 520 , 522 are folded, for example, as shown in FIG. 90 .
- the coaption element 510 includes the proximal portion 519 , a middle portion 518 , and a distal portion 517 .
- the proximal portion 519 includes the proximal opening 519 A.
- the distal portion 517 includes the distal opening 515 and is connected to the joint portions 525 .
- the shape of the coaption element 510 is rounded or generally rounded to prevent the device 500 from catching or snagging on structures of the heart, such as the chordae tendineae, during implantation.
- the distal portion 507 of the device 500 is generally narrower than the proximal portion 505 of the device 500 when the device 500 is viewed from the side.
- the coaption element 510 flares outwards in the proximal portion 519 from the proximal opening 519 A to the middle portion 518 .
- the coaption element 510 then tapers or narrows in the middle portion 518 from the proximal portion 519 to the distal portion 517 .
- the distal portion 517 remains narrow and then splits into the two joint portions 525 .
- the generally rounded features of the device 500 are further demonstrated by the round shape of the joint portions 523 that jointably connect the inner and outer paddles 520 , 522 and the outwardly bowed shape of the outer paddles 520 .
- the coaption gaps 542 formed between the inner paddles 522 and the coaption element 510 are configured to receive native tissue.
- the narrowing of the coaption element 510 gives the gaps 542 a somewhat teardrop shape that increases in width as the gaps 542 approach the distal portion 507 of the device 500 .
- the widening of the gaps 542 toward the distal portion 507 allows the inner paddles 522 to contact tissue grasped in the gaps 542 nearer to the proximal portion 505 where pinching forces are greater as a result of the mechanical advantage provided by the length of the paddles 520 , 522 and other securing or anchoring elements, such as those described in the present application.
- a top view of the device 500 is shown.
- the proximal opening 519 A in the coaption element 510 is visible at the proximal portion 505 of the device 500 and the coaption element 510 can be seen to be hollow inside.
- the coaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval-shape when viewed from the top. While the paddles 520 , 522 appear as protruding rectangular shapes, the paddles 520 , 522 can extend laterally and have an arcuate or crescent-like shape.
- the distal opening 515 in the coaption element 510 is visible at the distal portion 507 of the device 500 and the coaption element 510 can be seen to be hollow inside.
- the coaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval-shape when viewed from the top. While the paddles 520 , 522 appear as protruding rectangular shapes, the paddles 520 , 522 can extend laterally and have an arcuate or crescent-like shape.
- the distal portion 517 of the coaption element 510 can be seen splitting in two to join with the joint portions 525 .
- the portions of the device 500 A formed by the strip of material 501 A e.g., a single, continuous strip of material, a composite strip of material, etc.
- the coaption element 510 A and paddles 520 A, 522 A are shown.
- the coaption element 510 A and the paddles can be made from a wide variety of different materials.
- the coaption element 510 A, and paddles 520 A, 522 A can be formed from a material that can be a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, electrospun, deposited or formed in any other suitable way, laser cut, or otherwise cut material or flexible material.
- the material can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body.
- the coaption element 510 A, inner paddle 522 A, and outer paddle 520 A are made from a single, continuous strip of material 501 A.
- the strip of material 501 A can be formed from a material that can be a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, electrospun, deposited or formed in any other suitable way, laser cut, or otherwise cut material or flexible material.
- the material can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body.
- the strip of material 501 A is made of a braided mesh of between 25 and 100 strands, such as between 40 and 85 strands, such as between 45 and 60 strands, such as about 48 Nitinol wires or 48 Nitinol wires.
- FIGS. 205-207 an example woven or braided material 4000 that can be used for the strip of material 501 A is shown.
- FIG. 205 an enlarged plan view of the material 4000 is shown.
- the material 4000 extends from a first edge 4002 to a second edge 4004 .
- the edges 4002 , 4004 surround a central portion or field 4006 .
- the material 4000 is formed by braiding or weaving together central strands 4020 , such as Nitinol wires.
- Edge strands 4010 extend longitudinally through the material 4000 along the edges 4002 , 4004 .
- the central strands 4020 are woven or braided such that the central strands 4020 wrap around the edge strands 4010 .
- Wrapping the central strands 4020 around the edge strands 4010 causes the material 4000 near the edges 4002 , 4004 to be thicker than the material in the central portion 4006 , forming a lobed or dog-bone-like shape when the material 4000 is viewed from the end, as is shown in FIG. 206 .
- the edges 4002 , 4004 of the material 4000 are less flexible than the central portion 4006 .
- the edge strands 4010 and central strands 4020 can be similar in diameter and can have a diameter ranging from about 0.06 millimeters to about 0.18 millimeters.
- the edge strands 4010 can have a larger diameter than the central strands 4020 to impart more stiffness or rigidity to the edges 4002 , 4004 than the central portion 4006 .
- the edge strands 4010 can have a diameter ranging from 0.07 millimeters to about 0.27 millimeters, or about 0.17 millimeters
- the central strands 4020 can have a diameter ranging from about 0.04 millimeters to about 0.15 millimeters, or about 0.009 millimeters.
- the edges 4002 , 4004 are made less flexible than the central portion 4006 by using different materials for the edge strands 4010 and central strands 4020 , such as, for example, a metal material—e.g., Nitinol—for the edge strands 4010 and a cloth or plastic material—e.g., polyethylene—for the central strands 4020 .
- a metal material e.g., Nitinol
- a cloth or plastic material e.g., polyethylene
- the edge strands 4010 and central strands 4020 can be made from the same material that is subjected to different chemical and or thermal processes that alter the flexibility of the materials so that the central strands 4020 are more flexible than the edge strands 4010 .
- folded portions of material 4000 are layered on top of each other to form a section that has four layers 4000 A, 4000 B, 4000 C, 4000 D.
- the lobed shape of the individual layers, with thicker edges 4002 , 4004 than the central portion 4006 creates three gaps 4001 A, 4001 B, 4001 C between the layers 4000 A, 4000 B, 4000 C, 4000 D of material 4000 in the location of the central portion 4006 .
- Outer gaps 4001 A, 4001 C are formed between outer layers 4000 A, 4000 D and the adjacent middle layers 4000 B, 4000 C.
- the coaption element 510 A of the device 500 A can be formed from four layers of material, such as the material 4000 .
- the actuation element 512 A of the device 500 A can be inserted through the middle gap 4001 B formed in the center of the four layers of material 4000 .
- the actuation element 512 A can have a larger diameter than the width of the gap 4001 B, so that inserting the actuation element 512 A causes the middle gap 4001 B to stretch open and adjacent outer gaps 4001 A, 4001 C to reduce in size.
- inserting the actuation element 512 A causes the center body portions 4006 on either side to bulge outward to a thickness that is greater than the thickness of the four stacked edge portions 4002 , 4004 .
- the coaption element 510 A and paddles 520 A, 522 A can be covered in a cloth, such as a polyethylene cloth.
- the coaption element 510 A and paddles 520 A, 522 A can be surrounded in their entirety with a cloth cover (e.g., cover 540 A), such as a polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh.
- the cloth cover can provide a blood seal on the surface of the spacer, and/or promote rapid tissue ingrowth.
- a shape memory material such as braided Nitinol wire mesh
- the use of a shape memory material, such as braided Nitinol wire mesh, for the construction of the coaption element 510 A and paddles 520 A, 522 A results in a coaption element and paddles that can be self-expandable, flexible in all directions, and/or results in low strains when crimped and/or bent.
- the material can be a single piece, two halves joined together, or a plurality of sections or pieces that are fastened or joined together in any suitable manner, such as, by welding, with adhesives, or the like.
- the device 500 A extends from a proximal portion 505 A to a distal portion 507 A and includes a coaption element 510 A, inner paddles 522 A, and outer paddles 520 A.
- the single, continuous strip of material 501 A extends between two ends 501 B and is folded to form the coaption element 510 A, inner paddles 522 A, and outer paddles 520 A.
- Some portions of the device 500 A are formed from multiple layers of the strip of material 501 A. For example, the strip of material 501 A is overlapped to form four layers in the area of the coaption element 510 A and two layers in the area of the inner paddle 522 A.
- the coaption element 510 A and paddles 520 A, 522 A are jointably connected together by joint portions of the strip of material 501 A.
- the coaption element 510 A is jointably connected to the inner paddles 522 A by joint portions 525 A.
- the inner paddles 522 A are jointably connected to the outer paddles 520 A by joint portions 523 A.
- the outer paddles 520 A are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) to the distal portion 527 A by joint portions 521 A.
- the aperture 527 B in the distal portion 527 A engages the cap 514 A.
- Coaption gaps 542 A are formed between the inner paddles 522 A and the coaption element 510 A.
- Paddle gaps 544 A are formed between the inner and outer paddles 520 A, 522 A when the paddles 520 A, 522 A are folded, for example, as shown in FIG. 90A .
- Collar gaps 546 A are formed when the strip of material 501 A is folded to form the proximal portions 519 B of the coaption element 510 A.
- the coaption element 510 A includes the proximal portion 519 B extending above the joint portions 523 A of the paddles 520 A, 522 A.
- the distal portion 517 A of the coaption element 510 A is concealed by the paddles 520 A, 522 A when viewed from the front or back, giving the device 500 A a long and narrow rounded rectangular shape.
- the shape of the coaption element 510 A helps prevent the device 500 A from catching or snagging on structures of the heart, such as the chordae tendineae, during implantation.
- the distal end 507 A of the device 500 A is generally narrower than the proximal end 505 A of the device 500 A when the device 500 A is viewed from the side, forming a generally blunt and rounded shape.
- the coaption element 510 A includes the proximal portion 519 B, a middle portion 518 A, and the distal portion 517 A.
- the proximal portion 519 B flares outward from the middle portion 518 A to engage the collar 511 D ( FIG. 48A ).
- the middle portion 518 A of the coaption element 510 A is straight or generally straight when viewed from the side.
- the distal portion 517 A is attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) to the inner paddles 522 A by the joint portions 525 A.
- the generally rounded features of the device 500 A are further demonstrated by the round shape of the joint portions 523 A that jointably connect the paddles 520 A, 522 A.
- the joint portions 521 A connecting the outer paddles 520 A to the distal portion 527 A are also rounded and ease the transition in shape from the strip of material 501 A to the cap 514 A ( FIG. 48A ) that is assembled to the flat or generally flat distal portion 527 A.
- the coaption gaps 542 A formed between the inner paddles 522 A and the coaption element 510 A are configured to receive native tissue.
- the general straightness of the middle portion 518 A of the coaption element 510 A and the inner paddles 522 A gives the gaps 542 A a consistent or generally consistent width with a narrow upper end where the proximal portion 519 B flares outward to engage the collar 511 D ( FIG. 48A ).
- the inner paddles 522 A contact the tissue grasped in the gaps 542 A nearer to the proximal portion 505 A where pinching forces are greater as a result of the mechanical advantage provided by the length of the paddles 520 A, 522 A and other securing or anchoring elements, such as those described in the present application.
- the coaption element 510 A and paddles 520 A, 522 A of the device 500 A are formed by folding the strip of material 501 A.
- the strip of material 501 A is then unfolded and assembled with other components, such as the collar 511 D, cap 514 A, and paddle frames 524 A.
- the strip of material 501 A is shape-set after being formed into a desired shape so that the strip of material 501 A returns to the desired shape after assembly with other components.
- a jig is used during folding and shape-setting of the strip of material 501 A to ensure that the strip of material 501 A is folded in the proper location with the desired radius.
- portions of a jig 570 A to aid in folding and shape-setting the device 500 A are shown.
- the strip of material 501 A is shown folded around the jig 570 A so that the strip of material 501 A forms a desired shape.
- the strip of material 501 A is arranged with one of the ends 501 B at the location of the inner paddle 522 A.
- the strip 501 A is extended from the end 501 B in a distal direction 507 B to form a first layer 581 A of the inner paddle 522 A, around a first jig portion 572 A to form a first layer 581 A of the hinge portion 525 A, and then in a proximal direction 505 B to form the first layer 581 A of the coaption element 510 A.
- the first layer 581 A of material forms the sides of the inner paddle 522 A and coaption element 510 A that surround the coaption gap 542 A.
- the strip 501 A is then wrapped around a second jig portion 574 A to form one of the proximal portions 519 B and openings 546 A of the coaption element 510 A.
- the strip 501 A is then extended in a distal direction 507 A along the first layer 581 A to form a second layer 582 A of the coaption element 510 A.
- the strip 501 A is then wrapped back round the first jig portion 574 A, forming the second layer 582 A of the hinge portion 525 A and back in the proximal direction 505 A to form the second layer 582 A of the inner paddle 522 A.
- the strip 501 A is then wrapped around a third jig portion 576 A to form the joint portion 523 A.
- the strip 501 A then extends in the distal direction 507 A along the inner paddle 522 A to form the outer paddle 520 A before being folded around a fourth jig portion 578 A to form the joint portion 521 .
- the strip 501 A is then extended laterally to form the distal portion 527 .
- the routing of the strip 501 A through the jig 570 A is then performed in reverse order on the opposite side of the jig 570 A to form the second half of the device 500 A. That is, the strip 501 A is then wrapped around the fourth, third, first, second, and first jig portions 578 A, 576 A, 572 A, 574 A, 572 A to form the second half of the device 500 A.
- a shape-setting operation is performed.
- portions of the illustrated jig have a rounded or generally round shape, the portions can have any shape to aid in the folding and shaping of the strip of material 501 A.
- the jig 570 can have more or fewer portions for engaging the strip of material 501 A.
- FIG. 93A a top view of the device 500 A is shown.
- the first and second layers 581 A, 582 A of each half of the device 500 A form the four layers of the coaption device 510 A.
- the proximal opening 519 C of the coaption device 510 A is formed between the two second layers 582 A.
- the opening 519 C is formed by inserting the actuation element 512 A (not shown) between the folded and overlapping layers of the strip of material 501 A after shape-setting of the strip of material 501 A.
- the opening 519 C is formed by shape-setting the folded layers 581 A, 582 A of the strip of material 501 A around an additional jig portion (not shown) to give the coaption element 510 A a rounded or generally rounded shape when viewed from the top.
- FIG. 94A a bottom view of the device 500 A is shown.
- the distal portion 527 A of the strip of material 501 A is shown, as is the aperture 527 B for receiving the cap 514 A.
- the coaption element 510 A and outer paddles 520 A have a generally rounded rectangle shape when viewed from below.
- FIGS. 95-102 perspective and cross-sectional views of the device 500 are shown.
- the device 500 is shown sliced by cross-section plane 96 near the proximal portion of the coaption element 510 .
- FIG. 96 a cross-sectional view of the device 500 is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 96 in FIG. 95 .
- the coaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape with thicker portions along the sides of the coaption element 510 .
- the distal opening 515 is visible from the proximal portion and the coaption element 510 has a hollow interior.
- the device 500 is shown sliced by cross-section plane 98 positioned about half of the way between the distal portion 507 and the proximal portion 505 of the coaption element 510 .
- FIG. 98 a cross-sectional view of the device 500 is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 98 in FIG. 97 .
- the coaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape that is larger than the oval shape of FIG. 96 .
- the device 500 is shown sliced by cross-section plane 100 positioned about one-quarter of the way between the distal portion 507 and the proximal portion 505 of the coaption element 510 .
- a cross-sectional view of the device 500 is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 100 in FIG. 99 .
- the coaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape that is narrower than the oval shape seen in FIG. 98 .
- the device 500 is shown sliced by cross-section plane 102 positioned near the distal portion 507 of the coaption element 510 .
- FIG. 102 a cross-sectional view of the device 500 is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 102 in FIG. 101 .
- the coaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape that is smaller than the oval shape seen in FIG. 100 and that is split as the coaption element 510 joins the joint portions 525 .
- FIGS. 95A, 96A, 97A, 98A, 99A, 100A, 101A, and 102A perspective and cross-sectional views of the portions of the device 500 A formed by the single, continuous strip of material 501 A are shown.
- the device 500 A is shown sliced by cross-section plane 96 A near the proximal portion of the coaption element 510 A.
- FIG. 96A a cross-sectional view of the device 500 A is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 96 A in FIG. 95A .
- the coaption element 510 has a rectangular or generally rectangular shape.
- the coaption element 510 A when the actuation element (not shown) is inserted between the layers 582 A of the coaption element 510 A, the coaption element 510 A remains straight when viewed from the side but bows outward to form a rounded or generally round shape when viewed from cross-section plane 96 A.
- the device 500 A is shown sliced by cross-section plane 98 A near the proximal portion of the coaption element 510 A.
- FIG. 98A a cross-sectional view of the device 500 A is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 98 A in FIG. 97A .
- the coaption element 510 has a rectangular or generally rectangular shape.
- the coaption element 510 A when the actuation element (not shown) is inserted between the layers 582 A of the coaption element 510 A, the coaption element 510 A remains straight when viewed from the side but bows outward to form a rounded or generally round shape when viewed from cross-section plane 98 A.
- the device 500 A is shown sliced by cross-section plane 100 A near the proximal portion of the coaption element 510 A.
- FIG. 100A a cross-sectional view of the device 500 A is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 100 A in FIG. 99A .
- the coaption element 510 has a rectangular or generally rectangular shape.
- the actuation element (not shown) is inserted between the layers 582 A of the coaption element 510 A
- the coaption element 510 A remains straight when viewed from the side but bows outward to form a rounded or generally round shape when viewed from cross-section plane 100 A.
- the device 500 A is shown sliced by cross-section plane 102 A near the proximal portion of the coaption element 510 A.
- FIG. 102A a cross-sectional view of the device 500 A is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 102 A in FIG. 101A .
- the coaption element 510 has a rectangular or generally rectangular shape.
- the coaption element 510 A when the actuation element (not shown) is inserted between the layers 582 A of the coaption element 510 A, the coaption element 510 A remains straight when viewed from the side but bows outward to form a rounded or generally round shape when viewed from cross-section plane 102 A.
- the example implantable prosthetic device 100 is shown having covered and uncovered portions.
- the device 100 is shown implanted in the native mitral valve MV and secured to the native leaflets 20 , 22 .
- the device 100 includes a coaption element or means for coapting 110 , paddles 120 , clasps 130 , and a cap 114 .
- the paddles 120 and clasps 130 are in a closed position to secure the device 100 to the grasped native leaflets 20 , 22 of the mitral valve MV.
- a proximal portion 105 of the device 100 is exposed to the left atrium LA and a distal portion 107 of the device 100 is exposed to the left ventricle LV.
- the device 100 is shown with a covering 900 that covers the entirety of the coaption element or means for coapting 110 and the cap 114 .
- the covering 900 can be a cloth or fabric or polymer such as PET, velour, electrospun, deposited, or other suitable material.
- the cover in lieu of or in addition to a fabric, can include a coating (e.g., polymeric) that is applied to the prosthetic spacer device and/or mechanical sealing mechanisms, such as silicone and interlocking joints can be used.
- the covering 900 can be formed from a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, or formed in any other suitable way or a laser cut or otherwise cut flexible material.
- the covering 900 can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body.
- the covering 900 prohibits blood flow through coaption element or means for coapting 110 at the proximal portion 105 , and also provides a seal between the device 100 and the leaflets 20 , 22 .
- the covering 900 aids in the prohibition of blood flow through the native valve at the location of the device 100 .
- the covering 900 also prohibits recirculating blood flow from entering the device 100 from the distal portion 107 .
- the device 100 is shown with a covering 1000 that partially covers the coaption element or means for coapting 110 from the proximal portion 105 of the device 100 to the portion of the coaption element or means for coapting 110 that engages the native leaflets 20 , 22 .
- the cover can be a cloth or fabric such as PET, velour, or other suitable fabric.
- the cover in lieu of or in addition to a fabric, can include a coating (e.g., polymeric) that is applied to the prosthetic spacer device.
- the covering 1000 can be formed from a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, or formed in any other suitable way or a laser cut or otherwise cut flexible material.
- the covering 1000 can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body. Thus, the covering 1000 prohibits blood flow through the coaption element or means for coapting 110 at the proximal portion 105 .
- the device 100 is shown with a covering 1100 that partially covers the coaption element or means for coapting 110 extending from the portion of the coaption element or means for coapting 110 that engages the native leaflets 20 , 22 toward the distal portion 107 .
- the covering 1100 also covers the cap 114 .
- the cover can be a cloth or fabric such as PET, velour, or other suitable fabric.
- the cover in lieu of or in addition to a fabric, can include a coating (e.g., polymeric) that is applied to the prosthetic spacer device.
- the covering 1100 can be formed from a mesh, woven, braided, or formed in any other suitable way.
- the covering 1100 can be cloth, polymer, silicone, electrospun material, deposited material, and/or shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body.
- blood flow can enter the coaption element or means for coapting 110 but is prohibited from passing through the device by the covering 1100 arranged toward the distal portion 107 .
- the covering 1100 also prohibits recirculating blood flow from entering the device 100 from the distal portion 107 .
- the coaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application.
- the coaption element 1200 has a cylindrical or generally cylindrical shape extending between two caps 1201 .
- the coaption element 1200 can have any shape, such as any of the shapes disclosed herein.
- the direction of expansion of the coaption element 1200 can be controlled.
- the width/size of the coaption element in the Anterior to Posterior direction (when implanted), Medial to Lateral direction (when implanted), or both can be expanded (or contracted) in a controlled manner.
- the coaption element can be made from a mesh 1200 of material. Referring now to FIG. 107 , the mesh wall of the generally cylindrical coaption element 1200 extends outward from the caps 1201 by a distance 1204 . Referring now to FIG. 108 , axial forces 1208 are applied to the caps 1201 of the coaption element 1200 causing the coaption element 1200 to compress in an axial direction. Compressing the coaption element 1200 axially causes the coaption element 1200 to expand or bulge in an outward direction 1210 , such that the distance 1204 increases.
- the coaption element 1200 can be compressed in a wide variety of different ways.
- a threaded connection can be used to draw the two ends of the coaption element together or push the two ends of the coaption element apart.
- a collar can be provided on each end of the coaption element. One of the collars can threadedly engage a threaded shaft, while the other collar is rotatably connected to the shaft. Rotating the shaft in one direction draws the collars together. Rotating the shaft in the opposite direction moves the collars apart.
- example coaption elements 1200 similar to the embodiment illustrated by FIGS. 106-109 , for an implantable prosthetic device is shown.
- the coaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application.
- the coaption element 1200 has a cylindrical or generally cylindrical shape extending between two caps 1201 .
- the coaption element 1200 can have any shape, such as any of the shapes disclosed herein.
- the coaption element 1200 comprises a tube 1203 with slots 1205 .
- the tube 1203 can be made from a shape memory alloy, such as nitinol, and the slots can be cut, such as laser cut, into the tube.
- the slots can be cut into the material that forms the tube, before the material is formed into a tube.
- the direction of expansion of the coaption element 1200 can be controlled.
- the configuration of the slots 1205 and/or a shape-set of the tube can be selected to control the shape of the expanded coaption element 1200 .
- the configuration of the slots 1205 and/or a shape-set can determine the way the width/size of the coaption element in the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction expanded (and/or contract).
- the tube wall of the generally cylindrical coaption element 1200 can extend outward from caps 1201 by a distance 1204 . Referring now to FIG.
- axial forces 1208 and/or rotational forces 1209 can be applied to the caps 1201 of the coaption element 1200 causing the coaption element 1200 to expand from the configuration illustrated by FIG. 106A to the configuration illustrated by FIG. 108A .
- the coaption element 1200 can be compressed in a wide variety of different ways.
- a threaded connection 1221 can be used to draw the two ends of the coaption element together and twist the coaption element in a first direction or push the two ends of the coaption element apart and twist the coaption element in a second direction.
- a collar can be provided on each end of the coaption element. One of the collars can threadedly engage a threaded shaft, while the other collar is fixedly connected to the shaft. Rotating the shaft in one direction draws the collars together and rotates the collars relative to one another in a first direction.
- the pitch of the threaded connection can be selected to set a ratio between the distance the coaption element 1200 is compressed and the angle that the coaption element is twisted.
- FIGS. 106C and 108C illustrate an example embodiment of a controllably expandable coaption element 1200 for an implantable prosthetic device.
- the coaption element 1200 can be used on its own, with a covering, or inside any of the coaption elements described herein (to expand the coaption element).
- the coaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application.
- the coaption element 1200 has pairs of pivotally connected arms 1231 .
- the pairs of pivotally connected arms 1231 each extending between and pivotally connected to two caps 1201 . In the illustrated example, there are two pairs of pivotally connected arms 1231 . However, there can be one, three, four, or any number of pairs of pivotally connected arms.
- the direction of expansion of the coaption element 1200 can be controlled.
- two pairs (as illustrated) of pivotally connected arms can be included to change the width/size of the coaption element in only one of the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction.
- Four pairs of pivotally connected arms 1231 can be included to change the width/size of the coaption element in both the Anterior to Posterior direction and Medial to Lateral direction.
- the arms can have different lengths and/or pivot point locations to make the coaption element 1200 expand (or contract) differently in different dictions.
- the lengths of the arms can be selected to expand more in the Medial to Lateral direction than the Anterior to Posterior direction.
- axial forces 1208 can be applied to the caps 1201 of the coaption element 1200 causing the coaption element 1200 to expand from the configuration illustrated by FIG. 106C to the configuration illustrated by FIG. 108C .
- compressing the pivotally connected arms 1231 axially causes the pivotal connections 1233 or knees to spread apart in an outward direction 1210 , such that the distance 1204 increases.
- the coaption element 1200 can be compressed in a wide variety of different ways.
- a threaded connection 1221 can be used to draw the two ends of the coaption element together or push the two ends of the coaption element apart.
- a collar can be provided on each end of the coaption element. One of the collars can threadedly engage a threaded shaft, while the other collar is rotatably connected to the shaft. Rotating the shaft in one direction draws the collars together. Rotating the shaft in the opposite direction moves the collars apart.
- FIGS. 106D and 108D illustrate an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element 1200 for an implantable prosthetic device.
- the coaption element 1200 can be used on its own, with a covering (See FIGS. 106E and 108E ), or inside any of the coaption elements described herein (to expand the coaption element).
- the coaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application.
- the coaption element 1200 has, a central support member 1243 , one or more pivotally connected arms 1241 , and connection lines 1245 . Each arm 1241 extends from a pivotal connection to the central support member 1243 .
- connection line 1245 is connected to the central support member 1243 and a pivotally connected arm 1241 .
- the length of the connection line 1245 sets the degree to which the connection arms pivot away from the central support member 1243 .
- the direction of expansion of the coaption element 1200 can be controlled.
- two pivotally connected arms can be included to change the width/size of the coaption element in only one of the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction.
- Four pivotally connected arms 1241 can be included to change the width/size of the coaption element in both the Anterior to Posterior direction and Medial to Lateral direction.
- the arms and/or the connection lines 1245 can have different lengths and/or pivot point locations to make the coaption element 1200 expand (or contract) differently in different dictions.
- the lengths of the arms and/or the connection lines can be selected to expand more in the Medial to Lateral direction than the Anterior to Posterior direction.
- the arms 1241 can be moved from the contracted position ( FIG. 106D ) to the expanded position ( FIG. 108D ).
- the arms 1241 can be biased toward the expanded position 1241 by a spring or other biasing means.
- restraints 1247 such as sutures hold the arms 1241 in the contracted position.
- the restraints 1247 can be removed or broken to cause the coaption element 1200 to expand from the configuration illustrated by FIG. 106D to the configuration illustrated by FIG. 108D .
- FIGS. 106E and 108E illustrate an example embodiment that is similar to the embodiment illustrated by FIGS. 106D and 108D , except that the coaption element includes a covering material 1253 .
- the covering material 1253 can extend from the central support member 1243 to each arm 1241 .
- the covering material 1253 can be used with the connection lines 1245 or the covering material can eliminate the need for the connection lines 1245 .
- the coaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application.
- the coaption element 1200 is defined by a coil 1263 extending between two caps 1201 .
- the coaption element 1200 can have any shape, such as any of the shapes disclosed herein.
- the coil 1263 can be made from a shape memory alloy, such as nitinol.
- the direction of expansion of the coaption element 1200 can be controlled.
- the shape-set of the coil 1263 can be selected to control the shape of the expanded coaption element 1200 .
- the configuration of the shape-set can determine the way the width/size of the coaption element in the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction expand (and/or contract).
- Referring to Axial forces 1208 and/or rotational forces 1209 can be applied to caps 1201 of the coaption element 1200 causing the coaption element 1200 to expand or retract from the configuration illustrated by FIG. 106F .
- extending the coil 1263 axially and twisting the coil 1263 contracts the coil in an inward direction 1211 and compressing the coil 1263 axially and twisting the coil in the opposite direction expands or bulge the coil in an outward direction.
- the coaption element 1200 can be compressed in a wide variety of different ways.
- a threaded connection 1221 can be used to draw the two ends of the coaption element together and twist the coaption element in a first direction or push the two ends of the coaption element apart and twist the coaption element in a second direction.
- a collar can be fixedly connected to each end of the coil 1263 .
- One of the collars can threadedly engage a threaded shaft, while the other collar is fixedly connected to the shaft. Rotating the shaft in one direction draws the collars together and rotates the collars relative to one another in a first direction.
- the pitch of the threaded connection can be selected to set a ratio between the distance the coaption element 1200 is compressed and the angle that the coaption element is twisted.
- FIGS. 106G-106I illustrate example embodiments of expandable coaption elements 1200 .
- the coaption elements are inflated by a fluid medium to expand the coaption element.
- the fluid medium can take a wide variety of different forms. Examples of fluids that can be used to inflate the coaption element 1200 include, but are not limited to, air, gel, water, blood, foaming materials, etc.
- the coaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application.
- the coaption element 1200 can have an outer layer 1271 (For example, any of the coaption elements 110 , 510 disclosed herein) and an inner layer 1273 or balloon.
- the coaption element 1200 can have any shape, such as any of the shapes disclosed herein.
- the inner layer 1273 is disposed in the outer layer 1271 and can have the same or generally the same shape as the inner surface of the outer layer.
- the inner layer can be made from an expandable material, such as a rubber or other material traditionally used for making balloons and angioplasty devices.
- the outer layer 1271 can be made from a shape memory alloy, such as nitinol.
- the direction of expansion of the coaption element 1200 can be controlled.
- the inner layer 1273 comprises two balloons that are optionally connected together.
- the inner layer can comprise 3, 4, or any number of balloons.
- the balloons can be individually inflated to control the shape of expansion of the coaption element 1200 .
- the connection can also affect the shape of expansion.
- the balloons are connected together along a plane 1275 or area. Expansion of the inner layer 1273 in the direction 1277 will be less than the expansion in the direction 1279 due to the connection 1275 .
- the expansion due to inflation can be limited to or substantially limited to expansion in the Medial to Lateral direction.
- the use of multiple balloons and the configuration of any connections between the balloons can determine the way the width/size of the coaption element in the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction expand (and/or contract).
- the inner layer 1273 comprises one or more supports 1281 or struts.
- One support 1281 is illustrated, but any number can be used.
- the inner layer can comprise 2, 3, 4, or any number of supports.
- the supports 1281 can divide the inner layer into multiple independently inflatable chambers or the supports may not seal off independent chambers and inflation fluid applied to any chamber will fill all of the chambers.
- the chambers can be individually inflated to control the shape of expansion of the coaption element 1200 .
- the supports also affect the shape of expansion.
- the support 1281 will reduce or eliminate expansion of the inner layer 1273 in the direction 1277 .
- the expansion due to inflation can be limited to or substantially limited to expansion in the Medial to Lateral direction.
- the use of multiple independently inflatable chambers and/or the configuration of the support members 1281 can determine the way the width/size of the coaption element in the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction expand (and/or contract).
- FIGS. 110-111 an example implantable prosthetic device 1300 is shown.
- the device 1300 is similar to the device 100 , described above, and includes a coaption element 1310 , paddles 1320 , and clasps or gripping members 1330 .
- FIG. 111 a top view of the coaption element 1310 is shown. As can be seen in FIG. 111 , the coaption element 1310 has an oval or generally oval-shaped cross-section.
- the coaption element 1310 does not include a central opening and can be formed from a solid piece of material, such as foam.
- the device 1300 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the device 1300 can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- the prosthetic device 1300 can be opened and closed in a wide variety of different ways. For example, a sleeve can be slidably disposed over the coaption element to engage and open the paddles. Or, the paddles can be opened by pulling a line or suture that opens the clasps and the movement of the clasps can open the paddles. However, any mechanism for opening and closing the device 1300 can be used.
- the paddle frame 1400 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application.
- the paddle frame 1400 is formed from a piece of material 1402 , such as nitinol, or any other suitable material.
- the paddle frame 1400 extends from a cap attachment portion 1410 to a paddle connection portion 1420 and has a proximal portion 1422 , a middle portion 1424 , and a distal portion 1426 .
- the paddle frame 1400 includes attachment portions 1440 for securing a cover (see FIG. 30 ), the inner paddle 520 , and/or the outer paddle 522 to the paddle frame 1400 .
- the paddle frame 1400 is thinner in the location of the fifth curve 1438 to facilitate bending of both sides of the paddle frame 1400 toward the center plane 1404 during, for example, crimping of the device.
- the paddle frame 1400 extends between a first attachment portion 1412 in a rounded, three-dimensional shape through the proximal, middle, and distal portions 1422 , 1424 , 1426 and returns to a second attachment portion 1414 .
- the paddle frame 1400 is bent or curved in multiple locations as the paddle frame 1400 extends between the first and second attachment portions 1412 , 1414 .
- the attachment portions 1412 , 1414 include notches 1416 , 1418 respectively for attachment to the cap.
- the paddle frame 1400 flexes at the area 1419 .
- the area 1419 can include a wider portion 1417 to distribute the stress that results from flexing the paddle frame 1400 over a greater area.
- notches 1416 , 1418 can include radiused notches 1415 at each end of the notches. The radiused notches 1415 serve as strain reliefs for the bending area 1419 and the area where the paddle frame 1400 connects to the cap.
- the paddle frame 1400 curves away from a median or central plane 1404 ( FIG. 115 ) at a first curve 1430 to widen the shape of the paddle frame 1400 . As can be seen in FIG. 117 , the paddle frame 1400 also curves away from a frontal plane 1406 in the location of the first curve 1430 . The paddle frame 1400 curves away from the outward direction of the first curve 1430 at a second curve 1432 to form sides of the frame 1400 . The paddle frame continues to slope away from the frontal plane 1406 in the location of the second curve 1432 . In some embodiments, the second curve 1432 has a larger radius than the first curve 1430 .
- the paddle frame 1400 curves away from the frontal plane 1406 at a third curve 1434 as the paddle frame 1400 continues to curve in the arc of the second curve 1432 when viewed from the frontal plane 1406 .
- This curvature at the third curve 1434 results in a gradual departure of the frame 1400 , and thus the native valve leaflet from the centerline 1406 .
- This departure from the centerline results in spreading of the leaflet tissue toward the valve annulus, which can result in less stress on the leaflet tissue.
- the paddle frame 1400 curves toward the lateral plane 1404 at a fourth curve 1436 as the frame 1400 continues to curve away from the frontal plane 1406 .
- the rounded three-dimensional shape of the paddle frame 1400 is closed with a fifth curve 1438 that joins both sides of the paddle frame 1400 .
- the paddle frame 1400 has an arcuate or generally arcuate shape as the frame 1400 extends away from the attachment portion 1420 and to the closed portion 1424 .
- the middle portion 1422 of the frame is closer to the frontal plane 1406 than the closed portion 1424 , giving the sides of the middle portion 1422 a rounded, wing-like shape that engages the curved surface of coaption element (not shown) during grasping of native tissue between a paddle (not shown) and coaption element of an implantable device of the present invention.
- a flat blank 1403 of paddle frame 1400 can be cut, for example laser cut, from a flat sheet of material. Referring to FIG. 192 , the cut blank 1403 can then be bent to form the three-dimensional shaped paddle frame 1400 .
- the paddle frames 1400 can be shape-set to provide increased clamping force against or toward the coaption element 510 when the paddles 520 , 522 are in the closed configuration. This is because the paddle frames are shape-set relative to the closed position (e.g. FIG. 194 ) to a first position (e.g., FIG. 193 ) which is beyond the position where the inner paddle 520 would engage the coaption element, such as beyond the central plane 552 of the device 500 , such as beyond the opposite side of the coaption element, such as beyond the outer paddle on the opposite side of the coaption element.
- a first position e.g., FIG. 193
- the paddle frame 194 is flexed and attached to the inner and outer paddles 522 , 520 , for example by stitching. This results in the paddle frames having a preload (i.e., the clamping force against or toward the coaption element is greater than zero) when the paddle frames 1400 are in the closed configuration.
- shape-setting the paddle frames 1400 in the FIG. 193 configuration can increase the clamping force of the paddle frames 1400 compared to paddle frames that are shape-set in the closed configuration ( FIG. 194 ).
- the magnitude of the preload of the paddle frames 1400 can be altered by adjusting the degree to which the paddle frames 1400 are shape-set relative to the coaption element 510 . The farther the paddle frames 1400 are shape-set past the closed position, the greater the preload.
- the curves of the paddle frame 1400 can be independent from one another, that is, one curve is complete before another curve starts, or can be combined, that is, the paddle frame 1400 curves in multiple directions simultaneously.
- each paddle frame 1400 A is formed from a piece of material 1402 A, such as nitinol, or any other suitable material.
- Each paddle frame 1400 A extends from a cap attachment portion 1410 A to a paddle connection portion 1420 A and has a proximal portion 1422 A, a middle portion 1424 A, and a distal portion 1426 A.
- Each paddle frame 1400 A extends between a first attachment portion 1412 A in a rounded, three-dimensional shape through the proximal, middle, and distal portions 1422 , 1424 , 1426 and returns to a second attachment portion 1414 .
- each paddle frame 1400 A is bent or curved in multiple locations as the paddle frame 1400 A extends between the first and second attachment portions 1412 A, 1414 A.
- the attachment portions 1412 A, 1414 A include notches 1416 A, 1418 A respectively for attachment to the cap.
- the paddle frames 1400 A flex at the area 1419 A.
- the area 1419 A can include a wider portion 1417 A to distribute the stress that results from flexing the paddle frame 1400 A over a greater area.
- notches 1416 A, 1418 A can include radiused notches 1415 A at each end of the notches 1416 A, 1418 A.
- the radiused notches 1415 A serve as strain reliefs for the bending area 1419 A and the area where the paddle frame 1400 A connects to the cap.
- Each paddle frame 1400 A curves away from a median or central plane 1404 A ( FIG. 116A ) at a first curve 1430 A to widen the shape of the paddle frame 1400 A. As can be seen in FIG. 114A , the paddle frame 1400 A also curves away from a frontal plane 1406 A in the location of the first curve 1430 A. The paddle frame 1400 A curves away from the outward direction of the first curve 1430 A at a second curve 1432 A to form sides 1433 A of the frame 1400 A that are parallel or substantially parallel to the central plane 1404 A when viewed from the frontal plane 1406 A. The paddle frame continues to slope away from the frontal plane 1406 A in the location of the second curve 1432 A.
- the second curve 1432 A has a larger radius than the first curve 1430 A.
- the paddle frame 1400 A curves back toward from the frontal plane 1406 A at a third curve 1434 A in the middle portion 1424 A while the sides 1433 A of the paddle frame 1400 A remain parallel or substantially parallel to the central plane 1404 A.
- the paddle frame 1400 A curves away from the central plane 1404 A a second time at a fourth curve 1436 A and continues to curve away from the central plane 1404 A through the remainder of the middle and distal portions 1424 A, 1426 A.
- the rounded three-dimensional shape of the paddle frame 1400 A is closed by an end portion 1442 A connected to the sides 1433 A by fifth curves 1438 A that form rounded corners of the distal end 1426 A of the paddle frame 1400 A.
- the end portion 1442 A can be wider than the remainder of the paddle frame 1400 A to accommodate features that allow the paddle frames 1400 A to be attached to the paddles (not shown) and cover (not shown).
- the end portion 1442 A can include a slot 1444 A for receiving a portion of a strip of material, such as the strip of material 401 A, 501 A described above.
- An opening 1446 A in the end portion 1442 A allows a strip of material to be inserted into the slot 1444 A.
- the end portion 1442 A can also include attachment holes 1440 A for securing a cover (see FIG. 30A ) to the paddle frame 1400 A.
- the paddle frame 1400 A has a generally rounded rectangle shape as the frame extends away from the attachment portion 1410 A to the closed end of the paddle connection portion 1420 A.
- the middle portion 1424 A of the frame is closer to the frontal plane 1406 A than the distal portion 1426 A, giving the sides of the middle portion 1424 A a rounded, wing-like shape that engages the front and back surfaces of the coaption element (not shown) during grasping of native tissue between a paddle (not shown) and coaption element of an implantable device described herein.
- the paddle frames 1400 A are shown assembled to the collar 514 A of an example implantable device, such as the device 500 A described above.
- the paddle frames 1400 A can be shape-set to provide increased clamping force against or toward a coaption element 510 A when the paddles 520 A, 522 A are in the closed configuration. This is because the paddle frames 1400 A are shape-set relative to the closed position (e.g., FIG. 196 ) to a first position (e.g., FIG. 195 ) which is beyond the position where the inner paddle 522 A would engage the coaption element 510 A, such as beyond the central plane 552 A of the device 500 A (e.g., FIG.
- the sides 1433 A of the paddle frames 1400 A are intertwined in that the sides 1433 A of one paddle frame 1400 A are moved slightly laterally to allow movement past the sides 1433 A of the other paddle frame 1400 A until the end portions 1442 A of each frame 1400 A contact each other and the sides 1433 A and prevent further movement.
- the magnitude of the preload of the paddle frames 1400 A can be altered by adjusting the degree to which the paddle frames 1400 A are shape-set relative to the coaption element 510 A. The farther the paddle frames 1400 A are shape-set past the closed position, the greater the preload force when the paddle frames 1400 A are moved into the open position.
- the curves of the paddle frame 1400 A can be independent from one another, that is, one curve is complete before another curve starts, or can be combined, that is, the paddle frame 1400 A curves in multiple directions simultaneously.
- the paddle frame 1400 A can be formed from a flat blank that is cut from a flat sheet of material, for example, by laser cutting. The cut blank can then be bent to form the three-dimensional shape of the paddle frame 1400 A.
- the paddle frame 1400 is shown in an expanded condition ( FIG. 119 ) and a compressed condition ( FIG. 120 ).
- the paddle frame 1400 is in a compressed condition when the paddles are disposed in a delivery device 1450 .
- the paddle frame 1400 is moved from the expanded condition to the compressed condition by compressing the paddle in the direction X and extending a length of the paddle in the direction Y.
- the paddles When the paddles 1400 are in the compressed condition, the paddles have a width H.
- the width H can be, for example between about 4 mm and about 7 mm, such as, between about 5 mm and about 6 mm.
- the width H can be less than 4 mm or more than 7 mm.
- the width H of the compressed paddles 1400 is equal or substantially equal to a width D of the delivery opening 1452 of the delivery device 1450 .
- the ratio between the width W of the paddles in the expanded condition and the width H of the paddles in the compressed condition can be, for example, about 4 to 1 or less, such as about 3 to 1 or less, such as about 2 to 1 or less, such as about 1.5 to 1, such as about 1.25 to 1, such as about 1 to 1.
- the ratio between the width W and the width H can be more than 4 to 1.
- FIG. 120 illustrates the connection portions 1410 compressed from the positions illustrated by FIG. 119 .
- connection portions 1410 will not be compressed.
- the connection portions 1410 will not be compressed when the connection portions 1410 are connected to a cap 514 .
- the paddle frame 1400 A shown in FIGS. 112A and 114A-118A can be similarly compressed.
- the example implantable device 500 is shown in open and closed conditions with paddle frames that are compressed or stretched as the anchor portion 506 of the device is opened and closed.
- the paddle frames 1524 are like the paddle frame 1400 described above.
- the anchor portion 506 is shown in a closed condition.
- the paddle frames 1524 have a first width W 1 and a first length L 1 .
- the anchor portion 506 is shown in an open condition and the paddle frames 1524 are in an extended condition ( FIG. 124 ).
- Opening the anchor portion 506 of the device 500 causes the paddle frames 1524 to move, extend, or pivot outward from the coaption portion 510 and transition to the extended condition.
- the paddle frames 1524 In the extended condition, the paddle frames 1524 have a second or extended length L 2 and a second or extended width W 2 .
- the paddle frame 1524 lengthens and narrows such that the second length L 2 is greater than the first length L 1 and the second width W 2 is narrower than the first width W 1 .
- One advantage of this embodiment is that the paddle frames become narrower and can have less chordal engagement during grasping of the leaflets. However, the paddle frames become wide when the implant is closed to enhance support of the leaflet.
- Another advantage of this embodiment is that the paddle frames also become narrower and longer in the bailout position. The narrower paddle size in the extended, elongated, or bailout position can allow for less chordal entanglement and increased ease of bailout.
- the example implantable device 500 is shown in open and closed conditions with paddle frames that are compressed or stretched as the anchor portion 506 of the device is opened and closed.
- the paddle frames 1624 are similar to the paddle frame 1400 described above.
- the anchor portion 506 is shown in a closed condition.
- the paddle frames 1624 have a first width W 1 and a first length L 1 .
- the anchor portion 506 is shown in an open condition and the paddle frames 1624 are in a compressed condition ( FIG. 128 ).
- Opening the anchor portion 506 of the device 500 causes the paddle frames 1624 to move, extend, or pivot outward from the coaption portion 510 and transition to the compressed condition.
- the paddle frames 1624 In the compressed condition, the paddle frames 1624 have a second or compressed length L 2 and a second or compressed width W 2 .
- the paddle frame 1624 In the compressed condition, the paddle frame 1624 shortens and widens such that the second length L 2 is less than the first length L 1 and the second width W 2 is wider than the first width W 1 .
- example implantable prosthetic devices are shown that can be locked or fastened closed.
- the example implantable prosthetic device 500 is shown that can be locked or retained in a closed condition with magnets.
- the device 500 includes a coaption element 510 and paddles 520 .
- the paddles 520 open and close to grasp leaflets 20 , 22 of the native heart valve, as described in more detail above.
- the coaption element 510 includes one or more magnets 1700 and the paddles 520 include one or more magnets 1702 .
- the magnets 1700 , 1702 have opposite poles facing each other such that the magnets 1702 in the paddles 520 are attracted to the magnets 1700 in the coaption element 510 and the magnetic attractive forces between the magnets 1700 , 1702 retain the paddles 520 in a closed condition.
- the magnets 1700 , 1702 are programmed or polymagnets with patterns of polarity such that the implantable device 500 can be locked and unlocked by moving—such as rotating—the magnet 1700 within the coaption element.
- the magnet 1700 can be configured such that the magnet 1700 attracts the magnets 1702 in the paddles 520 in a first orientation and repels the magnets 1702 in the paddles 520 when the magnet 1700 is rotated 90 degrees into a second orientation.
- the example implantable prosthetic device 500 is shown that can be locked or retained in a closed condition with an elastic band 1800 .
- the elastic band 1800 can be made from any flexible material and have any configuration.
- the elastic band can comprise coiled nitinol, can have a stent like structure, etc.
- the device 500 includes a coaption element 510 , paddles 520 , and barbed clasps 530 .
- the paddles 520 and barbed clasps 530 open and close to grasp leaflets 20 , 22 of the native heart valve, as described in more detail above.
- the paddles 520 move between an open condition ( FIG. 130 ) to a closed condition ( FIG. 131 ) by actuation of an actuation element or means for actuation 512 , as described above.
- the elastic band 1800 can be arranged to lock or retain the device 500 in a closed condition. When the device 500 is in the open condition ( FIG. 130 ) the band 1800 is arranged around the paddles 520 in a relaxed or disengaged condition.
- the band 1800 can be arranged around a narrower portion of the open device 500 , such as a tapered portion of the paddles 520 near a distal portion 507 of the device.
- the band 1800 is arranged around the paddles 520 in an engaged condition.
- the band 1800 when the band 1800 is in the engaged condition it is arranged around the widest portion of the device 500 or can be arranged around the center of the device 500 .
- the band 1800 is moved from the disengaged condition in a closing or engaging direction 1802 to the engaged condition with sutures (not shown) or other suitable means of moving the band 1800 . Movement of the band 1800 can cause the paddles 520 to move in a closing direction 1804 , thereby closing and securing the device 500 in a single movement of the band 1800 . Alternatively, device 500 can be closed and the band 1800 moved into the engaged location to secure the device 500 in the closed condition.
- the example implantable prosthetic device 500 is shown that can be locked or retained in a closed condition with a biasing member 1900 .
- the device 500 includes a coaption element 510 , paddles 520 , and barbed clasps 530 .
- the paddles 520 are moved between open and closed positions with an actuation element 512 extending through the coaption element 510 to a cap 514 .
- the paddles 520 and barbed clasps 530 are opened and closed to grasp leaflets 20 , 22 of the native heart valve, as described in more detail above.
- the paddles 520 and the clasps 530 engage the tissue of valve leaflets 20 , 22 and each other to secure the device 500 to the valve tissue.
- the biasing member 1900 (e.g., a spring) is configured to bias the cap 514 toward the coaption element 510 , thereby biasing the device 500 toward the closed condition.
- a delivery device not shown
- the delivery device is removed from the patient's body and the biasing member 1900 maintains the device 500 in a closed condition to prevent detachment of the device 500 from the valve tissue.
- an example implantable prosthetic device 2000 is shown that can be locked or retained in a closed condition with latches.
- the device 2000 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the device 2000 can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- the device 2000 is similar to other implantable devices described above and includes paddles 2002 and gripping members or clasps 2004 .
- the paddles 2002 are opened and closed to grasp the native leaflets 20 , 22 in a gap 2006 between the paddles 2002 and gripping members 2004 .
- the device 2000 also includes a latch member 2008 attached to the paddles 2002 , in which the latch member 2008 is configured to attach the paddles 2002 to the gripping members 2004 when the device 2000 is in the closed position.
- the latch member 2008 serves as a secondary latching mechanism and is configured to keep the device 2000 in the closed position when other mechanisms fail.
- the device 2000 is in an open position with valve tissue 20 , 22 disposed in the gap or opening 2006 between the paddles 2002 and the gripping members 2004 .
- the device 2000 is moved to the closed position such that the valve tissue 20 , 22 is secured between the paddles 2002 and the gripping members 2004 .
- the device 2000 can be moved to the closed position by any suitable manner, such as, for example, any manner described in the present application.
- the latch member 2008 punctures the valve tissue 20 , 22 and is inserted into or through the gripping member 2004 to secure the paddle 2002 to the gripping member 2004 .
- the latch member 2008 can take any suitable form that can secure the paddles 2002 to the gripping members 2004 , such as, for example, metals, plastics, etc.
- the example implantable prosthetic device 2000 is shown that can be locked or retained in a closed condition with latches.
- the device 2000 includes a coaption element 2010 .
- the device 2000 is in an open position with valve tissue 20 , 22 disposed in the gap or opening 2006 between the paddles 2002 and the gripping members 2004 .
- the device 2000 is moved to the closed position such that the valve tissue 20 , 22 is secured between the paddles 2002 and the gripping members 2004 .
- the device 2000 can be moved to the closed position by any suitable manner, such as, for example, any manner described in the present application.
- the latch member 2008 punctures the valve tissue 20 , 22 and is inserted into or through the gripping member 2004 to secure the paddle 2002 to the gripping member 2004 .
- the latch member 2008 protrudes beyond the gripping members 2004 and into the coaption element 2010 .
- the latch member 2008 can be secured in the coaption element 2010 by latching onto a portion of the coaption element 2010 or by penetrating the coaption element 2010 material.
- the latch member 2008 can take any suitable form that can secure the paddles 2002 to the gripping members 2004 , such as, for example, metals, plastics, etc.
- FIGS. 137-145 various embodiments of implantable prosthetic devices and methods of using the same are shown that facilitate release of native tissue grasped by the implantable prosthetic devices.
- the devices can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the devices can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- the device 2100 is delivered from a delivery sheath 2102 and has a coaption element 2110 , paddles 2120 , and clasps or gripping members 2130 .
- the gripping members 2130 include barbs 2132 and stretchable portions 2134 .
- the stretchable portions 2134 allow the clasps 2130 to be stretched in a stretching direction 2136 .
- Actuation lines or actuation sutures 2104 extend from the delivery sheath 2102 to the clasps 2130 . Retracting the lines/sutures 2104 in a retraction direction 2106 opens and stretches the clasps 2130 to a fully extended position.
- the clasps 2130 primarily stretch once the clasps 2130 are in the fully open position. Movement of the barbs 2132 in the stretching direction 2136 allows for clean disengagement from the native tissue.
- the stretchable portion 2134 is configured to be moved such that the barbs 2132 exit the valve tissue in a direction opposite or substantially opposite the direction in which the barbs entered the native tissue.
- the clasps 2130 can be otherwise extendable to allow for disengagement from the native tissue without tearing the native tissue.
- joint portions 2131 can be configured to allow the barbs 2132 of the clasps 2130 to be pulled in the direction 2136 .
- the device 500 includes a coaption element 510 , inner paddles 522 , outer paddles 520 , and barbed clasps 530 .
- the device 500 is deployed from a delivery sheath 502 .
- An actuation element 512 extends through the coaption element 510 to a cap 514 . Actuation of the actuation element 512 opens and closes the paddles 520 , 522 to open and close the device.
- the barbed clasps 530 include barbs 536 , moveable arms 534 , and stationary arms 532 .
- the stationary arms 532 are attached to the inner paddles 522 so that the clasps 530 move with the movement of the inner paddles 522 .
- Clasp control members or actuation lines/sutures 537 extend from the delivery sheath 502 to the moveable arms 534 of the clasps 530 .
- FIGS. 138-141 illustrate an example method of releasing grasped valve tissue.
- the device is shown in an open or substantially open position to more clearly illustrate the movements of the parts of the device 500 that are involved with tissue release.
- the tissue release method is more likely to be practiced with the device 500 in the more closed positions illustrated by FIGS. 142 and 143 . That is, it is not likely that the paddles and clasps will be substantially opened before moving the clasps to release the valve tissue as illustrated by FIGS. 138-141 . It is more likely that the paddles and clasps will only be opened slightly before releasing the valve tissue as illustrated by FIGS. 142 and 143 .
- the same parts that move in the example illustrated by FIGS. 138-141 move in the example illustrated by FIGS. 142-143 .
- the device 500 is shown in an open or substantially open position with the clasps 530 in a closed position.
- Retraction of the clasp control members or actuation lines/sutures 537 articulates, flexes, or pivots the moveable arms 534 of the clasps 530 to a partially open position ( FIG. 139 ) and then to a fully open position ( FIG. 140 ).
- FIG. 141 once the clasps 530 are in the fully open position ( FIG. 140 ), further retraction of the actuation lines/sutures 537 in the retraction direction 560 pulls upward on the moveable arms 534 , barbs 536 , and inner paddles 522 in a tissue release direction.
- the portion 523 of the inner paddles 522 closest to the coaption element flex upward in direction 562 to allow this movement in the retraction direction 560 .
- the inner paddles can flex at the small gap (if there is a small gap) or at the connection 523 between the coaption element 510 and the inner paddles if there is not a gap.
- This flexing movement 562 of the inner paddles 522 can optionally also cause the outer paddles to move or pivot downward. Movement of the barbs 536 in the tissue release direction 560 allows for clean disengagement from the native tissue.
- the barbs can be at an angle ⁇ (see FIG. 138 ) to the moveable arms 534 that facilitates release from the tissue.
- the angle ⁇ can be between 10 and 60 degrees, such as 20 and 50 degrees, such as 25 and 45 degrees, such as about 30 degrees, or 30 degrees.
- the device 500 is shown in a slightly opened position or a closed position. As mentioned above, the same parts of the device 500 move in the example illustrated by FIGS. 142 and 143 as in the example illustrated by FIGS. 138-141 . In the partially open position or closed position, further retraction of the actuation lines/sutures 537 in the retraction direction 560 pulls upward on the moveable arms 534 , barbs 536 , and inner paddles 522 . The portion of the inner paddles 522 closest to the coaption element flexes or is lifted-up in the direction 562 to allow the movement 560 .
- the inner paddles can flex 562 at the small gap (if there is a small gap) or at the connection between the coaption element 510 and the inner paddles if there is not a gap.
- the movement of the barbs 536 in the direction 560 releases the valve tissue from the barbs.
- the lifting on the inner paddles 522 can optionally also force the outer paddles 520 to move outward in an opening direction 564 .
- the optional outward movement 564 of the outer paddles 520 relieves the pinching force applied to grasped tissue by the paddles and the coaption element.
- Relieving the pinching force on the tissue can also assist in the release of the tissue from the barbs.
- the device 500 is moved from the position illustrated by FIG. 143 to the position illustrated by FIG. 140 or 141 to fully disengage the device from the native valve.
- FIGS. 144-152 show an example delivery assembly 2200 and its components.
- the delivery assembly 2200 can comprise the implantable prosthetic spacer device 500 (or any other implantable device described in the present application) and a delivery apparatus 2202 .
- the delivery apparatus 2202 can comprise a plurality of catheters and catheter stabilizers.
- the delivery apparatus 2202 includes a first catheter 2204 , a second catheter 2206 , a third catheter 2208 , and catheter stabilizers 2210 .
- the second catheter 2206 extends coaxially through the first catheter 2204
- the third catheter 2208 extends coaxially through the first and second catheters 2204 , 2206 .
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can be releasably coupled to a distal end portion of the third catheter 2208 of the delivery apparatus 2202 , as further described below.
- the delivery assembly 2200 is configured, for example, for implanting the prosthetic spacer device 500 in a native valve via a transvascular approach (e.g., the native mitral valve MV via a transseptal delivery approach, etc.).
- the delivery assembly 2200 can be configured for implanting the prosthetic spacer device 500 in aortic, tricuspid, or pulmonary valve regions of a human heart.
- the delivery assembly 2200 can be configured for various delivery methods, including transseptal, transaortic, transventricular, etc.
- the first collar or cap 514 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 can include a bore 516 A.
- the bore 516 A can comprise internal threads configured to releasably engage corresponding external threads on a distal end 512 B of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 of the delivery apparatus 2202 , as shown in FIG. 145 .
- the second or proximal collar 511 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 can include a central opening 511 C that is axially aligned with the bore 516 A of the cap 514 .
- the central opening 511 C of the proximal collar 511 can be configured to slidably receive the actuation element, actuation shaft, or means of actuating 512 of the delivery apparatus 2202 , as shown in FIG. 145 .
- the proximal collar 511 and/or the coaption element 510 can have a sealing member (not shown, but see, e.g., the sealing member 413 shown in FIG. 23 ) configured to seal the central opening 511 C when the actuation element or means of actuating 512 is withdrawn from the central opening 511 C.
- the proximal collar 511 can also include a plurality of engagement portions or projections 511 A and a plurality of guide openings 511 B.
- the projections 511 A can extending radially outwardly and can be circumferentially offset (e.g., by about 90 degrees) relative to the guide openings 511 B.
- the guide openings 511 B can be disposed radially outwardly from the central opening 511 C.
- the projections 511 A and the guide openings 511 B of the proximal collar 511 can be configured to releasably engage a coupler or means for coupling 2214 of the delivery apparatus 2202 , as shown in FIG. 145 .
- the delivery apparatus 2202 can include the first and second catheters 2204 , 2206 .
- the first and second catheters 2204 , 2206 can be used, for example, to access an implantation location (e.g., a native mitral valve or tricuspid valve region of a heart) and/or to position the third catheter 2208 at the implantation location.
- an implantation location e.g., a native mitral valve or tricuspid valve region of a heart
- the first and second catheters 2204 , 2206 can comprise first and second sheaths 2216 , 2218 , respectively.
- the catheters 2204 , 2206 can be configured such that the sheaths 2216 , 2218 are steerable. Additional details regarding the first catheter 2204 can be found, for example, in U.S. Published Patent Application No. 2016/0155987, which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. Additional details regarding the second catheter 2206 can be found, for example, in U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 62/418,528, which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety.
- delivery apparatus 2202 can also include the third catheter 2208 , as mentioned above.
- the third catheter 2208 can be used, for example, to deliver, manipulate, position, and/or deploy the prosthetic spacer device 500 at the implantation location.
- the third catheter 2208 can comprise the actuation element or inner shaft 512 , the coupler or means for coupling 2214 , an outer shaft 2220 , a handle 2222 (shown schematically), and clasp control members or actuation lines 537 .
- a proximal end portion 2220 a of the outer shaft 2220 can be coupled to and extend distally from the handle 2222
- a distal end portion 2220 b of the outer shaft 2220 can be coupled to the coupler or means for coupling 2214 .
- a proximal end portion 512 A of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 can coupled to an actuation knob 2226 .
- the actuation element or means of actuating 512 can extend distally from the knob 2226 (shown schematically), through the handle 2222 , through the outer shaft 2220 , and through the coupler or means for coupling 2214 .
- the actuation element or means of actuating 512 can be moveable (e.g., axially and/or rotationally) relative to the outer shaft 2220 and the handle 2222 .
- the clasp control members or actuation lines 537 can extend through and be axially movable relative to the handle 2222 and the outer shaft 2220 .
- the clasp control members/actuation lines 537 can also be axially movable relative to the actuation element or means of actuating 512 .
- the actuation element or means of actuating 512 (e.g., actuation shaft, etc.) of the third catheter 2208 can be releasably coupled to the cap 514 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 .
- the distal end portion 512 B of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 can comprise external thread configured to releasably engage the interior threads of the bore 516 A of the prosthetic spacer device 500 .
- rotating the actuation element or means of actuating 512 in a first direction (e.g., clockwise) relative to the cap 514 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 releasably secures the actuation element or means of actuating 512 to the cap 514 .
- Rotating the actuation element or means of actuating 512 in a second direction (e.g., counterclockwise) relative to the cap 514 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 releases the actuation element or means of actuating 512 from the cap 514 .
- the coupler or means for coupling 2214 of the third catheter 2208 can be releasably coupled to the proximal collar 511 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 .
- the coupler or means for coupling 2214 can comprise a plurality of flexible arms 2228 and a plurality of stabilizer members 2230 .
- the flexible arms 2228 can comprise apertures 2232 , ports 2233 ( FIG. 146 ), and eyelets 2234 ( FIG. 147 ).
- the flexible arms 2228 can be configured to move or pivot between a first or release configuration ( FIG. 146 ) and a second or coupled configuration ( FIGS. 145 and 147 ).
- the flexible arms 2228 extend radially outwardly relative to the stabilizer members 2230 .
- the flexible arms 2230 extend axially parallel to the stabilizer members 2230 and the eyelets 2234 radially overlap 2234 , as shown in FIG. 147 .
- the flexible arms 2228 can be configured (e.g., shape-set) to be biased to the first configuration.
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can be releasably coupled to the coupler or means for coupling 2214 by inserting the stabilizer members 2230 of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 into the guide openings 511 B of the prosthetic spacer device 500 .
- the flexible arms 2228 of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 can then be moved or pivoted radially inwardly from the first configuration to the second configuration such that the projections 511 A of the prosthetic spacer device 500 extend radially into the apertures 2232 of the flexible arms 2228 .
- the flexible arms 2228 can be retained in the second configuration by inserting the distal end portion 512 B of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 (e.g., actuation shaft, etc.) through openings 2236 of the eyelets 2234 , which prevents the flexible arms 2228 from moving or pivoting radially outwardly from the second configuration to the first configuration, thereby releasably coupling the prosthetic spacer device 500 to the coupler or means for coupling 2214 .
- actuating 512 e.g., actuation shaft, etc.
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can be released from the coupler or means for coupling 2214 by proximally retracting the actuation element or means of actuating 512 relative to the coupler or means for coupling 2214 such that the distal end portion 512 B of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 withdraws from the openings 2236 of the eyelets 2234 .
- This allows the flexible arms 2228 to move or pivot radially outwardly from the second configuration to the first configuration, which withdraws the projections 511 A of the prosthetic spacer device 500 from the apertures 2232 of the flexible arms 2228 .
- the stabilizer members 2230 can remain inserted into the guide openings 511 B of the prosthetic spacer device 500 during and after the flexible arms 2228 are released.
- the stabilizer members 2230 can then be withdrawn from the guide openings 511 B of the prosthetic spacer device 500 by proximally retracting the coupler or means for coupling 2214 relative to the prosthetic spacer device 500 , thereby releasing the prosthetic spacer device 500 from the coupler or means for coupling 2214 .
- the outer shaft 2220 of the third catheter 2208 can be an elongate shaft extending axially between the proximal end portion 2220 a , which is coupled the handle 2222 , and the distal end portion 2220 b , which is coupled to the coupler or means for coupling 2214 .
- the outer shaft 2220 can also include an intermediate portion 2220 c disposed between the proximal and distal end portions 2220 a , 2220 b.
- the outer shaft 2220 can comprise a plurality of axially extending lumens, including an actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2238 and a plurality of control member lumens 2240 (e.g., four in the illustrated embodiment). In some embodiments, the outer shaft 2220 can comprise more (e.g., six) or less (e.g., two) than four control member lumens 2240 .
- the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2238 can be configured to receive the actuation element or means of actuating 512
- the control member lumens 2240 can be configured to receive one or more clasp control members or actuation lines 537 .
- the lumens 2238 , 2240 can also be configured such that the actuation element or means of actuating 512 and clasp control members/lines 537 can be movable axially and/or rotationally) relative to the respective lumens 2238 , 2240 .
- the lumens 2238 , 2240 can comprise a liner or coating configured to reduce friction within the lumens 2238 , 2240 .
- the lumens 2238 , 2240 can comprise a liner comprising PTFE.
- the outer shaft 2220 can be formed from various materials, including metals and polymers.
- the proximal end portion 2220 a can comprise stainless steel and the distal and intermediate portions 2220 b , 2220 c can comprise PEBAX (e.g., PEBAX®).
- the outer shaft 2220 can also comprise an outer covering or coating, such as a polymer that is reflowed over the portions 2220 a , 2220 b , and 2220 c.
- the outer shaft 2220 can include one or more coil portions 2242 disposed radially outwardly from the lumens 2238 , 2240 .
- the outer shaft 2220 can comprise a first coil 2242 a , a second coil 2242 b , and a third coil 2242 c .
- the first coil 2242 a can be the radially outermost coil
- the third coil 2242 c can be the radially innermost coil
- the second coil 2242 b can be radially disposed between the first coil 2242 a and the third coil 2242 c.
- the coil portions 2242 can comprise various materials and/or configurations.
- the coil portions 2242 can be formed from stainless steel.
- the first and third coils 2242 a , 2242 c comprise stainless steel coils wound in a left-hand configuration
- the second coil 2242 b comprises a stainless-steel coil wound in a right-hand configuration.
- the coil portions 2242 can also comprise various pitches.
- the pitch of one or more of the coils 2242 can be the same or different than the pitch of one or more other coils 2242 .
- the first and second coils 2242 a , 2242 b can have a first pitch (e.g., 0.74 in.), and the third coil can comprise a second pitch (e.g., 0.14 in.).
- the outer shaft 2220 can also comprise a tie layer 2244 disposed radially inwardly from the third coil 2242 c .
- the tie layer 2244 can be formed of various materials including polymers, such as PEBAX (e.g., PEBAX®).
- the handle 2222 of the third catheter 2208 can include a housing 2246 , an actuation lock mechanism 2248 , a clasp control mechanism 2250 , and a flushing mechanism 2252 .
- a distal end portion of the housing 2246 can be coupled to the proximal end portion 2220 a of the outer shaft 2220 .
- the actuation lock mechanism 2248 , the clasp control mechanism 2250 , and a flushing mechanism 2252 can be coupled to a proximal end of the housing 2246 .
- the actuation lock mechanism 2248 can be configured to selectively lock the position of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 relative to the housing 2246 and the outer shaft 2220 .
- the clasp control mechanism 2250 can also be coupled to proximal end portions of the clasp control members or actuation lines 537 and can be configured to secure the clasp control members 537 relative to the handle 2222 and to move the clasp control members 537 relative to the outer shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 .
- the flushing mechanism 2252 can be configured for flushing (e.g., with a saline solution) the outer shaft 2220 prior to inserting the outer shaft 2220 into a patient's vasculature.
- the housing 2246 of the handle 2222 can comprise a main body 2254 and a nose portion 2256 coupled to a distal end portion of the main body 2254 .
- the main body 2254 and the nose portion 2256 can be coupled together in various manners, including fasteners 2258 and/or pins 2260 (e.g., as shown in the illustrated embodiment), adhesive, and/or other coupling means.
- the housing 2246 can be formed from various materials, including polymers (e.g., polycarbonate).
- the main body 2254 of the housing 2246 can comprise a plurality of lumens, including an actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2262 (e.g., an actuation shaft lumen, actuation tube, etc.), control member lumens 2264 ( FIG. 152 ), and a flushing lumen 2266 that connects with the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2262 ( FIG. 151 ). As shown in FIG.
- the main body 2254 can also include a plurality of tubes (e.g., hypotubes), including an actuation tube 2268 and control member tubes 2270 that are disposed at least partially in the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2262 and the control member lumens 2264 , respectively.
- the tubes 2268 , 2270 can be axially movable (e.g., slidable) relative the lumens 2262 , 2264 , respectively.
- the proximal end of the actuation tube or lumen 2268 can extend proximally from the main body 2256 and can be coupled to the knob 2226 and to the proximal end portion 512 A of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 .
- the proximal ends of the control member tubes 2270 can extend proximally from the main body 2254 and can be coupled to the clasp control mechanism 2250 and the clasp control members 537 .
- the distal ends of the tubes 2268 , 2270 can comprise flanges 2272 , 2274 configured to engage a stopper to limit the axial movement of the tubes 2268 , 2270 relative to the housing 2224 .
- the flanges 2272 , 2274 can be configured to contact respective surfaces of the main body 2254 (e.g., a lip) to prevent to tubes 2268 , 2270 from withdrawing completely from the proximal ends of the lumens 2262 , 2264 , respectively.
- the actuation tube or lumen 2268 can be configured to receive and be coupled to the proximal end portion of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 .
- the control member tubes 2270 can be configured to receive portions of the clasp control mechanism 2250 , as further described below.
- the tubes 2268 , 2270 can be formed from various materials, including polymers and metals (e.g., stainless steel).
- the main body 2254 can include a plurality of seal members 2276 (e.g., O-rings) configured to prevent or reduce blood leakage through the lumens and around the shafts and/or tubes.
- the seal members can be secured relative to the main body 2254 , for example, by fasteners 2278 (e.g., hollow-lock or socket-jam set screws).
- the nose portion 2256 of the housing 2246 can comprise a plurality of lumens, including an actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2280 (e.g., an actuation shaft lumen, etc.), and control member lumens 2282 .
- the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2280 of the nose portion 2256 can be extend coaxially with the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2262 of the main body 2254 .
- Proximal ends of the control member lumens 2282 of the nose portion 2256 can be aligned with the control member lumens 2264 of the main body 2254 at the proximal end of the nose portion 2256 (i.e., the lumens 2282 , 2264 are in the same plane).
- the control member lumens 2282 can extend from the proximal ends at an angle (i.e., relative to the control member lumens 2264 of the main body 2254 ), and distal ends of the control member lumens 2282 can connect with the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2280 of the nose portion 2256 at a location toward the distal end of the nose portion 2256 .
- the proximal ends of the lumens 2282 are in a first plane (i.e., the plane of the control member lumens 2264 of the main body 2254 ), and the distal ends of the lumens 2282 are in a second plane (i.e., the plane of the actuation shaft lumen or means of actuating lumen 2262 of the main body 2254 ).
- the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2280 of the nose portion 2256 can be configured to receive the proximal end portion of the outer shaft 2220 .
- the proximal end portion of the outer shaft 2220 can be coupled to the nose portion 2256 in many ways such as with adhesive, fasteners, frictional fit, and/or other coupling means.
- the actuation lock mechanism 2248 of the handle 2222 can be coupled to the proximal end portion of the main body 2254 of the housing 2246 and to the actuation tube 2268 .
- the actuation lock mechanism 2248 can be configured to selectively control relative movement between the actuation tube 2268 and the housing 2246 . This, in turn, selectively controls relative movement between the actuation element or means of actuating 512 (which is coupled to the actuation tube 2268 ) and the outer shaft 2220 (which is coupled to the nose portion 2256 of the housing 2246 ).
- the actuation lock mechanism 2248 can comprise a lock configuration, which prevents relative movement between the actuation tube 2268 and the housing 2246 , and a release configuration, which allows relative movement between the actuation tube 2268 and the housing 2246 .
- the actuation lock mechanism 2248 can be configured to include one or more intermediate configurations (i.e., in addition to the lock and release configuration) which allow relative movement between the actuation tube 2268 and the housing 2246 , but the force required to cause the relative movement is greater than when the actuation lock mechanism is in the release configuration.
- the actuation lock mechanism 2248 can comprise a lock (e.g., a Tuohy-Borst adapter) 2284 and a coupler (e.g., a female luer coupler) 2286 .
- the coupler 2286 can be attached to the distal end of the lock 2284 and coupled to the proximal end of the main body 2254 of the housing 2246 .
- the actuation tube 2268 can coaxially extend through the lock 2284 and the coupler 2286 .
- rotating a knob 2288 of the lock 2284 in a first direction can increase the frictional engagement of the lock 2284 on the actuation tube 2268 , thus making relative movement between the actuation tube 2268 and the housing 2246 more difficult or preventing it altogether.
- Rotating a knob 2288 of the lock 2284 in a second direction can decrease the frictional engagement of the lock 2284 on the actuation tube 2268 , thus making relative movement between the actuation tube 2268 and the housing 2246 easier.
- actuation lock mechanism 2248 can comprise other configurations configured for preventing relative movement between the actuation tube 2268 and the housing 2246 .
- the locking mechanism 2248 can include lock configured like a stopcock valve in which a plunger portion of valve selectively engages the actuation tube 2268 .
- the clasp control mechanism 2250 can comprise an actuator member 2290 and one or more locking members 2292 (e.g., two in the illustrated embodiment).
- a distal end portion of the actuator member 2290 can be coupled to the control member tubes 2270 , which extend from the proximal end of the main body 2254 of the housing 2246 , as best shown in FIG. 151 .
- the locking members 2292 can be coupled to a proximal end portion of the actuator member 2290 .
- the actuator member 2290 can, optionally, comprise a first side portion 2294 and a second side portion 2296 selectively coupled to the first side portion 2294 by a connecting pin 2298 .
- the actuator member 2290 can be configured such that the first and second side portions 2294 , 2296 move together when the connecting pin 2298 is inserted through the first and second side portions 2294 , 2296 .
- the connecting pin 2298 is withdrawn, the first and second side portions 2294 , 2296 can be moved relative to each other. This can allow the clasp control members or lines 537 (which are releasably coupled to the first and second side portions 2294 , 2296 by the locking elements 2292 ) to be individually actuated.
- connection between the first and second side portions 2294 , 2296 can be configured such that the first and second side portions 2294 , 2296 can move axially (i.e., proximally and distally) but not rotationally relative to each other when the connecting pin 2298 is withdrawn.
- This can be accomplished, for example, by configuring the first side portion 2294 with keyed slot or groove and configuring second side portion 2296 with a keyed projection or tongue that corresponds to the keyed slot or groove of the first side portion 2294 .
- This can, for example, prevent or reduce the likelihood that the clasp control members/lines 537 from twisting relative to the outer shaft 2220 .
- the first and second side portions 2294 , 2296 can include axially extending lumens 2201 .
- Distal ends of the lumens 2201 can be configured to receive the proximal end portions of the control member tubes 2270 .
- Proximal ends of the lumens 2201 can be configured to receive portions of the locking members 2292 .
- the locking members 2292 can be configured to selectively control relative movement between a clasp control member 2224 and the respective first or second side portion 2294 , 2296 of the actuator member 2290 .
- the locking members 2292 can comprise a lock configuration, which prevents relative movement between a clasp control member 2224 and the respective first or second side portion 2294 , 2296 , and a release configuration, which allows relative movement between a clasp control member 2224 and the respective first or second side portion 2294 , 2296 .
- the locking members 2292 can also comprise one or more intermediate configurations (i.e., in addition to the lock and release configuration) which allows relative movement between a clasp control member 2224 and the respective first or second side portion 2294 , 2296 , but the force required to cause the relative movement is greater than when the locking members 2292 are in the release configuration.
- the locking members 2292 can be configured similar to stopcock valves.
- rotating knobs 2203 in a first direction e.g., clockwise
- Rotating knobs 2203 in a second direction e.g., counterclockwise
- actuation locking members 2292 can comprise other configurations configured for preventing relative movement between the locking members 2292 on the clasp control members 537 .
- the flushing mechanism 2252 can comprise a flushing tube 2205 and a valve 2207 (e.g., a stopcock valve).
- a distal end of the flushing tube 2205 can be coupled to and in fluidic communication with the flushing lumen 2266 and thus with the actuation shaft lumen or means of actuating lumen 2262 of the main body 2254 .
- a proximal end of the flushing tube 2205 can be coupled to the valve 2207 .
- the flushing mechanism 2252 can be configured for flushing (e.g., with a saline solution) the outer shaft 2220 prior to inserting the outer shaft 2220 into a patient's vasculature.
- the clasp control members 537 or actuation lines can be configured to manipulate the configuration of the clasps 530 , as further described below.
- each of the clasp control members or lines 537 can be configured as a suture (e.g., wire, thread, etc.) loop.
- Proximal end portions of the control members 537 can extend proximally from the proximal end portion of the clasp control mechanism 2250 and can be releasably coupled to the locking mechanisms 2292 of the clasp control mechanism 2250 .
- the clasp control members or actuation lines 537 can form loops extending distally through the lumens 2201 of the clasp control mechanism 2250 , through the control member tubes 2270 , the control member lumens 2264 , 2282 of the handle 2222 , and through the control member lumens 2240 of the outer shaft 2220 .
- the clasp control members 537 can extend radially outwardly from the lumens 2240 , for example, through the ports 2233 ( FIG. 146 ) of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 .
- the clasp control members 537 can then extend through openings 535 of the clasps 530 .
- the clasp control members 537 can then extend proximally back to the coupler or means for coupling 2214 , radially inwardly through the ports 2233 of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 , and then proximally through the outer shaft 2220 and the handle 2222 , and to the locking mechanisms 2292 of the clasp control mechanism 2250 .
- the clasp control members or lines 537 are shown slacken and the clasps 530 are partially open in order to illustrate the clasp control members 537 extending through the openings 535 of the clasps 530 .
- the clasps 530 would be in the closed configuration.
- each of the clasp control members or actuation lines 537 can extend through multiple lumens 2240 of the outer shaft 2220 .
- each of the clasp control members 537 can be looped through two of the lumens 2240 .
- each of the clasp control members 537 can be disposed in a single lumen 2240 .
- multiple clasp control members 537 can be disposed in a single lumen 2240 .
- the clasp control mechanism 2250 can be used to actuate the clasps 530 between open and closed configurations.
- the clasps 530 can be opened by moving the actuator member 2290 proximally relative to the knob 2226 and the housing 2246 . This increases tension of the clasp control members 537 and causes the clasp 530 to move from the closed configuration to the open configuration.
- the clasps 530 can be closed by moving the actuator member 2290 distally relative to the knob 2226 and the housing 2246 . This decreases tension on the clasp control members 537 and allows the clasp 530 to move from the open configuration to the closed configuration.
- the clasps 530 can be individually actuated by removing the pin 2298 and moving the first or second side portions 2294 , 2296 relative to each other, the knob 2226 , and the housing 2246 .
- the actuation element or means of actuating 512 can extend distally from the knob 2226 , through the actuation tube 2268 , through the actuation lumens 2262 , 2280 of the housing 2246 , through the actuation lumen 2238 of the outer shaft 2220 , and through the coupler or means for coupling 2214 .
- FIGS. 153-160 the delivery assembly 2200 is used, for example, to implant the prosthetic spacer device 500 in native mitral valve MV of a heart H using a transseptal delivery approach.
- FIGS. 153-160 are similar to FIGS. 15-20 , described above, that show the implantable prosthetic device 100 being implanted in the heart H and FIGS. 35-46 , described above, that show the implantable prosthetic device 500 being implanted in the heart H.
- the methods and steps shown and/or discussed can be performed on a living animal or on a simulation, such as on a cadaver, cadaver heart, simulator (e.g. with the body parts, heart, tissue, etc. being simulated), etc.
- a guide wire can be inserted into the patient's vasculature (e.g., a femoral vein) through an introducer sheath.
- the guide wire can be advanced through the femoral vein, through the inferior vena cava, into the right atrium, through the interatrial septum IAS (e.g., via the fossa ovalis), and into the left atrium LA.
- the first sheath 2216 of the first catheter 2204 can be advanced over the guide wire such that a distal end portion of the first sheath 2216 is disposed in the left atrium LA, as shown in FIG. 153 .
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 coupled to the third catheter 2208 (e.g., as shown in FIG. 145 ) and configured in a radially compressed, delivery configuration
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can be loaded into the first sheath 2216 at a distal end of the second sheath 2218 of the second catheter 2206 .
- the first sheath 2216 retains the prosthetic spacer device 500 in the delivery configuration.
- the radially compressed, delivery configuration can be an axially elongated configuration (e.g., like the configuration shown in FIG. 153 ).
- the radially compressed, delivery configuration can be an axially foreshorten configuration (e.g., similar to the configuration shown in FIG. 155 ).
- the second catheter 2206 along with the prosthetic spacer device 500 and the third catheter 2208 can then be advanced together through the first catheter 2204 such that a distal end portion of the sheath 2218 exposed from the distal end portion of the first sheath 2216 and is disposed in the left atrium LA, as shown in FIG. 153 .
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can be exposed from the first sheath 2216 by distally advancing the outer shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 of the third catheter 2208 relative to the first sheath 2216 and/or retracting the first sheath 2216 relative to the outer shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 , thus forcing the paddles 520 , 522 of the anchors 508 out of the first sheath 2216 .
- the paddles 520 , 522 can be folded by retracting the actuation element or means of actuating 512 of the third catheter 2208 relative to the outer shaft 2220 of the third catheter 2208 and/or by advancing the outer shaft 2220 relative to the actuation element or means of actuating 512 , causing the paddles 520 , 522 to bend from the configuration shown in FIG. 153 , to the configuration shown in FIG. 154 , and then to the configuration shown in FIG. 155 .
- Another option is to set the locking knob 2288 to maintain enough friction that you can actively slide the actuation element or means for actuation 512 but the actuation element or means for actuation will not move on its own.
- the physician can lock the relative position of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 and the outer shaft 2220 , and thus the position of the paddles 520 , 522 , by actuating the actuation locking mechanism 2248 .
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can then be positioned coaxial relative to the native mitral valve MV by manipulating (e.g., steering and/or bending) the second sheath 2218 of the second catheter 2206 , as shown in FIG. 155 .
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can also be rotated (e.g., by rotating the housing 2246 ) relative to the native mitral valve MV such that the paddles 520 , 522 align with native leaflets 20 , 22 of the mitral valve MV.
- the paddles 520 , 522 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 can then be partially opened (i.e., moved radially outwardly relative to the coaption element 510 ) to the configuration shown in FIG. 156 by moving the knob 2226 distally relative to the housing 2246 .
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can then be advanced through the annulus of the native mitral valve MV and at least partially into the left ventricle LV.
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 is then partially retracted such that the paddles 520 , 522 are positioned behind the ventricular portions of the leaflets 20 , 22 (e.g., at the A2/P2 positions) and the coaption element 510 is disposed on the atrial side of the leaflets 20 , 22 .
- the native leaflets 20 , 22 can be secured relative to the paddles 520 , 522 by capturing the native leaflets with the clasps 530 .
- the native leaflets 20 , 22 can be grasped simultaneously or separately by actuating the actuator member 2290 .
- FIG. 157 shows separate leaflet grasping. This can be accomplished by removing the pin 2298 from the actuator member 2290 and moving the first or second side portions 2294 , 2296 relative to each other, the knob 2226 , and the housing 2246 .
- the physician can move the knob 2226 proximally relative to the housing 2246 . This pulls the paddles 520 , 522 and thus the native leaflets 20 , 22 radially inwardly against the coaption element 510 , as shown in FIG. 158 . The physician can then observe the positioning and/or reduction in regurgitation. If repositioning or removal is desired the physician can re-open the paddles 520 , 522 and/or the clasps 530 .
- the physician can release the prosthetic spacer device 500 from the delivery apparatus 2202 .
- the clasps 530 can be released from the delivery apparatus 2202 by releasing the clasp control members or actuation lines 537 from the locking members 2292 and unthreading the clasp control members or actuation lines 537 from the openings 535 of the clasps 530 .
- the cap 514 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 can be released from the delivery apparatus 2202 by rotating the knob 2226 in the second direction relative to the housing 2246 such that the actuation element or means of actuating 512 withdraws from the bore 516 A.
- the actuation element or means of actuating 512 can then be retracted proximally through the prosthetic spacer device 500 by pulling the knob 2226 proximally relative to the housing 2224 .
- the proximal collar 511 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 can be released from the delivery apparatus 2202 by retracting the actuation element or means of actuating 512 proximally relative to the coupler or means for coupling 2214 such that the distal end portion of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 withdraws from the eyelets 2234 of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 .
- the shafts 512 , 2220 of the third catheter 2208 can then be retracted proximally into the second sheath 2218 of the second catheter 2206 , and the second sheath 2218 of the second catheter 2206 can be retracted proximally into the first sheath 2216 of the first catheter 2204 .
- the catheters 2204 , 2206 , 2208 can then be retracted proximally and removed from the patient's vasculature.
- the native mitral valve MV comprises a double orifice during ventricular diastole, as shown in FIG. 160 .
- the side surfaces of the native leaflets 20 , 22 can coapt all the way around the prosthetic spacer device 500 to prevent or reduce mitral regurgitation.
- the handle 2300 can comprise a housing 2302 , an actuation control mechanism 2304 , the clasp control mechanism 2250 , and a flushing mechanism (not shown, but see, e.g., the flushing mechanism 2252 in FIG. 150 ).
- the housing 2302 can include a main body 2306 and the nose portion 2256 .
- the nose portion 2256 of the housing 2302 can be coupled to a proximal end portion of the outer shaft 2220 .
- the actuation control mechanism 2304 , the clasp control mechanism 2250 , and a flushing mechanism 2252 can be coupled to a proximal end of the main body 2306 of the housing 2302 .
- the handle 2300 can be configured similar to the handle 2222 , except that the handle 2300 is configured such that rotational movement of the first knob 2318 of the actuation control mechanism 2304 relative to the housing 2302 causes axial movement of the actuation tube 2268 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 ; whereas, the handle 2222 is configured such that axial movement of the knob 2226 relative to the housing 2246 causes axial movement of the actuation tube 2268 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 .
- the housing 2302 can include a main body 2306 and the nose portion 2256 .
- the main body 2306 of the housing 2302 can comprise an actuation lumen 2308 , control member lumens 2310 , and a flange portion 2312 .
- the flange portion 2312 can extend axially from a proximal end portion of the main body 2306 and annularly around the actuation lumen 2308 .
- the flange portion 2312 of the main body 2306 can comprise one or more circumferential grooves 2314 , a bore (not shown), and a guide pin 2316 .
- the grooves 2314 can be configured to interact with the actuation control mechanism 2304 , as further described below.
- the bore can extend radially inwardly from an outside diameter to an inside diameter of the flange portion 2312 and can be configured to receive the guide pin 2316 .
- the guide pin 2316 can be partially disposed in the bore and can extend radially inwardly from the bore such that the guide pin 2316 protrudes into the actuation lumen 2308 .
- the actuation control mechanism 2304 can comprise a first knob 2318 , attachment pins 2320 , a drive screw 2322 , a collet 2324 , and a second knob 2326 .
- the first knob 2318 can have a distal end portion 2328 and a proximal end portion 2330 .
- the first knob 2318 can be configured such that the inside diameter of the distal end portion 2328 is relatively larger than the inside diameter of the proximal end portion 2330 .
- the distal end portion 2328 can comprise openings 2332 that extend radially inwardly from an outside diameter to the inside diameter of the distal end portion 2328 .
- the inside diameter of the distal end portion 2328 can be configured such that the distal end portion 2328 of the first knob 2318 can extend over the flange portion 2312 of the main body 2306 .
- the openings 2332 ( FIG. 162 ) can be configured to axially align with the grooves 2314 when the first knob 2318 is disposed over the flange 2312 .
- the attachment pins 2320 can be configured so as to extend through the openings 2332 of the first knob 2318 and into grooves 2314 of the flange 2312 . In this manner, the attachment pins 2320 allow relative rotational movement and prevent relative axial movement between the first knob 2318 and the flange 2312 .
- the inside diameter of the proximal end portion 2330 of the first knob 2318 can have internal threads (not shown) configured to engage corresponding external threads 2334 of the drive screw 2322 .
- the drive screw 2322 can have a slot 2336 that extends axially across the external threads 2334 .
- the slot 2336 can be configured to receive the guide pin 2316 of the flange portion 2312 .
- rotating the first knob 2318 in a first direction moves the drive screw distally relative to the housing 2306
- rotating the first knob 2318 in a second direction moves the drive screw proximally relative to the housing 2306 .
- the drive screw 2322 can also have a lumen 2338 , as shown in FIG. 162 .
- the lumen 2338 can be configured such that the actuation tube 2268 can extend through the drive screw 2322 .
- the lumen 2338 can be configured such that a distal end portion 2340 of the collet 2324 can also be inserted into a proximal end portion of the lumen 2338 .
- the second knob 2326 can comprise a first, distal portion 2342 and a second, proximal portion 2344 .
- the first portion 2342 can include internal threads (not shown) corresponding to the external threads 2334 of the drive screw 2322 .
- the second portion 2344 can comprise a conical inside surface configured to engage a proximal end portion 2346 of the collet 2324 .
- the actuation tube 2268 can extend through the lumen 2338 of the drive screw 2322 , through the collet 2324 , and through the second knob 2326 .
- the second knob 2326 can be disposed over the collet 2324 and the internal threads of the first portion 2342 of the second knob can threadedly engage the external threads 2334 of the drive screw 2322 . Accordingly, rotating the second knob 2326 in a first direction (e.g., clockwise) relative to the drive screw 2322 causes the second portion 2344 of the second knob 2326 to move toward the proximal end portion 2346 of the collet 2324 and thus urges the collet 2324 radially inwardly against the actuation tube 2268 .
- a first direction e.g., clockwise
- the actuation tube 2268 and the drive screw 2322 move axially together when the first knob 2318 is rotated relative to the housing 2306 .
- Rotating the second knob 2326 in a second direction (e.g., counterclockwise) relative to the drive screw 2322 causes the second portion 2344 of the second knob 2326 to move away from the proximal end portion 2346 of the collet 2324 and thus allows the collet 2324 to move radially outwardly relative to the actuation tube 2268 .
- the actuation tube 2268 and the drive screw 2322 can move relative to each other.
- the physician can use the actuation control mechanism 2304 of the handle 2300 to manipulate the paddles 520 , 522 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 relative to the spacer member 202 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 .
- the actuation control mechanism 2304 can be activated by rotating the second knob 2326 in the first direction relative to the drive screw 2322 to secure the actuation tube 2268 and thus the actuation element or means of actuating 512 to the drive screw 2322 .
- the physician can then rotate the first knob 2318 relative to the housing 2302 , which causes the drive screw 2322 and thus the actuation tube 2268 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 to move axially relative to the housing 2302 and thus the outer shaft 2220 .
- This causes the paddles 520 , 522 (which are coupled to the actuation element or means of actuating 512 via the cap 514 ) to move relative to the coaption element 510 (which is coupled to the outer shaft 2220 via coupler or means for coupling 2214 and the proximal collar 511 ).
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can be released from the delivery apparatus 2202 by rotating the second knob 2326 in the second direction relative to the drive screw 2322 . This allows the actuation tube 2268 and thus the actuation element or means of actuating 512 to move relative to the drive screw 2322 . The shafts 512 , 2220 of the delivery apparatus 2202 can then be removed from the respective collars of the prosthetic spacer device 500 , as described above.
- Configuring a delivery apparatus with the actuation control mechanism 2304 can provide several advantages.
- the rotational forces required to actuate the first knob 2318 of the handle 2300 can be less than the axial forces required to actuate the knob 2226 of the handle 2300 .
- the actuation control mechanism 2304 can also provide relatively more precise control of the paddles 520 , 522 because the axial movement of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 is controlled by rotation of the first knob 2318 and the thread pitch of the drive screw 2322 rather than be axial movement of the knob 2226 .
- the actuation control mechanism 2304 can be configured, for example, such that one rotation of the first knob 2318 moves the actuation element or means of actuating 512 a small axial distance (e.g., 1 mm): whereas, it can be relatively more difficult to axially move the knob 2226 and thus the shaft 512 in small increments (e.g., 1 mm).
- the actuation control mechanism 2304 can prevent or reduce inadvertent movement and release of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 .
- the actuation control mechanism 2304 requires rotational movement of the first knob 2318 to move the actuation element or means of actuating 512 , it can prevent or reduce the likelihood that the actuation element or means of actuating 512 will move if the knob 2226 is inadvertently contacted.
- the physician has to rotate the second knob 2326 to release the actuation tube 2268 from the drive screw 2322 before the physician can rotate the knob 2226 to release the actuation element or means of actuating 512 from the cap 514 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 and proximally retract the actuation element or means of actuating 512 .
- This two-step release process could reduce the likelihood of a physician inadvertently releasing the prosthetic spacer device 500 from the delivery apparatus 2202 .
- FIGS. 163-164 show example embodiments of a coupler 2400 and a proximal collar 2402 .
- the coupler 2400 can be coupled to the distal end portion of the outer shaft 2220 ( FIG. 149 ) in a manner similar to the coupler or means for coupling 2214 .
- the proximal collar 2402 can be coupled to a proximal end portion of the coaption element 510 in a manner similar to the proximal collar 511 ( FIG. 146 ).
- the coupler 2400 and the proximal collar 2402 can be used, for example, in lieu of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 and the proximal collar 514 of the delivery assembly 2200 , respectively, to releasably couple the prosthetic spacer device 500 to the outer shaft 2220 ( FIG. 149 ).
- the coupler 2400 can comprise an axially-extending lumen 2404 and a plurality of radially-extending openings 2406 .
- the lumen 2404 can be configured to receive the actuation element or means of actuating 512 ( FIG. 163 ).
- the openings 2406 can be configured to receive the proximal collar 2402 , as further described below.
- the proximal collar 2402 can comprise a plurality of proximally-extending tabs or fingers 2408 .
- Free end portions 2410 of the fingers 2408 can have radially-extending projections 2412 formed thereon.
- the fingers 2408 can be configured to move or pivot between a first or resting state ( FIG. 164 ) and a second or deflected state ( FIG. 163 ). In the first state, the free end portions 2410 of the fingers 2408 press radially inwardly against each other. In the second state, the free end portions 2410 of the fingers 2408 are radially spaced from each other.
- the coupler 2400 and the proximal collar 2402 be releasably coupled together by positioning the fingers 2408 of the proximal collar 2402 within the coupler 2400 .
- the actuation element or means of actuating 512 can then be advanced through the lumen 2404 of the coupler 2400 and through the fingers 2408 of the proximal collar 2400 , thus causing the free ends 2410 of the fingers 2408 to move or pivot radially-outwardly from the first state to the second state.
- the projections 2412 of the fingers 2408 and the openings 2406 of the coupler 2400 can be rotationally aligned such that the projections 2412 extend into the openings 2406 , thereby releasably coupling the coupler 2400 to the proximal collar 2402 .
- the coupler 2400 can be released from the proximal collar 2402 by retracting the actuation element or means of actuating 512 from the finger 2408 of the proximal collar 2402 .
- the fingers 2408 of the proximal collar 2402 can be configured to create a hemostatic seal when the fingers 2408 are in the first state. This can, for example, prevent or reduce blood from flowing through the proximal collar 2402 when the prosthetic spacer device 500 is implanted in a patient.
- FIGS. 165-166 show example embodiments of a cap 2500 , an actuation element or means of actuating 2502 (e.g., actuation shaft, etc.), and a release member (e.g., wire) 2504 , which can be used, for example, with the delivery assembly 2200 .
- the cap 2500 can be coupled to the distal portion of the prosthetic spacer device 500 .
- a proximal portion (not shown) of the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can be coupled to the actuation tube 2268 and the knob 2226 . From the proximal end portion, the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can extend distally through the handle 2222 ( FIG.
- a distal end portion of the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can be releasably coupled to the cap 2500 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 .
- the cap 2500 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can be used, for example, in lieu of the cap 514 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 of the delivery assembly 2200 , respectively.
- the cap 2500 can comprise a central bore 2506 and a tongue or tab 2508 formed (e.g., laser cut) in a side surface 2510 of the cap 2500 .
- the tongue 2508 can have an opening 2512 formed (e.g., laser cut) therein.
- the central bore 2506 can be configured to receive a distal end portion of the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 .
- the tongue 2508 can be movable or pivotable relative to the side surface 2508 of the cap 2500 from a first or resting configuration ( FIG. 166 ) to a second or deflected configuration ( FIG. 165 ). In the first configuration, the tongue 2508 can be flush with the side surface 2510 . In the second configuration, the tongue 2508 can extend radially inwardly relative to the side surface 2510 to protrude into the central bore 2506 .
- the tongue 2508 can be used, for example, to releasably couple the cap 2500 to the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 , as shown in FIGS. 165 and 166 .
- the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can be inserted into the central bore 2506 of the cap 2500 .
- the tongue 2508 can then be pushed radially inwardly from the first configuration to the second configuration such that the tongue 2508 presses against the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 .
- the release member 2504 can then be advanced distally such that a distal end portion 2514 of the release member 2504 extends through the opening 2512 of the tongue 2508 .
- the release member 2504 retains the tongue 2508 in the second configuration against the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 , thereby releasably coupling the cap 2500 to the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 .
- the cap 2500 can be released from the actuation element or means of actuating 2500 by retracting the release member 2504 proximally such that the distal end portion 2514 of the release member 2504 withdraws from the opening 2512 of the tongue 2508 . This allows the tongue to move radially outwardly from the second state back to the first state, thereby releasing the cap 2500 from the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 .
- the cap 2500 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can be formed without threads. Removing the threads can make manufacturing the cap 2500 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 easier and/or less expensive. Removing the threads from the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can also reduce the likelihood the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 could catch or snag on another component of the delivery assembly 2200 .
- FIGS. 167-168 show example embodiments of a coupler 2600 , a proximal collar 2602 , a cap 2604 , and an actuation element or means of actuating 2606 (e.g., actuation shaft, etc.), which can be used, for example, with the delivery assembly 2200 .
- the coupler 2600 can be coupled to the distal end portion of the outer shaft 2220 .
- the proximal collar 2602 can be coupled to the proximal portion of the prosthetic spacer device 500 (shown schematically in partial cross-section), and the cap 2604 can be coupled to the distal portion of the prosthetic spacer device 500 .
- a proximal portion (not shown) of the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can be coupled to the actuation tube 2268 and the knob 2226 . From the proximal end portion, the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can extend distally through the handle 2222 ( FIG. 150 ), through the outer shaft 2220 ( FIG. 150 ), and into the prosthetic spacer device 200 ( FIG. 145 ). A distal end portion of the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can be releasably coupled to the cap 2604 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 .
- the coupler 2600 , the proximal collar 2602 , the cap 2604 , and the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can be used, for example, in lieu of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 , the proximal collar 511 , the cap 514 , and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 of the delivery assembly 2200 , respectively.
- the coupler 2600 can comprise a connection portion 2608 , a plurality of pins 2610 (e.g., three in the illustrated embodiment), and one or more securing members 2612 (e.g., three in the illustrated embodiment).
- the pins 2610 and the securing members can be coupled to and extend distally from the connection portion 2600 .
- connection portion 2608 can have an axially-extending lumen 2614 configured to slidably receive the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 .
- connection portion 2608 can also have a recessed outwardly facing surface 2615 configured to be inserted into the distal end portion of the outer shaft 2220 , as shown in FIG. 167 .
- the pins 2610 can be spaced circumferentially relative to each other and relative to the securing members 2612 .
- the securing members 2612 can be spaced circumferentially relative to each other.
- the pins 2610 and the securing members 2612 can be configured in an alternating type pattern (e.g., pin-securing member-pin and so on) on the connection portion 2608 .
- the pins 2610 can be configured to extend into openings 2616 of the proximal collar 2602 .
- the securing members 2612 can be suture loops.
- the securing members 2612 can be configured to extend through the openings 2616 of the proximal collar 2602 and around the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 .
- only one securing member 2612 is shown extending around the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 in FIG. 167 .
- the proximal collar 2602 can comprise a central lumen 2618 disposed radially inward from the openings 2616 .
- the central lumen 2618 can extend axially and can be configured to slidably receive the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 , as shown in FIG. 167 .
- the cap 2604 can be configured in a sleeve-like manner such that the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can slidably extend through the cap 2604 , as shown in FIG. 167 .
- the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can comprise a radially-expandable portion 2620 disposed at or near the distal end portion 2622 of the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 .
- the radially-expandable portion 2620 can be configured to be selectively expandable from a compressed configuration to an expanded configuration.
- the radially-expandable portion 2620 can be configured such that an outside diameter of the radially-expandable portion 2620 is less than the inside diameter of the cap 2604 , the central lumen 2618 of the proximal collar 2602 , and the lumen 2614 of the coupler 2600 when the radially-expandable portion 2620 is in the compressed configuration.
- the radially expandable portion 2620 When the radially expandable portion 2620 is in the expanded configuration, the outside diameter of the radially-expandable portion 2620 is greater than the inside diameter of the cap 2604 . Thus, in the expanded configuration, the radially-expandable portion 2620 can prevent the distal end portion 2622 from moving proximally relative to the cap 2604 .
- the prosthetic spacer device 500 can be releasably coupled to the outer shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 by inserting the pins 2610 and the securing members 2612 through respective openings 2616 in the proximal collar 2602 .
- the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can be advanced distally through the lumen 2614 of the coupler 2600 , through the lumen 2618 and the securing members 2612 of the proximal collar 2602 , and through the cap 2604 such that the radially-expandable portion 2620 is disposed distal relative to the cap 2604 .
- the radially-expandable portion 2620 of the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can then be expanded from the compressed configuration to the expanded configuration, thus releasably coupling the prosthetic spacer device 500 to the outer shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 .
- the prosthetic device 500 can be released from the outer shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 by compressing the radially-expandable portion 2620 of the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 and proximally retracting the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 through the cap 2604 , through the securing members 2612 and the lumen 2618 of the proximal collar 2602 .
- the outer shaft 2220 can then be retracted proximally relative to the prosthetic spacer device 500 such that the pins 2610 and the securing members 2612 withdraw from the openings 2616 in the proximal collar 2602 , thus releasing the prosthetic spacer device 500 from the outer shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 .
- FIGS. 169-170 show an example embodiment of clasp control members 2700 , which can be used, for example, in lieu of the clasp control members 537 of the delivery assembly 2200 .
- the clasp control members 2700 can comprise sleeves 2702 , connecting members 2704 , and release members 2706 .
- the connecting members 2704 and the release members 2706 can extend axially through and can be movable relative to the sleeves 2702 .
- Proximal end portions (not shown) of the sleeves 2702 can be coupled to the control member tubes 2270 , and distal end portions of the sleeves 2708 can be releasable coupled to the clasps 530 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 by the connecting members 2704 and the release members 2706 , as further described below.
- the connecting members 2704 can, for example, be suture loops that extend distally from the clasp control mechanism 2250 of the delivery apparatus 2202 , through the control member tubes 2270 , through the sleeves 2702 , and through the openings 535 of the clasps 530 .
- the connecting members 2704 can be releasably coupled to the clasps 530 the prosthetic spacer device 500 by the release members 2706 .
- the release members 2706 can, for example, be wires that extend distally from the clasp control mechanism 2250 of the delivery apparatus 2202 , through the control member tubes 2270 , through the sleeves 2702 , and through the loops of the connecting members 2704 . In this manner, the release members 2706 releasably couple the connecting members 2704 and thus the sleeves 2702 to the clasps 530 by preventing the connection members 2704 from withdrawing through the openings 535 of the clasps 530 .
- the connection members 2704 can be released from the clasps 530 by withdrawing the release members 2706 from the loops of the connecting members 2704 and withdrawing the connecting members 2704 from the openings 535 of the clasps 530 .
- the clasps 530 can be actuated (either together or separately) by moving the sleeves 2702 axially relative to the outer shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 . This can be accomplished, for example, by moving the actuator member 2290 , which are coupled to the sleeves 2702 via the control tubes 2268 , relative to the housing 2246 and actuation tube 2268 .
- Moving the actuation member 2290 proximally relative to the housing 2246 and actuation tube 2268 can open the clasps 530 and moving the actuation member 2290 distally relative to the housing 2246 and actuation tube 2268 can close the clasps 530 .
- the sleeves 2702 are relatively rigid (e.g., compared to the clasp control members 537 ), the sleeves 2702 can be used to push the clasps 530 closed (either in lieu of or in addition to the bias of the clasps 530 to the closed position). This pushability can help to ensure the native leaflets are grasped within the clasps 530 and thus secured to the paddles 520 , 522 .
- FIG. 171 shows an example embodiment of a guide rail or means for guiding 2800 .
- the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 can, for example, be coupled to the clasps 530 of the prosthetic spacer device 500 .
- the clasp control member 2700 can be releasably coupled to the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 in a snare-like manner similar to that described above with respect to FIG. 170 .
- Coupling a clasp control member 2700 to the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 rather than directly to the clasps 530 allows the clasp control member 2700 to slide longitudinally along the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 as the clasp 530 moves between the open and the closed configurations. This can, for example, allow the clasp control member 2700 to maintain a relatively constant angle relative to the paddles 520 , 522 as the clasps 530 are actuated.
- the clasp control member 2700 can slide outwardly toward a first side portion 2802 of the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 when the clasp 206 is pulled open, and the clasp control member 2700 can slide inwardly toward a second side portion 2804 of the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 when the clasp 530 is pushed closed.
- the sleeves 2702 can remain more substantially straight as the movable portion of the clasp 530 swings through its full arc of motion. This is due to the sliding movement on the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 . By sliding and remaining substantially straight, the amount of bending of the sleeves is limited.
- FIG. 172 shows an example embodiment of a shaft 2900 .
- the shaft 2900 can be used, for example, with the delivery apparatus 500 in lieu of the outer shaft 2220 of the third catheter 508 .
- the shaft 2900 can comprise a plurality of axially extending lumens, including an actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2902 (e.g., an actuation shaft lumen, actuation tube, etc.), and a plurality of control member lumens 2904 (e.g., four in the illustrated embodiment) disposed radially outwardly from the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2902 .
- an actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2902 e.g., an actuation shaft lumen, actuation tube, etc.
- control member lumens 2904 e.g., four in the illustrated embodiment
- control member lumens 2904 can be spaced relative to each other and can be evenly distributed circumferentially around the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2902 .
- each of the control member lumens 2904 can be located approximately 90 degrees from an adjacent control member lumen 2904 .
- the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2902 can be configured to receive the actuation element or means of actuating 512
- the control member lumens 2904 can be configured to receive the clasp control members or actuation lines 537
- the lumens 2902 , 2904 can also be configured such that the actuation element or means of actuating 512 and clasp control members/lines 537 can be movable (e.g., axially and/or rotationally) relative to the lumens 2902 , 2904 , respectively.
- the lumens 2902 , 2904 can comprise a liner or coating (e.g., PTFE, polymer, hydrogel, etc.) configured to reduce friction between the lumens 2902 , 2904 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 and clasp control members/lines 537 , respectively.
- a liner or coating e.g., PTFE, polymer, hydrogel, etc.
- the shaft 2900 can be formed from various materials, including metals and polymers.
- the shaft 2900 can comprise a first portion 2906 , a second portion 2908 , and a third portion 2910 .
- the first portion 2906 be the radially outermost portion
- the third portion 2910 can be the radially innermost portion
- the second portion 2908 can be disposed radially between the first and third portions 2906 , 2910 .
- the first and third portions 2906 , 2910 can be formed from polymeric material (e.g., PEBAX or other material having a Type D Shore durometer value of 55D)
- the second portion 2908 can be formed from a metallic material (e.g., braided stainless steel).
- Configuring the shaft 2900 in this manner can, for example, further improve control of the distal end portion of the shaft 2900 .
- this configuration can prevent or reduce “whipping” (e.g., sudden or abrupt movement) at the distal end portion of the shaft 2900 when the shaft 2900 is rotated at the proximal end portion (e.g., by rotating the housing 2246 of the handle 2222 ).
- a physician can more precisely control the distal end portion of the shaft 2900 and thus more precisely control the prosthetic spacer device (e.g., the spacer device 500 ) during the implantation procedure such as when the physician rotates the prosthetic spacer device to align the anchors of the prosthetic spacer device with the native leaflets.
- the housing 2246 of the handle 2222 can comprise four control member lumens 2264 , 2282 (i.e., four of each) that are coupled to the control member lumens 2904 .
- each portion of the clasp control members or lines 537 can extend distally in a separate lumen from the clasp control mechanism 2250 of the handle 2222 to the prosthetic spacer device 500 .
- the actuation element 512 can be hollow so that a tethering line or suture 3000 can be extended through the actuation element 512 to the device 500 .
- the actuation element 512 extends through the device 500 and is attached to the cap 514 . Retracting the tethering line 3000 in the retraction direction X relative to a coupler of the delivery assembly 2200 reduces the length of the tethering line 3000 , thereby moving the coupler of the delivery assembly 2200 toward the device 500 in a recapture direction Y.
- the device 500 is shown in a closed position as if after delivery and implantation in a native valve.
- the coupler of the delivery assembly 2200 is opened and moved away from the device in a retraction direction X so that the performance of the device 500 can be monitored to see if any adjustments may be desirable. If further adjustments to the device 500 are desired, the tethering line 3000 is retracted in the retraction direction X so that the coupler of the delivery assembly 2200 moves in the recapture direction Y toward the device 500 .
- the coupler of the delivery assembly 2200 has been moved into a suitable position to recapture the device 500 .
- the actuation lines 3002 for each moveable arm 2228 are retracted in an actuation direction A to cause the moveable arms 2228 to move in a closing direction B close around the proximal collar 511 of the device 500 .
- the tethering line 3000 is adjusted simultaneously with the actuation lines 3002 to aid in recapturing the device 500 which may be moving around as the native valve opens and closes.
- the moveable arms 2228 are closed around the proximal collar 511 .
- the actuation element 512 is then moved in a distal direction C, through the securing portions 2234 of the moveable arms 2228 and into the device 500 along the tethering line 3000 .
- a threaded end 512 B of the actuation element 512 is threaded into a threaded receptacle 516 A of the cap 514 as shown in FIG. 176 .
- FIGS. 174A and 175A illustrate an example of a mechanism that can be used to recouple the coupler of the delivery assembly 2200 to the collar 511 of the device 500 .
- the actuation element 512 can be hollow so that a tethering line or suture 3000 can be extended through the actuation element 512 to the device 500 .
- retracting the tethering line 3000 in the retraction direction X moves the coupler of the delivery assembly 2200 toward the device 500 in a recapture direction Y.
- the coupler of the delivery assembly 2200 has been moved into a suitable position to recapture the device 500 .
- a closing sleeve 3003 that fits around the moveable arms 2228 is advanced over the coupler of the delivery assembly 2200 in a closing direction C to press the moveable arms 2228 inward in a closing direction D around the proximal collar 511 of the device 500 .
- the tethering line 3000 is adjusted simultaneously with the closing sleeve 3003 to aid in recapturing the device 500 which may be moving around as the native valve opens and closes.
- the moveable arms 2228 are closed around the proximal collar 511 .
- the actuation element 512 is then moved in a distal direction E and into the device 500 along the tethering line 3000 .
- a threaded end 512 B of the actuation element 512 is threaded into a threaded receptacle 516 A of the cap 514 as shown in FIG. 176 .
- the device 3100 includes an implantable prosthetic device 3110 and a coupler 3120 .
- An actuation element or means of actuating or wire 3130 can extend through the coupler 3120 to the device 3110 to open and close the device 3110 .
- the device 3110 is similar to example implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application and includes a proximal collar 3112 having an opening 3114 and radially disposed apertures 3116 .
- the coupler 3120 has moveable arms or fingers 3122 that can be moved between open and closed positions.
- the moveable arms 3122 include protrusions 3124 configured to engage the apertures 3116 of the proximal collar 3112 of the device 3110 .
- the moveable arms 3122 are biased inward so that moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3130 in a distal direction Y through the coupler 3120 and between the moveable arms 3122 spreads the moveable arms 3122 outwards so that the protrusions 3124 engage the apertures 3116 .
- the protrusions 3124 and apertures 3116 are tapered to ease engagement of the protrusions 3124 with the apertures 3116 .
- Moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3130 in a retraction direction X allows the moveable arms 3122 to move inward so that the protrusions 3124 disengage the apertures 3116 . In this way the device 3110 can be released and recaptured by the coupler 3120 .
- the device 3200 includes an implantable prosthetic device 3210 and a coupler 3220 .
- An actuation element or means of actuating or wire 3230 can extend through the coupler 3220 to the device 3210 to open and close the device 3210 .
- the device 3210 is similar to example implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application and includes a proximal collar 3212 having an opening 3214 and radially disposed apertures 3216 .
- the coupler 3220 has moveable arms or fingers 3222 that can be moved between open and closed positions.
- the moveable arms 3222 include protrusions 3224 configured to engage the apertures 3216 of the proximal collar 3212 of the device 3210 .
- the moveable arms 3222 are biased inward so that moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3230 in a distal direction Y through the coupler 3220 and between the moveable arms 3222 spreads the moveable arms 3222 outwards so that the protrusions 3224 engage the apertures 3216 .
- Moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3230 in a retraction direction X allows the moveable arms 3222 to move inward so that the protrusions 3224 disengage the apertures 3216 . In this way the device 3210 can be released and recaptured by the coupler 3220 .
- the actuation element 3230 (e.g., actuation wire, shaft, tube, etc.) can be hollow so that a tethering line or suture 3232 can be extended through the actuation element 3230 to the device 3210 .
- the actuation element 3230 extends through the opening 3214 of the device 3210 and is attached to securing portions 3218 . Retracting the tethering line 3232 in the retraction direction X ( FIG. 180 ) reduces the length of the tethering line 3232 , thereby moving the coupler 3220 toward the device 3210 such that the moveable arms 3222 are inserted into the opening 3214 of the device 3210 as shown in FIG. 180 .
- the actuation element 3230 is moved in the distal direction Y to recouple the coupler 3220 to the device 3210 .
- the actuation element 3230 engages the moveable arms 3222 , thereby causing the protrusions 3224 to move in an outward direction A to engage the apertures 3216 of the device 3210 .
- the protrusions 3224 and apertures 3216 are tapered to ease engagement of the protrusions 3224 with the apertures 3216 .
- the tethering line 3232 is adjusted simultaneously as the actuation element or means of actuating 3230 is extended to take up slack in the actuation line and maintain engagement between the coupler 3220 and device 3210 .
- the device 3300 includes an implantable prosthetic device 3310 and a coupler 3320 .
- An actuation element or means of actuating or wire 3330 can extend through the coupler 3320 to the device 3310 to open and close the device 3310 .
- the device 3310 is similar to example implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application and includes a proximal collar 3312 having an opening 3314 and radially disposed apertures 3316 .
- the coupler 3320 has moveable arms or fingers 3322 that can be moved between open and closed positions.
- the moveable arms 3322 include distal protrusions 3324 configured to engage the apertures 3316 of the proximal collar 3312 of the device 3310 .
- the moveable arms 3324 also include internal protrusions 3326 having apertures 3328 configured to receive the actuation element or means of actuating 3330 .
- the internal apertures 3328 are offset from the actuation element or means of actuating 3330 .
- the actuation element or means of actuating 3330 has a tapered end 3332 to engage the offset apertures 3328 . As successive apertures 3328 are engaged by the tapered end 3332 of the actuation element or means of actuating 3330 , the moveable arms 3322 are moved outward to engage the opening 3314 .
- the moveable arms 3322 are biased inward so that moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3330 in a distal direction Y through the coupler 3320 and between the moveable arms 3322 spreads the moveable arms 3322 outwards so that the protrusions 3324 engage the apertures 3316 .
- Moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3330 in a retraction direction X allows the moveable arms 3322 to move inward so that the protrusions 3324 disengage the apertures 3316 . In this way the device 3310 can be released and recaptured by the coupler 3320 .
- the prosthetic device 3300 is similar to the device 3200 and includes a tethering line (not shown) that allows the device 3300 to be recaptured.
- the device 3400 includes an implantable prosthetic device 3410 and a coupler 3420 .
- An actuation element or means of actuating or wire 3430 can extend through the coupler 3420 to the device 3410 to open and close the device 3410 .
- the device 3410 is similar to example implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application and includes a proximal collar 3412 having an opening 3414 and radially disposed apertures 3416 .
- the coupler 3420 has moveable arms or fingers 3422 that can be moved between open and closed positions.
- the moveable arms 3422 include distal protrusions 3424 configured to engage the apertures 3416 of the proximal collar 3412 of the device 3410 .
- the moveable arms 3424 also include internal protrusions 3426 having apertures 3428 configured to receive the actuation element or means of actuating 3430 .
- the internal apertures 3428 are offset from the actuation element or means of actuating 3430 .
- the actuation element or means of actuating 3430 has a tapered end 3432 to engage the offset apertures 3428 . As successive apertures 3428 are engaged by the tapered end 3432 of the actuation element or means of actuating 3430 , the moveable arms 3422 are moved inward to engage the opening 3414 .
- the moveable arms 3422 are biased outward so that moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3430 in a distal direction Y through the coupler 3420 and between the moveable arms 3422 retracts the moveable arms 3422 inwards so that the protrusions 3424 engage the apertures 3416 .
- Moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3430 in a retraction direction X allows the moveable arms 4622 to spread outward so that the protrusions 3424 disengage the apertures 3416 . In this way the device 3410 can be released and recaptured by the coupler 3420 .
- the prosthetic device 3400 is similar to the device 3200 and includes a tethering line (not shown) that allows the device 3400 to be recaptured.
- the actuation element or means of actuating 3500 for placing and actuating an implantable prosthetic device is shown.
- the actuation element or means of actuating 3500 includes a hollow positioning shaft 3510 and a hollow device shaft 3520 that fit over a retaining shaft 3530 that holds the hollow positioning and device shafts 3510 , 3520 together at a connection 3502 .
- the hollow positioning shaft 3510 extends from a delivery device 3504 and when coupled to the device shaft 3520 allows an implantable device 3506 to be placed in a suitable location for implantation.
- the location of the connection 3502 between the hollow positioning shaft 3510 and the device shaft 3520 can be at a wide variety of different positions in an implantable device.
- the connection 3502 can be at a proximal portion of a device or can be at a distal portion of a device.
- the hollow positioning shaft 3510 can include a protruding portion 3512 and a recessed receiving portion 3514 .
- the device shaft 3520 can also include a protruding portion 3522 and a recessed receiving portion 3524 .
- the protruding portion 3512 of the hollow positioning shaft 3510 is received by the receiving portion 3524 of the device shaft 3520
- the protruding portion 3522 of the device shaft 3520 is received by the receiving portion 3514 of the hollow positioning shaft 3510 .
- the hollow positioning and device shafts 3510 , 3520 can be connected in a wide variety of different ways.
- the hollow positioning shaft 3510 can include a bore or channel 3516 that is aligned with a bore or channel 3526 of the hollow device shaft 3520 when the protruding portions 3512 , 3522 are disposed in the receiving portions 3514 , 3524 , respectively.
- the openings 3516 , 3526 are aligned and the retaining shaft 3530 is placed into the openings 3516 , 3526 in the direction X, the hollow positioning and device shafts 3510 , 3520 are retained together.
- protruding portions 3512 , 3522 can be removed from the receiving portions 3514 , 3524 , such that the device 3506 is detached from the hollow positioning shaft 3510 .
- an aperture 3540 is created at interface 3542 between the hollow positioning and device shafts 3510 , 3520 .
- the aperture 3540 is configured to secure a control line 3544 between the hollow positioning and device shafts 3510 , 3520 to allow for separate control of clasps or gripping members (not shown). That is, the aperture 3540 is configured such that the line 3544 does not move relative to the aperture 3540 when the hollow positioning and device shafts 3510 , 3520 are joined together.
- the line 3544 Upon detachment of the hollow positioning and device shafts 3510 , 3520 , the line 3544 is released from the aperture 3540 and can be removed from the implantable device 3506 . The line 3544 can then be retracted into the catheter to release the clasps gripping members.
- the control mechanism 3600 can be used to open and close first and second clasps or gripping members 3610 , 3620 to grasp native leaflets for implantation of an implantable prosthetic device.
- the control mechanism 3600 includes a first gripper control member 3612 and a second gripper control member 3622 .
- the first gripper control member 3612 is configured to move the first gripping member 3610 bi-directionally in the direction X
- the second gripper control member 3622 is configured to move the first gripping member 3620 bi-directionally in the direction Z.
- Movement of the first gripping member 3610 in the direction X adjusts the width W of a first opening 3616 between the first gripping member 3610 and a first paddle 3614
- movement of the second gripping member 3620 in the direction Z will adjust the width H of a second opening 3626 between the second gripping member 3620 and a second paddle 3624 .
- the gripper control members 3610 , 3620 include actuation lines configured as push/pull links 3611 , 3621 , such as, for example, a catheter, a flexible rod, a stiff wire, etc. and a coupler 3613 , 3623 .
- Each push/pull link 3611 , 3621 extends from a delivery device 3602 and is removably attached to the corresponding gripping member 3612 , 3622 by the couplers 3613 , 3623 .
- the link 3611 is configured to be pushed and pulled in the direction Y. Movement of the link 3611 in the direction Y causes the gripping member 3610 to move in the direction X.
- the link 3621 is configured to be pushed and pulled in the direction M, and movement of the link 3621 in the direction M causes the gripping member 3620 to move in the direction H.
- the actuation mechanism 3700 allows for pushing and pulling of portions of an implantable device, such as the clasps or gripping members described above.
- the mechanism 3700 includes first and second control members 3710 , 3720 that extend from a delivery device 3702 .
- the delivery device 3702 can be any suitable device, such as a sheath or catheter.
- the first and second control members 3710 , 3720 include first and second sutures 3712 , 3722 and first and second flexible wires 3714 , 3724 .
- the first and second flexible wires 3714 , 3724 extend from the delivery device 3702 and each include a loop 3716 , 3726 for receiving the first and second sutures 3712 , 3722 and for engaging a clasp or gripping member.
- Each of the first and second sutures 3712 , 3722 extends from the delivery device 3702 , through a one of the first and second loops 3716 , 3726 , respectively, and back into the delivery device 3702 .
- each suture 3712 , 3722 extends through one of the loops 3716 , 3726 once.
- each suture 3712 , 3722 extends through one of the loops 3716 , 3726 twice.
- the first and second control members 3712 , 3722 extend through separate delivery devices 3702 .
- the sutures 3712 , 3722 are removably attached to moveable arms of example barbed clasps described above.
- the first and second loops 3716 , 3726 of the respective wires 3714 , 3724 are able to move along the corresponding sutures 3712 , 3722 such that the loops 3716 , 3726 can engage the corresponding barbed clasps to engage the moveable arms. That is, the sutures 3712 , 3722 are used to pull the moveable arms in an opening direction and the wires 3714 , 3724 are used to push the moveable arms in a closing direction.
- the wires 3714 , 3724 can be made of, for example, steel alloy, nickel-titanium alloy, or any other metal or plastic material. In certain embodiments, the wires 3714 , 3724 can have a diameter between about 0.10 mm and about 0.35 mm, between about 0.15 mm and about 0.30 mm, and between about 0.20 mm and about 0.25 mm. While the wires 3714 , 3724 are shown as coming out of separate lumens than the sutures 3712 , 3722 , in one embodiment, the wires 3714 , 3724 can share a lumen with a suture.
- the wires 3714 , 3724 can be replaced with a rigid or semi-rigid tube or pushable coil.
- the tube or pushable coil can share a lumen with a suture loop, the suture loop can be disposed inside the tube or pushable coil.
- the tube or pushable coil can be advanced over one side or both sides of each suture loop to push.
- the tube, pushable coil, or wire can be retracted as necessary into the catheter when not needed.
- an example embodiment of an actuation or control mechanism 3800 includes a first catheter 3811 , a second catheter 3821 , and single line 3830 , such as a wire or suture.
- the first catheter 3811 and line 3830 are configured to move a first gripping member 3810 in the direction X, and the second catheter 3821 and line 3830 configured to move a second gripping member 3820 in the direction Z.
- Movement of the gripping member 3810 in the direction X will adjust the width W of a first opening 3816 between the first gripping member 3810 and a first paddle 3814
- movement of the second gripping member 3820 in the direction Z will adjust the width H of a second opening 3826 between the second gripping member 3820 and a second paddle 3824 .
- the line 3830 extends from a delivery device 3802 through the catheters 3811 , 3821 and is threaded through openings in both gripping member 3810 , 3820 .
- Each catheter 3811 , 3821 is configured to engage and move the corresponding gripping member 3810 , 3820 .
- the first catheter 3811 is configured to be pushed in the direction Y while the line 3830 is payed out of the second catheter 3821 or tension in the line 3830 is reduced.
- the first catheter 3811 is configured to be pulled in the direction Y while the line 3830 is pulled into the first catheter 3811 or tension in the line is increased. Movement of the first catheter 3811 in the direction Y causes the first catheter 3811 to move the first gripping member 3810 in the direction X.
- the second catheter 3821 is configured to be pushed in the direction M while the line 3830 is payed out of the first catheter 3811 or tension in the line 3830 is reduced.
- the second catheter 3821 is configured to be pulled in the direction M while the line 3830 is pulled into the second catheter 3821 or tension in the line 3830 is increased. Movement of the second catheter 3821 in the direction M causes the second catheter 3821 to move the second gripping member 3820 in the direction H.
- the control mechanism 3800 described above with reference to FIG. 189 can include a first flexible wire with a loop (e.g., the flexible wire 3714 with the loop 3716 shown in FIG. 188 ) and a second flexible wire with a loop (e.g., the flexible wire 3724 with the loop 3726 shown in FIG. 188 ), and the single line 3830 extends through the loop 3716 , 3726 of each of the wires 3830 .
- an example embodiment of an actuation or control mechanism 3900 includes a single line 3930 , such as a suture or wire, that is removably attached to first and second clasps or gripping members 3910 , 3920 and removably fixed between a shaft or positioning shaft 3904 and a shaft or device shaft 3906 of an implantable device. While described as two shafts 3904 , 3906 , these could be configured as a single shaft passing through a loop of line 3930 , e.g., and can be retractable from the loop to release the line.
- the shafts 3904 , 3906 are similar to the hollow positioning and device shafts 3510 , 3520 , described in more detail above.
- the single line 3930 is connected at a connection 3908 between the shafts 3904 , 3906 , such that the single line 3930 can separately control the gripping members 3910 , 3920 . That is, movement of a first portion 3932 of the line 3930 in a direction Y will adjust a width W between the first gripping member 3910 and a first paddle 3914 but will not adjust a width H between the second gripping member 3920 and a second paddle 3924 . Similarly, movement of a second portion 3934 of the line 3930 in a direction M will adjust a width H between the second gripping member 3920 and a second paddle 3924 but will not adjust the width W between the first gripping member 3910 and the first paddle 3914 .
- the positioning shaft 3904 is detached from the device shaft 3906 .
- Decoupling the shafts 3904 , 3906 releases the line 3930 from the connection 3908 .
- the line 3930 can then be retracted into the catheter 3902 to release the gripping members 3910 , 3920 by pulling one end of the line 3930 into the catheter 3902 . Pulling one end of the line 3930 into the catheter 3902 pulls the other end of the line 3930 through the gripping members 3910 , 3920 and then into the catheter 3902 . Any of the lines described herein can be retracted in this manner.
- line 3930 is two separate lines each connecting in a similar way to a respective clasp or gripping member 3910 , 3920 , and with each of the separate lines attaching to the shafts 3904 , 3906 or to a combined single shaft (e.g., that passes through loops at the ends of the two lines and can be retracted to release the two lines).
- an example implantable prosthetic device 4100 such as the devices described in the present application, is shown anchored to native leaflets 20 , 22 .
- the device 4100 includes a coaption or spacer element 4102 and anchors 4104 .
- the anchors 4104 attach the device 4100 to the leaflets 20 , 22 .
- first and second gaps 26 A, 26 B remain between the closed leaflets 20 , 22 after the device 4100 is deployed.
- the coaption element 4102 includes first and second auxiliary, inflatable coaption or spacer elements 4106 , 4108 that are shown in a deflated condition in FIGS. 208A and 208B .
- the device 4100 is shown with the auxiliary coaption elements 4106 , 4108 in an inflated condition.
- the first and second auxiliary coaption elements 4106 , 4108 can be inflated to fill the first and second gaps 26 A, 26 B. Filling the gaps 26 A, 26 B allows the leaflets 20 , 22 to more fully seal around the device 4100 .
- the auxiliary coaption elements 4106 , 4108 are independently inflatable so that the first auxiliary coaption element 4106 can be inflated to a different size than the second auxiliary coaption element 4108 to fill different size gaps 26 A, 26 B.
- FIGS. 210A and 210B an example expandable coaption or spacer element 4200 for use with a prosthetic implantable device of the present disclosure is shown.
- the expandable coaption element 4200 is shown in a compressed condition.
- the expandable coaption element 4200 is formed from a coiled wire 4202 that is retained in the compressed condition by a retaining element 4204 .
- an actuation line or actuation suture 4206 is used to pull the retaining element 4204 in an actuation direction 4208 .
- the coaption element 4200 can be used as the auxiliary coaption element 4016 , 4018 in the embodiment of FIGS. 208A, 208B, 208C, and 208D .
- an example implantable prosthetic device 4300 such as the devices described in the present application, is shown.
- the device 4300 extends from a proximal end 4301 to a distal end 4303 .
- the device 4300 includes a coaption or spacer element 4302 that has first and second auxiliary, inflatable coaption or spacer elements 4306 , 4308 that are shown in a deflated condition in FIG. 211A .
- Each auxiliary coaption element 4306 , 4308 extends from a proximal end 4306 A, 4308 A to a distal end 4306 B, 4308 B.
- the device 4300 is shown with the auxiliary coaption elements 4306 , 4308 in an inflated condition.
- the proximal ends 4306 A, 4308 A and distal end 4306 B, 4308 B have different sizes such that the auxiliary coaption elements 4306 , 4308 increase in size from the proximal 4306 A, 4308 A to distal ends 4306 B, 4308 B.
- the proximal ends are larger than the distal ends.
- auxiliary coaption elements 4306 , 4308 improves coaption between leaflets (not shown) and the device 4300 where the gaps between leaflets change in size from the proximal to distal ends 4301 , 4303 of the device 4300 .
- the device 4400 includes a coaption or spacer element 4402 , anchors 4404 , and an attachment portion 4406 .
- the attachment portion 4406 is a threaded rod that extends from the coaption element 4402 to receive an auxiliary coaption or spacer element 4410 .
- the auxiliary coaption element 4410 has an inverted L-shape with an attachment opening 4412 and a spacer body 4414 .
- the attachment opening 4412 receives the attachment portion 4406 to attach the auxiliary coaption element 4410 to the device 4400 .
- the spacer body 4414 extends along one side of the coaption element 4402 to fill a gap (e.g., gaps 26 A, 26 B shown in FIG. 208B ) between the leaflets.
- the auxiliary coaption element 4410 can have any suitable shape and can vary in width and size like the inflatable spacers 4106 , 4108 , 4306 , and 4308 described above.
- the auxiliary coaption element 4410 is shown being assembled to the device 4400 .
- the auxiliary coaption element 4410 can be attached to the attachment portion 4406 of the device 4400 after the device 4400 has been implanted between the native leaflets (not shown) and anchored in place via the anchors 4404 .
- the auxiliary coaption element 4410 is secured to the attachment portion 4406 with a nut 4408 after being attached to the device 4400 .
- the attachment opening 4412 in the auxiliary coaption element 4410 is a slot to allow for lateral adjustment of the position of the auxiliary coaption element 4410 without fully removing the auxiliary coaption element 4410 from the device 4400 . That is, the nut 4408 can be loosened to allow the position of the auxiliary coaption element 4410 to be adjusted after assembly to the device 4400 .
- FIGS. 216A, 216B, 217A, 217B the device 4400 and auxiliary coaption element or spacer 4410 are shown with different means of attaching the auxiliary coaption element 4410 to the device 4400 than the threaded rod and nut 4408 described above.
- the device 4400 shown in FIGS. 216A and 216B includes a circular magnet 4407 surrounding the attachment portion 4406 .
- the auxiliary coaption element 4410 shown in FIGS. 217A and 217B includes a similarly shaped magnet 4413 surrounding the attachment opening 4412 (which is shown as a hole, rather than a slot).
- auxiliary coaption element 4410 When the auxiliary coaption element 4410 is assembled to the device 4400 opposite poles two magnets 4407 , 4413 face each other and are attracted to each other and retain the auxiliary coaption element 4410 on the device 4400 by way of magnetic attractive forces.
- a plurality of magnets are provided on the device 4400 and/or the auxiliary coaption element 4410 .
- auxiliary coaption element 4420 for attachment to the device 4400 is shown.
- the auxiliary coaption element 4420 has an inverted U-shape with an attachment opening 4422 disposed between two coaption portions 4424 .
- the attachment opening 4422 receives the attachment portion 4406 to attach the auxiliary coaption element 4420 to the device 4400 .
- the coaption portions 4424 extend along both sides of the coaption element 4402 to fill gaps (e.g., gaps 26 A, 26 B shown in FIG. 208B ) between the leaflets.
- the auxiliary coaption element 4420 can have any suitable shape and can vary in width and size like the inflatable spacers 4106 , 4108 , 4306 , and 4308 described above.
- the device 4500 includes a coaption or spacer element 4502 and attachment portions 4504 arranged on opposite sides of the coaption element 4502 .
- the attachment portions 4504 are configured to receive auxiliary coaption or spacer elements of varying shapes and sizes ( FIGS. 220A-220E ).
- the attachment portions 4504 are shown as hoops that receive posts or pins 4512 of the auxiliary coaption elements ( FIGS. 220A-220E ).
- the auxiliary coaption elements 4510 A, 4510 B, 4520 A, 4520 B, 4530 A, 4530 B, 4540 A, 4540 B, 4550 A, 4550 B shown in FIGS. 220A-220E extend along one or both sides of the coaption element 4502 to fill a gap (e.g., gaps 26 A, 26 B shown in FIG. 208B ) between the leaflets.
- auxiliary coaption elements 4510 A, 4510 B, 4520 A, 4520 B, 4530 A, 4530 B, 4540 A, 4540 B, 4550 A, 4550 B are provided with semi-circle, rounded triangular, or other suitable shapes in a range of sizes.
- Different size and shape auxiliary coaption elements 4510 A, 4510 B, 4520 A, 4520 B, 4530 A, 4530 B, 4540 A, 4540 B, 4550 A, 4550 B can be attached to the coaption element 4502 to accommodate gaps that are different shapes and sizes on opposite sides of the coaption element 4502 .
- an example implantable prosthetic device 4600 is shown.
- the device 4600 is shown cut from a flat sheet of material 4602 , such as Nitinol, into a lattice-like shape formed from a plurality of struts.
- the coaption portion 4604 of the device 4600 includes auxiliary coaption portions 4606 that expand outwards from the coaption element 4602 when the device 4600 is formed into a three-dimensional shape.
- the auxiliary coaption portions 4606 can be longer struts that are curved before the prosthetic device is expanded. Referring now to FIG.
- the coaption portion 4604 of the device is covered with a cover (not shown) can be a cloth material such as polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh. The cloth cover can provide a blood seal on the surface of the spacer, and/or promote rapid tissue ingrowth.
- an example implantable prosthetic device 4700 is shown.
- the device 4700 is shown cut from a flat sheet of material 4702 , such as Nitinol.
- the device 4700 includes coaption portions 4704 , inner paddle portions 4706 , outer paddle portions 4708 , and a middle portion 4710 .
- the device 4700 is shown folded into a three-dimensional shape.
- the material 4702 is folded at the middle portion 4710 so that the various portions of each side of the material 4702 align.
- a matrix of cut-outs in the material 4702 form the coaption portion 4704 into a three-dimensional shape similar to the shape of the coaption elements described above.
- FIGS. 232A-232B An example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device 23200 is illustrated in FIGS. 232A-232B .
- the device 23200 can be the same as, substantially the same as, or similar to the device 500 A, except the paddles 23202 of the device 23200 are configured to form an area 23304 (See FIG. 233A ) where the paddles are parallel or substantially parallel to enhance leaflet engagement.
- the implantable device 23200 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the device 23200 can be positioned to engage valve tissue 20 , 22 as part of any suitable valve repair system (e.g., any valve repair system disclosed in the present application).
- the prosthetic device 23200 comprises paddle frames 23202 , a coaption element 23204 , outer paddle portions 23206 , and inner paddle portions 23208 .
- the paddle frames 23202 , the paddle portions ( 23206 & 23208 ), and the coaption element 23204 work together to capture and secure the leaflets of a native valve.
- a clasp 23210 is connected to each inner paddle portion 23208 and serves to secure the leaflets during the installation of the prosthetic device 23200 .
- FIG. 232A and 232B the cross-section view of FIG.
- FIG. 232B the outer paddle 23206 and inner paddle 23208 portions of the coaption element 23204 are illustrated. Also visible are the clasp 23210 portions.
- the cross-section view of FIG. 232B shows a flexible portion 23212 extending between fixed and movable portions of the clasp 23210 .
- a portion 23302 of the paddle frames 23202 is configured to be parallel or substantially parallel between each paddle frame 23202 when in use.
- the area 23304 is rectangular or substantially rectangular.
- the area 23304 can have other shapes.
- the area 23304 can be somewhat tapered in other embodiments to correspond to a tapered shape of native valve leaflets.
- FIGS. 234A-234B illustrate an implantable prosthetic device 23200 which has captured native valve leaflets, such as native valve leaflets 20 and 22 or tricuspid leaflets.
- Device 23200 can also be covered similar to other devices herein.
- the leaflets 20 and 22 are captured between paddle frames 23202 in an area in which the paddle frames are parallel or substantially parallel to each other, as opposed to an area where the paddle frames curve away from each other.
- this parallel configuration provides an area extending from dashed line 23408 to dashed line 23410 where the leaflets are pressed together at the sides of the coaption element, rather than at a single point.
- the distance where the leaflets are pressed together can be from 1-10 mm, such as from 2-5 mm, such as from 3-4 mm.
- the cross-section view of FIG. 234B illustrates that the leaflets 20 and 22 are pressed together by the paddle frames 23202 and no blood will flow through the native valve in this area during diastole or systole.
- FIGS. 235A-235B An advantage of the embodiment illustrated by FIGS. 234A-234B is illustrated in FIGS. 235A-235B .
- the first leaflet extends farther into the prosthetic device 23200 than the second leaflet 22 .
- first and second are to simplify the explanation of the figure.
- a first leaflet 20 can be any leaflet (e.g., either an anterior or posterior leaflet, etc.) as is also the case with a second leaflet 22 .
- the leaflets ( 20 , 22 ) can be captured individually before being clamped in place by the coaption element and paddle frame.
Landscapes
- Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Cardiology (AREA)
- Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
- Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
- Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
- General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Public Health (AREA)
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Biomedical Technology (AREA)
- Heart & Thoracic Surgery (AREA)
- Oral & Maxillofacial Surgery (AREA)
- Transplantation (AREA)
- Surgery (AREA)
- Vascular Medicine (AREA)
- Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
- Medical Informatics (AREA)
- Molecular Biology (AREA)
- Epidemiology (AREA)
- Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
- Dermatology (AREA)
- Pathology (AREA)
- Manufacturing & Machinery (AREA)
- Inorganic Chemistry (AREA)
- Dispersion Chemistry (AREA)
- Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
- Rheumatology (AREA)
- Prostheses (AREA)
- Surgical Instruments (AREA)
- External Artificial Organs (AREA)
Abstract
Description
- This application is a continuation of PCT Application No. PCT/US2019/055320 filed Oct. 9, 2019, which claims the benefit of U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 62/744,031, filed Oct. 10, 2018, which is incorporated herein by reference for all purposes.
- The native heart valves (i.e., the aortic, pulmonary, tricuspid, and mitral valves) serve critical functions in assuring the forward flow of an adequate supply of blood through the cardiovascular system. These heart valves can be damaged, and thus rendered less effective, by congenital malformations, inflammatory processes, infectious conditions, disease, etc. Such damage to the valves can result in serious cardiovascular compromise or death. Damaged valves can be surgically repaired or replaced during open heart surgery. However, open heart surgeries are highly invasive and complications may occur. Transvascular techniques can be used to introduce and implant prosthetic devices in a manner that is much less invasive than open heart surgery. As one example, a transseptal technique could be used, e.g., comprising inserting a catheter into the right femoral vein, up the inferior vena cava and into the right atrium, puncturing the septum, and passing the catheter into the left atrium.
- A healthy heart has a generally conical shape that tapers to a lower apex. The heart is four-chambered and comprises the left atrium, right atrium, left ventricle, and right ventricle. The left and right sides of the heart are separated by a wall generally referred to as the septum. The native mitral valve of the human heart connects the left atrium to the left ventricle. The mitral valve has a very different anatomy than other native heart valves. The mitral valve includes an annulus portion, which is an annular portion of the native valve tissue surrounding the mitral valve orifice, and a pair of cusps, or leaflets, extending downward from the annulus into the left ventricle. The mitral valve annulus can form a “D”-shaped, oval, or otherwise out-of-round cross-sectional shape having major and minor axes. The anterior leaflet can be larger than the posterior leaflet, forming a generally “C”-shaped boundary between the abutting sides of the leaflets when they are closed together.
- When operating properly, the anterior leaflet and the posterior leaflet function together as a one-way valve to allow blood to flow only from the left atrium to the left ventricle. The left atrium receives oxygenated blood from the pulmonary veins. When the muscles of the left atrium contract and the left ventricle dilates (also referred to as “ventricular diastole” or “diastole”), the oxygenated blood that is collected in the left atrium flows into the left ventricle. When the muscles of the left atrium relax and the muscles of the left ventricle contract (also referred to as “ventricular systole” or “systole”), the increased blood pressure in the left ventricle urges the sides of the two leaflets together, thereby closing the one-way mitral valve so that blood cannot flow back to the left atrium and is instead expelled out of the left ventricle through the aortic valve. To prevent the two leaflets from prolapsing under pressure and folding back through the mitral annulus toward the left atrium, a plurality of fibrous cords called chordae tendineae tether the leaflets to papillary muscles in the left ventricle.
- Mitral regurgitation occurs when the native mitral valve fails to close properly and blood flows into the left atrium from the left ventricle during the systolic phase of heart contraction. Mitral regurgitation is one of the most common forms of valvular heart disease. Mitral regurgitation can have many different causes, such as leaflet prolapse, dysfunctional papillary muscles, stretching of the mitral valve annulus resulting from dilation of the left ventricle, more than one of these, etc. Mitral regurgitation at a central portion of the leaflets can be referred to as central jet mitral regurgitation and mitral regurgitation nearer to one commissure (i.e., location where the leaflets meet) of the leaflets can be referred to as eccentric jet mitral regurgitation. Central jet regurgitation occurs when the edges of the leaflets do not meet in the middle and thus the valve does not close, and regurgitation is present.
- A technique for treating mitral and other valvular regurgitation in patients may include securing edges of the native valve leaflets directly to one another. For example, a catheter delivered clip may be used to attempt to clip the sides of the leaflets together at the end portions of the leaflets. But significant challenges exist. For example, multiple clips may be required to eliminate or reduce regurgitation to an acceptable level, but in some circumstances, this can result in longer operation times and may result in over-restricted flow or undesirable stresses on the native anatomy.
- Despite these prior techniques, there is a continuing need for improved devices and methods for treating valvular regurgitation.
- This summary is meant to provide some examples and is not intended to be limiting of the scope of the invention in any way. For example, any feature included in an example of this summary is not required by the claims, unless the claims explicitly recite the features. Also, the features, components, steps, concepts, etc. described in examples in this summary and elsewhere in this disclosure can be combined in a variety of ways. Various features and steps as described elsewhere in this disclosure may be included in the examples summarized here.
- An example implantable prosthetic device has a coaption element (while the term coaption element is used throughout this application, this can also be referred to as a coaptation element, a spacer, etc.) and at least one anchor. The coaption element is configured to be positioned within the native heart valve orifice to help fill a space where the native valve is regurgitant and form a more effective seal. The coaption element can have a structure that is impervious to blood. The coaption element can be connected to leaflets of the native valve by the anchor.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a strip of material, and a pair of paddles. A coaption element is formed from or comprises the strip of material. The pair of paddles is formed from or comprises the strip of material and are connected to the coaption element. The pair of paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- The “strip of material” in the various embodiments described throughout this disclosure can be a single unitary strip or piece of a material. However, in some embodiments, the “strip of material” can be formed of multiple smaller discreet pieces of one or more materials combine into a larger composite strip of material.
- In one example method of manufacturing a valve repair device, a strip of material is folded to form a coaption element and a pair of paddles connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient. A portion of the strip of material forming the coaption element is attached to a collar. A portion of the strip of material forming the paddles is attached to a cap. Movement of the cap toward the collar causes the pair of paddles to move to the closed position. Movement of the cap away from the collar causes the pair of paddles to move to the open position.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient has a coaption element and a pair of paddles. The coaption element has four layers. The pair of paddles is connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a strip of material and a collar. A coaption element is formed from the strip of material. A collar is connected to the coaption element. A pair of paddles is formed from the strip of material and connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position by moving the collar toward and away from the paddles.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a collar, a coaption element, and a pair of paddles. The collar has a plurality of engagement portions configured to releasably engage a delivery apparatus. The coaption element is attached to the collar. The pair of paddles are connected to the coaption element are movable between an open position and a closed position. The paddles are circumferentially disposed between the engagement portions. The paddles are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a coaption element, a pair of paddles, and a covering. The pair of paddles is connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position. A catch point (e.g., a point that might snag or catch on a portion of the delivery system and interfere with deployment and/or recapture of the device) is formed by a portion of at least one of the coaption element and the pair of paddles when the paddles are in the open position. A cover connected to the coaption element and the paddles that covers the catch point.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a coaption element, a pair of paddles, a first cover, and a second cover. The pair of paddles is connected to the coaption element and are movable between an open position and a closed position. A first cover extends from a distal end of the device and covers at least a portion of the paddles. A second cover extending from a proximal end of the device and covers at least a portion of the coaption element.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient is made from a strip of material. The strip of material has first and second edges surrounding a central portion. A coaption element is formed from the strip of material. A pair of paddles is formed from the strip of material. The pair of paddles are connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a strip of material, a pair of attachment portions, a pair of extension members, and a cap. A coaption element is formed from the strip of material. The pair of extension members have attachment portions. A pair of paddles are formed from the strip of material. The pair of paddles are connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position. The paddles are disposed over the extension members. The cap is attached to the paddles. Movement of the cap toward the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the closed position. Movement of the cap away from the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the open position. The cap includes a retention body, a retaining nut, and a retaining bolt. The retention body has a locking aperture for receiving the attachment portions of the extension members. The retaining nut is inserted into the locking aperture. The retaining bolt for secures the retaining nut within the locking aperture.
- In one example method of manufacturing a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient a strip of material is folded to form a coaption element and a pair of paddles connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient. The portion of the strip of material forming the paddles is attached to a cap. Movement of the cap toward the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the closed position. Movement of the cap away from the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the open position. The cap includes a retention body, a retaining nut, and a retaining bolt. The retention body has a locking aperture for receiving attachment portions of extension members. The retaining nut is configured to insert into the locking aperture. The retaining bolt secures the retaining nut within the locking aperture. A pair of extension members are attached to the retention body of the cap via the attachment portions of the extension members such that the paddles are disposed over the extension members. The retaining bolt and the retaining nut are assembled to secure the cap to the strip of material.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a strip of material, a cap, and a pair of extension members. A coaption element is formed from the strip of material. A pair of paddles are formed from the strip of material and are connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient. A cap is attached to the paddles. Movement of the cap toward the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the closed position. Movement of the cap away from the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the open position. The pair of extension members are connected to the cap and are moveable between an open position and a closed position. In the closed position the extension members are biased in a closing direction.
- In one example method of manufacturing a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient a strip of material formed from shape-memory alloy is folded around a jig to form both a coaption element and a pair of paddles connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient. The strip of shape memory material is heat treated to shape-set the strip of material in the shape of the coaption element and paddles.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a strip of material, a cap, and a pair of extension members. A coaption element is formed from the strip of material. A pair of paddles is formed from the strip of material and is connected to the coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position and are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient. The cap is attached to the paddles. Movement of the cap toward the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the closed position. Movement of the cap away from the coaption element causes the pair of paddles to move to the open position. The pair of extension members is connected to the cap and the paddles. The extension members extend from attachment portions for attaching the extension members to the cap to end portions that are attached to the strip material forming the paddles. The end portions of the extension members extend beyond the strip of material.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a main coaption element, at least one auxiliary coaption element, and a pair of paddles. The at least one auxiliary coaption element is connected to the coaption element. The pair of paddles is connected to the main coaption element. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a coaption element, a pair of paddles connected to the coaption element, and a pair of paddle frames. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position. The paddles are configured to attach to the native valve of the patient. The first and second first paddle frames have spaced apart frame portions that are parallel or substantially parallel when the paddles are in a closed position to form rectangular shaped leaflet engagement areas.
- In one example method of repairing a native heart valve, first and second repair devices are installed on a pair of leaflets of the native heart valve. The repair devices each have a frame with a rectangular or substantially rectangular shape. The paddle frames of the installed repair devices are adjacent to one another and are parallel or substantially parallel to one another.
- The foregoing method and other treatment methods herein can be performed on a living animal or on a simulation, such as on a cadaver, cadaver heart, simulator (e.g. with the body parts, tissue, etc. being simulated), etc.
- In one example embodiment, a valve repair device for repairing a native valve of a patient includes a pair of paddles and a pair of clasps. The paddles are movable between an open position and a closed position. Each clasp has at least one barb, a barb support portion, a moveable arm, and a flexible portion between the barb support portion and the moveable arm. The flexible portion is configured to allow the barb support portion to flex away from the moveable arm.
- A further understanding of the nature and advantages of the present invention are set forth in the following description and claims, particularly when considered in conjunction with the accompanying drawings in which like parts bear like reference numerals.
- To further clarify various aspects of embodiments of the present disclosure, a more particular description of the certain embodiments will be made by reference to various aspects of the appended drawings. It is appreciated that these drawings depict only typical embodiments of the present disclosure and are therefore not to be considered limiting of the scope of the disclosure. Moreover, while the figures can be drawn to scale for some embodiments, the figures are not necessarily drawn to scale for all embodiments. Embodiments and other features and advantages of the present disclosure will be described and explained with additional specificity and detail through the use of the accompanying drawings in which:
-
FIG. 1 illustrates a cutaway view of the human heart in a diastolic phase; -
FIG. 2 illustrates a cutaway view of the human heart in a systolic phase; -
FIG. 2A is another cutaway view of the human heart in a systolic phase; -
FIG. 2B is the cutaway view ofFIG. 2A annotated to illustrate a natural shape of mitral valve leaflets in the systolic phase; -
FIG. 3 illustrates a cutaway view of the human heart in a diastolic phase, in which the chordae tendineae are shown attaching the leaflets of the mitral and tricuspid valves to ventricle walls; -
FIG. 4 illustrates a healthy mitral valve with the leaflets closed as viewed from an atrial side of the mitral valve; -
FIG. 5 illustrates a dysfunctional mitral valve with a visible gap between the leaflets as viewed from an atrial side of the mitral valve; -
FIG. 6 illustrates a mitral valve having a wide gap between the posterior leaflet and the anterior leaflet; -
FIG. 6A illustrates a coaption element in the gap of the mitral valve as viewed from an atrial side of the mitral valve; -
FIG. 6B illustrates a valve repair device attached to mitral valve leaflets with the coaption element in the gap of the mitral valve as viewed from a ventricular side of the mitral valve; -
FIG. 6C is a perspective view of a valve repair device attached to mitral valve leaflets with the coaption element in the gap of the mitral valve shown from a ventricular side of the mitral valve; -
FIG. 6D is a schematic view illustrating a path of mitral valve leaflets along each side of a coaption element of an example mitral valve repair device; -
FIG. 6E is a top schematic view illustrating a path of mitral valve leaflets around a coaption element of an example native valve repair device; -
FIG. 7 illustrates a tricuspid valve viewed from an atrial side of the tricuspid valve; -
FIGS. 8-14 show an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device, in various stages of deployment; -
FIG. 11A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device that is similar to the device illustrated byFIG. 11 , but where the paddles are independently controllable; -
FIGS. 15-20 show the implantable prosthetic device ofFIGS. 8-14 being delivered and implanted within the native valve; -
FIG. 21 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device or frame of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 22 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device or frame of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 23-25 show example embodiments of an implantable prosthetic device or component of an implantable medical device; -
FIGS. 26 and 27 show an example embodiment of a barbed clasp for use in an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 28-32 show example embodiments of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 32A and 32B are perspective views of a cap and a coaption element insert of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIGS. 28-32 in sealed and spaced apart positions, respectively; -
FIG. 33 shows a barbed clasp for use in an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 34 shows a portion of native valve tissue grasped by a barbed clasp; -
FIGS. 35-46 show an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device being delivered and implanted within the native valve; -
FIG. 47 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a closed position; -
FIG. 47A shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a closed position; -
FIG. 48 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device with barbed clasps in a closed position; -
FIG. 48A shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device with barbed clasps in a closed position; -
FIG. 48B shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device with barbed clasps in a closed position, the device being attached to a deployment device; -
FIG. 48C shows a side view of the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 48B , the device being provided with a cover; -
FIG. 48D shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 48B , the device being attached to a deployment device; -
FIG. 48E shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 48D , the device being provided with a cover; -
FIG. 48F shows a side view of the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 48B with barbed clasps in the closed position; -
FIG. 48G shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 48F ; -
FIG. 48H shows a bottom view of the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 48F ; -
FIG. 49 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a partially-open position; -
FIG. 50 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a partially-open position with barbed clasps in an open position; -
FIG. 51 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a partially-open position with barbed clasps in a closed position; -
FIG. 52 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a half-open position; -
FIG. 53 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a half-open position with barbed clasps in a closed position; -
FIG. 53A shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a half-open position with barbed clasps in a closed position; -
FIG. 53B shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 53A ; -
FIG. 53C shows a side view the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 53A , the device being provided with a cover; -
FIG. 53D shows a front view the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 53A , the device being provided with a cover; -
FIG. 54 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a half-open position with barbed clasps in an open position; -
FIG. 54A shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a half-open position with barbed clasps in an open position; -
FIG. 54B shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 54A ; -
FIG. 54C shows a side view the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 54A , the device being provided with a cover; -
FIG. 54D shows a front view the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 54A , the device being provided with a cover; -
FIG. 55 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a three-quarters-open position; -
FIG. 56 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a three-quarters-open position with barbed clasps in a closed position; -
FIG. 57 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a three-quarters-open position with barbed clasps in an open position; -
FIG. 58 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps near a full bailout position or near a fully-open position; -
FIG. 59 shows a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device without barbed clasps in a full bailout position or a fully-open position; -
FIG. 60 shows a side view of an example implantable in a full bailout position with barbed clasps in a closed position; -
FIG. 60A shows a side view of an example implantable in a full bailout position with barbed clasps in a closed position; -
FIG. 60B shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 60A ; -
FIG. 60C shows a side view the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 60A , the device being provided with a cover; -
FIG. 60D shows a front view the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 60A , the device being provided with a cover; -
FIG. 61 shows a side view of an example implantable in a full bailout position with barbed clasps in an open position; -
FIG. 61A shows a side view of an example implantable in a full bailout position with barbed clasps in an open position; -
FIG. 61B shows a front view of the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 61A ; -
FIG. 61C shows a side view the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 61A , the device being provided with a cover; -
FIG. 61D shows a front view the example implantable prosthetic device according toFIG. 61A , the device being provided with a cover; -
FIGS. 62A-62B illustrate the movement of the paddles of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 63A-63C illustrate the movement of the paddles of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 64A-64C illustrate the movement of the paddles of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 65 shows a perspective view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a closed position; -
FIG. 65A shows a perspective view of an example implantable prosthetic device in a closed position; -
FIG. 66 shows a perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 66A shows a perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A ; -
FIG. 67 shows a front view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 67A shows a front view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A ; -
FIG. 68 shows a front view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 with additional components; -
FIG. 68A shows a front view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A with additional components; -
FIG. 69 shows a side view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 70 shows a top view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 70A shows a top view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A ; -
FIG. 71 shows a top view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 with a collar component; -
FIG. 71A shows a top view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A with a collar component; -
FIG. 72 shows a bottom view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 72A shows a bottom view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A ; -
FIG. 73 shows a bottom view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 with a cap component; -
FIG. 73A shows a bottom view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A with a cap component; -
FIG. 74 shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 sectioned by cross-section plane 75; -
FIG. 74A shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A sectioned bycross-section plane 75A; -
FIG. 75 shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 74 ; -
FIG. 75A shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 74A ; -
FIG. 76 shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 sectioned bycross-section plane 77; -
FIG. 76A shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A sectioned bycross-section plane 77A; -
FIG. 77 shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 76 ; -
FIG. 77A shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 76A ; -
FIG. 78 shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 sectioned bycross-section plane 77; -
FIG. 78A shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A sectioned bycross-section plane 77A; -
FIG. 79 shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 78 ; -
FIG. 79A shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 78A ; -
FIG. 80 shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 sectioned bycross-section plane 81; -
FIG. 80A shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A sectioned bycross-section plane 81A; -
FIG. 81 shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 80 ; -
FIG. 81A shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 80A ; -
FIG. 82 shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 sectioned bycross-section plane 83; -
FIG. 82A shows a sectioned perspective view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A sectioned bycross-section plane 83A; -
FIG. 83 shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 82 ; -
FIG. 83A shows a top cross-section view of the example prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 82A ; -
FIG. 84 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs; -
FIG. 85 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs; -
FIG. 86 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs; -
FIG. 86A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs; -
FIG. 87 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs; -
FIG. 87A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs; -
FIG. 88 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs; -
FIG. 88A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with integral barbs; -
FIG. 89 shows a perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 89A shows a perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65A ; -
FIG. 90 shows a perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 90A shows a perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65A ; -
FIG. 91 shows a front view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 91A shows a front view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65A ; -
FIG. 92 shows a side view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 92A shows a side view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65A ; -
FIG. 93 shows a top view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 93A shows a top view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65A ; -
FIG. 94 shows a bottom view of a coapting portion and portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 94A shows a bottom view of a coapting portion and portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65A ; -
FIG. 95 shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65 with the section taken across plane 96; -
FIG. 95A shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65A with the section taken acrossplane 96A; -
FIG. 96 shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions ofFIG. 95 ; -
FIG. 96A shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions ofFIG. 95A ; -
FIG. 97 shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65 with the section taken acrossplane 98; -
FIG. 97A shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65A with the section taken acrossplane 98A; -
FIG. 98 shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions ofFIG. 97 ; -
FIG. 98A shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions ofFIG. 97A ; -
FIG. 99 shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65 with the section taken acrossplane 100; -
FIG. 99A shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65A with the section taken acrossplane 100A; -
FIG. 100 shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions ofFIG. 99 ; -
FIG. 100A shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions ofFIG. 99A ; -
FIG. 101 shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65 with the section taken acrossplane 102; -
FIG. 101A shows a sectioned perspective view of a coapting portion and paddle portions of the implantable prosthetic device illustrated byFIG. 65A with the section taken across plane 102A; -
FIG. 102 shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions ofFIG. 101 ; -
FIG. 102A shows a cross-section view of the coapting portion and paddle portions ofFIG. 101A ; -
FIG. 103 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 104 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 105 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 106 shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition; -
FIG. 106A shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition; -
FIG. 106B shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition; -
FIG. 106C shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition; -
FIG. 106D shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition; -
FIG. 106E shows a side view of an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element in an unexpanded condition; -
FIG. 106F shows an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element; -
FIG. 106G shows an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element; -
FIG. 106H shows an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element; -
FIG. 106I shows an example embodiment of an expandable coaption element; -
FIG. 107 shows an end view of the expandable coaption element ofFIG. 106 ; -
FIG. 108 shows the expandable coaption element ofFIG. 106 in an expanded condition; -
FIG. 108A shows the expandable coaption element ofFIG. 106A in an expanded condition; -
FIG. 108B shows the expandable coaption element ofFIG. 106B in an expanded condition; -
FIG. 108C shows the expandable coaption element ofFIG. 106C in an expanded condition; -
FIG. 108D shows the expandable coaption element ofFIG. 106D in an expanded condition; -
FIG. 108E shows the expandable coaption element ofFIG. 106E in an expanded condition; -
FIG. 109 shows an end view of the coaption element ofFIG. 108 ; -
FIG. 110 shows a side view of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 111 shows an end view of a coaption element of the example prosthetic device ofFIG. 110 , taken alonglines 111. -
FIGS. 112-114 show perspective views of an example embodiment of a paddle frame for the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65 ; -
FIG. 112A shows a perspective view of an example embodiment of a paddle frame for the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 65A ; -
FIG. 114A shows a side view of the paddle frame ofFIG. 112A ; -
FIG. 115 shows a front view of the paddle frame ofFIGS. 112-114 ; -
FIG. 115A shows a top view of the paddle frame ofFIG. 112A ; -
FIG. 116 shows a top view of the paddle frame ofFIGS. 112-114 ; -
FIG. 116A shows a front view of the paddle frame ofFIG. 112A ; -
FIG. 117 shows a side view of the paddle frame ofFIGS. 112-114 ; -
FIG. 117A shows a rear view of the paddle frame ofFIG. 112A ; -
FIG. 118 shows a bottom view of the paddle frame ofFIGS. 112-114 ; -
FIG. 118A shows a bottom view of the paddle frame ofFIG. 112A ; -
FIG. 119 shows a front view of the paddle frame ofFIGS. 112-114 ; -
FIG. 120 shows a front view of the paddle frame ofFIGS. 112-114 in a compressed condition inside a delivery device; -
FIG. 121 shows a side view of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device in a closed condition; -
FIG. 122 shows a front view of a paddle frame of the example prosthetic device ofFIG. 121 ; -
FIG. 123 shows a side view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 121 in an open condition; -
FIG. 124 shows a front view of the paddle frame of the open prosthetic device ofFIG. 123 ; -
FIG. 125 shows a side view of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device in a closed condition; -
FIG. 126 shows a front view of a paddle frame of the example prosthetic device ofFIG. 125 ; -
FIG. 127 shows a side view of the implantable prosthetic device ofFIG. 125 in a closed condition; -
FIG. 128 shows a front view of the paddle frame of the open prosthetic device ofFIG. 127 ; -
FIG. 129 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 130-131 show an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 132 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 133-134 show an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 135-136 show an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 137 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 138-143 show use of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 144 shows an example embodiment of a delivery assembly including a delivery device and an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 145 shows a perspective view of an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device releasably coupled to a delivery device; -
FIG. 146 shows the embodiment ofFIG. 145 with the implantable prosthetic device released from to the delivery device; -
FIG. 147 shows a cross-sectional view of the coupler ofFIG. 145 ; -
FIG. 148 shows a perspective view of the delivery assembly ofFIG. 144 with the prosthetic device shown in partial cross-section and some components of the delivery apparatus shown schematically; -
FIG. 149 shows a plan view of a shaft of the delivery device ofFIG. 144 ; -
FIG. 150 shows a side elevation view of a proximal end portion of the delivery device ofFIG. 144 ; -
FIG. 151 shows a cross-sectional view of the proximal end portion of the delivery device ofFIG. 144 , taken along the line 150-150 shown inFIG. 150 ; -
FIG. 152 shows an exploded view of the proximal end portion of the delivery device ofFIG. 144 ; -
FIGS. 153-160 show an example procedure used to repair a native valve of a heart, which is partially shown; -
FIG. 161 shows an example embodiment of a handle for the delivery apparatus ofFIG. 144 ; -
FIG. 162 is an exploded view of the handle ofFIG. 161 ; -
FIG. 163 shows an example embodiment of a coupler and a proximal collar for the delivery assembly ofFIG. 144 , showing the coupler releasably coupled to the proximal collar; -
FIG. 164 shows a perspective view of the coupler and proximal collar ofFIG. 163 , showing the coupler released from the proximal collar; -
FIG. 165 shows example embodiments of a cap, actuation element or means of actuating, and release wire for the delivery assembly ofFIG. 144 , showing the cap releasably coupled to the actuation element or means of actuating by the release wire. -
FIG. 166 shows a perspective view of the cap, actuation element or means of actuating, and the release wire ofFIG. 163 , showing the cap released from the actuation element or means of actuating and the release wire; -
FIG. 167 shows example embodiments of a coupler, a proximal collar, a cap, and an actuation element or means of actuating of the delivery assembly ofFIG. 144 ; -
FIG. 168 shows a perspective view of the coupler and proximal collar ofFIG. 167 ; -
FIG. 169 shows an example embodiment of a clasp control member of the delivery apparatus ofFIG. 144 ; -
FIG. 170 shows a detail view of the clasp control member ofFIG. 169 , taken from theperspective 170 shown inFIG. 169 ; -
FIG. 171 shows an example embodiment of a guide rail for the clasp control member ofFIG. 169 ; -
FIG. 172 shows an example embodiment of a shaft of the delivery device ofFIG. 144 ; -
FIG. 173 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device; -
FIG. 174 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device; -
FIG. 174A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device; -
FIG. 175 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device; -
FIG. 175A shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device; -
FIG. 176 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device and delivery device for releasing and recapturing the prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 177-178 show an example embodiment of a coupler for an example implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 179-181 show an example embodiment of a coupler for an example implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 182-183 show an example embodiment of a coupler for an example implantable prosthetic device; -
FIGS. 184-185 show an example embodiment of a coupler for an example implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 186 shows an example embodiment of an actuation element or means of actuating for an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 187 shows an actuation mechanism for an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 188 shows an actuation mechanism for an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 188A shows an actuation mechanism for an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 189 shows an actuation mechanism for an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 190 shows an actuation mechanism for an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 191 is a perspective view of a blank used to make a paddle frame; -
FIG. 192 is a perspective view of the blank ofFIG. 191 bent to make a paddle frame; -
FIG. 193 is a perspective view of a shape-set paddle frame attached to a cap of a valve repair device; -
FIG. 194 is a perspective view of the paddle frame ofFIG. 193 flexed and attached to inner and outer paddles at a closed position; -
FIG. 195 is a perspective view of two of the paddle frames ofFIG. 112A showing the paddle frames in a shape-set position; -
FIG. 196 is a perspective view of the paddle frames ofFIG. 195 showing the paddle frames in a loaded position; -
FIG. 197 is an enlarged side view of device ofFIG. 60C showing the cover; -
FIG. 198 is an enlarged side view of the device ofFIG. 60C showing the cover; -
FIG. 199 shows an exploded view of an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 200 shows an enlarged perspective view of the collar of an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 201 shows an enlarged perspective view of the cap of an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 202 shows an exploded view of the cap ofFIG. 206 ; -
FIG. 203 shows a plan view of an inner cover for an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 204 shows a plan view of an outer cover for an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 205 shows an enlarged view of a strip of material for an example prosthetic device; -
FIG. 206 shows an end view of the material ofFIG. 205 ; -
FIG. 207 shows an end view of the material ofFIG. 205 arranged in a plurality of layers; -
FIG. 208A shows an example implantable prosthetic device in the gap of the native valve as viewed from an atrial side of the native valve during diastole, with example inflatable spacers in a deflated condition; -
FIG. 208B shows the device ofFIG. 208A during systole, with example inflatable spacers in a deflated condition; -
FIG. 209A shows the device ofFIG. 208A during diastole, with example inflatable spacers in an inflated condition; -
FIG. 209B shows the device ofFIG. 208A during systole, with example inflatable spacers in an inflated condition; -
FIG. 210A shows an example expandable spacer in a compressed condition; -
FIG. 210B shows the expandable spacer ofFIG. 210A in an expanded condition; -
FIG. 211A shows an example implantable prosthetic device, with example inflatable spacers in a deflated condition; -
FIG. 211B shows the device ofFIG. 211B , with example inflatable spacers in an inflated condition; -
FIG. 212A is a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 212B is a front/back view of the device ofFIG. 212A ; -
FIG. 213A is a top view of an example auxiliary spacer for attaching to the device ofFIG. 212A ; -
FIG. 213B is a side view of the spacer ofFIG. 213A ; -
FIG. 214 is a side view of the spacer ofFIGS. 213A, 213B being assembled to the device ofFIGS. 212A, 212B ; -
FIG. 215A is a side view of the spacer ofFIGS. 213A, 213B assembled to the device ofFIGS. 212A, 212B ; -
FIG. 215B is a top view of the assembly ofFIG. 215A ; -
FIG. 216A is a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 216B is a front/back view of the device ofFIG. 216A ; -
FIG. 217A is a top view of an example auxiliary spacer for attaching to the device ofFIG. 216A ; -
FIG. 217B is a side view of the spacer ofFIG. 217A ; -
FIG. 218 is an example auxiliary spacer; -
FIG. 219A is a top view of an example implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 219B is a side view of an example implantable prosthetic device; -
FIG. 220A is a top view of example auxiliary spacers; -
FIG. 220B is a top view of example auxiliary spacers; -
FIG. 220C is a top view of example auxiliary spacers; -
FIG. 220D is a top view of example auxiliary spacers; -
FIG. 220E is a top view of example auxiliary spacers; -
FIG. 221 is a plan view of an example implantable prosthetic device cut from a flat sheet of material; -
FIG. 222 is a perspective view of the device ofFIG. 221 ; -
FIG. 223 shows the device ofFIGS. 221-222 in the gap of the native valve as viewed from an atrial side of the native valve; -
FIG. 224 is a plan view of an example implantable prosthetic device cut from a flat sheet of material; -
FIG. 225 is a perspective view of the device ofFIG. 224 ; -
FIG. 226 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover; -
FIG. 227 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover; -
FIG. 228 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover; -
FIG. 229 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover; -
FIG. 230 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover; -
FIG. 231 shows an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device with a two-piece cover; -
FIG. 232A is a front view of an implantable prosthetic device including barbed clasps and substantially parallel paddle frame elements according to an example embodiment; -
FIG. 232B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated bylines 232B-232B inFIG. 232A ; -
FIG. 233A is a view similar toFIG. 232A with an annotation of the space between substantially parallel sections of the paddle frame elements; -
FIG. 233B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated bylines 233B-233B inFIG. 233A ; -
FIG. 234A is a view similar toFIG. 232A illustrating engagement of a portion native valve leaflets between the substantially parallel paddle frame elements; -
FIG. 234B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated bylines 234B-234B inFIG. 234A ; -
FIG. 235A is a view similar to the view ofFIG. 234A illustrating misaligned native valve leaflets; -
FIG. 235B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated bylines 235B-235B inFIG. 235A ; -
FIG. 236 is a side view of an implantable prosthetic device according to an example embodiment; -
FIG. 237 is a side view of two adjacent implantable prosthetic devices according to an example embodiment; -
FIG. 238A is a side view of an implantable prosthetic device installed on a native valve according to an example embodiment; -
FIG. 238B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated bylines 238B-238B inFIG. 238A ; -
FIG. 239A is a side view of two adjacent implantable prosthetic devices installed on a mitral valve according to an example embodiment; -
FIG. 239B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated bylines 239B-239B inFIG. 239A ; -
FIG. 240A is a view similar to the view ofFIG. 239A illustrating two adjacent but misaligned implantable prosthetic devices; -
FIG. 240B is a cross section view taken along the plane indicated bylines 240B-240B inFIG. 240A ; -
FIG. 241 is a perspective view of a portion of a clasp with a flexible barb support according to an example embodiment; -
FIG. 242 is the portion of a clasp ofFIG. 241 where the barb support is bent back to illustrate the flexible nature of the barb support in an example embodiment; -
FIGS. 243A-243H are schematic illustrations of the clasp with a flexible barb support ofFIG. 242 releasing from a valve leaflet; -
FIGS. 244A-244E are schematic illustrations of an implantable prosthetic device with a clasp and flexible barb support releasing from a valve leaflet; -
FIGS. 245A-245E are illustrations of an implantable prosthetic device with a clasp and flexible barb support releasing from a valve leaflet; and -
FIG. 246 is an illustration of an implantable device exerting force on a single leaflet to illustrate a circumstance in which a clasp may be released from a native valve leaflet. - The following description refers to the accompanying drawings, which illustrate specific embodiments of the present disclosure. Other embodiments having different structures and operation do not depart from the scope of the present disclosure.
- Example embodiments of the present disclosure are directed to devices and methods for repairing a defective heart valve. It should be noted that various embodiments of native valve reparation devices and systems for delivery are disclosed herein, and any combination of these options can be made unless specifically excluded. In other words, individual components of the disclosed devices and systems can be combined unless mutually exclusive or otherwise physically impossible.
- As described herein, when one or more components are described as being connected, joined, affixed, coupled, attached, or otherwise interconnected, such interconnection may be direct as between the components or may be indirect such as through the use of one or more intermediary components. Also as described herein, reference to a “member,” “component,” or “portion” shall not be limited to a single structural member, component, or element but can include an assembly of components, members, or elements. Also as described herein, the terms “substantially” and “about” are defined as at least close to (and includes) a given value or state (preferably within 10% of, more preferably within 1% of, and most preferably within 0.1% of).
-
FIGS. 1 and 2 are cutaway views of the human heart H in diastolic and systolic phases, respectively. The right ventricle RV and left ventricle LV are separated from the right atrium RA and left atrium LA, respectively, by the tricuspid valve TV and mitral valve MV; i.e., the atrioventricular valves. Additionally, the aortic valve AV separates the left ventricle LV from the ascending aorta AA, and the pulmonary valve PV separates the right ventricle from the pulmonary artery PA. Each of these valves has flexible leaflets (e.g.,leaflets FIGS. 4 and 5 ) extending inward across the respective orifices that come together or “coapt” in the flow stream to form the one-way, fluid-occluding surfaces. The native valve repair systems of the present application are described primarily with respect to the mitral valve MV. Therefore, anatomical structures of the left atrium LA and left ventricle LV will be explained in greater detail. It should be understood that the devices described herein may also be used in repairing other native valves, e.g., the devices can be used in repairing the tricuspid valve TV, the aortic valve AV, and the pulmonary valve PV. - The left atrium LA receives oxygenated blood from the lungs. During the diastolic phase, or diastole, seen in
FIG. 1 , the blood that was previously collected in the left atrium LA (during the systolic phase) moves through the mitral valve MV and into the left ventricle LV by expansion of the left ventricle LV. In the systolic phase, or systole, seen inFIG. 2 , the left ventricle LV contracts to force the blood through the aortic valve AV and ascending aorta AA into the body. During systole, the leaflets of the mitral valve MV close to prevent the blood from regurgitating from the left ventricle LV and back into the left atrium LA, and blood is collected in the left atrium from the pulmonary vein. In one example embodiment, the devices described by the present application are used to repair the function of a defective mitral valve MV. That is, the devices are configured to help close the leaflets of the mitral valve to prevent blood from regurgitating from the left ventricle LV and back into the left atrium LA. Unlike the prior art that describes using sutures or clips often require multiple sutures or clips and additional supports to treat large regurgitant, the devices described in the present application are designed to easily grasp and secure the native leaflets around a coaption element that acts as a filler in the regurgitant orifice. - Referring now to
FIGS. 1-7 , the mitral valve MV includes two leaflets, theanterior leaflet 20 and theposterior leaflet 22. The mitral valve MV also includes anannulus 24, which is a variably dense fibrous ring of tissues that encircles theleaflets FIG. 3 , the mitral valve MV is anchored to the wall of the left ventricle LV bychordae tendineae 10. Thechordae tendineae 10 are cord-like tendons that connect the papillary muscles 12 (i.e., the muscles located at the base of the chordae tendineae and within the walls of the left ventricle) to theleaflets papillary muscles 12 serve to limit the movements of the mitral valve MV and prevent the mitral valve from being reverted. The mitral valve MV opens and closes in response to pressure changes in the left atrium LA and the left ventricle LV. The papillary muscles do not open or close the mitral valve MV. Rather, the papillary muscles brace the mitral valve MV against the high pressure needed to circulate blood throughout the body. Together the papillary muscles and the chordae tendineae are known as the subvalvular apparatus, which functions to keep the mitral valve MV from prolapsing into the left atrium LA when the mitral valve closes. - Various disease processes can impair proper function of one or more of the native valves of the heart H. These disease processes include degenerative processes (e.g., Barlow's Disease, fibroelastic deficiency), inflammatory processes (e.g., Rheumatic Heart Disease), and infectious processes (e.g., endocarditis). In addition, damage to the left ventricle LV or the right ventricle RV from prior heart attacks (i.e., myocardial infarction secondary to coronary artery disease) or other heart diseases (e.g., cardiomyopathy) can distort a native valve's geometry, which can cause the native valve to dysfunction. However, the vast majority of patients undergoing valve surgery, such as surgery to the mitral valve MV, suffer from a degenerative disease that causes a malfunction in a leaflet (e.g.,
leaflets 20, 22) of a native valve (e.g., the mitral valve MV), which results in prolapse and regurgitation. - Generally, a native valve may malfunction in two different ways: (1) valve stenosis; and (2) valve regurgitation. Valve stenosis occurs when a native valve does not open completely and thereby causes an obstruction of blood flow. Typically, valve stenosis results from buildup of calcified material on the leaflets of a valve, which causes the leaflets to thicken and impairs the ability of the valve to fully open to permit forward blood flow.
- The second type of valve malfunction, valve regurgitation, occurs when the leaflets of the valve do not close completely thereby causing blood to leak back into the prior chamber (e.g., causing blood to leak from the left ventricle to the left atrium). There are three main mechanisms by which a native valve becomes regurgitant—or incompetent—which include Carpentier's type I, type II, and type III malfunctions. A Carpentier type I malfunction involves the dilation of the annulus such that normally functioning leaflets are distracted from each other and fail to form a tight seal (i.e., the leaflets do not coapt properly). Included in a type I mechanism malfunction are perforations of the leaflets, as are present in endocarditis. A Carpentier's type II malfunction involves prolapse of one or more leaflets of a native valve above a plane of coaption. A Carpentier's type III malfunction involves restriction of the motion of one or more leaflets of a native valve such that the leaflets are abnormally constrained below the plane of the annulus. Leaflet restriction can be caused by rheumatic disease (Ma) or dilation of a ventricle (IIIb).
- Referring to
FIG. 4 , when a healthy mitral valve MV is in a closed position, theanterior leaflet 20 and theposterior leaflet 22 coapt, which prevents blood from leaking from the left ventricle LV to the left atrium LA. Referring toFIG. 5 , regurgitation occurs when theanterior leaflet 20 and/or theposterior leaflet 22 of the mitral valve MV is displaced into the left atrium LA during systole. This failure to coapt causes agap 26 between theanterior leaflet 20 and theposterior leaflet 22, which allows blood to flow back into the left atrium LA from the left ventricle LV during systole. As set forth above, there are several different ways that a leaflet (e.g. leaflets - Referring to
FIG. 6 , in certain situations, the mitral valve MV of a patient can have awide gap 26 between theanterior leaflet 20 and theposterior leaflet 22 when the mitral valve is in a closed position (i.e., during the systolic phase). For example, thegap 26 can have a width W between about 2.5 mm and about 17.5 mm, such as between about 5 mm and about 15 mm, such as between about 7.5 mm and about 12.5 mm, such as about 10 mm. In some situations, thegap 3002 can have a width W greater than 15 mm. In any of the above-mentioned situations, a valve repair device is desired that is capable of engaging theanterior leaflet 20 and theposterior leaflet 22 to close thegap 26 and prevent regurgitation of blood through the mitral valve MV. - Although stenosis or regurgitation can affect any valve, stenosis is predominantly found to affect either the aortic valve AV or the pulmonary valve PV, and regurgitation is predominantly found to affect either the mitral valve MV or the tricuspid valve TV. Both valve stenosis and valve regurgitation increase the workload of the heart H and may lead to very serious conditions if left un-treated; such as endocarditis, congestive heart failure, permanent heart damage, cardiac arrest, and ultimately death. Because the left side of the heart (i.e., the left atrium LA, the left ventricle LV, the mitral valve MV, and the aortic valve AV) is primarily responsible for circulating the flow of blood throughout the body, malfunction of the mitral valve MV or the aortic valve AV is particularly problematic and often life threatening. Accordingly, because of the substantially higher pressures on the left side of the heart, dysfunction of the mitral valve MV or the aortic valve AV is often more problematic.
- Malfunctioning native heart valves may either be repaired or replaced. Repair typically involves the preservation and correction of the patient's native valve. Replacement typically involves replacing the patient's native valve with a biological or mechanical substitute. Typically, the aortic valve AV and pulmonary valve PV are more prone to stenosis. Because stenotic damage sustained by the leaflets is irreversible, the most conventional treatments for a stenotic aortic valve or stenotic pulmonary valve are removal and replacement of the valve with a surgically implanted heart valve, or displacement of the valve with a transcatheter heart valve. The mitral valve MV and the tricuspid valve TV are more prone to deformation of leaflets, which, as described above, prevents the mitral valve or tricuspid valve from closing properly and allows for regurgitation or back flow of blood from the ventricle into the atrium (e.g., a deformed mitral valve MV may allow for regurgitation or back flow from the left ventricle LV to the left atrium LA). The regurgitation or back flow of blood from the ventricle to the atrium results in valvular insufficiency. Deformations in the structure or shape of the mitral valve MV or the tricuspid valve TV are often repairable. In addition, regurgitation can occur due to the
chordae tendineae 10 becoming dysfunctional (e.g., the chordae tendineae may stretch or rupture), which allows theanterior leaflet 20 and theposterior leaflet 22 to be reverted such that blood is regurgitated into the left atrium LA. The problems occurring due todysfunctional chordae tendineae 10 can be repaired by repairing the chordae tendineae or the structure of the mitral valve (e.g., by securing theleaflets - The devices and procedures disclosed herein often make reference to repairing a mitral valve for illustration. However, it should be understood that the devices and concepts provided herein can be used to repair any native valve, as well as any component of a native valve. For example, referring now to
FIG. 7 , any of the devices and concepts provided herein can be used to repair the tricuspid valve TV. For example, any of the devices and concepts provided herein can be used between any two of theanterior leaflet 30,septal leaflet 32, andposterior leaflet 34 to prevent regurgitation of blood from the right ventricle into the right atrium. In addition, any of the devices and concepts provided herein can be used on all three of theleaflets leaflets - An example implantable prosthetic device has a coaption element and at least one anchor. The coaption element is configured to be positioned within the native heart valve orifice to help fill the space and form a more effective seal, thereby reducing or preventing regurgitation described above. The coaption element can have a structure that is impervious or resistant to blood and that allows the native leaflets to close around the coaption element during ventricular systole to block blood from flowing from the left or right ventricle back into the left or right atrium, respectively. The prosthetic device can be configured to seal against two or three native valve leaflets; that is, the device may be used in the native mitral (bicuspid) and tricuspid valves. The coaption element is sometimes referred to herein as a spacer because the coaption element can fill a space between improperly functioning native mitral or tricuspid leaflets that do not close completely.
- The coaption element (e.g., spacer, coaptation element, etc.) can have various shapes. In some embodiments, the coaption element can have an elongated cylindrical shape having a round cross-sectional shape. In other embodiments, the coaption element can have an oval cross-sectional shape, a crescent cross-sectional shape, a rectangular cross-sectional shape, or various other non-cylindrical shapes. The coaption element can have an atrial portion positioned in or adjacent to the left atrium, a ventricular or lower portion positioned in or adjacent to the left ventricle, and a side surface that extends between the native mitral leaflets. In embodiments configured for use in the tricuspid valve, the atrial or upper portion is positioned in or adjacent to the right atrium, and the ventricular or lower portion is positioned in or adjacent to the right ventricle, and the side surface that extends between the native tricuspid leaflets.
- The anchor can be configured to secure the device to one or both of the native mitral leaflets such that the coaption element is positioned between the two native leaflets. In embodiments configured for use in the tricuspid valve, the anchor is configured to secure the device to one, two, or three of the tricuspid leaflets such that the coaption element is positioned between the three native leaflets. In some embodiments, the anchor can attach to the coaption element at a location adjacent the ventricular portion of the coaption element. In some embodiments, the anchor can attach to an actuation element, such as a shaft or actuation wire, to which the coaption element is also attached. In some embodiments, the anchor and the coaption element can be positioned independently with respect to each other by separately moving each of the anchor and the coaption element along the longitudinal axis of the shaft or actuation wire. In some embodiments, the anchor and the coaption element can be positioned simultaneously by moving the anchor and the coaption element together along the longitudinal axis of the shaft or actuation wire. The anchor can be configured to be positioned behind a native leaflet when implanted such that the leaflet is grasped by the anchor.
- The prosthetic device can be configured to be implanted via a delivery sheath. The coaption element and the anchor can be compressible to a radially compressed state and can be self-expandable to a radially expanded state when compressive pressure is released. The device can be configured for the anchor to be expanded radially away from the still-compressed coaption element initially in order to create a gap between the coaption element and the anchor. A native leaflet can then be positioned in the gap. The coaption element can be expanded radially, closing the gap between the coaption element and the anchor and capturing the leaflet between the coaption element and the anchor. In some embodiments, the anchor and coaption element are optionally configured to self-expand. The implantation methods for various embodiments can be different and are more fully discussed below with respect to each embodiment. Additional information regarding these and other delivery methods can be found in U.S. Pat. No. 8,449,599 and U.S. Patent Application Publication Nos. 2014/0222136, and 2014/0067052, 2016/0331523 each of which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety. These methods can be performed on a living animal or on a simulation, such as on a cadaver, cadaver heart, simulator (e.g. with the body parts, tissue, etc. being simulated), etc.
- The disclosed prosthetic devices can be configured such that the anchor is connected to a leaflet, taking advantage of the tension from native chordae tendineae to resist high systolic pressure urging the device toward the left atrium. During diastole, the devices can rely on the compressive and retention forces exerted on the leaflet that is grasped by the anchor.
- Referring now to
FIGS. 8-14 , a schematically illustrated implantableprosthetic device 100 is shown in various stages of deployment. Thedevice 100 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and thedevice 100 can be positioned to engagevalve tissue - The
device 100 is deployed from a delivery sheath or means fordelivery 102 and includes acoaptation portion 104 and ananchor portion 106. Thecoaptation portion 104 of thedevice 100 includes a coaption element or means for coapting 110 that is adapted to be implanted between the leaflets of a native valve (e.g., a native mitral valve, tricuspid valve, etc.) and is slidably attached to an actuation element 112 (e.g., actuation wire, actuation shaft, actuation tube, etc.). Theanchor portion 106 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element or means for actuating 112 opens and closes theanchor portion 106 of thedevice 100 to grasp the native valve leaflets during implantation. The actuation element 112 (e.g., wire, shaft, tube, screw, line, etc.) can take a wide variety of different forms. For example, the actuation element can be threaded such that rotation of the actuation element (e.g., wire, shaft, tube, screw, etc.) moves theanchor portion 106 relative to thecoaption portion 104. Or, the actuation element can be unthreaded, such that pushing or pulling theactuation element 112 moves theanchor portion 106 relative to thecoaption portion 104. - The
anchor portion 106 of thedevice 100 includesouter paddles 120 andinner paddles 122 that are connected between acap 114 and the coaption element or means for coapting 110 byportions portions outer paddles 120, theinner paddles 122, the coaption element or means forcoapting 110, and thecap 114 by theportions - In some implementations, the actuation element or means for actuating 112 (e.g., actuation wire, actuation shaft, etc.) extends through the delivery sheath and the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to the
cap 114 at the distal connection of theanchor portion 106. Extending and retracting the actuation element or means for actuating 112 increases and decreases the spacing between the coaption element or means forcoapting 110 and thecap 114, respectively. A collar or other attachment element removably attaches the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to the delivery sheath or means fordelivery 102 so that the actuation element or means for actuating 112 slides through the collar or other attachment element and through the coaption element or means for coapting 110 during actuation to open and close thepaddles anchor portion 106. - Referring now to
FIG. 11 , theanchor portion 106 includes attachment portions or gripping members. The illustrated gripping members comprisebarbed clasps 130 that include a base or fixedarm 132, amoveable arm 134, barbs or means for securing 136, and ajoint portion 138. The fixedarms 132 are attached to theinner paddles 122, with thejoint portion 138 disposed proximate the coaption element or means forcoapting 110. The barbed clasps have flat surfaces and do not fit in a recess of the paddle. Rather, the flat portions of the barbed clasps are disposed against the surface of theinner paddle 122. Thejoint portion 138 provides a spring force between the fixed andmoveable arms barbed clasp 130. Thejoint portion 138 can be any suitable joint, such as a flexible joint, a spring joint, a pivot joint, or the like. In certain embodiments, thejoint portion 138 is a flexible piece of material integrally formed with the fixed andmoveable arms arms 132 are attached to theinner paddles 122 and remain stationary relative to theinner paddles 122 when themoveable arms 134 are opened to open thebarbed clasps 130 and expose the barbs or means for securing 136. In some implementations, thebarbed clasps 130 are opened by applying tension toactuation lines 116 attached to themoveable arms 134, thereby causing themoveable arms 134 to articulate, flex, or pivot on thejoint portions 138. Other actuation mechanisms are also possible. - During implantation, the
paddles paddles coapting 110. Thebarbed clasps 130 can be used to grasp and/or further secure the native leaflets by engaging the leaflets with barbs or means for securing 136 and pinching the leaflets between the moveable and fixedarms barbed clasps 130 increase friction with the leaflets or may partially or completely puncture the leaflets. The actuation lines 116 can be actuated separately so that eachbarbed clasp 130 can be opened and closed separately. Separate operation allows one leaflet to be grasped at a time, or for the repositioning of aclasp 130 on a leaflet that was insufficiently grasped, without altering a successful grasp on the other leaflet. Thebarbed clasps 130 can be opened and closed relative to the position of the inner paddle 122 (as long as the inner paddle is in an open position), thereby allowing leaflets to be grasped in a variety of positions as the particular situation requires. - The
barbed clasps 130 can be opened separately by pulling on an attachedactuation line 116 that extends through the delivery sheath or means fordelivery 102 to thebarbed clasp 130. Theactuation line 116 can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, a line, a suture, a wire, a rod, a catheter, or the like. Thebarbed clasps 130 can be spring loaded so that in the closed position thebarbed clasps 130 continue to provide a pinching force on the grasped native leaflet. This pinching force remains constant regardless of the position of theinner paddles 122. Barbs or means for securing 136 of thebarbed clasps 130 can pierce the native leaflets to further secure the native leaflets. - Referring now to
FIG. 8 , thedevice 100 is shown in an elongated or fully open condition for deployment from the delivery sheath. Thedevice 100 is loaded in the delivery sheath in the fully open position, because the fully open position takes up the least space and allows the smallest catheter to be used (or thelargest device 100 to be used for a given catheter size). In the elongated condition thecap 114 is spaced apart from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 such that thepaddles anchor portion 106 are fully extended. In some embodiments, an angle formed between the interior of the outer andinner paddles barbed clasps 130 are kept in a closed condition during deployment through the delivery sheath or means fordelivery 102 so that the barbs or means for securing 136 (FIG. 11 ) do not catch or damage the sheath or tissue in the patient's heart. - Referring now to
FIG. 9 , thedevice 100 is shown in an elongated detangling condition, similar toFIG. 8 , but with thebarbed clasps 130 in a fully open position, ranging from about 140 degrees to about 200 degrees, to about 170 degrees to about 190 degrees, or about 180 degrees between fixed and moveable portions of thebarbed clasps 130. Fully opening thepaddles clasps 130 has been found to improve ease of detanglement or detachment from anatomy of the patient during implantation of thedevice 100. - Referring now to
FIG. 10 , thedevice 100 is shown in a shortened or fully closed condition. The compact size of thedevice 100 in the shortened condition allows for easier maneuvering and placement within the heart. To move thedevice 100 from the elongated condition to the shortened condition, the actuation element or means for actuating 112 is retracted to pull thecap 114 towards the coaption element or means forcoapting 110. The joints orflexible connections 126 between theouter paddle 120 andinner paddle 122 are constrained in movement such that compression forces acting on theouter paddle 120 from thecap 114 being retracted towards the coaption element or means for coapting 110 cause the paddles orgripping elements outer paddles 120 maintain an acute angle with the actuation element or means for actuating 112. Theouter paddles 120 can optionally be biased toward a closed position. Theinner paddles 122 during the same motion move through a considerably larger angle as they are oriented away from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 in the open condition and collapse along the sides of the coaption element or means for coapting 110 in the closed condition. In certain embodiments, theinner paddles 122 are thinner and/or narrower than theouter paddles 120, and the joint orflexible portions inner paddles 122 can be thinner and/or more flexible. For example, this increased flexibility can allow more movement than the joint orflexible portion 124 connecting theouter paddle 124 to thecap 114. In certain other embodiments, theouter paddles 120 are narrower than theinner paddles 122. The joint orflexible portions inner paddles 122 can be more flexible, for example, to allow more movement than the joint orflexible portion 124 connecting theouter paddle 124 to thecap 114. In one embodiment, theinner paddles 122 can be the same or substantially the same width as the outer paddles (See for example,FIG. 65A ). - Referring now to
FIGS. 11-13 , thedevice 100 is shown in a partially open, grasp-ready condition. To transition from the fully closed to the partially open condition, the actuation element or means for actuating 112 is extended to push thecap 114 away from the coaption element or means forcoapting 110, thereby pulling on theouter paddles 120, which in turn pulls on theinner paddles 122, causing theanchor portion 106 to partially unfold. The actuation lines 116 are also retracted to open theclasps 130 so that the leaflets can be grasped. In the example illustrated byFIG. 11 , the pair of inner andouter paddles clasps 130 are dependent on the positions of thepaddles FIG. 10 closing thepaddles -
FIG. 11A illustrates an example embodiment where thepaddles device 100A illustrated byFIG. 11A is similar to the device illustrated byFIG. 11 , except thedevice 100A includes an actuation element that is configured as twoindependent actuation elements 112A, 112B, which are coupled to twoindependent caps cap 114A away from the coaption element or means forcoapting 110, thereby pulling on theouter paddle 120, which in turn pulls on theinner paddle 122, causing thefirst anchor portion 106 to partially unfold. To transition a second inner paddle and a second outer paddle from the fully closed to the partially open condition, the actuation element or means for actuating 112B is extended to push thecap 114 away from the coaption element or means forcoapting 110, thereby pulling on theouter paddle 120, which in turn pulls on theinner paddle 122, causing thesecond anchor portion 106 to partially unfold. The independent paddle control illustrated byFIG. 11A can be implemented on any of the devices disclosed by the present application. - Referring now to
FIG. 12 , one of theactuation lines 116 is extended to allow one of theclasps 130 to close. Referring now toFIG. 13 , theother actuation line 116 is extended to allow theother clasp 130 to close. Either or both of theactuation lines 116 can be repeatedly actuated to repeatedly open and close thebarbed clasps 130. - Referring now to
FIG. 14 , thedevice 100 is shown in a fully closed and deployed condition. The delivery sheath or means fordelivery 102 and actuation element or means for actuating 112 is/are retracted and thepaddles device 100 can be maintained in the fully closed position with a mechanical latch or can be biased to remain closed through the use of spring materials, such as steel, other metals, plastics, composites, etc. or shape-memory alloys such as Nitinol. For example, the jointed orflexible portions outer paddles 122, and/or an additional biasing component (seecomponent 524 inFIG. 28 ) can be formed of metals such as steel or shape-memory alloy, such as Nitinol—produced in a wire, sheet, tubing, or laser sintered powder—and are biased to hold theouter paddles 120 closed around the coaption element or means forcoapting 110 and thebarbed clasps 130 pinched around native leaflets. Similarly, the fixed andmoveable arms barbed clasps 130 are biased to pinch the leaflets. In certain embodiments, the attachment orjoint portions outer paddles 122, and/or an additional biasing component (seecomponent 524 inFIG. 28 ) can be formed of any other suitably elastic material, such as a metal or polymer material, to maintain the device in the closed condition after implantation. - Referring now to
FIGS. 226-231 , theimplantable device 100 is shown provided with acover 140. Thecover 140 can be a cloth material such as polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh. The cloth cover can provide a blood seal on the surface of the spacer, and/or promote rapid tissue ingrowth. Thecover 140 includes first andsecond cover portions device 100. In some embodiments, a portion of one of the first andsecond cover portions second cover portion second cover portions portion 146 that overlaps one of the first andsecond cover portions - Referring now to
FIGS. 226-229 , various arrangements of the first andsecond cover portions portions 146. Referring now toFIG. 226 , the first cover portion 142 (represented by thin line cross-hatching), which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from thecap 114 to cover thecap 114,outer paddles 120,inner paddles 122, and the fixedarms 132 of theclasps 130. The second cover 144 (represented by thick line cross-hatching), which can be a single piece of material, covers the coaption element or means forcoapting 110. - Referring now to
FIG. 227 , thefirst cover portion 142, which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from thecap 114 to cover thecap 114,outer paddles 120,inner paddles 122, the fixedarms 132 andmoveable arms 134 of theclasps 130. As with thecover 140 ofFIG. 226 , thesecond cover 144 covers the coaption element or means forcoapting 110. - Referring now to
FIG. 228 , thefirst cover portion 142, which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from thecap 114 to cover thecap 114,outer paddles 120,inner paddles 122, and the fixedarms 132 of theclasps 130. Thesecond cover 144, which can be made from a single piece of material, covers the coaption element or means forcoapting 110 and extends from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to cover themoveable arms 134 of theclasps 130. - Referring now to
FIG. 229 , thefirst cover portion 142, which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from thecap 114 to cover thecap 114 andouter paddles 120. Thesecond cover 144, which can be made from a single piece of material, covers the coaption element or means forcoapting 110 and extends from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to cover theinner paddles 122, and the fixedarms 132 andmoveable arms 134 of theclasps 130. - Referring now to
FIGS. 230-231 , arrangements of the first andsecond cover portions portion 146. Referring now toFIG. 230 , thefirst cover portion 142, which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from thecap 114 to cover thecap 114,outer paddles 120,inner paddles 122, and the fixedarms 132 andmoveable arms 134 of theclasps 130. Thesecond cover 144, which can be made from a single piece of material, covers the coaption element or means forcoapting 110 and includes overlappingportions 146 that extend from the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to overlap a portion of themoveable arms 134 that are covered by thefirst cover 142. - Referring now to
FIG. 231 , thefirst cover portion 142, which can be made from a single piece of material, extends from thecap 114 to cover thecap 114,outer paddles 120,inner paddles 122, and the fixedarms 132 of theclasps 130. Thesecond cover 144, which can be made from a single piece of material, covers the coaption element or means forcoapting 110 andmoveable arms 134 of theclasps 130. Thefirst cover 142 also includes overlappingportions 146 that extend from the fixedarms 132 andinner paddles 122 to overlap a portion of themoveable arms 134 and coaption element or means for coapting 110 that are covered by thesecond cover 144. - Referring now to
FIGS. 15-20 , theimplantable device 100 ofFIGS. 8-14 is shown being delivered and implanted within the native mitral valve MV of the heart H. The methods and steps shown and/or discussed can be performed on a living animal or on a simulation, such as on a cadaver, cadaver heart, simulator (e.g. with the body parts, heart, tissue, etc. being simulated), etc. - Referring now to
FIG. 15 , the delivery sheath is inserted into the left atrium LA through the septum and thedevice 100 is deployed from the delivery sheath in the fully open condition. The actuation element or means for actuating 112 is then retracted to move thedevice 100 into the fully closed condition shown inFIG. 16 . As can be seen inFIG. 17 , thedevice 100 is moved into position within the mitral valve MV into the ventricle LV and partially opened so that theleaflets FIG. 18 , anactuation line 116 is extended to close one of theclasps 130, capturing aleaflet 20.FIG. 19 shows theother actuation line 116 being then extended to close theother clasp 130, capturing the remainingleaflet 22. As can be seen inFIG. 20 , the delivery sheath or means fordelivery 102 and actuation element or means for actuating 112 andactuation lines 116 are then retracted and thedevice 100 is fully closed and deployed in the native mitral valve MV. - Referring now to
FIG. 21 , an example implantableprosthetic device 200 or frame thereof is shown. In certain embodiments, thedevice 200 includes anannular spacer member 202, a fabric cover (not shown), and anchors 204 extending from thespacer member 202. The ends of eachanchor 204 can be coupled to respective struts of thespacer member 202 byrespective sleeves 206 that can be crimped or welded around the connection portions of theanchors 206 and the struts of thespacer member 202. In one example embodiment, a latching mechanism can bind thespacer member 202 to theanchor 204 within thesleeve 206. For example, the sleeve can be machined to have an interior shape that matches or is slightly smaller than the exterior shape of the ends of thespacer member 202 and theanchor 204, so that the sleeve can be friction fit on the connection portions. One or more barbs orprojections 208 can be mounted on the frame of thespacer member 202. The free ends of the barbs orprojections 208 can comprise various shapes including rounded, pointed, barbed, or the like. Theprojections 208 can exert a retaining force against native leaflets by virtue of theanchors 204, which are shaped to force the native leaflets inwardly into thespacer member 202. - Referring now to
FIG. 22 , an example implantableprosthetic device 300 or frame thereof is shown. In certain embodiments, theprosthetic spacer device 300 includes anannular spacer member 302, a fabric cover (not shown), and anchors 304 extending from thespacer member 302 and can be configured similar to theprosthetic spacer device 200. One or more barbs orprojections 306 can be mounted on the frame of thespacer member 302. The ends of theprojections 306 can comprisestoppers 308. Thestoppers 308 of the projections can be configured in a wide variety of different ways. For example, thestoppers 308 can be configured to limit the extent of theprojections 306 that can engage and/or penetrate the native leaflets and/or the stoppers can be configured to prevent removal of theprojections 306 from the tissue after theprojections 306 have penetrated the tissue. - The
anchors 304 of theprosthetic spacer device 300 can be configured similar to theanchors 204 of theprosthetic spacer device 200 except that the curve of eachanchor 304 comprises a larger radius than theanchors 204. As such, theanchors 304 cover a relatively larger portion of thespacer member 302 than theanchors 204. This can, for example, distribute the clamping force of theanchors 304 against the native leaflets over a relatively larger surface of the native leaflets in order to further protect the native leaflet tissue. - Additional details regarding the prosthetic spacer devices can be found, for example, in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0331523 and U.S. Provisional Application No. 62/161,688, which applications are incorporated by reference herein. The
devices device valve tissue - Referring now to
FIGS. 23-27 , an example embodiment of an implantableprosthetic spacer device 400 and components thereof are shown. Thedevice 400 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and thedevice 400 can be positioned to engagevalve tissue - Referring now to
FIG. 23 , the prosthetic spacer orcoaption device 400 can include acoaption portion 404 and ananchor portion 406, theanchor portion 406 including a plurality ofanchors 408. Thecoaption portion 404 includes a coaption orspacer member 410. Theanchor portion 406 includes a plurality of paddles 420 (e.g., two in the illustrated embodiment), and a plurality of clasps 430 (e.g., two in the illustrated embodiment). A first orproximal collar 411, and a second collar orcap 414 are used to move thecoaption portion 404 and theanchor portion 406 relative to one another. - As shown in
FIG. 25 ,first connection portions 425 of theanchors 408 can be coupled to and extend from afirst portion 417 of the coaption orspacer member 410, andsecond connection portions 421 of theanchors 408 can be coupled to thefirst collar 414. Theproximal collar 411 can be coupled to asecond portion 419 of thecoaption member 410. - The
coaption member 410 and theanchors 408 can be coupled together in various ways. For example, as shown in the illustrated embodiment, thecoaption member 410 and theanchors 408 can be coupled together by integrally forming thecoaption member 410 and theanchors 408 as a single, unitary component. This can be accomplished, for example, by forming thecoaption member 410 and theanchors 408 from a braided or woven material, such as braided or woven nitinol wire. In other embodiments, thecoaption member 410 and theanchors 408 can be coupled together by welding, fasteners, adhesive, joint connections, sutures, friction fittings, swaging, and/or other means for coupling. - Referring now to
FIG. 24 , theanchors 408 can comprise first portions orouter paddles 420 and second portions orinner paddles 422 separated byjoint portions 423. In this manner, theanchors 408 are configured similar to legs in that theinner paddles 422 are like upper portions of the legs, theouter paddles 420 are like lower portions of the legs, and thejoint portions 423 are like knee portions of the legs. In some embodiments, theinner paddle portion 422, theouter paddle portion 420, and thejoint portion 423 are formed from a continuous strip of a fabric, such as a metal fabric. In some embodiments, the strip of fabric is a composite strip of fabric. - The
anchors 408 can be configured to move between various configurations by axially moving thecap 414 relative to theproximal collar 411 and thus theanchors 408 relative to thecoaption member 410 along a longitudinal axis extending between the first or distal and second orproximal portions coaption member 410. For example, theanchors 408 can be positioned in a straight configuration by moving thecap 414 away from thecoaption member 410. In the straight configuration, the paddle portions are aligned or straight in the direction of the longitudinal axis of the device and thejoint portions 423 of theanchors 408 are adjacent the longitudinal axis of the coaption member 410 (e.g., similar to the configuration shown inFIG. 59 ). From the straight configuration, theanchors 408 can be moved to a fully folded configuration (e.g.,FIG. 23 ) by moving the toward thecoaption member 410. Initially as thecap 414 moves toward thecoaption member 410, theanchors 408 bend at thejoint portions joint portions 423 move radially outwardly relative to the longitudinal axis of thecoaption member 410 and axially toward thefirst portion 414 of thecoaption member 410, as shown inFIGS. 24-25 . As thecap 414 continues to move toward thecoaption member 410, thejoint portions 423 move radially inwardly relative to the longitudinal axis of thecoaption member 410 and axially toward theproximal portion 419 of thecoaption member 410, as shown inFIG. 23 . - In some embodiments, an angle between the
inner paddles 422 of theanchors 408 and thecoaption member 410 can be approximately 180 degrees when theanchors 408 are in the straight configuration (see, e.g.,FIG. 59 ), and the angle between theinner paddles 422 of theanchors 408 and thecoaption member 410 can be approximately 0 degrees when theanchors 408 are in the fully folded configuration (SeeFIG. 23 ). Theanchors 408 can be positioned in various partially folded configurations such that the angle between theinner paddles 422 of theanchors 408 and thecoaption member 410 can be approximately 10-170 degrees or approximately 45-135 degrees. - Configuring the
prosthetic spacer device 400 such that theanchors 408 can extend to a straight or approximately straight configuration (e.g. approximately 120-180 degrees relative to the coaption member 410) can provide several advantages. For example, this can reduce the radial crimp profile of theprosthetic spacer device 400. It can also make it easier to grasp the native leaflets by providing a larger opening in which to grasp the native leaflets. Additionally, the relatively narrow, straight configuration can prevent or reduce the likelihood that theprosthetic spacer device 400 will become entangled in native anatomy (e.g., chordae tendineae) when positioning and/or retrieving theprosthetic spacer device 400 into the delivery apparatus. - Referring again to
FIG. 24 , theclasps 430 can comprise attachment or fixedportions 432 and arm ormoveable portions 434. The attachment or fixedportions 432 can be coupled to theinner paddles 422 of theanchors 408 in various ways such as with sutures, adhesive, fasteners, welding, stitching, swaging, friction fit and/or other means for coupling or fastening. - In some embodiments, the
moveable portions 434 can articulate, flex, or pivot relative to the fixedportions 432 between an open configuration (e.g.,FIG. 24 ) and a closed configuration (FIGS. 23 and 25 ). In some embodiments, theclasps 430 can be biased to the closed configuration. In some embodiments, in the open configuration, the fixedportions 432 and themoveable portions 434 flex or pivot away from each other such that native leaflets can be positioned between thefixed portions 432 and themoveable portions 434. In some embodiments, in the closed configuration, the fixedportions 432 and themoveable portions 434 flex or pivot toward each other, thereby clamping the native leaflets between thefixed portions 432 and themoveable portions 434. - Referring to
FIGS. 26-27 , clasps 430 are shown in top and perspective views. The fixed portions 432 (only one shown inFIGS. 26-27 ) can comprise one or more openings 433 (e.g., three in the illustrated embodiment). At least some of theopenings 433 can be used to couple the fixedportions 432 to theanchors 408. For example, sutures and/or fasteners can extend through theopenings 433 to couple the fixedportions 432 to theanchors 408 or other attachments, such as welding, adhesives, etc. can be used. - The
moveable portions 434 can comprise one or more side beams 431. When two side beams are included as illustrated, the side beams can be spaced apart to formslots 431A. Theslots 431A can be configured to receive the fixedportions 432. Themoveable portions 434 can also includespring portions 434A that are coupled to the fixedportions 432 and barb support portions 434B disposed opposite thespring portions 434A. - The barb support portions 434B can comprise gripper or attachment elements such as
barbs 436 and/or other means for frictionally engaging native leaflet tissue. The gripper elements can be configured to engage and/or penetrate the native leaflet tissue to help retain the native leaflets between thefixed portions 432 andmoveable portions 434 of theclasps 430. - The barb support portions 434B can also comprise
eyelets 435, which can be used to couple the barb support portions 434B to an actuation mechanism configured to flex or pivot themoveable portions 434 relative to the fixedportions 432. Additional details regarding coupling theclasps 430 to the actuation mechanism are provided below. - In some embodiments, the
clasps 430 can be formed from a shape memory material such as nitinol, stainless steel, and/or shape memory polymers. In certain embodiments, theclasps 430 can be formed by laser-cutting a piece of flat sheet material (e.g., nitinol) or a tube in the configuration shown inFIG. 26 or a similar or different configuration and then shape-setting theclasp 430 in the configuration shown inFIG. 27 . - Shape-setting the
clasps 430 in this manner can provide several advantages. For example, theclasps 430 can optionally be compressed from the shape-set configuration (e.g.,FIG. 27 ) to the flat configuration (e.g.,FIG. 26 ), or another configuration which reduces the radial crimp profile of theclasps 430. For example, the barbs can optionally be compressed to a flat configuration. Reducing the radial crimp profile can improve trackability and retrievability of theprosthetic spacer device 400 relative to a catheter shaft of a delivery apparatus because barbs 440 are pointing radially inwardly toward theanchors 408 when theprosthetic spacer device 400 is advanced through or retrieved into the catheter shaft (see, e.g.,FIG. 33 ). This can prevent or reduce the likelihood that theclasps 430 may snag or skive the catheter shaft. - In addition, shape-setting the
clasps 430 in the configuration shown inFIG. 27 can increase the clamping force of theclasps 430 when theclasps 430 are in the closed configuration. This is because themoveable portions 434 are shape-set relative to the fixedportions 432 to a first position (e.g.,FIG. 27 ) which is beyond the position themoveable portions 434 can achieve when theclasps 430 are attached to the anchors 408 (e.g.,FIG. 25 ) because theanchors 408 prevent themoveable portions 434 from further movement toward the shape-set configuration. This results inmoveable portions 434 having a preload (i.e., the clamping force is greater than zero) when theclasps 430 are attached to theanchors 408 and in the closed configuration. Thus, shape-setting theclasps 430 in theFIG. 27 configuration can increase the clamping force of theclasps 430 compared to clasps that are shape-set in the closed configuration. - The magnitude of the preload of the
clasps 430 can be altered by adjusting the angle in which themoveable portions 434 are shape-set relative to the fixedportions 432. For example, increasing the relative angle between themoveable portions 434 and the fixedportions 432 increases the preload, and decreasing the relative angle between themoveable portions 434 and the fixedportions 432 decreases the preload. It can also be adjusted in other ways, such as based on the configuration of the joint, hinge, materials, etc. - In some embodiments, the
proximal collar 411 and/or thecoaption member 410 can comprise ahemostatic seal 413 configured to reduce or prevent blood from flowing through theproximal collar 411 and/or thecoaption member 410. For example, in some embodiments, thehemostatic seal 413 can comprise a plurality offlexible flaps 413A, as shown inFIG. 23 . In some embodiments, theflaps 413A can be configured to pivot from a sealed configuration to an open configuration to allow a shaft of a delivery apparatus to extend through thesecond collar 410. In one example embodiment, theflaps 413A form a seal around the shaft of the delivery apparatus. When the shaft of the delivery apparatus is removed, theflaps 413A can be configured to return to the sealed configuration from the open configuration. - Referring now to
FIG. 23A , an example embodiment of an implantableprosthetic spacer device 400A is shown. Thedevice 400A can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and thedevice 400A can be positioned to engagevalve tissue - The prosthetic spacer or
coaption device 400A can include acoaption portion 404A and ananchor portion 406A, theanchor portion 406A including a plurality ofanchors 408A. Thecoaption portion 404A includes a coaption member orspacer 410A. Theanchor portion 406A includes a plurality ofpaddles 420A (e.g., two in the illustrated embodiment), and a plurality ofclasps 430A (e.g., two in the illustrated embodiment). A first orproximal collar 411A, and a second collar orcap 414A are used to move thecoaption portion 404A and theanchor portion 406A relative to one another. - The
coaption member 410A extends from a proximal portion 419A assembled to thecollar 411A to adistal portion 417A that connects to theanchors 408A. Thecoaption member 410A and theanchors 408A can be coupled together in various ways. For example, as shown in the illustrated embodiment, thecoaption member 410A and theanchors 408A can be coupled together by integrally forming thecoaption member 410A and theanchors 408A as a single, unitary component. This can be accomplished, for example, by forming thecoaption member 410A and theanchors 408A from acontinuous strip 401A of a braided or woven material, such as braided or woven nitinol wire. - The
anchors 408A are attached to thecoaption member 410A byhinge portions 425A and to thecap 414A byhinge portions 421A. Theanchors 408A can comprise first portions orouter paddles 420A and second portions orinner paddles 422A separated byjoint portions 423A. Thejoint portions 423A are attached to paddleframes 424A that are hingably attached to thecap 414A. In this manner, theanchors 408A are configured similar to legs in that theinner paddles 422A are like upper portions of the legs, theouter paddles 420A are like lower portions of the legs, and thejoint portions 423A are like knee portions of the legs. In the illustrated example, theinner paddle portion 422A, theouter paddle portion 420A, and thejoint portion 423A are formed from the continuous strip offabric 401A, such as a metal fabric. - The
anchors 408A can be configured to move between various configurations by axially moving thecap 414A relative to theproximal collar 411A and thus theanchors 408A relative to thecoaption member 410A along a longitudinal axis extending between thecap 414A and theproximal collar 411A. For example, theanchors 408 can be positioned in a straight configuration (seeFIG. 60A ) by moving thecap 414A away from thecoaption member 410A. In the straight configuration, thepaddle portions joint portions 423A of theanchors 408A are adjacent the longitudinal axis of thecoaption member 410A (e.g., similar to the configuration shown inFIG. 60A ). From the straight configuration, theanchors 408 can be moved to a fully folded configuration (e.g.,FIG. 23A ) by moving the toward thecoaption member 410A. Initially, as thecap 414A moves toward thecoaption member 410A, theanchors 408A bend atjoint portions joint portions 423A move radially outwardly relative to the longitudinal axis of thedevice 400A and axially toward thedistal portion 417A of thecoaption member 410A, as shown inFIGS. 53A and 54A . As thecap 414A continues to move toward thecoaption member 410A, thejoint portions 423A move radially inwardly relative to the longitudinal axis of thedevice 400A and axially toward the proximal portion 419A of thecoaption member 410A, as shown inFIG. 23A . - In some embodiments, an angle between the
inner paddles 422A of theanchors 408A and thecoaption member 410A can be approximately 180 degrees when theanchors 408A are in the straight configuration (see, e.g.,FIG. 60A ), and the angle between theinner paddles 422A of theanchors 408A and thecoaption member 410A can be approximately 0 degrees when theanchors 408A are in the fully folded configuration (seeFIG. 23A ). Theanchors 408A can be positioned in various partially folded configurations such that the angle between theinner paddles 422A of theanchors 408A and thecoaption member 410A can be approximately 10-170 degrees or approximately 45-135 degrees. - Configuring the
prosthetic spacer device 400A such that theanchors 408A can extend to a straight or approximately straight configuration (e.g. approximately 120-180 degrees relative to thecoaption member 410A) can provide several advantages. For example, this can reduce the radial crimp profile of theprosthetic spacer device 400A. It can also make it easier to grasp the native leaflets by providing a larger opening in which to grasp the native leaflets. Additionally, the relatively narrow, straight configuration can prevent or reduce the likelihood that theprosthetic spacer device 400A will become entangled in native anatomy (e.g., chordae tendineae) when positioning and/or retrieving theprosthetic spacer device 400A into the delivery apparatus. - The
clasps 430A can comprise attachment or fixedportions 432C and arm or moveable portions 434C. The attachment or fixedportions 432C can be coupled to theinner paddles 422A of theanchors 408A in various ways such as with sutures, adhesive, fasteners, welding, stitching, swaging, friction fit, and/or other means for coupling. Theclasps 430A are similar to theclasps 430. - In some embodiments, the moveable portions 434C can articulate, flex, or pivot relative to the fixed
portions 432C between an open configuration (e.g.,FIG. 54A ) and a closed configuration (FIG. 53A ). In some embodiments, theclasps 430A can be biased to the closed configuration. In the open configuration, the fixedportions 432C and the moveable portions 434C articulate, pivot, or flex away from each other such that native leaflets can be positioned between thefixed portions 432C and the moveable portions 434C. In the closed configuration, the fixedportions 432C and the moveable portions 434C articulate, pivot, or flex toward each other, thereby clamping the native leaflets between thefixed portions 432C and the moveable portions 434C. - The
strip 401A is attached thecollar 411A,cap 414A, paddle frames 424A, clasps 430A to form both thecoaption portion 404A and theanchor portion 406A of thedevice 400A. In the illustrated embodiment, thecoaption member 410A,hinge portions outer paddles 420A, andinner paddles 422A are formed from thecontinuous strip 401A. Thecontinuous strip 401A can be a single layer of material or can include two or more layers. In certain embodiments, portions of thedevice 400A have a single layer of the strip ofmaterial 401A and other portions are formed from multiple overlapping or overlying layers of the strip ofmaterial 401A. For example,FIG. 23A shows thecoaption member 410A andinner paddles 422A formed from multiple overlapping layers of the strip ofmaterial 401A. The single continuous strip ofmaterial 401A can start and end in various locations of thedevice 400A. The ends of the strip ofmaterial 401A can be in the same location or different locations of thedevice 400A. For example, in the illustrated embodiment ofFIG. 23A , the strip of material begins and ends in the location of theinner paddles 422A. - Referring now to
FIG. 30A , the example implantableprosthetic device 400A is shown covered with acover 440A. Thecover 440A is disposed on thecoaption member 410A, thecollar 411A, thecap 414A, thepaddles clasps 430A. Thecover 440A can be configured to prevent or reduce blood-flow through theprosthetic spacer device 400A and/or to promote native tissue ingrowth. In some embodiments, thecover 440A can be a cloth or fabric such as PET, velour, or other suitable fabric. In other embodiments, in lieu of or in addition to a fabric, thecover 440A can include a coating (e.g., polymeric material, silicone, etc.) that is applied to theprosthetic spacer device 400A. - Referring now to
FIGS. 28-30 , an example embodiment of an implantable prosthetic device 500 (e.g., a prosthetic spacer device) is shown. Theimplantable device 500 is one of the many different configurations that thedevice 100 that is schematically illustrated inFIGS. 8-20 can take. Thedevice 500 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and thedevice 500 can be positioned to engagevalve tissue - The
prosthetic spacer device 500 can comprise a coaption element orspacer member 510, a plurality ofanchors 508 that includeouter paddles 520,inner paddles 522, clasps 530, a first orproximal collar 511, and a second collar orcap 514. These components of theprosthetic spacer device 500 can be configured the same or substantially similar to the corresponding components of theprosthetic spacer device 400. - The
prosthetic spacer device 500 can also include a plurality of paddle extension members or paddle frames 524. The paddle frames 524 can be configured with a round three-dimensional shape withfirst connection portions 526 coupled to and extending from thecap 514 andsecond connection portions 528 disposed opposite thefirst connection portions 526. The paddle frames 524 can be configured to extend circumferentially farther around thecoaption member 510 than theouter paddles 520. For example, in some embodiments, each of the paddle frames 524 extend around approximately half of the circumference of the coaption member 510 (as shown inFIG. 29 ), and theouter paddles 520 extend around less than half of the circumference of the coaption member 510 (as shown inFIG. 28 ). The paddle frames 524 can also be configured to extend laterally (i.e., perpendicular to a longitudinal axis of the coaption member 510) beyond an outer diameter of thecoaption member 510. In the illustrated example, theinner paddle portions 522 and theouter paddle portions 520 can formed from a continuous strip of fabric that are connected to the paddle frames 524. For example, the inner paddle portions and the outer paddle portions can be connected to the connection portion of the paddle frame at the flexible connection between the inner paddle portion and the outer paddle portion. - The paddle frames 524 can further be configured such that
connection portions 528 of the paddle frames 524 are connected to or axially adjacent ajoint portion 523. The connection portions of the paddle frames 534 can be positioned between outer andinner paddles paddle portion 520, on the inside of the inner paddle portion, or on top of thejoint portion 523 when theprosthetic spacer device 500 is in a folded configuration (e.g.,FIGS. 28-30 ). The connections between the paddle frames 524, the single strip that forms the outer andinner paddles cap 514, and the coaption element can constrain each of these parts to the movements and positions described herein. In particular thejoint portion 523 is constrained by its connection between the outer andinner paddles paddle frame 524 is constrained by its attachment to the joint portion 523 (and thus the inner and outer paddles) and to the cap. - Configuring the paddle frames 524 in this manner provides increased surface area compared to the
outer paddles 520 alone. This can, for example, make it easier to grasp and secure the native leaflets. The increased surface area can also distribute the clamping force of thepaddles 520 and paddleframes 524 against the native leaflets over a relatively larger surface of the native leaflets in order to further protect the native leaflet tissue. - The increased surface area of the paddle frames 524 can also allow the native leaflets to be clamped to the
prosthetic spacer device 500, such that the native leaflets coapt entirely around thecoaption member 510. This can, for example, improve sealing of the native leaflet and thus prevent or further reduce mitral regurgitation. - Referring to
FIG. 30 , theprosthetic spacer device 500 can also include acover 540. In some embodiments, thecover 540 can be disposed on thecoaption member 510, thepaddles cover 540 can be configured to prevent or reduce blood-flow through theprosthetic spacer device 500 and/or to promote native tissue ingrowth. In some embodiments, thecover 540 can be a cloth or fabric such as PET, velour, or other suitable fabric. In other embodiments, in lieu of or in addition to a fabric, thecover 540 can include a coating (e.g., polymeric, silicone, etc.) that is applied to theprosthetic device 500. -
FIGS. 31-32 illustrate the implantableprosthetic device 500 ofFIGS. 28 and 29 withanchors 508 of ananchor portion 506 and clasps 530 in open positions. Thedevice 500 is deployed from a delivery sheath (not shown) and includes acoaption portion 504 and theanchor portion 506. Thedevice 500 is loaded in the delivery sheath in the fully extended or bailout position, because the fully extended or bailout position takes up the least space and allows the smallest catheter to be used (SeeFIG. 35 ). Or, the fully extended position allows thelargest device 500 to be used for a given catheter size. Thecoaption portion 504 of the device includes acoaption element 510 for implantation between the native leaflets of a native valve (e.g., mitral valve, tricuspid valve, etc.). Aninsert 516A is disposed inside thecoaption element 510. Theinsert 516A and thecoaption element 510 are slidably attached to an actuation element 512 (e.g., actuation wire, rod, shaft, tube, screw, suture, line, etc.). Theanchors 508 of thedevice 500 includeouter paddles 520 andinner paddles 522 that are flexibly connected to thecap 514 and thecoaption element 510. Actuation of the actuation element or means foractuation 512 opens and closes theanchors 508 of thedevice 500 to grasp the native valve leaflets during implantation. - The
actuation element 512 extends through the delivery sheath (not shown), theproximal collar 511, thecoaption element 510, theinsert 516A, and extends to thecap 514. Extending and retracting theactuation element 512 increases and decreases the spacing between thecoaption element 510 and thecap 514, respectively. This changing of the spacing between thecoaption element 510 and thecap 514 causes theanchor portion 506 of the device to move between different positions. - The
proximal collar 511 optionally includes acollar seal 513 that forms a seal around the actuation element or means foractuation 512 during implantation of thedevice 500, and that seals shut when theactuation element 512 is removed to close or substantially close the proximal end of thedevice 500 to blood flow through the interior of thecoaption element 510 after implantation. In some embodiments, a coupler or means for coupling 2214 (seeFIG. 145 ) removably engages and attaches theproximal collar 511 and thecoaption element 500 to the delivery sheath. In some embodiments, coupler or means forcoupling 2214 is held closed around theproximal collar 511 by theactuation element 512, such that removal of theactuation element 512 allows fingers (seeFIG. 145 ) of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 to open, releasing theproximal collar 511. - The
proximal collar 511 and theinsert 516A in thecoaption element 510 slide along theactuation element 512 during actuation to open and close thepaddles anchors 508. Referring toFIGS. 32A and 32B , in some embodiments thecap 514 optionally includes a sealingprojection 516 that sealingly fits within asealing opening 517 of theinsert 516A. In one example embodiment, thecap 514 includes a sealing opening and theinsert 516A includes a sealing projection. Theinsert 516A can sealingly fit inside adistal opening 515 of thecoaption element 510, thecoaption element 510 having a hollow interior. Referring toFIG. 32A , the sealingprojection 516 of thecap 514 sealingly engages theopening 517 in theinsert 516A to maintain the distal end of thecoaption element 510 closed or substantially closed to blood flow when thedevice 500 is implanted and/or in the closed position. - In one example embodiment, instead of the sealing engagement between the
cap 514 and theinsert 516A, theinsert 516A can optionally include a seal, like thecollar seal 513 of the proximal collar, that forms a seal around the actuation element or means foractuation 512 during implantation of thedevice 500, and that seals shut when theactuation element 512 is removed. Such a seal can close or substantially close the distal end of thecoaption element 510 to blood flow after implantation. - The
coaption element 510 and paddles 520, 522 are formed from a flexible material that can be a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, or formed in any other suitable way or a laser cut or otherwise cut flexible material. The material can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body. Paddle frames 524 provide additional pinching force between theinner paddles 522 and thecoaption element 510 and assist in wrapping the leaflets around the sides of thecoaption element 510 for a better seal between thecoaption element 510 and the leaflets. In some embodiments, the covering 540 illustrated byFIG. 30 extends around the paddle frames 524. - The
clasps 530 include a base or fixedarm 532, amoveable arm 534,barbs 536, and ajoint portion 538. The fixedarms 532 are attached to theinner paddles 522, with thejoint portion 538 disposed proximate thecoaption element 510. The barbed clasps have flat surfaces and do not fit in a recess of the paddle. Rather, the flat portion of the barbed clasps are disposed against the surface of theinner paddle 522. For example, the fixedarms 532 are attached to theinner paddles 522 through holes orslots 533 with sutures (not shown). The fixedarms 532 can be attached to theinner paddles 522 or another portion of the device with any suitable means, such as screws or other fasteners, crimped sleeves, mechanical latches or snaps, welding, adhesive, or the like. The fixedarms 532 remain stationary or substantially stationary relative to theinner paddles 522 when themoveable arms 534 are opened to open thebarbed clasps 530 and expose thebarbs 536. Thebarbed clasps 530 are opened by applying tension to actuation lines (not shown) attached toholes 535 in themoveable arms 534, thereby causing themoveable arms 534 to pivot or flex on thejoint portions 538. - During implantation, the
anchors 508 are opened and closed to grasp the native valve leaflets between thepaddles coaption element 510. Thebarbed clasps 530 further secure the native leaflets by engaging the leaflets withbarbs 536 and pinching the leaflets between the moveable and fixedarms barbs 536 of thebarbed clasps 530 increase friction with the leaflets or may partially or completely puncture the leaflets. The actuation lines can be actuated separately so that eachbarbed clasp 530 can be opened and closed separately. Separate operation allows one leaflet to be grasped at a time, or for the repositioning of aclasp 530 on a leaflet that was insufficiently grasped, without altering a successful grasp on the other leaflet. Thebarbed clasps 530 can open and close when theinner paddle 522 is not closed, thereby allowing leaflets to be grasped in a variety of positions as the particular situation requires. - Referring now to
FIG. 33 , an examplebarbed clasp 600 for use in implantable prosthetic devices, such as the devices described above, is shown. However, a wide variety of different barbed clasps can be used. Examples of barbed clasps that can be used include but are not limited to any of the barbed clasps disclosed in the present application and any of the applications that are incorporated herein by reference and/or that the present application claims priority to. In the illustrated example, thebarbed clasp 600 is formed from atop layer 602 and abottom layer 604. The two-layer design of theclasp 600 allow thinner sheets of material to be used, thereby improving the flexibility of theclasp 600 over a clasp formed from a single thicker sheet, while maintaining the strength of theclasp 600 needed to successfully retain a native valve leaflet. - The
barbed clasp 600 includes a fixedarm 610, a jointedportion 620, and amovable arm 630 having abarbed portion 640. The top andbottom layers barbed portion 640. However, the top andbottom layers portion 620 is spring-loaded so that the fixed andmoveable arms barbed clasp 600 is in a closed condition. When assembled to an implantable prosthetic device, the fixedarm 610 is attached to a portion of the prosthetic device. Theclasp 600 is opened by pulling on an actuation line attached to themoveable arm 630 until the spring force of thejoint portion 620 is overcome. - The fixed
arm 610 is formed from atongue 611 of material extending from the jointedportion 620 between twoside beams 631 of themoveable arm 630. Thetongue 611 is biased between the side beams 631 by thejoint portion 620 such that force must be applied to move thetongue 611 from a neutral position located beyond the side beams 631 to a preloaded position parallel or substantially parallel with the side beams 631. Thetongue 611 is held in the preloaded position by an optional T-shaped cross-bar 614 that is attached to thetongue 611 and extends outward to engage the side beams 631. In one example embodiment, the cross-bar is omitted and thetongue 611 is attached to theinner paddle 522, and theinner paddle 522 maintains the clasp in the preloaded position. In the two-layer clasp application, the top andbottom layers moveable arms - The
tongue 611 includesholes 612 for receiving sutures (not shown) that attach the fixedarm 610 to an implantable device. The fixedarm 610 can be attached to an implantable device, such as with screws or other fasteners, crimped sleeves, mechanical latches or snaps, welding, adhesive, or the like. In certain embodiments, theholes 612 are elongated slots or oval-shaped holes to accommodate sliding of thelayers clasp 600 to an implantable device. - The
joint portion 620 is formed by twobeam loops 622 that extend from thetongue 611 of the fixedarm 610 to the side beams 631 of themoveable arm 630. In certain embodiments, thebeam loops 622 are narrower than thetongue 611 andside beam 631 to provide additional flexibility. Thebeam loops 622 each include acenter portion 624 extending from thetongue 611 and anouter portion 626 extending to the side beams 631. Thebeam loops 622 are bent into a somewhat spiral or helical shape by bending the center andouter portions step distance 628 between thetongue 611 and side beams 631. Thestep distance 628 provides space between thearms step distance 628 is about 0.5 millimeter to about 1 millimeter, or about 0.75 millimeters. - When viewed in a top plan view, the beam loops have an “omega-like” shape. This shape of the
beam loops 622 allows the fixed andmoveable arms tongue 611 can be flexed or pivoted from a neutral position that is approximately 45 degrees beyond themoveable arm 630 to a fully open position that ranges from about 140 degrees to about 200 degrees, to about 170 degrees to about 190 degrees, or about 180 degrees from themoveable arm 630 without plastically deforming the clasp material. In certain embodiments, the clasp material plastically deforms during opening without reducing or without substantially reducing the pinch force exerted between the fixed and moveable arms in the closed position. - Preloading the
tongue 611 enables theclasp 600 to maintain a pinching or clipping force on the native leaflet when closed. The preloading of thetongue 611 provides a significant advantage over prior art clips that provide little or no pinching force when closed. Additionally, closing theclasp 600 with spring force is a significant improvement over clips that use a one-time locking closure mechanism, as theclasp 600 can be repeatedly opened and closed for repositioning on the leaflet while still maintaining sufficient pinching force when closed. In addition, the spring-loaded clasps also allow for easier removal of the device over time as compared to a device that locks in a closed position (after tissue ingrowth). In one example embodiment, both the clasps and the paddles are spring biased to their closed positions (as opposed to being locked in the closed position), which can allow for easier removal of the device after tissue ingrowth. - The
barbed portion 640 of themoveable arm 630 includes aneyelet 642,barbs 644, and barb supports 646. Positioning the barbed portion of theclasp 600 toward an end of themoveable arm 630 increases the space between thebarbs 644 and the fixedarm 610 when theclasp 600 is opened, thereby improving the ability of theclasp 600 to successfully grasp a leaflet during implantation. This distance also allows thebarbs 644 to more reliably disengage from the leaflet for repositioning. In certain embodiments, the barbs of the clasps can be staggered longitudinally to further distribute pinch forces and local leaflet stress. - The
barbs 644 are laterally spaced apart at the same distance from thejoint portion 620, providing a superior distribution of pinching forces on the leaflet tissue while also making the clasp more robust to leaflet grasp than barbs arranged in a longitudinal row. In some embodiments, thebarbs 644 can be staggered to further distribute pinch forces and local leaflet stress. - The
barbs 644 are formed from thebottom layer 604 and the barb supports 646 are formed from the top layer. In certain embodiments, the barbs are formed from thetop layer 602 and the barb supports are formed from thebottom layer 604. Forming thebarbs 644 only in one of the twolayers barbs 644 to stiffen thebarbs 644, further improving penetration and retention of the leaflet tissue. In certain embodiments, the ends of thebarbs 644 are further sharpened using any suitable sharpening means. - The
barbs 644 are angled away from themoveable arm 630 such that they easily penetrate tissue of the native leaflets with minimal pinching or clipping force. Thebarbs 644 extend from the moveable arm at an angle of about 45 degrees to about 75 degrees, or about 45 degrees to about 60 degrees, or about 48 to about 56 degrees, or about 52 degrees. The angle of thebarbs 644 provides further benefits, in that force pulling the implant off the native leaflet will encourage thebarbs 644 to further engage the tissue, thereby ensuring better retention. Retention of the leaflet in theclasp 600 can be further improved by the position of the T-shapedcross bar 614 near thebarbs 644 when theclasp 600 is closed. In this arrangement, the tissue pierced by thebarbs 644 is pinched against themoveable arm 630 at thecross bar 614 location, thereby forming the tissue into an S-shaped torturous path as it passes over thebarbs 644. Thus, forces pulling the leaflet away from theclasp 600 will encourage the tissue to further engage thebarbs 644 before the leaflets can escape. For example, leaflet tension during diastole can encourage the barbs to pull toward the end portion of the leaflet. The S-shaped path can utilize the leaflet tension during diastole to more tightly engage the leaflets with the barbs. - Each
layer clasp 600 is laser cut from a sheet of shape-memory alloy, such as Nitinol. Thetop layer 602 is aligned and attached to thebottom layer 604. In certain embodiments, thelayers barbed portion 640 of themoveable arm 630. For example, thelayers barbed portion 640, to allow the remainder of the layers to slide relative to one another. Portions of the combinedlayers fixed arm 610,barbs 644 and barb supports 646, andbeam loops 622 are bent into a desired position. Thelayers clasp 600 is then subjected to a shape-setting process so that internal forces of the material will tend to return to the set shape after being subjected to deformation by external forces. After shape-setting, thetongue 611 is moved to its preloaded position so that the cross-bar 614 can be attached. In one example embodiment, theclasp 600 can optionally be completely flattened for delivery through a delivery sheath and allowed to expand once deployed within the heart. Theclasp 600 is opened and closed by applying and releasing tension on an actuation line, suture, wire, rod, catheter, or the like (not shown) attached to themoveable arm 630. In some embodiments, he actuation line or suture is inserted through aneyelet 642 near thebarbed portion 640 of themoveable arm 630 and wraps around themoveable arm 630 before returning to the delivery sheath. In certain embodiments, an intermediate suture loop is made through the eyelet and the suture is inserted through the intermediate loop. An alternate embodiment of the intermediate loop can be composed of fabric or another material attached to the movable arm, instead of a suture loop. - An intermediate loop of suture material reduces friction experienced by the actuation line/suture relative to the friction between the actuation line/suture and the clasp material. When the suture is looped through the
eyelet 642 or intermediate loop, both ends of the actuation line/suture extend back into and through a delivery sheath (e.g.,FIG. 8 ). The suture can be removed by pulling one end of the suture proximally until the other end of the suture pulls through the eyelet or intermediate loop and back into the delivery sheath. - Referring now to
FIG. 34 , a close-up view of one of theleaflets clasps leaflet arms clasp FIG. 34 , the tissue of theleaflet barbs barbs leaflet barbs moveable arm leaflet clasp barbs leaflet clasp arm barbs clasp arms moveable arms barbs clasp barbs - Referring now to
FIGS. 35-46 , theimplantable device 500 is shown being delivered and implanted within the native mitral valve MV of the heart H. The methods and steps shown and/or discussed can be performed on a living animal or on a simulation, such as on a cadaver, cadaver heart, simulator (e.g. with the body parts, heart, tissue, etc. being simulated), etc. - As described above, the
device 500 has a covering 540 (seeFIG. 30 ) over thecoaption element 510, clasps 530,inner paddles 522 and/or theouter paddles 520. Thedevice 500 is deployed from adelivery sheath 502 and includes acoaption portion 504 and ananchor portion 506 including a plurality of anchors 508 (i.e., two in the illustrated embodiment). Thecoaption portion 504 of the device includes acoaption element 510 for implantation between theleaflets actuation 512. Actuation of the actuation element or means foractuation 512 opens and closes theanchors 508 of thedevice 500 to grasp themitral valve leaflets - The
anchors 508 of thedevice 500 includeouter paddles 520 andinner paddles 522 that are flexibly connected to thecap 514 and thecoaption element 510. Theactuation element 512 extends through a capture mechanism 503 (seeFIG. 41 ),delivery sheath 502, and thecoaption element 510 to thecap 514 connected to theanchor portion 506. Extending and retracting theactuation element 512 increases and decreases the spacing between thecoaption element 510 and thecap 514, respectively. In the example illustrated byFIGS. 35-46 , the pair of inner andouter paddles single actuation element 512. Also, the positions of theclasps 530 are dependent on the positions of thepaddles FIG. 45 closing thepaddles device 500 can be made to have thepaddles FIG. 11A embodiment. - Fingers of the
capture mechanism 503 removably attach thecollar 511 to thedelivery sheath 502. Thecollar 511 and thecoaption element 510 slide along theactuation element 512 during actuation to open and close theanchors 508 of theanchor portion 506. In some embodiments, thecapture mechanism 503 is held closed around thecollar 511 by theactuation element 512, such that removal of theactuation element 512 allows the fingers of thecapture mechanism 503 to open, releasing thecollar 511, and thus thecoaption element 510. - In some embodiments, the
coaption element 510 and paddles 520, 522 are formed from a flexible material that can be a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, or formed in any other suitable way or a laser cut or otherwise cut flexible material. The flexible material can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body. Other configurations are also possible. - The
barbed clasps 530 include a base or fixedarm 532, amoveable arm 534, barbs 536 (seeFIG. 41 ), and ajoint portion 538. The fixedarms 532 are attached to theinner paddles 522, with thejoint portions 538 disposed proximate thecoaption element 510. Sutures (not shown) attach the fixedarms 532 to theinner paddles 522. The fixedarms 532 can be attached to theinner paddles 522 and/or another portion of the device with any suitable means, such as screws or other fasteners, crimped sleeves, mechanical latches or snaps, welding, adhesive, or the like. The fixedarms 532 remain stationary or substantially stationary when themoveable arms 534 are opened to open thebarbed clasps 530 and expose thebarbs 536. Thebarbed clasps 530 are opened by applying tension to clasp control members oractuation lines 537 attached to themoveable arms 534, thereby causing themoveable arms 534 to pivot or flex on thejoint portions 538. - During implantation, the
anchors 508 are opened and closed to grasp the native valve leaflets between thepaddles coaption element 510. Theouter paddles 520 have a wide curved shape that fits around the curved shape of thecoaption element 510 to more securely grip theleaflets outer paddle 520 also prohibits tearing of the leaflet tissue. Thebarbed clasps 530 further secure the native leaflets by engaging the leaflets withbarbs 536 and pinching the leaflets between the moveable and fixedarms barbs 536 of thebarbed clasps 530 increase friction with the leaflets or may partially or completely puncture the leaflets. The actuation lines can be actuated separately so that eachbarbed clasp 530 can be opened and closed separately. Separate operation allows one leaflet to be grasped at a time, or for the repositioning of aclasp 530 on a leaflet that was insufficiently grasped, without altering a successful grasp on the other leaflet. Thebarbed clasps 530 can be fully opened and closed when theinner paddle 522 is not closed, thereby allowing leaflets to be grasped in a variety of positions as the particular situation requires. - The
device 500 is loaded in the delivery sheath in the fully open or fully extended position, because the fully open or fully extended position takes up the least space and allows the smallest catheter to be used (or thelargest device 500 to be used for a given catheter size). Referring now toFIG. 35 , the delivery sheath is inserted into the left atrium LA through the septum and thedevice 500 is deployed from thedelivery sheath 502 in the fully open condition. Theactuation element 512 is then retracted to move thedevice 500 into the fully closed condition shown inFIGS. 36-37 and then maneuvered towards the mitral valve MV as shown inFIG. 38 . Referring now toFIG. 39 , when thedevice 500 is aligned with the mitral valve MV (or other native valve, if implanted in another valve), theactuation element 512 is extended to open thepaddles actuation lines 537 are retracted to open thebarbed clasps 530 to prepare for leaflet grasp. Next, as shown inFIGS. 40-41 , the partiallyopen device 500 is inserted through the mitral valve MV untilleaflets inner paddles 522 and thecoaption element 510 and inside the openbarbed clasps 530.FIG. 42 shows thedevice 500 with bothclasps 530 closed, though thebarbs 536 of oneclasp 530 missed one of theleaflets 22. As can be seen inFIGS. 42-44 , the out ofposition clasp 530 is opened and closed again to properly grasp the missedleaflet 22. When bothleaflets actuation element 512 is retracted to move thedevice 500 into the fully closed position shown inFIG. 45 . With thedevice 500 fully implanted in the native mitral valve MV, theactuation element 512 is withdrawn to release thecapture mechanism 503 from theproximal collar 511. Once deployed, thedevice 500 can be maintained in the fully closed position with a mechanical means such as a latch or can be biased to remain closed through the use of spring material, such as steel, and/or shape-memory alloys such as Nitinol. For example, thepaddles outer paddles 520 closed around theinner paddles 522,coaption element 510, and thebarbed clasps 530 pinched aroundnative leaflets - The
device 500 can have a wide variety of different shapes and sizes. Referring toFIGS. 6 and 6A-6E , in an example embodiment, thecoaption element 510 functions as a gap filler in the valve regurgitant orifice, such as thegap 26 in the native valve illustrated byFIG. 6 . Referring toFIG. 6A , since thecoaption element 510 is deployed between two opposingvalve leaflets coaption element 510, but coapt against thecoaption element 510 instead. This reduces the distance theleaflets FIG. 6 ). Since thecoaption element 510 reduces the distance the native valves have to be approximated, the stress in the native valves can be reduced or minimized. Shorter approximation distance of thevalve leaflets coaption element 510 can reduce the transvalvular gradients. - In one example embodiment, the paddle frames 524 conform to the shape of the
coaption element 510. In one example, if thecoaption element 510 is wider than the paddle frames 524, a distance (gap) between the opposingleaflets device 500. Referring toFIGS. 6A-6E , in one example embodiment the paddles are configured to conform to the shape or geometry of thecoaption element 510. As a result, the paddles can mate with both thecoaption element 510 and the native valve. Referring toFIGS. 6D and 6E , in one example embodiment thepaddles 524 surround thecoaption element 510. Thus, when theleaflets coaption element 510, theleaflets coaption element 510 in its entirety, thus small leaks on the medial and lateral aspects of thecoaption element 510 an be prevented.FIGS. 6B and 6C illustrate thevalve repair device 500 attached tonative valve leaflets FIG. 6A illustrates thevalve repair device 500 attached tomitral valve leaflets FIGS. 6A and 6B , when the paddles have a geometry that conforms to the geometry of thecoaption element 510, theleaflets FIG. 6E , a schematic atrial view/surgeons view depicts the paddle frames (which would not actually be visible from a true atrial view), conforming to the spacer geometry. The opposingleaflets 20, 22 (the ends of which would also not be visible in the true atrial view) being approximated by the paddles, to fully surround or “hug” thecoaption element 510. - Referring to
FIGS. 6B-6E , because the paddle frames 524 conform to the shape of thecoaption element 510, thevalve leaflets medial aspects coaption element 510. This coaption of theleaflets coaption element 510 would seem to contradict the statement above that the presence of acoaption element 510 minimizes the distance the leaflets need to be approximated. However, the distance theleaflets coaption element 510 is placed precisely at a regurgitant gap and the regurgitant gap is less than the width (medial-lateral) of thecoaption element 510. - Referring to
FIGS. 6A and 6E , thecoaption element 510 can take a wide variety of different shapes. In one example embodiment, when viewed from the top (and/or sectional views from the top; seeFIGS. 95-102 ), the coaption element has an oval shape or an elliptical shape. The oval or elliptical shape can allow the paddle frames 524 co conform to the shape of the coaption element and/or can reduce lateral leaks (SeeFIGS. 65-83 ). - As mentioned above, the
coaption element 510 can reduce tension of the opposing leaflets by reducing the distance the leaflets need to be approximated to thecoaption element 510 at thepositions positions native valve leaflets device 500. Referring toFIG. 2A , as seen from a Left Ventricular Outflow Tract (LVOT) view, the anatomy of theleaflets leaflets leaflets - In one example embodiment, the
valve repair device 500 and itscoaption element 510 are designed to conform to the geometrical anatomy of thevalve leaflets valve repair device 500 can be designed to coapt the native leaflets to the coaption element, completely around the coaption element, including at the medial 601 and lateral 603 positions of thecoaption element 510. Additionally, a reduction on forces required to bring the leaflets into contact with thecoaption element 510 at thepositions FIG. 2B shows how a tapered or triangular shape of acoaption element 510 will naturally adapt to the native valve geometry and to its expanding leaflet nature (toward the annulus). -
FIG. 6D illustrates the geometry of thecoaption element 510 and thepaddle frame 524 from an LVOT perspective. As can be seen in this view, thecoaption element 510 has a tapered shape being smaller in dimension in the area closer to where the inside surfaces of theleaflets FIG. 6D , the tapered coaption element geometry, in conjunction with the illustrated expandingpaddle frame 524 shape (toward the valve annulus) can help to achieve coaptation on the lower end of the leaflets, reduce stress, and minimize transvalvular gradients. - Referring to
FIG. 6C , in one example embodiment remaining shapes of thecoaption element 510 and the paddle frames 524 can be defined based on an Intra-Commissural view of the native valve and thedevice 510. Two factors of these shapes are leaflet coaptation against thecoaption element 510 and reduction of stress on the leaflets due to the coaption. Referring toFIGS. 6C and 67 , to both coapt thevalve leaflets coaption element 510 and reduce the stress applied to thevalve leaflets coaption element 510 and/or thepaddles 524, thecoaption element 510 can have a round or rounded shape and thepaddle frame 524 can have a full radius that spans from one leg of the paddles to the other leg of the paddles. The round shape of the coaption element and/or the illustrated fully rounded shape of the paddle frame will distribute the stresses on theleaflets curved engagement area 607. For example, inFIG. 6C , the force on theleaflets paddle frame 524, as theleaflets 20 try to open during the diastole cycle. - Referring to
FIG. 67 , in one example embodiment, to cooperate with the full rounded shape of the paddle frames 524, and/or in order to maximize leaflet coaptation against thecoaption element 510 and leaflet-to-leaflet coaptation at thesides coaption element 510, the shape of the coaption element in the intra-commissural view follows a round shape. Referring toFIG. 67 , the round shape of the coaption element in this view substantially follows or is close to the shape of the paddle frames 524. - In one example embodiment, the overall shape of the
coaption element 510 is an elliptical or oval cross section when seen from the surgeon's view (top view—SeeFIG. 70 ), a tapered shape or cross section when seen from an LVOT view (side view—SeeFIG. 69 ), and a substantially round shape or rounded shape when seen from an intra-commissural view (SeeFIG. 68 ). In one example embodiment, a blend of these three geometries can result in the three-dimensional shape of the illustratedcoaption element 510 that achieves the benefits described above. - In one example embodiment, the dimensions of the coaption element are selected to minimize the number of implants that a single patient will require (preferably one), while at the same time maintaining low transvalvular gradients. In one example embodiment, the anterior-posterior distance X47B at the top of the spacer is about 5 mm, and the medial-lateral distance X67D of the spacer at its widest is about 10 mm. In one example embodiment, the overall geometry of the
device 510 can be based on these two dimensions and the overall shape strategy described above. It should be readily apparent that the use of other anterior-posterior distance anterior-posterior distance X47B and medial-lateral distance X67D as starting points for the device will result in a device having different dimensions. Further, using other dimensions and the shape strategy described above will also result in a device having different dimensions. - Tables A, B, and C provide examples of values and ranges for dimensions of the device and components of the device for some example embodiments. However, the device can have a wide variety of different shapes and sizes and need not have all or any of the dimensional values or dimensional ranges provided in Tables A, B, and C. Table A provides examples of linear dimensions X in millimeters and ranges of linear dimensions in millimeters for the device and components of the device. Table B provides examples of radius dimensions R in millimeters and ranges of radius dimensions in millimeters for the device and components of the device. Table C provides examples of angular dimensions α in degrees and ranges of angular dimensions in degrees for the device and components of the device. The subscripts for each of the dimensions indicates the drawing in which the dimension first appears.
-
TABLE A Linear Dimensions (mm) Range A Range B Range C Range D Range C Example (max) (min) (max) (min) (max) (min) (max) (min) X47A 2.8 1.4 4.2 2.1 3.5 2.52 3.08 2.66 2.94 X47B 5.3 2.65 7.95 3.975 6.625 4.77 5.83 5.035 5.565 X47C 2.8 1.4 4.2 2.1 3.5 2.52 3.08 2.66 2.94 X47D 3.3 1.65 4.95 2.475 4.125 2.97 3.63 3.135 3.465 X47E 5.4 2.7 8.1 4.05 6.75 4.86 5.94 5.13 5.67 X47F 8 4 12 6 10 7.2 8.8 7.6 8.4 X47G 1 0.5 1.5 0.75 1.25 0.9 1.1 0.95 1.05 X52A 12 6 18 9 15 10.8 13.2 11.4 12.6 X58A 11 5.5 16.5 8.25 13.75 9.9 12.1 10.45 11.55 X59A 27 13.5 40.5 20.25 33.75 24.3 29.7 25.65 28.35 X59B 8 4 12 6 10 7.2 8.8 7.6 8.4 X59C 7 3.5 10.5 5.25 8.75 6.3 7.7 6.65 7.35 X67A 2.4 1.2 3.6 1.8 3 2.16 2.64 2.28 2.52 X67B 3.7 1.85 5.55 2.775 4.625 3.33 4.07 3.515 3.885 X67C 10 5 15 7.5 12.5 9 11 9.5 10.5 X67D 10 5 15 7.5 12.5 9 11 9.5 10.5 X67E 15 7.5 22.5 11.25 18.75 13.5 16.5 14.25 15.75 X67F 1 0.5 1.5 0.75 1.25 0.9 1.1 0.95 1.05 X68 14.2 7.1 21.3 10.65 17.75 12.78 15.62 13.49 14.91 X70A 1.7 0.85 2.55 1.275 2.125 1.53 1.87 1.615 1.785 X70B 2.8 1.4 4.2 2.1 3.5 2.52 3.08 2.66 2.94 X71A 6.2 3.1 9.3 4.65 7.75 5.58 6.82 5.89 6.51 X71B 5.4 2.7 8.1 4.05 6.75 4.86 5.94 5.13 5.67 X71C 0.9 0.45 1.35 0.675 1.125 0.81 0.99 0.855 0.945 X71D 3.75 1.875 5.625 2.8125 4.6875 3.375 4.125 3.5625 3.9375 X71E 4.5 2.25 6.75 3.375 5.625 4.05 4.95 4.275 4.725 X72A 10.4 5.2 15.6 7.8 13 9.36 11.44 9.88 10.92 X91A 8.8 4.4 13.2 6.6 11 7.92 9.68 8.36 9.24 X91B 7.8 3.9 11.7 5.85 9.75 7.02 8.58 7.41 8.19 X91C 8.1 4.05 12.15 6.075 10.125 7.29 8.91 7.695 8.505 X91D 13.6 6.8 20.4 10.2 17 12.24 14.96 12.92 14.28 X92A 0.05 0.025 0.075 0.0375 0.0625 0.045 0.055 0.0475 0.0525 X92B 1.5 0.75 2.25 1.125 1.875 1.35 1.65 1.425 1.575 X92C 10.8 5.4 16.2 8.1 13.5 9.72 11.88 10.26 11.34 X95A 13.8 6.9 20.7 10.35 17.25 12.42 15.18 13.11 14.49 X96A 8.2 4.1 12.3 6.15 10.25 7.38 9.02 7.79 8.61 X96B 5.1 2.55 7.65 3.825 6.375 4.59 5.61 4.845 5.355 X96C 0.5 0.25 0.75 0.375 0.625 0.45 0.55 0.475 0.525 X97 10.8 5.4 16.2 8.1 13.5 9.72 11.88 10.26 11.34 X98A 9.8 4.9 14.7 7.35 12.25 8.82 10.78 9.31 10.29 X98B 5 2.5 7.5 3.75 6.25 4.5 5.5 4.75 5.25 X99 8 4 12 6 10 7.2 8.8 7.6 8.4 X100A 9.7 4.85 14.55 7.275 12.125 8.73 10.67 9.215 10.185 X100B 4 2 6 3 5 3.6 4.4 3.8 4.2 X101 5.2 2.6 7.8 3.9 6.5 4.68 5.72 4.94 5.46 X102A 8 4 12 6 10 7.2 8.8 7.6 8.4 X102B 2.9 1.45 4.35 2.175 3.625 2.61 3.19 2.755 3.045 X117A 4.2 2.1 6.3 3.15 5.25 3.78 4.62 3.99 4.41 X117B 14.5 7.25 21.75 10.875 18.125 13.05 15.95 13.775 15.225 X117C 13 6.5 19.5 9.75 16.25 11.7 14.3 12.35 13.65 -
TABLE B Radius Dimensions (mm) Range A Range B Range C Range D Range C Example (max) (min) (max) (min) (max) (min) (max) (min) R47A 1.3 0.65 1.95 0.975 1.625 1.17 1.43 1.235 1.365 R47B 1 0.5 1.5 0.75 1.25 0.9 1.1 0.95 1.05 R47C 0.6 0.3 0.9 0.45 0.75 0.54 0.66 0.57 0.63 R47D 5 2.5 7.5 3.75 6.25 4.5 5.5 4.75 5.25 R47E 0.75 0.375 1.125 0.5625 0.9375 0.675 0.825 0.7125 0.7875 R67A 0.75 0.375 1.125 0.5625 0.9375 0.675 0.825 0.7125 0.7875 R67B 0.9 0.45 1.35 0.675 1.125 0.81 0.99 0.855 0.945 R70A 1.4 0.7 2.1 1.05 1.75 1.26 1.54 1.33 1.47 R70B 0.4 0.2 0.6 0.3 0.5 0.36 0.44 0.38 0.42 R70C 0.6 0.3 0.9 0.45 0.75 0.54 0.66 0.57 0.63 R70D 7 3.5 10.5 5.25 8.75 6.3 7.7 6.65 7.35 R71A 1.6 0.8 2.4 1.2 2 1.44 1.76 1.52 1.68 R72A 1.85 0.925 2.775 1.3875 2.3125 1.665 2.035 1.7575 1.9425 R73A 1.9 0.95 2.85 1.425 2.375 1.71 2.09 1.805 1.995 R91A 9.2 4.6 13.8 6.9 11.5 8.28 10.12 8.74 9.66 R91B 0.3 0.15 0.45 0.225 0.375 0.27 0.33 0.285 0.315 R91C 0.3 0.15 0.45 0.225 0.375 0.27 0.33 0.285 0.315 R92A 0.75 0.375 1.125 0.5625 0.9375 0.675 0.825 0.7125 0.7875 R94A 1.65 0.825 2.475 1.2375 2.0625 1.485 1.815 1.5675 1.7325 R96A 1.7 0.85 2.55 1.275 2.125 1.53 1.87 1.615 1.785 R96B 4.7 2.35 7.05 3.525 5.875 4.23 5.17 4.465 4.935 R98A 1.3 0.65 1.95 0.975 1.625 1.17 1.43 1.235 1.365 R98B 7.6 3.8 11.4 5.7 9.5 6.84 8.36 7.22 7.98 R100A 0.9 0.45 1.35 0.675 1.125 0.81 0.99 0.855 0.945 R100B 9.6 4.8 14.4 7.2 12 8.64 10.56 9.12 10.08 R102A 0.45 0.225 0.675 0.3375 0.5625 0.405 0.495 0.4275 0.4725 R102B 8.5 4.25 12.75 6.375 10.625 7.65 9.35 8.075 8.925 R115A 9.3 4.65 13.95 6.975 11.625 8.37 10.23 8.835 9.765 R115B 7.8 3.9 11.7 5.85 9.75 7.02 8.58 7.41 8.19 R115C 7.8 3.9 11.7 5.85 9.75 7.02 8.58 7.41 8.19 R115D 6.7 3.35 10.05 5.025 8.375 6.03 7.37 6.365 7.035 R115E 1.5 0.75 2.25 1.125 1.875 1.35 1.65 1.425 1.575 -
TABLE C Angular Dimensions (degrees) Range A Range B Range C Range D Range C Example (max) (min) (max) (min) (max) (min) (max) (min) α 4712 6 18 9 15 10.8 13.2 11.4 12.6 α 91A9 4.5 13.5 6.75 11.25 8.1 9.9 8.55 9.45 α 91B14 7 21 10.5 17.5 12.6 15.4 13.3 14.7 α 91C20 10 30 15 25 18 22 19 21 α117A 39 19.5 58.5 29.25 48.75 35.1 42.9 37.05 40.95 α 117B3 1.5 4.5 2.25 3.75 2.7 3.3 2.85 3.15 - Referring now to
FIGS. 47-61 , animplantable device 500 is shown in various positions and configurations. Theimplantable device 500 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and thedevice 500 can be positioned to engagevalve tissue - The
implantable device 500 has a proximal orattachment portion 505, a coaption element 510 (e.g., spacer, etc.), inner anchor portions orinner paddles 522, outer anchor portions orouter paddles 520, anchor extension members or paddleframes 524, and adistal portion 507. Theinner paddles 522 are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) between thecoaption element 510 and theouter paddles 520. Theouter paddles 520 are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) between theinner paddles 522 and thedistal portion 507. The paddle frames 524 are attached to thecap 514 at thedistal portion 507 and extend to thejoint portion 523 between the inner andouter paddles paddles paddles inner paddles 522 are stiff, relatively stiff, rigid, have rigid portions and/or are stiffened by a stiffening member or the fixed portion of theclasps 530. The stiffening of the inner paddle allows the device to move to the various different positions shown and described herein. Theinner paddle 522, theouter paddle 520, the coaption can all be interconnected as described herein, such that thedevice 500 is constrained to the movements and positions shown and described herein. - Referring now to
FIGS. 47-48 , thedevice 500 is shown in a closed position. When closed, theinner paddles 522 are disposed between theouter paddles 520 and thecoaption element 510. In some embodiments, thedevice 500 includes clasps or gripping members 530 (FIG. 48 ) that can be opened and closed to grasp thenative leaflets clasps 530 are attached to and move with theinner paddles 522 and are disposed between theinner paddles 522 and thecoaption element 510. - Referring now to
FIGS. 49-51 , thedevice 500 is shown in a partially open position. Thedevice 500 is moved into the partially open position by an actuation element or means foractuation 512 that passes through theattachment portion 505 andcoaption element 510 and can removably engage thedistal portion 507. Theactuation element 512 is extended through theattachment portion 505 such that a distance D between theattachment portion 505 anddistal portion 507 increases as theactuation element 512 is extended. In the example illustrated byFIGS. 49-51 , the pair of inner andouter paddles single actuation element 512. Also, the positions of theclasps 530 are dependent on the positions of thepaddles FIG. 48 closing thepaddles device 500 can be made to have thepaddles FIG. 11A embodiment. - Extending the
actuation element 512 pulls down on the bottom portions of theouter paddles 520 and paddle frames 524. Theouter paddles 520 and paddleframes 524 pull down on theinner paddles 522, where theinner paddles 522 are connected to theouter paddles 520 and the paddle frames 524. Because theattachment portion 505 andcoaption element 510 are held in place, theinner paddles 522 are caused to flex or pivot in an opening direction. Theinner paddles 522, theouter paddles 520, and the paddle frames all flex to the position shown inFIG. 49 . Opening thepaddles gap 520A between thecoaption element 510 and theinner paddle 522 that can receive and grasp thenative leaflets 20. - As is described above, some embodiments of the
device 500 include clasps or grippingmembers 530. When thedevice 500 is partially opened theclasps 530 are exposed. In some embodiments, the closed clasps 530 (FIG. 50 ) can be opened (FIG. 51 ), thereby creating a second opening orgap 530A for receiving and capturing thenative leaflets gap 530A in theclasps 530 is limited to the extent that theinner paddle 522 has spread away from thecoaption element 510. - Referring now to
FIGS. 52-54 , thedevice 500 is shown in a laterally extended or open position. Thedevice 500 is moved into the laterally extended or open position by continuing to extend theactuation element 512 described above, thereby increasing the distance D between theattachment portion 505 anddistal portion 507. Continuing to extend theactuation element 512 pulls down on theouter paddles 520 and paddleframes 524, thereby causing theinner paddles 522 to spread apart further from thecoaption element 510. In the laterally extended or open position, theinner paddles 522 extend horizontally more than in other positions of thedevice 500 and form an approximately 90-degree angle with thecoaption element 510. Similarly, the paddle frames 524 are at their maximum spread position when thedevice 500 is in the laterally extended or open position. The increasedgap 520A formed in the laterally extended or open position allowsclasps 530 to open further (FIG. 54 ) before engaging thecoaption element 510, thereby increasing the size of thegap 530A. - Referring now to
FIGS. 55-57 , thedevice 500 is shown in a three-quarters extended position. Thedevice 500 is moved into the three-quarters extended position by continuing to extend theactuation element 512 described above, thereby increasing the distance D between theattachment portion 505 anddistal portion 507. Continuing to extend theactuation element 512 pulls down on theouter paddles 520 and paddleframes 524, thereby causing theinner paddles 522 to spread apart further from thecoaption element 510. In the three-quarters extended position, theinner paddles 522 are open beyond 90 degrees to an approximately 135-degree angle with thecoaption element 510. The paddle frames 524 are less spread than in the laterally extended or open position and begin to move inward toward theactuation element 512 as theactuation element 512 extends further. Theouter paddles 520 also flex back toward theactuation element 512. As with the laterally extended or open position, the increasedgap 520A formed in the laterally extended or open position allowsclasps 530 to open even further (FIG. 57 ), thereby increasing the size of thegap 530A. - Referring now to
FIG. 58 , thedevice 500 is shown in an almost fully extended position. Thedevice 500 is moved into the almost fully extended position by continuing to extend theactuation element 512 described above, thereby increasing the distance D between theattachment portion 505 anddistal portion 507. Continuing to extend theactuation element 512 pulls down on theouter paddles 520 and paddleframes 524, thereby causing theinner paddles 522 to spread apart further from thecoaption element 510. In the almost fully extended position theinner paddles 522 begin to approach an approximately 180-degree angle with thecoaption element 510. Although the inner paddles move to this position, theouter paddles 520 and the paddle frames 522 never move or flex to or past a ninety-degree angle with respect to thecoaption element 510. In the almost fully extended position the inner andouter paddles - Referring now to
FIGS. 59-61 , thedevice 500 is shown in a fully extended position. Thedevice 500 is moved into the fully extended position by continuing to extend theactuation element 512 described above, thereby increasing the distance D between theattachment portion 505 anddistal portion 507 to a maximum distance allowable by thedevice 500. Continuing to extend theactuation element 512 pulls down on theouter paddles 520 and paddleframes 524, thereby causing theinner paddles 522 to spread apart further from thecoaption element 510. Theouter paddles 520 and paddleframes 524 move to a position where they are close to the actuation element. In the fully extended position, theinner paddles 522 are open to an approximately 180-degree angle with thecoaption element 510. The inner andouter paddles paddles device 500 provides the maximum size of thegap 520A between the paddles, and, in some embodiments, allowsclasps 530 to also open fully to approximately 180 degrees (FIG. 61 ) between portions of theclasp 530. The position of thedevice 500 is the narrowest configuration. Thus, the fully extended position of thedevice 500 may be a desirable position for bailout of thedevice 500 from an attempted implantation or may be a desired position for placement of the device in a delivery catheter, or the like. - Referring now to
FIGS. 47A, 48A-48H, 53A-53C, 54A-54D, 60A-60D, and 61A-61D , animplantable device 500A is shown in various positions and configurations. Theimplantable device 500A can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and thedevice 500A can be positioned to engagevalve tissue - The
implantable device 500A has a proximal orattachment portion 505A, acoaption element 510A, inner anchor portions orinner paddles 522A, outer anchor portions orouter paddles 520A, anchor extension members or paddleframes 524A, and adistal portion 507A. Theinner paddles 522A are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) between thecoaption element 510A, e.g., byjoint portions 525A and theouter paddles 520A byjoint portions 523A. Theouter paddles 520A are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) between theinner paddles 522A, e.g., byjoint portions 523A and thedistal portion 507A byjoint portions 521A. The paddle frames 524A are attached to thecap 514A (FIG. 48A ) at thedistal portion 507A and extend to thejoint portion 523A between the inner andouter paddles paddles paddles joint portions 523A (FIG. 65A ). In some embodiments, theinner paddles 522A are stiff, relatively stiff, rigid, have rigid portions and/or are stiffened by a stiffening member or the fixed portion of theclasps 530C. The stiffening of the inner paddle allows the device to move to the various different positions shown and described herein. Theinner paddle 522A, theouter paddle 520A, and the coaption element can all be interconnected as described herein, such that thedevice 500A is constrained to the movements and positions shown and described herein. - The
coaption element 510A,inner paddles 522A,outer paddles 520A can be attached together by integrally forming thecoaption element 510A and thepaddles coaption element 510A and thepaddles continuous strip 501A of a braided or woven material, such as braided or woven nitinol wire. - The
continuous strip 501A is attached acollar 511D, acap 514A, paddle frames 524A, clasps 530C. In the illustrated embodiment, thecoaption element 510A,hinge portions outer paddles 520A, andinner paddles 522A are formed from thecontinuous strip 501A. Thecontinuous strip 501A can be a single layer of material or can include two or more layers. In certain embodiments, portions of thedevice 500A have a single layer of the strip ofmaterial 501A and other portions are formed from multiple overlapping or overlying layers of the strip ofmaterial 501A. For example,FIG. 47A shows thecoaption element 510A andinner paddles 522A formed from multiple overlapping or overlying layers of the strip ofmaterial 501A. Consequently, thecoaption element 510A andinner paddle 522A have an increased stiffness relative to theouter paddles 520A that are formed from a single layer ofmaterial 501A. The single continuous strip ofmaterial 501A can start and end in various locations of thedevice 500A. The ends of the strip ofmaterial 501A can be in the same location or different locations of thedevice 500A. For example, in the illustrated embodiment ofFIG. 47A , the strip of material begins and ends in the location of theinner paddles 522. - The
clasps 530C can comprise attachment or fixedportions 532C, arm ormoveable portions 534C,barbs 536C, andjoint portions 538C. The attachment or fixedportions 532C can be coupled to theinner paddles 522A in various ways such as with sutures, adhesive, fasteners, welding, stitching, swaging, friction fit and/or other means for coupling with thejoint portions 538C disposed proximate thecoaption element 510A. Theclasps 530C can be similar toclasps 430, - The
moveable portions 534C can pivot or flex relative to the fixedportions 532C between an open configuration (e.g.,FIG. 54A ) and a closed configuration (FIG. 48A ). In some embodiments, theclasps 530C can be biased to the closed configuration. In the open configuration, the fixedportions 532C and themoveable portions 534C pivot or flex away from each other such that native leaflets can be positioned between thefixed portions 532C and themoveable portions 534C. In the closed configuration, the fixedportions 532C and themoveable portions 534C pivot or flex toward each other, thereby clamping the native leaflets between thefixed portions 532C and themoveable portions 534C. The fixedarms 532C remain stationary or substantially stationary when themoveable arms 534C are opened to open thebarbed clasps 530C and expose thebarbs 536C. Thebarbed clasps 530C are opened by applying tension toactuation lines 516A attached to themoveable arms 534C, thereby causing themoveable arms 534C to pivot or flex on thejoint portions 538C. - Referring now to
FIGS. 47A, and 48A-48H , thedevice 500A is shown in a closed position. A side view of thedevice 500A is shown inFIGS. 48B, 48C, and 48F , from a front view in FiguresFIGS. 48D, 48E, and 48G , and from a bottom view inFIG. 48H . Thedevice 500A is narrower when viewed from the front than the side. From the side, thedevice 500A has a generally inverted trapezoidal shape that is rounded and tapers toward thedistal portion 507A of thedevice 500A. From the front, thedevice 500A has a generally rounded rectangle shape that tapers somewhat toward thedistal portion 507A. As can be seen from the bottom view of thedevice 500A shown inFIG. 48H , thedevice 500A has a generally rounded rectangle shape when viewed from below (and when viewed from above as can be seen in, for example,FIG. 70A ). - In the closed configuration of the
device 500A, theinner paddles 522A are disposed between theouter paddles 520A and thecoaption element 510A. In some embodiments, thedevice 500A includes clasps or grippingmembers 530C (FIG. 48A ) that can be opened and closed to grasp thenative leaflets clasps 530C are attached to and move with theinner paddles 522A and are disposed between theinner paddles 522A and thecoaption element 510A. - Referring now to
FIGS. 48B-48D , thedevice 500A is shown attached to adelivery device 502A. Thedelivery device 502A has actuatable members orfingers 503A that releasably engage theattachment portion 505A. Anactuation element 512A extends from thedelivery device 502A to thecap 514A through theattachment portion 505A andcoaption element 510A of theprosthetic device 500A. Extending and retracting theactuation element 512A causes thedevice 500A to open and close, as is described below. Actuation lines/sutures 516A extend from thedelivery device 502A to attach to theclasps 530C. Tension can be applied to thesutures 516A to open theclasps 530C and released to allow theclasps 530C to close. Thedevice 500A is shown separated from thedelivery device 502A in a deployed condition inFIGS. 48F-48G . - Referring now to
FIGS. 48C and 48E , thedevice 500A is shown with acover 540A. Thecover 540A can be formed from a single piece of material, or from multiple segments abutting or joined to each other. In the illustrated embodiment, thecover 540A has an outer orlower cover 541A and an inner orupper cover 543A. Theouter cover 541A covers thecap 514A,outer paddles 520A,inner paddles 522A, and clasps 530C. Theinner cover 543A covers thecoaption element 510A and the proximal ends of theinner paddles 522A and clasps 530C where thecoaption element 510A meets theinner paddles 522A and clasps 530C. Thecover 540A can be a cloth material such as polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh. The cloth cover can provide a blood seal on the surface of the spacer, and/or promote rapid tissue ingrowth. - Referring now to
FIGS. 53A-53D and 54A-54D , thedevice 500A is shown in a laterally extended or open position. Thedevice 500A is moved into the open position by the actuation element or means foractuation 512A that passes through theattachment portion 505A andcoaption element 510A and can removably engage thedistal portion 507A. Theactuation element 512A is extended through theattachment portion 505A such that a distance D2 between theattachment portion 505A anddistal portion 507A increases as theactuation element 512A is extended. In the example illustrated byFIGS. 53A-53D and 54A-54D , the pair of inner andouter paddles single actuation element 512A. Also, the positions of theclasps 530C are dependent on the positions of thepaddles FIG. 48A closing thepaddles clasps 530C. In one example embodiment, thedevice 500A can be made to have thepaddles FIG. 11A embodiment. - Extending the
actuation element 512A pulls down on the bottom portions of theouter paddles 520A and paddleframes 524A to transition thedevice 500A from a closed to partially open position. Theouter paddles 520A and paddleframes 524A pull down on theinner paddles 522A where theinner paddles 522A are connected to theouter paddles 520A and the paddle frames 524A. Because theattachment portion 505A andcoaption element 510A are held in place, theinner paddles 522A are caused to pivot or flex in an opening direction. Theinner paddles 522A, theouter paddles 520A, and the paddle frames all flex to the position shown inFIG. 53A . Opening thepaddles gap 520D between thecoaption element 510A and theinner paddle 522A that can receive and grasp thenative leaflets 20. - Continuing to extend the
actuation element 512A pulls down on theouter paddles 520A and paddleframes 524A, thereby causing theinner paddles 522A to spread apart further from thecoaption element 510A. In the laterally extended or open position, theinner paddles 522A extend horizontally more than in other positions of thedevice 500A and form an approximately 90-degree angle with thecoaption element 510A. Similarly, the paddle frames 524A are at their maximum spread position when thedevice 500A is in the laterally extended or open position. The increasedgap 520D formed in the laterally extended or open position allowsclasps 530C to open further (FIG. 54A ) before engaging thecoaption element 510A, thereby increasing the size of thegap 530D as compared to the partially open position. - As is described above, some embodiments of the
device 500A include clasps or grippingmembers 530A. When thedevice 500A is opened theclasps 530C are exposed. In some embodiments, theclosed clasps 530C (FIGS. 53A-53D ) can be opened (FIGS. 54A-54D ), thereby creating a second opening orgap 530D for receiving and capturing thenative leaflets gap 530D in theclasps 530C is limited to the extent that theinner paddle 522A has spread away from thecoaption element 510A. - Referring now to
FIGS. 60A-60D and 61A-61D , thedevice 500A is shown in a fully extended position. Thedevice 500A is moved into the fully extended position by continuing to extend theactuation element 512A described above, thereby increasing the distance D2 between theattachment portion 505A anddistal portion 507A to a maximum distance allowable by thedevice 500A. Continuing to extend theactuation element 512A pulls down on theouter paddles 520A and paddleframes 524A, thereby causing theinner paddles 522A to extend further away from thecoaption element 510A. Theouter paddles 520A and paddleframes 524A move to a position where they are close to the actuation element. In the fully extended position, theinner paddles 522A are open to an approximately 180-degree angle with thecoaption element 510A. The inner andouter paddles paddles device 500A provides the maximum size of thegap 520D between the paddles, and, in some embodiments, allowsclasps 530C to also open fully to approximately 180 degrees (FIG. 61A ) between portions of theclasp 530A. The position of thedevice 500A is the narrowest configuration. Thus, the fully extended position of thedevice 500A may be a desirable position for bailout of thedevice 500A from an attempted implantation or may be a desired position for placement of the device in a delivery catheter, or the like. - Referring now to
FIGS. 197-198 , enlarged views of portions ofFIG. 60C are shown. Referring now toFIG. 197 , theinner cover 543A can be seen covering thecoaption element 510A from theproximal portion 519B to thedistal portion 517A. In some embodiments, theinner cover 543A is formed from a flat sheet (seeFIG. 201 ) of a cloth material such as polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh and is folded around thecoaption element 510A and held in place bystitches 545A. Referring now toFIG. 198 , theouter cover 541A can be seen covering theclasps 530C andinner paddles 522A.Collar portions 548A ofinner cover 543A cover the portion of theclasps 530C andinner paddles 522A closest to thecoaption element 510A.Transition portions 547A of theinner cover 543A extend from thecoaption element 510A to thecollar portions 548A to provide a smooth transition between thecoaption element 510A and theclasps 530C andinner paddles 522A so that native tissue is not caught on thedevice 500A during implantation. - Referring now to
FIG. 199 , an exploded view of thedevice 500A is shown. Thecoaption element 510A,outer paddles 520A, andinner paddles 522A are formed from a single strip ofmaterial 501A, as described above. Thecollar 511D,cap 514A, paddle frames 524A, and clasps 530C are assembled to the strip ofmaterial 501A to form thedevice 500A. Thecap 514A includes aretention body 560A with a lockingaperture 561A for receiving a retainingnut 562A having a threadedbore 564A that engages a threadedportion 568A of a retainingbolt 566A. The threadedportion 568A of the retainingbolt 566A is inserted through theopening 527B to engage the retention body andnut cap 514A to the strip ofmaterial 501A. - In some embodiments, a stiffening member 539C is attached to the
inner paddle 522A to stiffen theinner paddle 522A to maintain the inner paddle in a straight or substantially straight configuration as the inner paddle is moved between the various positions. Acutout 539D in the stiffening member 539C is shaped to receive the fixedarm 532C of theclasp 530C so that the stiffening member 539C can fit around the fixedarm 532C when both the stiffening member 539C andclasp 530C are attached to theinner paddle 522A. Like the fixedarm 532C, the stiffening member 539C can be coupled to theinner paddles 522A in various ways such as with sutures, adhesive, fasteners, welding, stitching, swaging, friction fit and/or other means for coupling. - Referring now to
FIG. 200 , an enlarged view of thecollar 511A attached to theproximal portion 519B of thecoaption element 510A is shown. Thecollar 511A includes protrusions 511B for releasably engaging thefingers 503A of thedelivery device 502A. Anaperture 515A in thecollar 511A receives theactuation element 512A. Theproximal portion 519B of thecoaption element 510A flares outward to form two loops 519D that are inserted through thearcuate openings 513A of thecollar 511D to attach thecollar 511D to theproximal portion 519B of thecoaption element 510A. The loops 519D are formed by folding the strip ofmaterial 501A to form first andsecond layers arcuate openings 513A include an opening (not shown) similar to the - Referring now to
FIGS. 201-202 , enlarged and exploded views of thecap 514A are shown, respectively.FIG. 201 shows an enlarged view of thecap 514A attached to thedistal portion 527A of the strip ofmaterial 501A is shown. Theretention body 560A, retainingnut 562A, and retainingbolt 566A cooperate to attach the paddle frames 524A to thedistal portion 527A of the strip ofmaterial 501A. In particular, the retainingbolt 566A is inserted through theopening 527B of thedistal portion 527A (FIG. 202 ) to prohibit movement of thecap 514A along the strip ofmaterial 501A. Achannel 560B in theretention body 560A and aflange 567A of thebolt 566A form a passageway 514B through thecap 514A for thedistal portion 527A. - Referring now to
FIG. 202 , the components of thecap 514A are shown in an exploded view to better illustrate the features of the components of thecap 514A and paddleframes 524A and to show how those features interlock during assembly of thecap 514A to thedistal portion 527A. Forming thecap 514A from multiple components that can be assembled around the strip ofmaterial 501A allows thecap 514A to be attached after the strip ofmaterial 501A has been folded to form thecoaption element 510A and paddles 520A, 522A and been woven through thecollar 511D and paddleframes 524A. - The
retention body 560A includes a lockingaperture 561A for receiving the retainingnut 562A. The lockingaperture 561A has a generally rectangular shape and includes two opposing lockingchannels 561B that receive theattachment portions 524C of the paddle frames 524A. Atransverse locking channel 561C formed in the bottom of theretention body 560A has the same width as the lockingchannels 561B. The paddle frames 524A includenotches 524D in theattachment portions 524C that formhook portions 524E that engage thetransverse locking channel 561A to secure the paddle frames 524A to thecap 514A. - The retaining
nut 562A includes arectangular locking body 563A extending distally from a flange 563B. The lockingbody 563A is configured to slidably engage the lockingaperture 561A of theretention body 560A while leaving the lockingchannels 561B unobstructed. Thus, the lockingbody 563A can be inserted into the lockingaperture 561A to lock theattachment portions 524C of the paddle frames 524A within the lockingchannels 561B.Notches 563C in the flange 563B accommodate theattachment portions 524C of the paddle frames 524A. The threadedbore 564A is formed through the retainingnut 562A to receive the retainingbolt 566A. - The retaining
bolt 566A includes a threadedportion 568A extending from theflange 567A. The threadedportion 568A is inserted through theopening 527B in thedistal portion 527A to threadedly engage the threadedbore 564A of the retainingnut 562A. Theflange 567A has a rounded shape that provides a rounded end to thedistal portion 505A of thedevice 500A. Theflange 567A includesopenings 567B for receiving a tool (not shown) that engages thebolt 566A so that thebolt 566A can be turned during assembly to couple the components of thecap 514A together. - To assemble the paddle frames 524A and cap 514A to the
distal portion 527A, the paddle frames 524A are squeezed to narrow the width of theattachment portion 524C so that theattachment portions 524C can be inserted into the lockingchannels 561B of the lockingaperture 561A. When the paddle frames 524A are allowed to expand, theattachment portions 524C expand outward so that thenotches 524D engage theretention body 560A and thehook portions 524E engage thetransverse locking channel 561C. The retainingnut 562A is then inserted into the lockingaperture 561A with the lockingportion 563A arranged between the twoattachment portions 524C of eachpaddle frame 524A, thereby locking the paddle frames 524A in engagement with theretention body 560A. The assembledpaddle frames 524A,retention body 560A, and retainingnut 562A are placed on thedistal portion 527A so that the threadedbore 564A aligns with theopening 527B and the threadedportion 568A of thebolt 566A is inserted through theopening 527B to threadedly engage the threadedbore 564A. Thebolt 566A is then tightened until theflange 567A engages theretention body 560A and thecap 514A is securely assembled to thedistal portion 527A. - Referring now to
FIGS. 203 and 204 , portions of thecover 540A are shown cut from flat sheets of material. Thecover 540A includes theouter cover 541A and theinner cover 543A. Each of thecovers device 500A. In particular, thecovers device 500A to reduce catch points and provide a smoother exterior to thedevice 500. - The various segments of the
covers device 500A. In other embodiments, the portion of thecover device 500A is located at an end of thecovers covers covers device 500A. Thecover 540A can be made of any suitable material, such as a polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh. In certain embodiments, the cover is formed out of a single piece of material. In other embodiments, the cover can be formed of any number of pieces of material that are attached to the device and/or joined together by any suitable means, such as by stitching, adhesives, welding, or the like. - Referring to
FIGS. 60C and 204 , theouter cover 541A extends outward from amiddle portion 580 to endportions 588. Themiddle portion 580 is shaped to be attached to thecap 514A of thedevice 500A.Outer paddle portions 582 extend from themiddle portion 580 to inner paddle and insideclasp portions 584. The inner paddle and insideclasp portions 584 extend from theouter paddle portions 582 to outsidemoveable clasp portions 586. The outsidemoveable clasp portions 586 extend from theinner paddle portions 584 to theend portions 588. - The
outer paddle portions 582 includewing portions 583 that extend laterally to a width that is wider than the other portions of theouter cover 541A so that theouter paddle portions 582 can attach to theouter paddles 520A and paddleframes 524A of thedevice 500A. Theinner paddle portions 584 attach to theinner paddles 522A,stationary arms 532C, and the inside surface (the side with the barbs) of themoveable arms 534C. Theoutside clasp portions 586 attach to the outside surface (the side without the barbs) of themoveable arms 534C of theclasps 530C. The ends 588 of theouter cover 541A terminate near thejoint portion 538C of theclasp 530C on the outside of theclasps 530C. The inner paddle and insideclasp portions 584 includeopenings 585 that allow thebarbs 536C of theclasps 530C to protrude through theouter cover 541A to engage tissue of the native heart valve. - Referring to
FIGS. 60C and 203 , theinner cover 543A extends outward from amiddle portion 590 to endportions 598. Themiddle portion 590 is configured to be attached to thecollar 511D of thedevice 500A.Openings 591 in themiddle portion 590 expose theprotrusions 511E from thecollar 511D when themiddle portion 590 is attached to thecollar 511D so that theprotrusions 511E can be engaged by thedelivery device 502A.Coaption portions 592 extend from themiddle portion 590 toflexible hinge portions 594.Holes 593 along the edges of thecoaption portions 592 allow each of thecoaption portions 592 to be joined together after being folded around thecoaption element 510A, such as, for example, bystitches 545A. Theflexible hinge portions 594 extend from thecoaption portions 592 to transitionportions 596. Thetransition portions 596 extend from theflexible hinge portions 594 to theend portions 598.Holes 597 along the edges of thetransition portions 596 allow each of thetransition portions 596 to be wrapped around theinner paddle 522A and ends of theclasp 536C and secured to itself by stitches or other suitable securing means. Theflexible hinge portions 594 bridge the gaps between thecoaption element 510A and theclasps 530C when thedevice 500A is opened, as can be seen inFIG. 198 . - Referring now to
FIGS. 62A-64C , animplantable device 700 is shown. Theimplantable device 700 haspaddles 702 that open and close to graspleaflets gripping devices 704. Thepaddles 702 move to create anopening 706 between thepaddles 702 andgripping devices 704 in which theleaflets device 700 can be configured to close a wide gap 26 (FIG. 6 ) in the native heart valve MV, TV. In addition, theimplantable device 700 can include any other features for a device discussed in the present application, and thedevice 700 can be positioned to engagevalve leaflets device 700 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and thedevice 700 can be positioned to engagevalve tissue - Referring to
FIG. 62A , thepaddles 702 of thedevice 700 are moved, rotated, or pivoted outward in the direction X to create anopening 706 between thepaddles 702 and the grippingmembers 704 having a width W. The width W can be, for example, between about 5 mm and about 15 mm, such as between 7.5 mm and about 12.5 mm, such as about 10 mm. In alternative embodiments, the width W can be less than 5 mm or greater than 15 mm. - Referring to
FIG. 62B , thepaddles 702 of thedevice 700 are moved outward in the direction Z such that theopening 706 has a width H. The width H can be, for example, between about 10 mm and about 25 mm, such as between about 10 mm and about 20 mm, such as between about 12.5 mm and about 17.5 mm, such as about 15 mm. In some embodiments, the width H can be less than 10 mm or more than 25 mm. In certain embodiments, the ratio between the width H and the width W can be about 5 to 1 or less, such as about 4 to 1 or less such as about 3 to 1 or less, such as about 2 to 1 or less, such as about 1.5 to 1 or less, such as about 1.25 to 1 or less, such as about 1 to 1. Thedevice 700 can be configured such that thepaddles 702 are moved, rotated, or pivoted outward in the direction X and then moved outward in the direction Z to create theopening 706 having a width H between thepaddles 702 and the grippingmembers 704. Optionally, thedevice 700 can be configured such that the paddles are moved outward in the direction Z and then moved or pivoted outward in the direction X to create width H between thepaddles 702 andgripping members 704. In addition, thedevice 700 can be configured such that thepaddles 702 are moved or pivoted outward in the direction X and moved outward in the direction Z simultaneously to create the width H between thepaddles 702 and the grippingmembers 704. -
FIGS. 63A-63C illustrate animplantable device 700 in which thepaddles 702 are moved, rotated, or pivoted outward in the direction X, and, subsequently, moved outward in the direction Z to create awider opening 706.FIG. 63A illustrates theimplantable device 700 in a closed position, such that thepaddles 702 are engaging the grippingmembers 704. Referring toFIG. 63B , thepaddles 702 are moved or pivoted outward in the direction X to create anopening 706 having a width W for receiving valve tissue. Referring toFIG. 63C , after thepaddles 702 are moved or pivoted outward in the direction X, thepaddles 702 are moved outward in the direction Z such that theopening 706 has a width H. After valve tissue is received in theopenings 706 between thepaddles 702 and the grippingmembers 704, the valve repair device is moved back to the closed position (as shown inFIG. 63A ) to secure thevalve repair device 700 to the valve tissue. Theimplantable device 700 can include any other features for an implantable device discussed in the present application, and theimplantable device 700 can be positioned to engagevalve tissue -
FIGS. 64A-64C illustrate animplantable device 700 in which thepaddles 702 are moved outward in the direction Z, and, subsequently, moved, extended, or pivoted outward in the direction X to create awider opening 706.FIG. 64A illustrates theimplantable device 700 in a closed position, such that thepaddles 702 are engaging the grippingmembers 704. Referring toFIG. 64B , thepaddles 702 are moved outward in the direction Z to create anopening 706 having a width W for receiving valve tissue. Referring toFIG. 64C , after thepaddles 702 are moved outward in the direction Z, thepaddles 702 are moved or pivoted outward in the direction X such that theopening 706 has a width H. After valve tissue is received in theopenings 706 between thepaddles 702 and the grippingmembers 704, theimplantable device 700 is moved back to the closed position (as shown inFIG. 64A ) to secure theimplantable device 700 to the valve tissue. Theimplantable device 700 can include any other features for an implantable device discussed in the present application, and theimplantable device 700 can be positioned to engagevalve tissue - While
FIGS. 63A-63C illustrate adevice 700 in which thepaddles 702 are moved or pivoted and then spread apart, andFIGS. 64A-64C illustrate adevice 700 in which thepaddles 702 are spread apart and then moved or pivoted, in alternative embodiments, adevice 700 can includepaddles 702 that can be spread apart and moved or pivoted simultaneously. In addition, in certain embodiments, thepaddles 702 can be spread apart and moved or pivoted independently of each other. That is, in the embodiments for thevalve repair device 700 shown inFIGS. 63A-63C and 64A-64C , as well as the embodiment in which the spreading apart and moving or pivoting of eachpaddle 702 is completed simultaneously, thepaddles 702 can be controlled independently of each other. - Referring now to
FIGS. 65-83 , the exampleimplantable device 500 is shown in the closed condition. Referring now toFIGS. 65-66 , thedevice 500 extends from aproximal portion 505 to adistal portion 507 and includes acoaption portion 510,inner paddles 522,outer paddles 520, and paddle frames 524. In some embodiments, theouter paddles 520 extend to and/or around the paddle frames 524 and can have more than one layer to surround the paddle frames 524. Theproximal portion 505 can include acollar 511 for attaching a delivery device (not shown). Thedistal portion 507 can include acap 514 that is attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) to theouter paddles 520 and is engaged by an actuation element (not shown) to open and close thedevice 500 to facilitate implantation in the native valve as described in the present application. - Referring now to
FIGS. 67-68 , a front view of thedevice 500 is shown. Thedevice 500 has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a vertical front-to-back plane 550 and is generally narrower at thedistal portion 507 than theproximal portion 505. The shape of thecoaption element 510 and paddleframes 524 is rounded or generally rounded to prevent thedevice 500 from catching or snagging on structures of the heart, such as the chordae tendineae, during implantation. For this reason, the proximal collar 511 (FIG. 68 ) and cap 514 (FIG. 68 ) also have round edges. When viewed from the front or back, the paddle frames 524 can be seen to have a rounded or generally rounded shape, extending upwards and outwards from thedistal portion 507 to approximately coincide with the shape of thecoaption element 510 when viewed from the front or back. Thus, thecoaption element 510 and paddleframes 524 generally define the shape of thedevice 500 when viewed from the front or back. In addition, the rounded shape of the paddle frames 524 and the corresponding rounded shape of the coaption element can distribute leaflet stress across a wider surface. In some example embodiments, the paddle frames 524 and/or thecoaption element 510 can have other shapes. - Referring now to
FIG. 69 , a side view of thedevice 500 is shown. As with the front and back views (FIGS. 67-68 ), thedevice 500 has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a vertical side-to-side plane 552 when viewed from the side. Thedistal portion 507 is also generally narrower than theproximal portion 505 when thedevice 500 is viewed from the side. Thecoaption element 510 optionally also has a tapering or generally tapering shape that narrows toward thedistal portion 507 of thedevice 500. However, in some example embodiments, the coaption element does not taper as it extends from the proximal portion of the device to the distal portion of the device. - The rounded features of the
device 500 are further demonstrated by the round shape of thepaddles outer paddles paddles frames 524 can take a wide variety of different forms. For example, thepaddles paddles paddles - The closed paddles 520, 522
form gaps 542 between theinner paddles 522 and thecoaption element 510 that are configured to receive native tissue. As can be seen inFIG. 69 , the narrowing of thecoaption element 510 gives the gaps 542 a somewhat teardrop shape that increases in width as thegaps 542 approach thedistal portion 507 of the device. The widening of thegaps 542 toward thedistal portion 507 allows thepaddles gaps 542 nearer to theproximal portion 505. - The paddle frames 524 extend vertically from the
distal portion 507 toward theproximal portion 505 until approximately a middle third of thedevice 500 before bending or flaring outward so that the connection portion of theframes 524 passes throughgaps 544 formed by theinner paddles 522 folded inside of theouter paddles 520. However, in other embodiments the connection of the frames are positioned inside theinner paddles 522 or outside theouter paddles 520. Theouter paddles 520 have a rounded shape that is similar to that of thecoaption element 510 when viewed from the front or back (FIGS. 67-68 ). Thus, thedevice 500 has a rounded shape or substantially round shape. The round shape of thedevice 500 is particularly visible when thedevice 500 is viewed from the top (FIGS. 70-71 ) or bottom (FIGS. 72-73 ). - Referring now to
FIGS. 70-71 , top views of thedevice 500 are shown. Thedevice 500 has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a front-to-back plane 550 and is also symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a side-to-side plane 552 when viewed from the top. Anopening 519A in thecoaption element 510 is visible at theproximal portion 505 of thedevice 500. As can be seen inFIG. 70 , thecoaption element 510 can be hollow inside. Theproximal collar 511 shown inFIG. 71 can be secured to thecoaption element 510 to close off thecoaption element 510. - In one example embodiment, the coaption element is not planar and has all curved surfaces. For example, the
coaption elements 510 illustrated herein can be formed of a series of blended surfaces have a variety of different radii of curvature. Thecoaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval-shape when viewed from the top. However, in some example embodiments, thecoaption element 510 can have other shapes when viewed from the top. For example, the coaption element can have a rectangular, square, diamond, elliptical, or any other shape. The paddle frames 224 each have an arcuate shape with a smaller radius than thecoaption element 510 so that thegaps 542 formed between theinner paddles 522 and paddleframes 524 and thecoaption element 510 taper as they approach left 551 and right 553 sides of thedevice 500. Thus, native tissue, such as theleaflets coaption element 510 towards the left andright sides device 500. - Referring now to
FIGS. 72-73 , bottom views of thedevice 500 are shown. As with the top views (FIGS. 70-71 ), thedevice 500 has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around the front-to-back plane 550 and is also symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around the side-to-side plane 552 when viewed from the bottom. Thecap 514 is shown inFIG. 73 and can jointably attach to theouter paddles 520 and the paddle frames 524. - The paddle frames 524 extend outward from the
distal portion 507 of thedevice 500 to the left andright sides side plane 552. The paddle frames 524 extend further away from the side-to-side plane 552 as the paddle frames 524 extend toward the proximal portion of the device 500 (FIG. 69 ) to ultimately form the arcuate shape seen inFIGS. 70-71 . - Referring now to
FIGS. 74-83 , perspective and cross-sectional views of thedevice 500 are shown. Referring now toFIG. 74 , thedevice 500 is shown sliced by cross-section plane 75 near the proximal portion of thecoaption element 510. Referring now toFIG. 75 , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500 is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 75 inFIG. 74 . At the location of the plane 75, thecoaption element 510 has a round or generally round shape with lobes arranged along the front-to-back plane 550. Thegaps 542 between the paddle frames 524 andcoaption element 510 form a crescent-like shape with acentral width 543. As noted above, thegaps 542 narrow as thegaps 542 approach the left andright sides - Referring now to
FIG. 76 , thedevice 500 is shown sliced bycross-section plane 77 positioned about three-quarters of the way between thedistal portion 507 and theproximal portion 505 of thecoaption element 510. Referring now toFIG. 77 , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500 is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 77 inFIG. 76 . At the location of the plane 75, thecoaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552. Thegaps 542 between the paddle frames 524 andcoaption element 510 form a crescent or crescent-like shape with acentral width 543 that is less than thecentral width 543 seen inFIG. 75 . At the location of theplane 77, thewidth 543 of thegaps 542 is narrower towards the center of the device, widens somewhat as thegaps 542 approach the left andright sides gaps 542 about three-quarters of the way up thecoaption element 510. - Referring now to
FIG. 78 , thedevice 500 is shown sliced bycross-section plane 79 positioned about half of the way between thedistal portion 507 and theproximal portion 505 of thecoaption element 510. Referring now toFIG. 79 , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500 is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 79 inFIG. 78 . At the location of theplane 79, thecoaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552. The paddle frames 524 can be seen near the left andright sides coaption element 510. Thegaps 542 are crescent or generally crescent shaped and are wider than thegaps 542 viewed along the plane 77 (FIG. 77 .) - Referring now to
FIG. 80 , thedevice 500 is shown sliced bycross-section plane 81 positioned about one-quarter of the way between thedistal portion 507 and theproximal portion 505 of thecoaption element 510. Referring now toFIG. 81 , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500 is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 81 inFIG. 80 . At the location of theplane 81, thecoaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552 that is narrower than the oval shape seen inFIG. 77 . The paddle frames 524 can be seen near the left andright sides coaption element 510. Thegaps 542 are crescent or generally crescent shaped and are wider than thegaps 542 viewed along the plane 79 (FIG. 79 .) - Referring now to
FIG. 82 , thedevice 500 is shown sliced bycross-section plane 83 positioned near thedistal portion 507 of thecoaption element 510. Referring now toFIG. 83 , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500 is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 83 inFIG. 82 . At the location of theplane 83, thecoaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552 that is narrower than the oval shape seen inFIG. 79 as thecoaption element 510 tapers toward thedistal portion 507 of thedevice 500. The paddle frames 524 can be seen near the left andright sides coaption element 510. While theinner paddles 522 are not visible inFIG. 81 , thegaps 542 are crescent or generally crescent shaped and are wider than thegaps 542 viewed along the plane 81 (FIG. 81 .) - Referring now to
FIGS. 65A, 66A, 67A, 68A, 70A, 71A, 72A, 73A, 74A, 75A, 76A, 77A, 78A, 79A, 80A, 81A, 82A, and 83A , the exampleimplantable device 500A is shown in the closed condition. Referring now toFIGS. 65A and 66A , thedevice 500A extends from aproximal portion 505A to adistal portion 507A and includes acoaption portion 510A,inner paddles 522A,outer paddles 520A, and paddleframes 524A. Theproximal portion 505A can include acollar 511D for attaching a delivery device (not shown). Thedistal portion 507A can include acap 514A that is attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) to theouter paddles 520A and is engaged by an actuation element (not shown) to open and close thedevice 500A to facilitate implantation in the native valve as described in the present application. - Referring now to
FIGS. 67A and 68A , front views of thedevice 500A are shown. Thedevice 500A has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a vertical front-to-back plane 550A and is generally narrower at thedistal portion 507A than along the paddle frames 524A. The shape of thecoaption element 510A and paddleframes 524A is a generally rounded rectangular shape to prevent thedevice 500A from catching or snagging on structures of the heart, such as the chordae tendineae, during implantation. For this reason, theproximal collar 511D (FIG. 68A ) and cap 514A (FIG. 68A ) can also have round edges. When viewed from the front or back, the paddle frames 524A can be seen to have a generally rounded rectangular shape, extending upwards and outwards from thedistal portion 507A to a shape that has sides that are wider than and approximately parallel to thecoaption element 510A when viewed from the front or back. Thus, the paddle frames 524A generally define the shape of thedevice 500A when viewed from the front or back. In addition, the rounded rectangular shape of the paddle frames 524A can distribute leaflet stress across a wider surface. In some example embodiments, the paddle frames 524A and/or thecoaption element 510A can have other shapes. - As with the front and back views (
FIGS. 67A and 68A ), thedevice 500A has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a vertical side-to-side plane 552A (FIG. 70A ) when viewed from the side (e.g.,FIG. 47A ). Thedistal portion 507A is also generally narrower than theproximal portion 505A when thedevice 500A is viewed from the side. In the embodiment illustrated inFIG. 48B , thecoaption element 510A does not taper as it extends from theproximal portion 505A of thedevice 500A to thedistal portion 507A of thedevice 500A. However, in some example embodiments, the coaption element does taper as it extends from the proximal portion of the device to the distal portion of the device (e.g.,FIG. 47 ). - The generally rounded features of the
device 500A are further demonstrated by the rounded shape of thepaddles outer paddles paddles frames 524A can take a wide variety of different forms. For example, thepaddles device 500A). By making thepaddles - The closed paddles 520A,
522 A form gaps 542A between theinner paddles 522A and thecoaption element 510A that are configured to receive native tissue. As can be seen inFIGS. 48B and 48F , the proximal end of thecoaption element 510A has an approximately dog-bone shape so that thegaps 542A are narrower toward theproximal portion 505A than as thegaps 542A approach thedistal portion 507A of the device. The narrowing of thegaps 542A toward theattachment portion 507A allows thepaddles gaps 542A nearer to theproximal portion 505A. - The paddle frames 524A extend vertically from the
distal portion 507A toward theproximal portion 505A until approximately a middle third of thedevice 500A before bending or flaring outward so that aconnection portion 524B of theframes 524A passes throughgaps 544A formed by theinner paddles 522A folded inside of theouter paddles 520A. However, in other embodiments the connections of the frames are positioned inside theinner paddles 522A or outside theouter paddles 520A. Theouter paddles 520A have a rounded rectangular shape that is similar to that of thecoaption element 510A when viewed from the front or back (FIGS. 67A and 68A ). Thus, thedevice 500A has a rounded rectangular shape. The rounded rectangular shape of thedevice 500A is particularly visible when thedevice 500A is viewed from the top (FIGS. 70A and 71A ) or bottom (FIGS. 72A and 73A ). - Referring now to
FIGS. 70A and 71A , top views of thedevice 500A are shown. Thedevice 500A has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a front-to-back plane 550A and is also symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around a side-to-side plane 552A when viewed from the top. A proximal opening 519C in thecoaption element 510A is visible at theproximal portion 505A of thedevice 500A. Theactuation element 512A is received through the opening 519C so that thecoaption element 510A wraps around theactuation element 512A. In some embodiments, the opening 519C is formed by inserting theactuation element 512A between the folded and overlapping layers of the strip ofmaterial 501A (described in detail below). In other embodiments, the opening 519C is formed by shape-setting the folded layers of the strip ofmaterial 501A forming thecoaption element 510A around a blank or jig to give thecoaption element 510A a rounded or generally rounded shape. Theproximal collar 511D shown inFIG. 71A can be secured to thecoaption element 510A to close off thecoaption element 510A. Theproximal collar 511D includesattachment portions 513A that engage withopenings 546A formed by the folded layers of the strip ofmaterial 501A that form thecoaption element 510A. In some embodiments, theattachment portions 513A are holes in thecollar 511D so that the strip ofmaterial 501A must be inserted through thecollar 511D before folding the strip ofmaterial 501A during assembly of thedevice 500A. In some embodiments, theattachment portions 513A are open slots (e.g., theattachment portions 524B of the paddle frames 524A) that receive the strip ofmaterial 501A before or after folding the strip ofmaterial 501A. - As is noted above, the
coaption element 510A has a generally rectangular shape when viewed from the top. In some example embodiments, thecoaption element 510A can have other shapes when viewed from the top. For example, the coaption element can have a round, square, diamond, elliptical, or any other shape. The paddle frames 224A each have a rounded rectangular shape when viewed from the top so that the paddle frames 224A surround therectangular coaption element 510A. Thus, native tissue, such as theleaflets gaps 542A formed between theinner paddles 522A and paddleframes 524A and thecoaption element 510A. - Referring now to
FIGS. 72A and 73A , bottom views of thedevice 500A are shown. As with the top views (FIGS. 70A and 71A ), thedevice 500A has a shape that is symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around the front-to-back plane 550A and is also symmetrical or substantially symmetrical around the side-to-side plane 552A when viewed from the bottom. Adistal portion 527A of the strip ofmaterial 501A includes anaperture 527B for receiving thecap 514A shown inFIG. 73A . - The paddle frames 524A extend outward from the
distal portion 507A of thedevice 500A to the left andright sides side plane 552A. The paddle frames 524A extend further away from the side-to-side plane 552A while maintaining a generally constant distance relative to the front-to-back plane 550A as thepaddle frames 524A extend toward theproximal portion 505A of thedevice 500A (FIG. 65A ) to ultimately form the rounded rectangle shape seen inFIGS. 70A and 71A . - In one example embodiment, the dimensions of the
device 500A are selected to minimize the number of implants that a single patient will require (preferably one), while at the same time maintaining low transvalvular gradients. In one example embodiment, the anterior-posterior distance Y47I of thedevice 500A at the widest is less than 10 mm, and the medial-lateral distance Y67C of the spacer at its widest is less than 6 mm. In one example embodiment, the overall geometry of thedevice 500A can be based on these two dimensions and the overall shape strategy described above. It should be readily apparent that the use of other anterior-posterior distance Y47I and medial-lateral distance Y67C as starting points for thedevice 500A will result in a device having different dimensions. Further, using other dimensions and the shape strategy described above will also result in a device having different dimensions. - Tables D and E provide examples of values and ranges for dimensions of the
device 500A and components of thedevice 500A for some example embodiments. However, thedevice 500A can have a wide variety of different shapes and sizes and need not have all or any of the dimensional values or dimensional ranges provided in Tables D and E. Table D provides examples of linear dimensions Y in millimeters and ranges of linear dimensions in millimeters for thedevice 500A and components of thedevice 500A. Table B provides examples of radius dimensions S in millimeters and ranges of radius dimensions in millimeters for thedevice 500A and components of thedevice 500A. The subscripts for each of the dimensions indicates the drawing in which the dimension first appears. -
TABLE D Linear Dimensions (mm) Range A Range B Range C Range D Example (max) (min) (max) (min) (max) (min) (max) (min) Y47A 2.58 2.25 3.87 1.94 5.23 2.32 2.84 2.45 2.71 Y47B 1.43 0.72 2.15 1.07 1.79 1.29 1.57 1.36 1.50 Y47C 3.75 1.88 5.63 2.81 4.68 3.38 4.13 3.56 3.94 Y47D 0.35 0.18 0.53 0.26 0.44 0.32 0.39 0.33 0.37 Y47E 0.71 0.36 1.07 0.53 0.89 0.64 0.78 0.67 0.75 Y47F 1.07 0.94 1.61 0.80 1.34 0.96 1.18 1.02 1.12 Y47G 7.68 3.84 11.52 5.76 9.60 6.91 8.45 7.30 8.06 Y47H 5.41 2.71 8.12 4.06 6.76 4.87 5.95 5.14 9.62 Y47I 9.16 4.58 13.74 6.87 11.45 8.24 10.08 8.70 9.62 Y47J 0.72 0.36 1.08 0.54 0.90 0.65 0.79 0.68 0.76 Y67A 1.61 0.81 2.42 1.21 2.01 1.45 1.77 1.53 1.69 Y67B 3.25 1.63 4.88 2.44 4.06 2.93 3.58 3.09 3.41 Y67C 5.90 2.95 8.85 4.43 7.38 5.31 6.49 5.61 6.20 Y67D 15.21 7.60 22.81 11.41 19.01 13.69 16.73 14.45 15.97 Y67E 3.25 1.63 4.88 2.44 4.06 2.93 3.58 3.09 3.41 Y68A 14.04 7.02 21.06 10.53 17.55 12.64 15.44 13.34 14.74 Y71A 4.50 2.25 6.75 3.38 5.63 4.05 4.95 4.28 4.73 Y72A 2.50 1.25 3.75 1.88 3.13 2.25 2.75 2.38 2.63 Y114A 4.34 2.17 6.50 3.25 5.42 3.90 4.77 4.12 4.55 Y114B 13.28 6.64 19.92 9.96 16.60 11.95 14.61 12.62 13.94 Y116A 14.79 7.39 22.18 11.09 18.48 13.31 16.27 14.05 15.53 -
TABLE E Radius Dimensions (mm) Range A Range B Range C Range D Example (max) (min) (max) (min) (max) (min) (max) (min) S47A 0.74 0.37 1.11 0.56 0.93 0.67 0.81 0.70 0.78 S47B 0.68 0.34 1.02 0.51 0.85 0.61 0.75 0.65 0.71 S47C 1.10 0.55 1.65 0.83 1.38 0.99 1.21 0.05 1.16 S47D 5.62 2.81 8.43 4.22 7.03 5.06 6.18 5.34 5.90 S47E 0.96 0.48 1.44 0.72 1.20 0.86 1.06 0.91 1.01 S71A 0.63 0.31 0.94 0.47 0.78 0.56 0.69 0.59 0.66 S71B 2.07 1.04 3.11 1.55 2.59 1.86 2.28 1.97 2.17 S73A 1.88 0.94 2.81 1.41 2.34 1.69 2.06 1.78 1.97 S114A 5.62 2.81 8.43 4.22 7.03 5.06 6.18 5.34 5.90 S114B 6.00 3.00 9.00 4.50 7.50 5.40 6.60 5.70 6.30 S114C 3.15 1.58 4.73 2.36 3.94 2.84 3.47 2.99 3.31 S117A 1.15 0.58 1.73 0.86 1.44 1.04 1.27 1.09 1.21 S117B 2.69 1.35 4.04 2.02 3.36 2.42 2.96 2.56 2.82 - Referring now to
FIGS. 74A, 75A, 76A, 77A, 78A, 79A, 80A, 81A, 82A, and 83A , perspective and cross-sectional views of thedevice 500A are shown. Referring now toFIG. 74A , thedevice 500A is shown sliced bycross-section plane 75A near the proximal portion of thecoaption element 510A. Referring now toFIG. 75A , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500A is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 75A inFIG. 74A . At the location of theplane 75A, thecoaption element 510A has a generally rounded rectangular shape. Thegaps 542A between theinner paddles 522A andcoaption element 510A have awidth 542B. As noted above, thegaps 542A have a consistent or generally consistent width. - Referring now to
FIG. 76A , thedevice 500A is shown sliced bycross-section plane 77A positioned about three-quarters of the way between thedistal portion 507A and theproximal portion 505A of thecoaption element 510A. Referring now toFIG. 77A , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500A is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 77A inFIG. 76A . As can be seen inFIGS. 76A and 77A , the strip ofmaterial 501A forming thedevice 500A is overlapped to form four layers in the area of thecoaption element 510A. A single layer of the strip ofmaterial 501A forms each of theinner paddle 522A and theouter paddle 520A. At the location of theplane 75A, thecoaption element 510A has a generally rectangular shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552A. Thegaps 542A between theinner paddle 522A and thecoaption element 510A are visible. Thegaps 542A between theinner paddles 522A andcoaption element 510A have awidth 542B that is greater than thewidth 542B seen inFIG. 75A . Thegaps 544A between the outer andinner paddles consistent width 544B for receiving theattachment portion 524B of the paddle frames 524A. - Referring now to
FIG. 78A , thedevice 500A is shown sliced bycross-section plane 79A positioned about half of the way between thedistal portion 507A and theproximal portion 505A of thedevice 500A. Referring now toFIG. 79A , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500A is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 79A inFIG. 78A . As can be seen inFIGS. 78A and 79A , the strip ofmaterial 501A forming thedevice 500A is overlapped to form four layers in the area of thecoaption element 510A, two layers in the area of theinner paddle 522A, and one layer in the area of theouter paddle 520A. At the location of theplane 79A, thecoaption element 510A has a generally rectangular shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552A. Thegaps 542A between theinner paddles 522A and thecoaption element 510A have awidth 542B that is the same or about the same as thewidth 542B seen inFIG. 77A . - Referring now to
FIG. 80A , thedevice 500A is shown sliced bycross-section plane 81A positioned about one-quarter of the way between thedistal portion 507A and theproximal portion 505A of thedevice 500A. Referring now toFIG. 81A , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500A is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 81A inFIG. 80A . As can be seen inFIGS. 80A and 81A , the strip ofmaterial 501A forming thedevice 500A is overlapped to form four layers in the area of thecoaption element 510A, two layers in the area of theinner paddle 522A, and theouter paddle 520A is formed by a single layer. At the location of theplane 81A, thecoaption element 510A has a generally rectangular shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552A. Thegaps 542A between theinner paddle 522A andcoaption element 510A have awidth 542B that is about the same as thecentral width 542B seen inFIG. 79A . - Referring now to
FIG. 82A , thedevice 500A is shown sliced bycross-section plane 83A positioned about one-quarter of the way between thedistal portion 507A and theproximal portion 505A of thedevice 500A. Referring now toFIG. 83A , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500A is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 83A inFIG. 82A . As can be seen inFIGS. 82A and 83A , the strip ofmaterial 501A forming thedevice 500A is overlapped to form four layers in the area of thecoaption element 510A, two layers in the area of theinner paddle 522A, and a single layer forms theouter paddle 520A. At the location of theplane 83A, thecoaption element 510A has a generally rectangular shape oriented along the side-to-side plane 552A. Thegaps 542A between theinner paddles 522A andcoaption element 510A form an arcuate shape with awidth 542B that is about the same as thecentral width 542B seen inFIG. 81A . - Referring now to
FIGS. 84-88, 86A, 87A, and 88A , exampleimplantable devices example devices FIGS. 84-88, 86A, 87A, and 88A , have barbs or grippingmembers 800/800A and/or 802/802A integrated into portions of the coaption element or paddles of the anchor portion of the devices to facilitate grasping of the tissue of the native heart valve. - Referring now to
FIG. 84 , an exampleimplantable device 100 is shown that does not include articulable clasps or gripping elements. As described above, thedevice 100 is deployed from a delivery sheath or means fordelivery 102 and includes acoaption portion 104 and ananchor portion 106. Thecoaption portion 104 of thedevice 100 includes a coaption element or means for coapting 110 that is adapted to be implanted between theleaflets shaft 112 that extends through the coaption element or means for coapting 110 to adistal cap 114. - The
anchor portion 106 of thedevice 100 includesouter paddles 120 andinner paddles 122 that are connected between thedistal cap 114 and the coaption element or means forcoapting 110. Theanchor portion 106 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element or means for actuating 112 opens and closes theanchor portion 106 of thedevice 100 to grasp thenative valve leaflets - Rather than articulable clasps or gripping elements, the
device 100 shown inFIG. 84 includesbarbed portions 800 arranged on the coaption element or means forcoapting 110, with each side of the coaption element or means for coapting 110 having at least onebarbed portion 800. When theanchor portion 106 of thedevice 100 is closed, tissue grasped between theinner paddles 122 and the coaption element or means forcoapting 110 is pressed against thebarbed portions 800. Thebarbed portions 800 can be sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from thedevice 100. In some embodiments, thebarbed portions 800 are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue. - Referring now to
FIG. 85 , the exampleimplantable device 100 is shown without separate articulable clasps. As described above, thedevice 100 is deployed from a delivery sheath or means fordelivery 102 and includes acoaption portion 104 and ananchor portion 106. Thecoaption portion 104 of thedevice 100 includes a coaption element or means for coapting 110 that is adapted to be implanted between theleaflets distal cap 114. - The
anchor portion 106 of thedevice 100 includesouter paddles 120 andinner paddles 122 that are connected between thedistal cap 114 and the coaption element or means forcoapting 110. Theanchor portion 106 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element or means for actuating 112 opens and closes theanchor portion 106 of thedevice 100 to grasp thenative valve leaflets - Rather than separate articulable clasps or gripping elements, the
device 100 shown inFIG. 85 includesbarbed portions 800 arranged on theinner paddles 122, with eachinner paddle 122 having at least onebarbed portion 800. When theanchor portion 106 of thedevice 100 is closed, tissue grasped between theinner paddles 122 and the coaption element or means forcoapting 110 is pressed against thebarbed portions 800. Thebarbed portions 800 are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from thedevice 100. In some embodiments, thebarbed portions 800 are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue. - Referring now to
FIG. 86 , the exampleimplantable device 500 is shown that does not include articulable clasps or gripping elements. As described above, thedevice 500 includes acoaption portion 504 and ananchor portion 506. Thecoaption portion 504 of thedevice 500 includes acoaption element 510 that is adapted to be implanted between theleaflets actuation 512 that extends through thecoaption element 510 to adistal cap 514. - The
anchor portion 506 of thedevice 500 includesouter paddles 520 andinner paddles 522 that are connected between thedistal cap 514 and thecoaption element 510. Theanchor portion 506 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of theactuation element 512 opens and closes theanchor portion 506 of thedevice 500 to grasp thenative valve leaflets - Rather than articulable clasps or gripping elements, the
device 500 includesbarbed portions 800 arranged on theinner paddles 522, with eachinner paddle 522 optionally having more than onebarbed portion 800. When theanchor portion 506 of thedevice 500 is closed, tissue grasped between theinner paddles 522 and thecoaption element 510 is pressed against thebarbed portions 800. Thebarbed portions 800 are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from thedevice 500. In some embodiments, thebarbed portions 800 are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue. - Referring now to
FIG. 86A , the exampleimplantable device 500A is shown that does not include articulable clasps or gripping elements. As described above, thedevice 500A acoaption element 510A that is adapted to be implanted between theleaflets coaption element 510A to adistal cap 514A. Thedevice 500A also includesouter paddles 520A andinner paddles 522A that are connected between thedistal cap 514A and thecoaption element 510A. Thedevice 500A is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element opens and closes thepaddles device 500A to grasp thenative valve leaflets - Rather than articulable clasps or gripping elements, the
device 500A includesbarbed portions 800A arranged on theinner paddles 522A, with eachinner paddle 522A optionally having more than onebarbed portion 800A. When thedevice 500A is closed, tissue grasped between theinner paddles 522A and thecoaption element 510A is pressed against thebarbed portions 800A. Thebarbed portions 800A are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from thedevice 500A. In some embodiments, thebarbed portions 800A are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue. - Referring now to
FIG. 87 , the exampleimplantable device 500 is shown that does not include separate articulable clasps or gripping elements. As described above, thedevice 500 includes acoaption portion 502 and ananchor portion 504. Thecoaption portion 502 of thedevice 500 includes acoaption element 510 that is adapted to be implanted between theleaflets actuation 512 that extends through thecoaption element 510 to adistal cap 514. - The
anchor portion 506 of thedevice 500 includesouter paddles 520 andinner paddles 522 that are connected between thedistal cap 514 and thecoaption element 510. Theanchor portion 506 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of theactuation element 512 opens and closes theanchor portion 506 of thedevice 500 to grasp thenative valve leaflets - Rather than separate articulable clasps or gripping elements, the
device 500 includesbarbed portions 800 arranged on thecoaption element 510, with each side of thecoaption element 510 having more than onebarbed portion 800. When theanchor portion 506 of thedevice 500 is closed, tissue grasped between theinner paddles 522 and thecoaption element 510 is pressed against thebarbed portions 800. Thebarbed portions 800 are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from thedevice 500. In some embodiments, thebarbed portions 800 are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue. - Referring now to
FIG. 87A , the exampleimplantable device 500A is shown that does not include articulable clasps or gripping elements. As described above, thedevice 500A can have acoaption element 510A that is adapted to be implanted between theleaflets coaption element 510A to adistal cap 514A. Thedevice 500A also includesouter paddles 520A andinner paddles 522A that are connected between thedistal cap 514A and thecoaption element 510A. Thedevice 500A is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element opens and closes thepaddles device 500A to grasp thenative valve leaflets - Rather than separate articulable clasps or gripping elements, the
device 500A includesbarbed portions 800A arranged on thecoaption element 510A, with each side of thecoaption element 510A having more than onebarbed portion 800A. When thedevice 500A is closed, tissue grasped between theinner paddles 522A and thecoaption element 510A is pressed against thebarbed portions 800A. Thebarbed portions 800A are sharp so that they engage—and in some embodiments, pierce—the native tissue and prohibit the tissue from retracting from thedevice 500A. In some embodiments, thebarbed portions 800A are angled downward to increase engagement with the native tissue. - Referring now to
FIG. 88 , the exampleimplantable device 500 is shown that does not include separate articulable clasps or gripping elements. As described above, thedevice 500 includes acoaption portion 502 and ananchor portion 504. Thecoaption portion 502 of thedevice 500 includes acoaption element 510 that is adapted to be implanted between theleaflets actuation 512 that extends through thecoaption element 510 to adistal cap 514. - The
anchor portion 506 of thedevice 500 includesouter paddles 520 andinner paddles 522 that are connected between thedistal cap 514 and thecoaption element 510. Theanchor portion 506 is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of theactuation element 512 opens and closes theanchor portion 506 of thedevice 500 to grasp thenative valve leaflets - Rather than articulable clasps or gripping elements, the
device 500 includesbarbed portions 800 arranged on thecoaption element 510, with each side of thecoaption element 510 including at least onebarbed portion 800. Similar to device 1500 described above, thedevice 500 also includesbarbed portions 802 arranged on theinner paddles 522, with eachinner paddle 522 having at least onebarbed portion 802. - When the
anchor portion 506 of thedevice 500 is closed, tissue grasped between theinner paddles 522 and thecoaption element 510 is pressed against thebarbed portions barbed portions device 500. In some embodiments, thebarbed portions barbed portions 800 on thecoaption element 510 andbarbed portions 802 on theinner paddles 522 forms the grasped tissue into an S-shaped tortuous path as it passes over thebarbed portions device 500 will encourage the tissue to further engage thebarbed portions - Referring now to
FIG. 88A , the exampleimplantable device 500A is shown that does not include articulable clasps or gripping elements. As described above, thedevice 500A can have acoaption element 510A that is adapted to be implanted between theleaflets coaption element 510A to adistal cap 514A. Thedevice 500A also includesouter paddles 520A andinner paddles 522A that are connected between thedistal cap 514A and thecoaption element 510A. Thedevice 500A is actuatable between open and closed conditions and can take a wide variety of forms, such as, for example, paddles, gripping elements, or the like. Actuation of the actuation element opens and closes thepaddles device 500A to grasp thenative valve leaflets - Rather than articulable clasps or gripping elements, the
device 500A includesbarbed portions 800A arranged on thecoaption element 510A, with each side of thecoaption element 510A including at least onebarbed portion 800A. Thedevice 500A also includesbarbed portions 802A arranged on theinner paddles 522A, with eachinner paddle 522A having at least onebarbed portion 802A. - When the
device 500A is closed, tissue grasped between theinner paddles 522A and thecoaption element 510A is pressed against thebarbed portions barbed portions device 500A. In some embodiments, thebarbed portions barbed portions 800A on thecoaption element 510A andbarbed portions 802A on theinner paddles 522A forms the grasped tissue into an S-shaped tortuous path as it passes over thebarbed portions device 500A will encourage the tissue to further engage thebarbed portions - Referring now to
FIGS. 89-102 , thecoaption element 510 and paddles 520, 522 of theexample device 500 are shown. Thecoaption element 510 and the paddles can be made from a wide variety of different materials. Thecoaption element 510 and paddles 520, 522 can be formed from one or more of a variety of materials, for example, a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, electrospun, deposited or formed in any other suitable way, laser cut, or otherwise cut material or flexible material. The material can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body. - In one example embodiment, the coaption element is made from a braided mesh of metal wires, such as a braided mesh of nitinol wires. In one example embodiment, the
coaption element 510 is made of a braided mesh of between 25 and 100 wires, such as between 40 and 85 wires, such as between 45 and 60 wires, such as about 48 Nitinol wires or 48 Nitinol wires. - The coaption element can be covered in a cloth, such as a polyethylene cloth. The
coaption element 510, can be surrounded in its entirety with a cloth cover, such as a polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh. The cloth cover can provide a blood seal on the surface of the spacer, and/or promote rapid tissue ingrowth. - The use of a shape memory material, such as braided Nitinol wire mesh, for the construction of the
coaption element 510 results in a coaption element that can self-expandable, flexible in all directions, and/or results in low strains when the coaption element is crimped and/or bent. The material can be a single piece, two halves joined together, or a plurality of sections or pieces that are fastened or joined together in any suitable manner, such as, by welding, with adhesives, or the like. - Referring now to
FIGS. 89-90 , thedevice 500 extends from aproximal portion 505 to adistal portion 507 and includes acoaption element 510,inner paddles 522, andouter paddles 520. Thecoaption element 510 includes aproximal opening 519A and a distal opening 515 (FIGS. 92 and 94 ). Theproximal opening 519A of thecoaption element 510 is formed in aproximal portion 519 of thecoaption element 510. Thecoaption element 510 is jointably connected to theinner paddles 522 byjoint portions 525. Theinner paddles 522 are jointably connected to theouter paddles 520 byjoint portions 523. Theouter paddles 520 are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) todistal portions 527 byjoint portions 521.Coaption gaps 542 are formed between theinner paddles 522 and thecoaption element 510.Paddle gaps 544 are formed between the inner andouter paddles paddles FIG. 90 . - Referring now to
FIG. 91 , a front view of thedevice 500 is shown (a back view of which would be identical). Thecoaption element 510 includes theproximal portion 519, amiddle portion 518, and adistal portion 517. Theproximal portion 519 includes theproximal opening 519A. Thedistal portion 517 includes thedistal opening 515 and is connected to thejoint portions 525. The shape of thecoaption element 510 is rounded or generally rounded to prevent thedevice 500 from catching or snagging on structures of the heart, such as the chordae tendineae, during implantation. - Referring now to
FIG. 92 , a side view of thedevice 500 is shown Similar to thedevice 500 viewed from the front, thedistal portion 507 of thedevice 500 is generally narrower than theproximal portion 505 of thedevice 500 when thedevice 500 is viewed from the side. Thecoaption element 510 flares outwards in theproximal portion 519 from theproximal opening 519A to themiddle portion 518. Thecoaption element 510 then tapers or narrows in themiddle portion 518 from theproximal portion 519 to thedistal portion 517. Thedistal portion 517 remains narrow and then splits into the twojoint portions 525. The generally rounded features of thedevice 500 are further demonstrated by the round shape of thejoint portions 523 that jointably connect the inner andouter paddles outer paddles 520. - The
coaption gaps 542 formed between theinner paddles 522 and thecoaption element 510 are configured to receive native tissue. The narrowing of thecoaption element 510 gives the gaps 542 a somewhat teardrop shape that increases in width as thegaps 542 approach thedistal portion 507 of thedevice 500. The widening of thegaps 542 toward thedistal portion 507 allows theinner paddles 522 to contact tissue grasped in thegaps 542 nearer to theproximal portion 505 where pinching forces are greater as a result of the mechanical advantage provided by the length of thepaddles - Referring now to
FIG. 93 , a top view of thedevice 500 is shown. Theproximal opening 519A in thecoaption element 510 is visible at theproximal portion 505 of thedevice 500 and thecoaption element 510 can be seen to be hollow inside. Thecoaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval-shape when viewed from the top. While thepaddles paddles - Referring now to
FIG. 94 , a bottom view of thedevice 500 is shown. Thedistal opening 515 in thecoaption element 510 is visible at thedistal portion 507 of thedevice 500 and thecoaption element 510 can be seen to be hollow inside. Thecoaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval-shape when viewed from the top. While thepaddles paddles distal portion 517 of thecoaption element 510 can be seen splitting in two to join with thejoint portions 525. - Referring now to
FIGS. 89A, 90A, 91A, 92A, 93A, 94A, 95A, 96A, 97A, 98A, 99A, 100A, 101A, and 102A , the portions of thedevice 500A formed by the strip ofmaterial 501A (e.g., a single, continuous strip of material, a composite strip of material, etc.), that is, thecoaption element 510A and paddles 520A, 522A, are shown. Thecoaption element 510A and the paddles can be made from a wide variety of different materials. Thecoaption element 510A, and paddles 520A, 522A can be formed from a material that can be a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, electrospun, deposited or formed in any other suitable way, laser cut, or otherwise cut material or flexible material. The material can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body. - In one example embodiment, the
coaption element 510A,inner paddle 522A, andouter paddle 520A are made from a single, continuous strip ofmaterial 501A. The strip ofmaterial 501A can be formed from a material that can be a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, electrospun, deposited or formed in any other suitable way, laser cut, or otherwise cut material or flexible material. The material can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body. In one example embodiment, the strip ofmaterial 501A is made of a braided mesh of between 25 and 100 strands, such as between 40 and 85 strands, such as between 45 and 60 strands, such as about 48 Nitinol wires or 48 Nitinol wires. - Referring now to
FIGS. 205-207 , an example woven orbraided material 4000 that can be used for the strip ofmaterial 501A is shown. Referring now toFIG. 205 , an enlarged plan view of thematerial 4000 is shown. Thematerial 4000 extends from afirst edge 4002 to asecond edge 4004. Theedges field 4006. Thematerial 4000 is formed by braiding or weaving togethercentral strands 4020, such as Nitinol wires.Edge strands 4010 extend longitudinally through thematerial 4000 along theedges central strands 4020 are woven or braided such that thecentral strands 4020 wrap around theedge strands 4010. Wrapping thecentral strands 4020 around theedge strands 4010 causes thematerial 4000 near theedges central portion 4006, forming a lobed or dog-bone-like shape when thematerial 4000 is viewed from the end, as is shown inFIG. 206 . Thus, theedges material 4000 are less flexible than thecentral portion 4006. Theedge strands 4010 andcentral strands 4020 can be similar in diameter and can have a diameter ranging from about 0.06 millimeters to about 0.18 millimeters. In some embodiments, theedge strands 4010 can have a larger diameter than thecentral strands 4020 to impart more stiffness or rigidity to theedges central portion 4006. For example, theedge strands 4010 can have a diameter ranging from 0.07 millimeters to about 0.27 millimeters, or about 0.17 millimeters, and thecentral strands 4020 can have a diameter ranging from about 0.04 millimeters to about 0.15 millimeters, or about 0.009 millimeters. In some embodiments, theedges central portion 4006 by using different materials for theedge strands 4010 andcentral strands 4020, such as, for example, a metal material—e.g., Nitinol—for theedge strands 4010 and a cloth or plastic material—e.g., polyethylene—for thecentral strands 4020. Alternatively, theedge strands 4010 andcentral strands 4020 can be made from the same material that is subjected to different chemical and or thermal processes that alter the flexibility of the materials so that thecentral strands 4020 are more flexible than theedge strands 4010. - Referring now to
FIG. 207 , folded portions ofmaterial 4000 are layered on top of each other to form a section that has fourlayers thicker edges central portion 4006, creates threegaps layers central portion 4006.Outer gaps outer layers middle layers 4000B, 4000C. - As is discussed in the present disclosure, the
coaption element 510A of thedevice 500A can be formed from four layers of material, such as thematerial 4000. When layers of thematerial 4000 are used to form thecoaption element 510A, theactuation element 512A of thedevice 500A can be inserted through themiddle gap 4001B formed in the center of the four layers ofmaterial 4000. Theactuation element 512A can have a larger diameter than the width of thegap 4001B, so that inserting theactuation element 512A causes themiddle gap 4001B to stretch open and adjacentouter gaps actuation element 512A causes thecenter body portions 4006 on either side to bulge outward to a thickness that is greater than the thickness of the four stackededge portions - The
coaption element 510A and paddles 520A, 522A can be covered in a cloth, such as a polyethylene cloth. Thecoaption element 510A and paddles 520A, 522A can be surrounded in their entirety with a cloth cover (e.g., cover 540A), such as a polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh. The cloth cover can provide a blood seal on the surface of the spacer, and/or promote rapid tissue ingrowth. - The use of a shape memory material, such as braided Nitinol wire mesh, for the construction of the
coaption element 510A and paddles 520A, 522A results in a coaption element and paddles that can be self-expandable, flexible in all directions, and/or results in low strains when crimped and/or bent. The material can be a single piece, two halves joined together, or a plurality of sections or pieces that are fastened or joined together in any suitable manner, such as, by welding, with adhesives, or the like. - Referring now to
FIGS. 89A and 90A , thedevice 500A extends from aproximal portion 505A to adistal portion 507A and includes acoaption element 510A,inner paddles 522A, andouter paddles 520A. The single, continuous strip ofmaterial 501A extends between twoends 501B and is folded to form thecoaption element 510A,inner paddles 522A, andouter paddles 520A. Some portions of thedevice 500A are formed from multiple layers of the strip ofmaterial 501A. For example, the strip ofmaterial 501A is overlapped to form four layers in the area of thecoaption element 510A and two layers in the area of theinner paddle 522A. - The
coaption element 510A and paddles 520A, 522A are jointably connected together by joint portions of the strip ofmaterial 501A. Thecoaption element 510A is jointably connected to theinner paddles 522A byjoint portions 525A. Theinner paddles 522A are jointably connected to theouter paddles 520A byjoint portions 523A. Theouter paddles 520A are attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) to thedistal portion 527A byjoint portions 521A. Theaperture 527B in thedistal portion 527A engages thecap 514A. - Various gaps are formed between portions of the
device 500A when the strip ofmaterial 501A is folded into the desired shape.Coaption gaps 542A are formed between theinner paddles 522A and thecoaption element 510A.Paddle gaps 544A are formed between the inner andouter paddles paddles FIG. 90A .Collar gaps 546A are formed when the strip ofmaterial 501A is folded to form theproximal portions 519B of thecoaption element 510A. - Referring now to
FIG. 91A , a front view of thedevice 500A is shown (a back view of which would be identical). Thecoaption element 510A includes theproximal portion 519B extending above thejoint portions 523A of thepaddles distal portion 517A of thecoaption element 510A is concealed by thepaddles device 500A a long and narrow rounded rectangular shape. The shape of thecoaption element 510A helps prevent thedevice 500A from catching or snagging on structures of the heart, such as the chordae tendineae, during implantation. - Referring now to
FIG. 92A , a side view of thedevice 500A is shown. Thedistal end 507A of thedevice 500A is generally narrower than theproximal end 505A of thedevice 500A when thedevice 500A is viewed from the side, forming a generally blunt and rounded shape. Thecoaption element 510A includes theproximal portion 519B, amiddle portion 518A, and thedistal portion 517A. Theproximal portion 519B flares outward from themiddle portion 518A to engage thecollar 511D (FIG. 48A ). Themiddle portion 518A of thecoaption element 510A is straight or generally straight when viewed from the side. Thedistal portion 517A is attached (e.g., jointably attached, etc.) to theinner paddles 522A by thejoint portions 525A. The generally rounded features of thedevice 500A are further demonstrated by the round shape of thejoint portions 523A that jointably connect thepaddles joint portions 521A connecting theouter paddles 520A to thedistal portion 527A are also rounded and ease the transition in shape from the strip ofmaterial 501A to thecap 514A (FIG. 48A ) that is assembled to the flat or generally flatdistal portion 527A. - The
coaption gaps 542A formed between theinner paddles 522A and thecoaption element 510A are configured to receive native tissue. The general straightness of themiddle portion 518A of thecoaption element 510A and theinner paddles 522A gives thegaps 542A a consistent or generally consistent width with a narrow upper end where theproximal portion 519B flares outward to engage thecollar 511D (FIG. 48A ). Thus, theinner paddles 522A contact the tissue grasped in thegaps 542A nearer to theproximal portion 505A where pinching forces are greater as a result of the mechanical advantage provided by the length of thepaddles - As discussed above, the
coaption element 510A and paddles 520A, 522A of thedevice 500A are formed by folding the strip ofmaterial 501A. The strip ofmaterial 501A is then unfolded and assembled with other components, such as thecollar 511D, cap 514A, and paddleframes 524A. The strip ofmaterial 501A is shape-set after being formed into a desired shape so that the strip ofmaterial 501A returns to the desired shape after assembly with other components. In some embodiments, a jig is used during folding and shape-setting of the strip ofmaterial 501A to ensure that the strip ofmaterial 501A is folded in the proper location with the desired radius. - Referring again to
FIG. 92A , portions of ajig 570A to aid in folding and shape-setting thedevice 500A are shown. The strip ofmaterial 501A is shown folded around thejig 570A so that the strip ofmaterial 501A forms a desired shape. To fold the strip ofmaterial 501A into the shape of thedevice 500A using thejig 570A, the strip ofmaterial 501A is arranged with one of theends 501B at the location of theinner paddle 522A. Thestrip 501A is extended from theend 501B in adistal direction 507B to form afirst layer 581A of theinner paddle 522A, around afirst jig portion 572A to form afirst layer 581A of thehinge portion 525A, and then in a proximal direction 505B to form thefirst layer 581A of thecoaption element 510A. Thefirst layer 581A of material forms the sides of theinner paddle 522A andcoaption element 510A that surround thecoaption gap 542A. Thestrip 501A is then wrapped around asecond jig portion 574A to form one of theproximal portions 519B andopenings 546A of thecoaption element 510A. Thestrip 501A is then extended in adistal direction 507A along thefirst layer 581A to form asecond layer 582A of thecoaption element 510A. Thestrip 501A is then wrapped back round thefirst jig portion 574A, forming thesecond layer 582A of thehinge portion 525A and back in theproximal direction 505A to form thesecond layer 582A of theinner paddle 522A. Thestrip 501A is then wrapped around athird jig portion 576A to form thejoint portion 523A. Thestrip 501A then extends in thedistal direction 507A along theinner paddle 522A to form theouter paddle 520A before being folded around afourth jig portion 578A to form thejoint portion 521. Thestrip 501A is then extended laterally to form thedistal portion 527. The routing of thestrip 501A through thejig 570A is then performed in reverse order on the opposite side of thejig 570A to form the second half of thedevice 500A. That is, thestrip 501A is then wrapped around the fourth, third, first, second, andfirst jig portions device 500A. Once thestrip 501A has been wrapped around the jig portions as described above, a shape-setting operation is performed. While the portions of the illustrated jig have a rounded or generally round shape, the portions can have any shape to aid in the folding and shaping of the strip ofmaterial 501A. The jig 570 can have more or fewer portions for engaging the strip ofmaterial 501A. - Referring now to
FIG. 93A , a top view of thedevice 500A is shown. The first andsecond layers device 500A form the four layers of thecoaption device 510A. The proximal opening 519C of thecoaption device 510A is formed between the twosecond layers 582A. In some embodiments, the opening 519C is formed by inserting theactuation element 512A (not shown) between the folded and overlapping layers of the strip ofmaterial 501A after shape-setting of the strip ofmaterial 501A. In other embodiments, the opening 519C is formed by shape-setting the foldedlayers material 501A around an additional jig portion (not shown) to give thecoaption element 510A a rounded or generally rounded shape when viewed from the top. - Referring now to
FIG. 94A , a bottom view of thedevice 500A is shown. Thedistal portion 527A of the strip ofmaterial 501A is shown, as is theaperture 527B for receiving thecap 514A. Thecoaption element 510A andouter paddles 520A have a generally rounded rectangle shape when viewed from below. - Referring now to
FIGS. 95-102 , perspective and cross-sectional views of thedevice 500 are shown. Referring now toFIG. 95 , thedevice 500 is shown sliced by cross-section plane 96 near the proximal portion of thecoaption element 510. Referring now toFIG. 96 , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500 is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 96 inFIG. 95 . At the location of the plane 96, thecoaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape with thicker portions along the sides of thecoaption element 510. Thedistal opening 515 is visible from the proximal portion and thecoaption element 510 has a hollow interior. - Referring now to
FIG. 97 , thedevice 500 is shown sliced bycross-section plane 98 positioned about half of the way between thedistal portion 507 and theproximal portion 505 of thecoaption element 510. Referring now toFIG. 98 , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500 is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 98 inFIG. 97 . At the location of theplane 98, thecoaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape that is larger than the oval shape ofFIG. 96 . - Referring now to
FIG. 99 , thedevice 500 is shown sliced bycross-section plane 100 positioned about one-quarter of the way between thedistal portion 507 and theproximal portion 505 of thecoaption element 510. Referring now toFIG. 99 , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500 is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 100 inFIG. 99 . At the location of theplane 100, thecoaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape that is narrower than the oval shape seen inFIG. 98 . - Referring now to
FIG. 101 , thedevice 500 is shown sliced bycross-section plane 102 positioned near thedistal portion 507 of thecoaption element 510. Referring now toFIG. 102 , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500 is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 102 inFIG. 101 . At the location of theplane 102, thecoaption element 510 has an oval or generally oval shape that is smaller than the oval shape seen inFIG. 100 and that is split as thecoaption element 510 joins thejoint portions 525. - Referring now to
FIGS. 95A, 96A, 97A, 98A, 99A, 100A, 101A, and 102A , perspective and cross-sectional views of the portions of thedevice 500A formed by the single, continuous strip ofmaterial 501A are shown. Referring now toFIG. 95A , thedevice 500A is shown sliced bycross-section plane 96A near the proximal portion of thecoaption element 510A. Referring now toFIG. 96A , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500A is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 96A inFIG. 95A . At the location of theplane 96A, thecoaption element 510 has a rectangular or generally rectangular shape. In some embodiments, when the actuation element (not shown) is inserted between thelayers 582A of thecoaption element 510A, thecoaption element 510A remains straight when viewed from the side but bows outward to form a rounded or generally round shape when viewed fromcross-section plane 96A. - Referring now to
FIG. 97A , thedevice 500A is shown sliced bycross-section plane 98A near the proximal portion of thecoaption element 510A. Referring now toFIG. 98A , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500A is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 98A inFIG. 97A . At the location of theplane 98A, thecoaption element 510 has a rectangular or generally rectangular shape. In some embodiments, when the actuation element (not shown) is inserted between thelayers 582A of thecoaption element 510A, thecoaption element 510A remains straight when viewed from the side but bows outward to form a rounded or generally round shape when viewed fromcross-section plane 98A. - Referring now to
FIG. 99A , thedevice 500A is shown sliced bycross-section plane 100A near the proximal portion of thecoaption element 510A. Referring now toFIG. 100A , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500A is shown as viewed fromcross-section plane 100A inFIG. 99A . At the location of theplane 100A, thecoaption element 510 has a rectangular or generally rectangular shape. In some embodiments, when the actuation element (not shown) is inserted between thelayers 582A of thecoaption element 510A, thecoaption element 510A remains straight when viewed from the side but bows outward to form a rounded or generally round shape when viewed fromcross-section plane 100A. - Referring now to
FIG. 101A , thedevice 500A is shown sliced by cross-section plane 102A near the proximal portion of thecoaption element 510A. Referring now toFIG. 102A , a cross-sectional view of thedevice 500A is shown as viewed from cross-section plane 102A inFIG. 101A . At the location of the plane 102A, thecoaption element 510 has a rectangular or generally rectangular shape. In some embodiments, when the actuation element (not shown) is inserted between thelayers 582A of thecoaption element 510A, thecoaption element 510A remains straight when viewed from the side but bows outward to form a rounded or generally round shape when viewed from cross-section plane 102A. - Referring now to
FIGS. 103-105 , the example implantableprosthetic device 100 is shown having covered and uncovered portions. Thedevice 100 is shown implanted in the native mitral valve MV and secured to thenative leaflets device 100 includes a coaption element or means forcoapting 110, paddles 120, clasps 130, and acap 114. Thepaddles 120 and clasps 130 are in a closed position to secure thedevice 100 to the graspednative leaflets proximal portion 105 of thedevice 100 is exposed to the left atrium LA and adistal portion 107 of thedevice 100 is exposed to the left ventricle LV. - Referring now to
FIG. 103 , thedevice 100 is shown with a covering 900 that covers the entirety of the coaption element or means forcoapting 110 and thecap 114. In some embodiments, the covering 900 can be a cloth or fabric or polymer such as PET, velour, electrospun, deposited, or other suitable material. In other embodiments, in lieu of or in addition to a fabric, the cover can include a coating (e.g., polymeric) that is applied to the prosthetic spacer device and/or mechanical sealing mechanisms, such as silicone and interlocking joints can be used. The covering 900 can be formed from a metal fabric, such as a mesh, woven, braided, or formed in any other suitable way or a laser cut or otherwise cut flexible material. The covering 900 can be cloth, shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body. The covering 900 prohibits blood flow through coaption element or means for coapting 110 at theproximal portion 105, and also provides a seal between thedevice 100 and theleaflets device 100. The covering 900 also prohibits recirculating blood flow from entering thedevice 100 from thedistal portion 107. - Referring now to
FIG. 104 , thedevice 100 is shown with a covering 1000 that partially covers the coaption element or means for coapting 110 from theproximal portion 105 of thedevice 100 to the portion of the coaption element or means for coapting 110 that engages thenative leaflets proximal portion 105. - Referring now to
FIG. 105 , thedevice 100 is shown with a covering 1100 that partially covers the coaption element or means for coapting 110 extending from the portion of the coaption element or means for coapting 110 that engages thenative leaflets distal portion 107. The covering 1100 also covers thecap 114. In some embodiments, the cover can be a cloth or fabric such as PET, velour, or other suitable fabric. In other embodiments, in lieu of or in addition to a fabric, the cover can include a coating (e.g., polymeric) that is applied to the prosthetic spacer device. The covering 1100 can be formed from a mesh, woven, braided, or formed in any other suitable way. The covering 1100 can be cloth, polymer, silicone, electrospun material, deposited material, and/or shape-memory alloy wire—such as Nitinol—to provide shape-setting capability, or any other flexible material suitable for implantation in the human body. Thus, blood flow can enter the coaption element or means for coapting 110 but is prohibited from passing through the device by the covering 1100 arranged toward thedistal portion 107. The covering 1100 also prohibits recirculating blood flow from entering thedevice 100 from thedistal portion 107. - Referring now to
FIGS. 106-109 , anexample coaption element 1200 for an implantable prosthetic device is shown. Thecoaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application. Referring toFIG. 106 , thecoaption element 1200 has a cylindrical or generally cylindrical shape extending between twocaps 1201. However, thecoaption element 1200 can have any shape, such as any of the shapes disclosed herein. In one example embodiment, the direction of expansion of thecoaption element 1200 can be controlled. For example, the width/size of the coaption element in the Anterior to Posterior direction (when implanted), Medial to Lateral direction (when implanted), or both can be expanded (or contracted) in a controlled manner. The coaption element can be made from amesh 1200 of material. Referring now toFIG. 107 , the mesh wall of the generallycylindrical coaption element 1200 extends outward from thecaps 1201 by adistance 1204. Referring now toFIG. 108 ,axial forces 1208 are applied to thecaps 1201 of thecoaption element 1200 causing thecoaption element 1200 to compress in an axial direction. Compressing thecoaption element 1200 axially causes thecoaption element 1200 to expand or bulge in anoutward direction 1210, such that thedistance 1204 increases. - The
coaption element 1200 can be compressed in a wide variety of different ways. For example, a threaded connection can be used to draw the two ends of the coaption element together or push the two ends of the coaption element apart. For example, a collar can be provided on each end of the coaption element. One of the collars can threadedly engage a threaded shaft, while the other collar is rotatably connected to the shaft. Rotating the shaft in one direction draws the collars together. Rotating the shaft in the opposite direction moves the collars apart. - Incorporating the
coaption element 1200 into an implantable prosthetic device of the present application allows the coaption element to be expanded to press outward against tissue grasped between the coaption element and the paddles and/or gripping members. - Referring now to
FIGS. 106A, 108A, 106B, and 108B ,example coaption elements 1200, similar to the embodiment illustrated byFIGS. 106-109 , for an implantable prosthetic device is shown. Thecoaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application. Referring toFIG. 106A , thecoaption element 1200 has a cylindrical or generally cylindrical shape extending between twocaps 1201. However, thecoaption element 1200 can have any shape, such as any of the shapes disclosed herein. In the example illustrated byFIGS. 106A and 108A , thecoaption element 1200 comprises atube 1203 withslots 1205. For example, thetube 1203 can be made from a shape memory alloy, such as nitinol, and the slots can be cut, such as laser cut, into the tube. The slots can be cut into the material that forms the tube, before the material is formed into a tube. - In one example embodiment, the direction of expansion of the
coaption element 1200 can be controlled. For example, the configuration of theslots 1205 and/or a shape-set of the tube can be selected to control the shape of the expandedcoaption element 1200. For example, the configuration of theslots 1205 and/or a shape-set can determine the way the width/size of the coaption element in the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction expanded (and/or contract). Referring toFIG. 106A , the tube wall of the generallycylindrical coaption element 1200 can extend outward fromcaps 1201 by adistance 1204. Referring now toFIG. 108A ,axial forces 1208 and/orrotational forces 1209 can be applied to thecaps 1201 of thecoaption element 1200 causing thecoaption element 1200 to expand from the configuration illustrated byFIG. 106A to the configuration illustrated byFIG. 108A . In the illustrated example, compressing thecoaption element 1200 axially and twisting the coaption element thecoaption element 1200 to expand or bulge in anoutward direction 1210, such that thedistance 1204 increases. - Referring to
FIGS. 106B and 108B , thecoaption element 1200 can be compressed in a wide variety of different ways. For example, a threadedconnection 1221 can be used to draw the two ends of the coaption element together and twist the coaption element in a first direction or push the two ends of the coaption element apart and twist the coaption element in a second direction. For example, a collar can be provided on each end of the coaption element. One of the collars can threadedly engage a threaded shaft, while the other collar is fixedly connected to the shaft. Rotating the shaft in one direction draws the collars together and rotates the collars relative to one another in a first direction. Rotating the shaft in the opposite direction moves the collars apart and rotates the collars relative to one another in a second direction. The pitch of the threaded connection can be selected to set a ratio between the distance thecoaption element 1200 is compressed and the angle that the coaption element is twisted. - Incorporating the
coaption elements 1200 illustrated byFIGS. 106A, 108A, 106B, and 108B into an implantable prosthetic device of the present application allows the coaption element to be expanded to press outward against tissue grasped between the coaption element and the paddles and/or gripping members. -
FIGS. 106C and 108C illustrate an example embodiment of a controllablyexpandable coaption element 1200 for an implantable prosthetic device. Thecoaption element 1200 can be used on its own, with a covering, or inside any of the coaption elements described herein (to expand the coaption element). Thecoaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application. Referring toFIG. 106C , thecoaption element 1200 has pairs of pivotally connectedarms 1231. The pairs of pivotally connectedarms 1231 each extending between and pivotally connected to twocaps 1201. In the illustrated example, there are two pairs of pivotally connectedarms 1231. However, there can be one, three, four, or any number of pairs of pivotally connected arms. - In one example embodiment, the direction of expansion of the
coaption element 1200 can be controlled. For example, two pairs (as illustrated) of pivotally connected arms can be included to change the width/size of the coaption element in only one of the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction. Four pairs of pivotally connectedarms 1231 can be included to change the width/size of the coaption element in both the Anterior to Posterior direction and Medial to Lateral direction. When four pairs of pivotally connectedarms 1231 are included, the arms can have different lengths and/or pivot point locations to make thecoaption element 1200 expand (or contract) differently in different dictions. For example, the lengths of the arms can be selected to expand more in the Medial to Lateral direction than the Anterior to Posterior direction. - Referring now to
FIG. 108C ,axial forces 1208 can be applied to thecaps 1201 of thecoaption element 1200 causing thecoaption element 1200 to expand from the configuration illustrated byFIG. 106C to the configuration illustrated byFIG. 108C . In the illustrated example, compressing the pivotally connectedarms 1231 axially causes thepivotal connections 1233 or knees to spread apart in anoutward direction 1210, such that thedistance 1204 increases. - Referring to
FIGS. 106C and 108C , thecoaption element 1200 can be compressed in a wide variety of different ways. For example, a threadedconnection 1221 can be used to draw the two ends of the coaption element together or push the two ends of the coaption element apart. For example, a collar can be provided on each end of the coaption element. One of the collars can threadedly engage a threaded shaft, while the other collar is rotatably connected to the shaft. Rotating the shaft in one direction draws the collars together. Rotating the shaft in the opposite direction moves the collars apart. - Incorporating the
coaption element 1200 illustrated byFIGS. 106C, and 108C into an implantable prosthetic device of the present application allows the coaption element to be expanded to press outward against tissue grasped between the coaption element and the paddles and/or gripping members. -
FIGS. 106D and 108D illustrate an example embodiment of anexpandable coaption element 1200 for an implantable prosthetic device. Thecoaption element 1200 can be used on its own, with a covering (SeeFIGS. 106E and 108E ), or inside any of the coaption elements described herein (to expand the coaption element). Thecoaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application. Referring toFIG. 106C , thecoaption element 1200 has, acentral support member 1243, one or more pivotally connectedarms 1241, andconnection lines 1245. Eacharm 1241 extends from a pivotal connection to thecentral support member 1243. Eachconnection line 1245 is connected to thecentral support member 1243 and a pivotallyconnected arm 1241. The length of theconnection line 1245 sets the degree to which the connection arms pivot away from thecentral support member 1243. In the illustrated example, there are two pivotally connectedarms 1241. However, there can be one, three, four, or any number of pivotally connected arms. - In one example embodiment, the direction of expansion of the
coaption element 1200 can be controlled. For example, two pivotally connected arms can be included to change the width/size of the coaption element in only one of the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction. Four pivotally connectedarms 1241 can be included to change the width/size of the coaption element in both the Anterior to Posterior direction and Medial to Lateral direction. When four pivotally connectedarms 1241 are included, the arms and/or theconnection lines 1245 can have different lengths and/or pivot point locations to make thecoaption element 1200 expand (or contract) differently in different dictions. For example, the lengths of the arms and/or the connection lines can be selected to expand more in the Medial to Lateral direction than the Anterior to Posterior direction. - The
arms 1241 can be moved from the contracted position (FIG. 106D ) to the expanded position (FIG. 108D ). For example, thearms 1241 can be biased toward the expandedposition 1241 by a spring or other biasing means. In the illustrated example,restraints 1247, such as sutures hold thearms 1241 in the contracted position. Therestraints 1247 can be removed or broken to cause thecoaption element 1200 to expand from the configuration illustrated byFIG. 106D to the configuration illustrated byFIG. 108D . -
FIGS. 106E and 108E illustrate an example embodiment that is similar to the embodiment illustrated byFIGS. 106D and 108D , except that the coaption element includes acovering material 1253. Thecovering material 1253 can extend from thecentral support member 1243 to eacharm 1241. Thecovering material 1253 can be used with theconnection lines 1245 or the covering material can eliminate the need for the connection lines 1245. - Referring now to
FIG. 106F , anexample coaption element 1200, similar to the embodiment illustrated byFIGS. 106-109 , for an implantable prosthetic device is shown. Thecoaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application. Referring toFIG. 106F , thecoaption element 1200 is defined by acoil 1263 extending between twocaps 1201. Thecoaption element 1200 can have any shape, such as any of the shapes disclosed herein. Thecoil 1263 can be made from a shape memory alloy, such as nitinol. - In one example embodiment, the direction of expansion of the
coaption element 1200 can be controlled. For example, the shape-set of thecoil 1263 can be selected to control the shape of the expandedcoaption element 1200. For example, the configuration of the shape-set can determine the way the width/size of the coaption element in the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction expand (and/or contract). Referring toAxial forces 1208 and/orrotational forces 1209 can be applied tocaps 1201 of thecoaption element 1200 causing thecoaption element 1200 to expand or retract from the configuration illustrated byFIG. 106F . In the illustrated example, extending thecoil 1263 axially and twisting thecoil 1263 contracts the coil in aninward direction 1211 and compressing thecoil 1263 axially and twisting the coil in the opposite direction expands or bulge the coil in an outward direction. - Referring to
FIG. 106F , thecoaption element 1200 can be compressed in a wide variety of different ways. For example, a threadedconnection 1221 can be used to draw the two ends of the coaption element together and twist the coaption element in a first direction or push the two ends of the coaption element apart and twist the coaption element in a second direction. For example, a collar can be fixedly connected to each end of thecoil 1263. One of the collars can threadedly engage a threaded shaft, while the other collar is fixedly connected to the shaft. Rotating the shaft in one direction draws the collars together and rotates the collars relative to one another in a first direction. Rotating the shaft in the opposite direction moves the collars apart and rotates the collars relative to one another in a second direction. The pitch of the threaded connection can be selected to set a ratio between the distance thecoaption element 1200 is compressed and the angle that the coaption element is twisted. - Incorporating the
coaption elements 1200 illustrated byFIG. 106F into an implantable prosthetic device of the present application allows the coaption element to be expanded to press outward against tissue grasped between the coaption element and the paddles and/or gripping members. -
FIGS. 106G-106I illustrate example embodiments ofexpandable coaption elements 1200. In the examples illustrated byFIGS. 106G-106I , the coaption elements are inflated by a fluid medium to expand the coaption element. The fluid medium can take a wide variety of different forms. Examples of fluids that can be used to inflate thecoaption element 1200 include, but are not limited to, air, gel, water, blood, foaming materials, etc. Thecoaption element 1200 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application. - Referring to
FIG. 106G , thecoaption element 1200 can have an outer layer 1271 (For example, any of thecoaption elements inner layer 1273 or balloon. Thecoaption element 1200 can have any shape, such as any of the shapes disclosed herein. In the example illustrated byFIGS. 106G and 1086 , theinner layer 1273 is disposed in theouter layer 1271 and can have the same or generally the same shape as the inner surface of the outer layer. The inner layer can be made from an expandable material, such as a rubber or other material traditionally used for making balloons and angioplasty devices. Theouter layer 1271 can be made from a shape memory alloy, such as nitinol. - Referring to
FIGS. 106H and 106I , in one example embodiment, the direction of expansion of thecoaption element 1200 can be controlled. In the example illustrated byFIG. 106H , theinner layer 1273 comprises two balloons that are optionally connected together. However, any number of balloons can be used. For example, the inner layer can comprise 3, 4, or any number of balloons. The balloons can be individually inflated to control the shape of expansion of thecoaption element 1200. When the balloons are connected together, the connection can also affect the shape of expansion. In the example illustrated by 106H, the balloons are connected together along aplane 1275 or area. Expansion of theinner layer 1273 in thedirection 1277 will be less than the expansion in thedirection 1279 due to theconnection 1275. As such, in this example, the expansion due to inflation can be limited to or substantially limited to expansion in the Medial to Lateral direction. - The use of multiple balloons and the configuration of any connections between the balloons can determine the way the width/size of the coaption element in the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction expand (and/or contract).
- In the example illustrated by
FIG. 106I , theinner layer 1273 comprises one ormore supports 1281 or struts. Onesupport 1281 is illustrated, but any number can be used. For example, the inner layer can comprise 2, 3, 4, or any number of supports. Thesupports 1281 can divide the inner layer into multiple independently inflatable chambers or the supports may not seal off independent chambers and inflation fluid applied to any chamber will fill all of the chambers. When there are independently inflatable chambers, the chambers can be individually inflated to control the shape of expansion of thecoaption element 1200. The supports also affect the shape of expansion. In the example illustrated by 106I, thesupport 1281 will reduce or eliminate expansion of theinner layer 1273 in thedirection 1277. As such, in this example, the expansion due to inflation can be limited to or substantially limited to expansion in the Medial to Lateral direction. - The use of multiple independently inflatable chambers and/or the configuration of the
support members 1281 can determine the way the width/size of the coaption element in the Anterior to Posterior direction, and/or Medial to Lateral direction expand (and/or contract). - Incorporating the
coaption elements 1200 illustrated byFIGS. 106G-106I into an implantable prosthetic device of the present application allows the coaption element to be expanded to press outward against tissue grasped between the coaption element and the paddles and/or gripping members. - Referring now to
FIGS. 110-111 , an example implantableprosthetic device 1300 is shown. Thedevice 1300 is similar to thedevice 100, described above, and includes acoaption element 1310, paddles 1320, and clasps or grippingmembers 1330. Referring now toFIG. 111 , a top view of thecoaption element 1310 is shown. As can be seen inFIG. 111 , thecoaption element 1310 has an oval or generally oval-shaped cross-section. Thecoaption element 1310 does not include a central opening and can be formed from a solid piece of material, such as foam. Forming thecoaption element 1310 from a solid piece of foam material prohibits blood from flowing through the center of thecoaption element 1310, thereby substantially eliminating a location where blood can be captured. Thedevice 1300 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and thedevice 1300 can be positioned to engagevalve tissue prosthetic device 1300 can be opened and closed in a wide variety of different ways. For example, a sleeve can be slidably disposed over the coaption element to engage and open the paddles. Or, the paddles can be opened by pulling a line or suture that opens the clasps and the movement of the clasps can open the paddles. However, any mechanism for opening and closing thedevice 1300 can be used. - Referring now to
FIGS. 112-128 , anexample paddle frame 1400 for an implantable prosthetic device is shown. Thepaddle frame 1400 can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application. Thepaddle frame 1400 is formed from a piece ofmaterial 1402, such as nitinol, or any other suitable material. Thepaddle frame 1400 extends from acap attachment portion 1410 to apaddle connection portion 1420 and has aproximal portion 1422, amiddle portion 1424, and adistal portion 1426. In some embodiments, thepaddle frame 1400 includesattachment portions 1440 for securing a cover (seeFIG. 30 ), theinner paddle 520, and/or theouter paddle 522 to thepaddle frame 1400. In some embodiments, thepaddle frame 1400 is thinner in the location of thefifth curve 1438 to facilitate bending of both sides of thepaddle frame 1400 toward thecenter plane 1404 during, for example, crimping of the device. - The
paddle frame 1400 extends between afirst attachment portion 1412 in a rounded, three-dimensional shape through the proximal, middle, anddistal portions second attachment portion 1414. To form a rounded three-dimensional shape, thepaddle frame 1400 is bent or curved in multiple locations as thepaddle frame 1400 extends between the first andsecond attachment portions attachment portions notches paddle frame 1400 flexes at thearea 1419. Thearea 1419 can include awider portion 1417 to distribute the stress that results from flexing thepaddle frame 1400 over a greater area. Also,notches radiused notches 1415 at each end of the notches. Theradiused notches 1415 serve as strain reliefs for thebending area 1419 and the area where thepaddle frame 1400 connects to the cap. - The
paddle frame 1400 curves away from a median or central plane 1404 (FIG. 115 ) at afirst curve 1430 to widen the shape of thepaddle frame 1400. As can be seen inFIG. 117 , thepaddle frame 1400 also curves away from afrontal plane 1406 in the location of thefirst curve 1430. Thepaddle frame 1400 curves away from the outward direction of thefirst curve 1430 at asecond curve 1432 to form sides of theframe 1400. The paddle frame continues to slope away from thefrontal plane 1406 in the location of thesecond curve 1432. In some embodiments, thesecond curve 1432 has a larger radius than thefirst curve 1430. Thepaddle frame 1400 curves away from thefrontal plane 1406 at athird curve 1434 as thepaddle frame 1400 continues to curve in the arc of thesecond curve 1432 when viewed from thefrontal plane 1406. This curvature at thethird curve 1434 results in a gradual departure of theframe 1400, and thus the native valve leaflet from thecenterline 1406. This departure from the centerline results in spreading of the leaflet tissue toward the valve annulus, which can result in less stress on the leaflet tissue. Thepaddle frame 1400 curves toward thelateral plane 1404 at afourth curve 1436 as theframe 1400 continues to curve away from thefrontal plane 1406. The rounded three-dimensional shape of thepaddle frame 1400 is closed with afifth curve 1438 that joins both sides of thepaddle frame 1400. As can be seen inFIGS. 116 and 118 , thepaddle frame 1400 has an arcuate or generally arcuate shape as theframe 1400 extends away from theattachment portion 1420 and to theclosed portion 1424. Themiddle portion 1422 of the frame is closer to thefrontal plane 1406 than theclosed portion 1424, giving the sides of the middle portion 1422 a rounded, wing-like shape that engages the curved surface of coaption element (not shown) during grasping of native tissue between a paddle (not shown) and coaption element of an implantable device of the present invention. - Referring to
FIG. 191 , in an example embodiment, a flat blank 1403 ofpaddle frame 1400 can be cut, for example laser cut, from a flat sheet of material. Referring toFIG. 192 , the cut blank 1403 can then be bent to form the three-dimensionalshaped paddle frame 1400. - Referring to
FIGS. 193 and 194 , in one example embodiment, the paddle frames 1400 can be shape-set to provide increased clamping force against or toward thecoaption element 510 when thepaddles FIG. 194 ) to a first position (e.g.,FIG. 193 ) which is beyond the position where theinner paddle 520 would engage the coaption element, such as beyond thecentral plane 552 of thedevice 500, such as beyond the opposite side of the coaption element, such as beyond the outer paddle on the opposite side of the coaption element. Referring toFIG. 194 , thepaddle frame 194 is flexed and attached to the inner andouter paddles FIG. 193 configuration can increase the clamping force of the paddle frames 1400 compared to paddle frames that are shape-set in the closed configuration (FIG. 194 ). - The magnitude of the preload of the paddle frames 1400 can be altered by adjusting the degree to which the paddle frames 1400 are shape-set relative to the
coaption element 510. The farther the paddle frames 1400 are shape-set past the closed position, the greater the preload. - The curves of the
paddle frame 1400 can be independent from one another, that is, one curve is complete before another curve starts, or can be combined, that is, thepaddle frame 1400 curves in multiple directions simultaneously. - Referring now to
FIGS. 112A, 114A, 115A, 116A, 117A, and 118A , example paddle frames 1400A for an implantable prosthetic device are shown. The paddle frames 1400A can be used with any of the implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application. Eachpaddle frame 1400A is formed from a piece ofmaterial 1402A, such as nitinol, or any other suitable material. Eachpaddle frame 1400A extends from acap attachment portion 1410A to apaddle connection portion 1420A and has aproximal portion 1422A, amiddle portion 1424A, and adistal portion 1426A. - Each
paddle frame 1400A extends between afirst attachment portion 1412A in a rounded, three-dimensional shape through the proximal, middle, anddistal portions second attachment portion 1414. To form a rounded three-dimensional shape, eachpaddle frame 1400A is bent or curved in multiple locations as thepaddle frame 1400A extends between the first andsecond attachment portions attachment portions notches area 1419A. Thearea 1419A can include awider portion 1417A to distribute the stress that results from flexing thepaddle frame 1400A over a greater area. Also,notches radiused notches 1415A at each end of thenotches radiused notches 1415A serve as strain reliefs for thebending area 1419A and the area where thepaddle frame 1400A connects to the cap. - Each
paddle frame 1400A curves away from a median orcentral plane 1404A (FIG. 116A ) at afirst curve 1430A to widen the shape of thepaddle frame 1400A. As can be seen inFIG. 114A , thepaddle frame 1400A also curves away from afrontal plane 1406A in the location of thefirst curve 1430A. Thepaddle frame 1400A curves away from the outward direction of thefirst curve 1430A at asecond curve 1432A to formsides 1433A of theframe 1400A that are parallel or substantially parallel to thecentral plane 1404A when viewed from thefrontal plane 1406A. The paddle frame continues to slope away from thefrontal plane 1406A in the location of thesecond curve 1432A. In some embodiments, thesecond curve 1432A has a larger radius than thefirst curve 1430A. Thepaddle frame 1400A curves back toward from thefrontal plane 1406A at athird curve 1434A in themiddle portion 1424A while thesides 1433A of thepaddle frame 1400A remain parallel or substantially parallel to thecentral plane 1404A. Thepaddle frame 1400A curves away from thecentral plane 1404A a second time at afourth curve 1436A and continues to curve away from thecentral plane 1404A through the remainder of the middle anddistal portions paddle frame 1400A is closed by anend portion 1442A connected to thesides 1433A byfifth curves 1438A that form rounded corners of thedistal end 1426A of thepaddle frame 1400A. - The
end portion 1442A can be wider than the remainder of thepaddle frame 1400A to accommodate features that allow the paddle frames 1400A to be attached to the paddles (not shown) and cover (not shown). For example, theend portion 1442A can include aslot 1444A for receiving a portion of a strip of material, such as the strip ofmaterial opening 1446A in theend portion 1442A allows a strip of material to be inserted into theslot 1444A. Theend portion 1442A can also includeattachment holes 1440A for securing a cover (seeFIG. 30A ) to thepaddle frame 1400A. - As can be seen in
FIGS. 116A and 117A , thepaddle frame 1400A has a generally rounded rectangle shape as the frame extends away from theattachment portion 1410A to the closed end of thepaddle connection portion 1420A. Themiddle portion 1424A of the frame is closer to thefrontal plane 1406A than thedistal portion 1426A, giving the sides of themiddle portion 1424A a rounded, wing-like shape that engages the front and back surfaces of the coaption element (not shown) during grasping of native tissue between a paddle (not shown) and coaption element of an implantable device described herein. - Referring to
FIGS. 195 and 196 , thepaddle frames 1400A are shown assembled to thecollar 514A of an example implantable device, such as thedevice 500A described above. In one example embodiment, the paddle frames 1400A can be shape-set to provide increased clamping force against or toward acoaption element 510A when thepaddles FIG. 196 ) to a first position (e.g.,FIG. 195 ) which is beyond the position where theinner paddle 522A would engage thecoaption element 510A, such as beyond thecentral plane 552A of thedevice 500A (e.g.,FIG. 70A ), such as beyond the opposite side of the coaption element, such as beyond the outer paddle on the opposite side of the coaption element. In the first position thesides 1433A of the paddle frames 1400A are intertwined in that thesides 1433A of onepaddle frame 1400A are moved slightly laterally to allow movement past thesides 1433A of theother paddle frame 1400A until theend portions 1442A of eachframe 1400A contact each other and thesides 1433A and prevent further movement. - The magnitude of the preload of the paddle frames 1400A can be altered by adjusting the degree to which the paddle frames 1400A are shape-set relative to the
coaption element 510A. The farther the paddle frames 1400A are shape-set past the closed position, the greater the preload force when the paddle frames 1400A are moved into the open position. - The curves of the
paddle frame 1400A can be independent from one another, that is, one curve is complete before another curve starts, or can be combined, that is, thepaddle frame 1400A curves in multiple directions simultaneously. - Like the
paddle frame 1400 shown inFIGS. 191 and 192 , in an example embodiment, thepaddle frame 1400A can be formed from a flat blank that is cut from a flat sheet of material, for example, by laser cutting. The cut blank can then be bent to form the three-dimensional shape of thepaddle frame 1400A. - Referring now to
FIGS. 119-120 , thepaddle frame 1400 is shown in an expanded condition (FIG. 119 ) and a compressed condition (FIG. 120 ). Thepaddle frame 1400 is in a compressed condition when the paddles are disposed in adelivery device 1450. Referring toFIG. 119 , thepaddle frame 1400 is moved from the expanded condition to the compressed condition by compressing the paddle in the direction X and extending a length of the paddle in the direction Y. When thepaddles 1400 are in the compressed condition, the paddles have a width H. The width H can be, for example between about 4 mm and about 7 mm, such as, between about 5 mm and about 6 mm. In alternative embodiments, the width H can be less than 4 mm or more than 7 mm. In certain embodiments, the width H of thecompressed paddles 1400 is equal or substantially equal to a width D of thedelivery opening 1452 of thedelivery device 1450. The ratio between the width W of the paddles in the expanded condition and the width H of the paddles in the compressed condition can be, for example, about 4 to 1 or less, such as about 3 to 1 or less, such as about 2 to 1 or less, such as about 1.5 to 1, such as about 1.25 to 1, such as about 1 to 1. In alternative embodiments, the ratio between the width W and the width H can be more than 4 to 1.FIG. 120 illustrates theconnection portions 1410 compressed from the positions illustrated byFIG. 119 . However, in some example embodiments, theconnection portions 1410 will not be compressed. For example, theconnection portions 1410 will not be compressed when theconnection portions 1410 are connected to acap 514. Thepaddle frame 1400A shown inFIGS. 112A and 114A-118A can be similarly compressed. - Referring now to
FIGS. 121-124 , the exampleimplantable device 500 is shown in open and closed conditions with paddle frames that are compressed or stretched as theanchor portion 506 of the device is opened and closed. The paddle frames 1524 are like thepaddle frame 1400 described above. Referring now toFIG. 121 , theanchor portion 506 is shown in a closed condition. Referring now toFIG. 122 , the paddle frames 1524 have a first width W1 and a first length L1. Referring now toFIG. 123 , theanchor portion 506 is shown in an open condition and the paddle frames 1524 are in an extended condition (FIG. 124 ). Opening theanchor portion 506 of thedevice 500 causes the paddle frames 1524 to move, extend, or pivot outward from thecoaption portion 510 and transition to the extended condition. In the extended condition, the paddle frames 1524 have a second or extended length L2 and a second or extended width W2. In the extended condition, thepaddle frame 1524 lengthens and narrows such that the second length L2 is greater than the first length L1 and the second width W2 is narrower than the first width W1. One advantage of this embodiment is that the paddle frames become narrower and can have less chordal engagement during grasping of the leaflets. However, the paddle frames become wide when the implant is closed to enhance support of the leaflet. Another advantage of this embodiment is that the paddle frames also become narrower and longer in the bailout position. The narrower paddle size in the extended, elongated, or bailout position can allow for less chordal entanglement and increased ease of bailout. - Referring now to
FIGS. 125-128 , the exampleimplantable device 500 is shown in open and closed conditions with paddle frames that are compressed or stretched as theanchor portion 506 of the device is opened and closed. The paddle frames 1624 are similar to thepaddle frame 1400 described above. Referring now toFIG. 125 , theanchor portion 506 is shown in a closed condition. Referring now toFIG. 126 , the paddle frames 1624 have a first width W1 and a first length L1. Referring now toFIG. 127 , theanchor portion 506 is shown in an open condition and the paddle frames 1624 are in a compressed condition (FIG. 128 ). Opening theanchor portion 506 of thedevice 500 causes the paddle frames 1624 to move, extend, or pivot outward from thecoaption portion 510 and transition to the compressed condition. In the compressed condition, the paddle frames 1624 have a second or compressed length L2 and a second or compressed width W2. In the compressed condition, thepaddle frame 1624 shortens and widens such that the second length L2 is less than the first length L1 and the second width W2 is wider than the first width W1. - Referring now to
FIGS. 129-136 , example implantable prosthetic devices are shown that can be locked or fastened closed. Referring now toFIG. 129 , the example implantableprosthetic device 500 is shown that can be locked or retained in a closed condition with magnets. As described above, thedevice 500 includes acoaption element 510 and paddles 520. Thepaddles 520 open and close to graspleaflets coaption element 510 includes one ormore magnets 1700 and thepaddles 520 include one ormore magnets 1702. Themagnets magnets 1702 in thepaddles 520 are attracted to themagnets 1700 in thecoaption element 510 and the magnetic attractive forces between themagnets paddles 520 in a closed condition. In certain embodiments, themagnets implantable device 500 can be locked and unlocked by moving—such as rotating—themagnet 1700 within the coaption element. For example, themagnet 1700 can be configured such that themagnet 1700 attracts themagnets 1702 in thepaddles 520 in a first orientation and repels themagnets 1702 in thepaddles 520 when themagnet 1700 is rotated 90 degrees into a second orientation. - Referring now to
FIGS. 130-131 , the example implantableprosthetic device 500 is shown that can be locked or retained in a closed condition with anelastic band 1800. Theelastic band 1800 can be made from any flexible material and have any configuration. For example, the elastic band can comprise coiled nitinol, can have a stent like structure, etc. - As described above, the
device 500 includes acoaption element 510, paddles 520, andbarbed clasps 530. Thepaddles 520 andbarbed clasps 530 open and close to graspleaflets paddles 520 move between an open condition (FIG. 130 ) to a closed condition (FIG. 131 ) by actuation of an actuation element or means foractuation 512, as described above. Theelastic band 1800 can be arranged to lock or retain thedevice 500 in a closed condition. When thedevice 500 is in the open condition (FIG. 130 ) theband 1800 is arranged around thepaddles 520 in a relaxed or disengaged condition. For example, theband 1800 can be arranged around a narrower portion of theopen device 500, such as a tapered portion of thepaddles 520 near adistal portion 507 of the device. When thedevice 500 is in the closed condition (FIG. 131 ) theband 1800 is arranged around thepaddles 520 in an engaged condition. In certain embodiments, when theband 1800 is in the engaged condition it is arranged around the widest portion of thedevice 500 or can be arranged around the center of thedevice 500. - The
band 1800 is moved from the disengaged condition in a closing or engaging direction 1802 to the engaged condition with sutures (not shown) or other suitable means of moving theband 1800. Movement of theband 1800 can cause thepaddles 520 to move in aclosing direction 1804, thereby closing and securing thedevice 500 in a single movement of theband 1800. Alternatively,device 500 can be closed and theband 1800 moved into the engaged location to secure thedevice 500 in the closed condition. - Referring now to
FIG. 132 , the example implantableprosthetic device 500 is shown that can be locked or retained in a closed condition with a biasing member 1900. As described above, thedevice 500 includes acoaption element 510, paddles 520, andbarbed clasps 530. Thepaddles 520 are moved between open and closed positions with anactuation element 512 extending through thecoaption element 510 to acap 514. Thepaddles 520 andbarbed clasps 530 are opened and closed to graspleaflets paddles 520 and theclasps 530 engage the tissue ofvalve leaflets device 500 to the valve tissue. - The biasing member 1900 (e.g., a spring) is configured to bias the
cap 514 toward thecoaption element 510, thereby biasing thedevice 500 toward the closed condition. After thedevice 500 is delivered to and attached to the valve tissue with a delivery device (not shown), the delivery device is removed from the patient's body and the biasing member 1900 maintains thedevice 500 in a closed condition to prevent detachment of thedevice 500 from the valve tissue. - Referring now to
FIGS. 133-134 , an example implantableprosthetic device 2000 is shown that can be locked or retained in a closed condition with latches. Thedevice 2000 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and thedevice 2000 can be positioned to engagevalve tissue - The
device 2000 is similar to other implantable devices described above and includespaddles 2002 and gripping members or clasps 2004. Thepaddles 2002 are opened and closed to grasp thenative leaflets gap 2006 between thepaddles 2002 and grippingmembers 2004. Thedevice 2000 also includes alatch member 2008 attached to thepaddles 2002, in which thelatch member 2008 is configured to attach thepaddles 2002 to thegripping members 2004 when thedevice 2000 is in the closed position. In some embodiments, thelatch member 2008 serves as a secondary latching mechanism and is configured to keep thedevice 2000 in the closed position when other mechanisms fail. - Referring to
FIG. 133 , thedevice 2000 is in an open position withvalve tissue opening 2006 between thepaddles 2002 and thegripping members 2004. Referring toFIG. 134 , thedevice 2000 is moved to the closed position such that thevalve tissue paddles 2002 and thegripping members 2004. Thedevice 2000 can be moved to the closed position by any suitable manner, such as, for example, any manner described in the present application. When thedevice 2000 is moved to the closed position, thelatch member 2008 punctures thevalve tissue member 2004 to secure thepaddle 2002 to the grippingmember 2004. Thelatch member 2008 can take any suitable form that can secure thepaddles 2002 to thegripping members 2004, such as, for example, metals, plastics, etc. - Referring now to
FIGS. 135-136 , the example implantableprosthetic device 2000 is shown that can be locked or retained in a closed condition with latches. InFIGS. 135-136 , thedevice 2000 includes acoaption element 2010. Referring toFIG. 135 , thedevice 2000 is in an open position withvalve tissue opening 2006 between thepaddles 2002 and thegripping members 2004. Referring toFIG. 136 , thedevice 2000 is moved to the closed position such that thevalve tissue paddles 2002 and thegripping members 2004. Thedevice 2000 can be moved to the closed position by any suitable manner, such as, for example, any manner described in the present application. When thedevice 2000 is moved to the closed position, thelatch member 2008 punctures thevalve tissue member 2004 to secure thepaddle 2002 to the grippingmember 2004. In the illustrated embodiment, thelatch member 2008 protrudes beyond the grippingmembers 2004 and into thecoaption element 2010. In some embodiments, thelatch member 2008 can be secured in thecoaption element 2010 by latching onto a portion of thecoaption element 2010 or by penetrating thecoaption element 2010 material. Thelatch member 2008 can take any suitable form that can secure thepaddles 2002 to thegripping members 2004, such as, for example, metals, plastics, etc. - Referring now to
FIGS. 137-145 , various embodiments of implantable prosthetic devices and methods of using the same are shown that facilitate release of native tissue grasped by the implantable prosthetic devices. The devices can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and the devices can be positioned to engagevalve tissue - Referring now to
FIG. 137 , adevice 2100 with stretchable clasps or gripping members is shown. Thedevice 2100 is delivered from adelivery sheath 2102 and has acoaption element 2110, paddles 2120, and clasps or grippingmembers 2130. The grippingmembers 2130 includebarbs 2132 andstretchable portions 2134. Thestretchable portions 2134 allow theclasps 2130 to be stretched in a stretching direction 2136. Actuation lines oractuation sutures 2104 extend from thedelivery sheath 2102 to theclasps 2130. Retracting the lines/sutures 2104 in aretraction direction 2106 opens and stretches theclasps 2130 to a fully extended position. In certain embodiments, theclasps 2130 primarily stretch once theclasps 2130 are in the fully open position. Movement of thebarbs 2132 in the stretching direction 2136 allows for clean disengagement from the native tissue. In some embodiments, thestretchable portion 2134 is configured to be moved such that thebarbs 2132 exit the valve tissue in a direction opposite or substantially opposite the direction in which the barbs entered the native tissue. Alternatively, theclasps 2130 can be otherwise extendable to allow for disengagement from the native tissue without tearing the native tissue. For example,joint portions 2131 can be configured to allow thebarbs 2132 of theclasps 2130 to be pulled in the direction 2136. - Referring now to
FIGS. 138-143 , two example embodiments of methods of releasing valve tissue from theprosthetic device 500 are shown. As described above, thedevice 500 includes acoaption element 510,inner paddles 522,outer paddles 520, andbarbed clasps 530. Thedevice 500 is deployed from adelivery sheath 502. Anactuation element 512 extends through thecoaption element 510 to acap 514. Actuation of theactuation element 512 opens and closes thepaddles barbed clasps 530 includebarbs 536,moveable arms 534, andstationary arms 532. Thestationary arms 532 are attached to theinner paddles 522 so that theclasps 530 move with the movement of theinner paddles 522. Clasp control members or actuation lines/sutures 537 extend from thedelivery sheath 502 to themoveable arms 534 of theclasps 530. -
FIGS. 138-141 illustrate an example method of releasing grasped valve tissue. In the example illustrated byFIGS. 138-141 , the device is shown in an open or substantially open position to more clearly illustrate the movements of the parts of thedevice 500 that are involved with tissue release. However, in practice the tissue release method is more likely to be practiced with thedevice 500 in the more closed positions illustrated byFIGS. 142 and 143 . That is, it is not likely that the paddles and clasps will be substantially opened before moving the clasps to release the valve tissue as illustrated byFIGS. 138-141 . It is more likely that the paddles and clasps will only be opened slightly before releasing the valve tissue as illustrated byFIGS. 142 and 143 . The same parts that move in the example illustrated byFIGS. 138-141 move in the example illustrated byFIGS. 142-143 . - Referring now to
FIG. 138 , thedevice 500 is shown in an open or substantially open position with theclasps 530 in a closed position. Retraction of the clasp control members or actuation lines/sutures 537 articulates, flexes, or pivots themoveable arms 534 of theclasps 530 to a partially open position (FIG. 139 ) and then to a fully open position (FIG. 140 ). Referring now toFIG. 141 , once theclasps 530 are in the fully open position (FIG. 140 ), further retraction of the actuation lines/sutures 537 in theretraction direction 560 pulls upward on themoveable arms 534,barbs 536, andinner paddles 522 in a tissue release direction. Theportion 523 of theinner paddles 522 closest to the coaption element flex upward indirection 562 to allow this movement in theretraction direction 560. There can optionally be a small gap G140 between theclaps 530 and thecoaption element 510. The inner paddles can flex at the small gap (if there is a small gap) or at theconnection 523 between thecoaption element 510 and the inner paddles if there is not a gap. Thisflexing movement 562 of theinner paddles 522 can optionally also cause the outer paddles to move or pivot downward. Movement of thebarbs 536 in thetissue release direction 560 allows for clean disengagement from the native tissue. The barbs can be at an angle θ (seeFIG. 138 ) to themoveable arms 534 that facilitates release from the tissue. For example, the angle θ can be between 10 and 60 degrees, such as 20 and 50 degrees, such as 25 and 45 degrees, such as about 30 degrees, or 30 degrees. - Referring now to
FIGS. 142-143 , thedevice 500 is shown in a slightly opened position or a closed position. As mentioned above, the same parts of thedevice 500 move in the example illustrated byFIGS. 142 and 143 as in the example illustrated byFIGS. 138-141 . In the partially open position or closed position, further retraction of the actuation lines/sutures 537 in theretraction direction 560 pulls upward on themoveable arms 534,barbs 536, andinner paddles 522. The portion of theinner paddles 522 closest to the coaption element flexes or is lifted-up in thedirection 562 to allow themovement 560. As mentioned above, there can optionally be a small gap G140 between theclasps 530 and thecoaption element 510. The inner paddles can flex 562 at the small gap (if there is a small gap) or at the connection between thecoaption element 510 and the inner paddles if there is not a gap. The movement of thebarbs 536 in thedirection 560 releases the valve tissue from the barbs. The lifting on theinner paddles 522 can optionally also force theouter paddles 520 to move outward in anopening direction 564. The optionaloutward movement 564 of theouter paddles 520 relieves the pinching force applied to grasped tissue by the paddles and the coaption element. Relieving the pinching force on the tissue can also assist in the release of the tissue from the barbs. In one example embodiment, thedevice 500 is moved from the position illustrated byFIG. 143 to the position illustrated byFIG. 140 or 141 to fully disengage the device from the native valve. -
FIGS. 144-152 show anexample delivery assembly 2200 and its components. Referring toFIG. 144 , thedelivery assembly 2200 can comprise the implantable prosthetic spacer device 500 (or any other implantable device described in the present application) and adelivery apparatus 2202. Thedelivery apparatus 2202 can comprise a plurality of catheters and catheter stabilizers. For example, in the illustrated embodiment, thedelivery apparatus 2202 includes afirst catheter 2204, asecond catheter 2206, athird catheter 2208, andcatheter stabilizers 2210. Thesecond catheter 2206 extends coaxially through thefirst catheter 2204, and thethird catheter 2208 extends coaxially through the first andsecond catheters prosthetic spacer device 500 can be releasably coupled to a distal end portion of thethird catheter 2208 of thedelivery apparatus 2202, as further described below. - In the illustrated embodiment, the
delivery assembly 2200 is configured, for example, for implanting theprosthetic spacer device 500 in a native valve via a transvascular approach (e.g., the native mitral valve MV via a transseptal delivery approach, etc.). In other embodiments, thedelivery assembly 2200 can be configured for implanting theprosthetic spacer device 500 in aortic, tricuspid, or pulmonary valve regions of a human heart. Also, thedelivery assembly 2200 can be configured for various delivery methods, including transseptal, transaortic, transventricular, etc. - Referring to
FIG. 146 , the first collar orcap 514 of theprosthetic spacer device 500 can include abore 516A. In some embodiments, thebore 516A can comprise internal threads configured to releasably engage corresponding external threads on adistal end 512B of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 of thedelivery apparatus 2202, as shown inFIG. 145 . - Referring again to
FIG. 146 , the second orproximal collar 511 of theprosthetic spacer device 500 can include acentral opening 511C that is axially aligned with thebore 516A of thecap 514. Thecentral opening 511C of theproximal collar 511 can be configured to slidably receive the actuation element, actuation shaft, or means of actuating 512 of thedelivery apparatus 2202, as shown inFIG. 145 . In some embodiments, theproximal collar 511 and/or thecoaption element 510 can have a sealing member (not shown, but see, e.g., the sealingmember 413 shown inFIG. 23 ) configured to seal thecentral opening 511C when the actuation element or means of actuating 512 is withdrawn from thecentral opening 511C. - As shown in
FIG. 146 , theproximal collar 511 can also include a plurality of engagement portions orprojections 511A and a plurality of guide openings 511B. Theprojections 511A can extending radially outwardly and can be circumferentially offset (e.g., by about 90 degrees) relative to the guide openings 511B. The guide openings 511B can be disposed radially outwardly from thecentral opening 511C. Theprojections 511A and the guide openings 511B of theproximal collar 511 can be configured to releasably engage a coupler or means for coupling 2214 of thedelivery apparatus 2202, as shown inFIG. 145 . - Referring again to
FIG. 144 and as mentioned above, thedelivery apparatus 2202 can include the first andsecond catheters second catheters third catheter 2208 at the implantation location. - The first and
second catheters second sheaths catheters sheaths first catheter 2204 can be found, for example, in U.S. Published Patent Application No. 2016/0155987, which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. Additional details regarding thesecond catheter 2206 can be found, for example, in U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 62/418,528, which is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. - Referring still to
FIG. 144 ,delivery apparatus 2202 can also include thethird catheter 2208, as mentioned above. Thethird catheter 2208 can be used, for example, to deliver, manipulate, position, and/or deploy theprosthetic spacer device 500 at the implantation location. - Referring to
FIG. 148 , thethird catheter 2208 can comprise the actuation element orinner shaft 512, the coupler or means forcoupling 2214, anouter shaft 2220, a handle 2222 (shown schematically), and clasp control members oractuation lines 537. Aproximal end portion 2220 a of theouter shaft 2220 can be coupled to and extend distally from thehandle 2222, and adistal end portion 2220 b of theouter shaft 2220 can be coupled to the coupler or means forcoupling 2214. Aproximal end portion 512A of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 can coupled to anactuation knob 2226. The actuation element or means of actuating 512 can extend distally from the knob 2226 (shown schematically), through thehandle 2222, through theouter shaft 2220, and through the coupler or means forcoupling 2214. The actuation element or means of actuating 512 can be moveable (e.g., axially and/or rotationally) relative to theouter shaft 2220 and thehandle 2222. The clasp control members oractuation lines 537 can extend through and be axially movable relative to thehandle 2222 and theouter shaft 2220. The clasp control members/actuation lines 537 can also be axially movable relative to the actuation element or means of actuating 512. - As shown in
FIGS. 145-146 , the actuation element or means of actuating 512 (e.g., actuation shaft, etc.) of thethird catheter 2208 can be releasably coupled to thecap 514 of theprosthetic spacer device 500. For example, in some embodiments, thedistal end portion 512B of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 can comprise external thread configured to releasably engage the interior threads of thebore 516A of theprosthetic spacer device 500. As such, rotating the actuation element or means of actuating 512 in a first direction (e.g., clockwise) relative to thecap 514 of theprosthetic spacer device 500 releasably secures the actuation element or means of actuating 512 to thecap 514. Rotating the actuation element or means of actuating 512 in a second direction (e.g., counterclockwise) relative to thecap 514 of theprosthetic spacer device 500 releases the actuation element or means of actuating 512 from thecap 514. - Referring now to
FIGS. 145-147 , the coupler or means for coupling 2214 of thethird catheter 2208 can be releasably coupled to theproximal collar 511 of theprosthetic spacer device 500. For example, in some embodiments, the coupler or means for coupling 2214 can comprise a plurality offlexible arms 2228 and a plurality ofstabilizer members 2230. Theflexible arms 2228 can compriseapertures 2232, ports 2233 (FIG. 146 ), and eyelets 2234 (FIG. 147 ). Theflexible arms 2228 can be configured to move or pivot between a first or release configuration (FIG. 146 ) and a second or coupled configuration (FIGS. 145 and 147 ). In the first configuration, theflexible arms 2228 extend radially outwardly relative to thestabilizer members 2230. In the second configuration, theflexible arms 2230 extend axially parallel to thestabilizer members 2230 and theeyelets 2234 radially overlap 2234, as shown inFIG. 147 . Theflexible arms 2228 can be configured (e.g., shape-set) to be biased to the first configuration. - The
prosthetic spacer device 500 can be releasably coupled to the coupler or means for coupling 2214 by inserting thestabilizer members 2230 of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 into the guide openings 511B of theprosthetic spacer device 500. Theflexible arms 2228 of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 can then be moved or pivoted radially inwardly from the first configuration to the second configuration such that theprojections 511A of theprosthetic spacer device 500 extend radially into theapertures 2232 of theflexible arms 2228. Theflexible arms 2228 can be retained in the second configuration by inserting thedistal end portion 512B of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 (e.g., actuation shaft, etc.) throughopenings 2236 of theeyelets 2234, which prevents theflexible arms 2228 from moving or pivoting radially outwardly from the second configuration to the first configuration, thereby releasably coupling theprosthetic spacer device 500 to the coupler or means forcoupling 2214. - The
prosthetic spacer device 500 can be released from the coupler or means for coupling 2214 by proximally retracting the actuation element or means of actuating 512 relative to the coupler or means for coupling 2214 such that thedistal end portion 512B of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 withdraws from theopenings 2236 of theeyelets 2234. This allows theflexible arms 2228 to move or pivot radially outwardly from the second configuration to the first configuration, which withdraws theprojections 511A of theprosthetic spacer device 500 from theapertures 2232 of theflexible arms 2228. Thestabilizer members 2230 can remain inserted into the guide openings 511B of theprosthetic spacer device 500 during and after theflexible arms 2228 are released. This can, for example, prevent theprosthetic spacer device 500 from moving (e.g., shifting and/or rocking) while theflexible arms 2228 are released. Thestabilizer members 2230 can then be withdrawn from the guide openings 511B of theprosthetic spacer device 500 by proximally retracting the coupler or means for coupling 2214 relative to theprosthetic spacer device 500, thereby releasing theprosthetic spacer device 500 from the coupler or means forcoupling 2214. - Referring to
FIG. 148 , theouter shaft 2220 of thethird catheter 2208 can be an elongate shaft extending axially between theproximal end portion 2220 a, which is coupled thehandle 2222, and thedistal end portion 2220 b, which is coupled to the coupler or means forcoupling 2214. Theouter shaft 2220 can also include an intermediate portion 2220 c disposed between the proximal anddistal end portions - Referring to
FIG. 149 , theouter shaft 2220 can comprise a plurality of axially extending lumens, including an actuation element lumen or means ofactuating lumen 2238 and a plurality of control member lumens 2240 (e.g., four in the illustrated embodiment). In some embodiments, theouter shaft 2220 can comprise more (e.g., six) or less (e.g., two) than fourcontrol member lumens 2240. - The actuation element lumen or means of
actuating lumen 2238 can be configured to receive the actuation element or means of actuating 512, and thecontrol member lumens 2240 can be configured to receive one or more clasp control members oractuation lines 537. Thelumens lines 537 can be movable axially and/or rotationally) relative to therespective lumens lumens lumens lumens - Referring still to
FIGS. 148-149 , theouter shaft 2220 can be formed from various materials, including metals and polymers. For example, in one particular embodiment, theproximal end portion 2220 a can comprise stainless steel and the distal andintermediate portions 2220 b, 2220 c can comprise PEBAX (e.g., PEBAX®). Theouter shaft 2220 can also comprise an outer covering or coating, such as a polymer that is reflowed over theportions - The
outer shaft 2220 can include one ormore coil portions 2242 disposed radially outwardly from thelumens outer shaft 2220 can comprise a first coil 2242 a, a second coil 2242 b, and a third coil 2242 c. The first coil 2242 a can be the radially outermost coil, the third coil 2242 c can be the radially innermost coil, and the second coil 2242 b can be radially disposed between the first coil 2242 a and the third coil 2242 c. - The
coil portions 2242 can comprise various materials and/or configurations. For example, thecoil portions 2242 can be formed from stainless steel. In one particular embodiment, the first and third coils 2242 a, 2242 c comprise stainless steel coils wound in a left-hand configuration, and the second coil 2242 b comprises a stainless-steel coil wound in a right-hand configuration. - The
coil portions 2242 can also comprise various pitches. The pitch of one or more of thecoils 2242 can be the same or different than the pitch of one or moreother coils 2242. In one particular embodiment, the first and second coils 2242 a, 2242 b can have a first pitch (e.g., 0.74 in.), and the third coil can comprise a second pitch (e.g., 0.14 in.). - The
outer shaft 2220 can also comprise atie layer 2244 disposed radially inwardly from the third coil 2242 c. Thetie layer 2244 can be formed of various materials including polymers, such as PEBAX (e.g., PEBAX®). - As shown in
FIGS. 150-152 , thehandle 2222 of thethird catheter 2208 can include ahousing 2246, anactuation lock mechanism 2248, aclasp control mechanism 2250, and aflushing mechanism 2252. Referring toFIG. 150 , a distal end portion of thehousing 2246 can be coupled to theproximal end portion 2220 a of theouter shaft 2220. Theactuation lock mechanism 2248, theclasp control mechanism 2250, and aflushing mechanism 2252 can be coupled to a proximal end of thehousing 2246. Theactuation lock mechanism 2248 can be configured to selectively lock the position of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 relative to thehousing 2246 and theouter shaft 2220. Theclasp control mechanism 2250 can also be coupled to proximal end portions of the clasp control members oractuation lines 537 and can be configured to secure theclasp control members 537 relative to thehandle 2222 and to move theclasp control members 537 relative to theouter shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512. Theflushing mechanism 2252 can be configured for flushing (e.g., with a saline solution) theouter shaft 2220 prior to inserting theouter shaft 2220 into a patient's vasculature. - As shown in
FIGS. 151-152 , thehousing 2246 of thehandle 2222 can comprise amain body 2254 and anose portion 2256 coupled to a distal end portion of themain body 2254. Themain body 2254 and thenose portion 2256 can be coupled together in various manners, includingfasteners 2258 and/or pins 2260 (e.g., as shown in the illustrated embodiment), adhesive, and/or other coupling means. Thehousing 2246 can be formed from various materials, including polymers (e.g., polycarbonate). - The
main body 2254 of thehousing 2246 can comprise a plurality of lumens, including an actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2262 (e.g., an actuation shaft lumen, actuation tube, etc.), control member lumens 2264 (FIG. 152 ), and aflushing lumen 2266 that connects with the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2262 (FIG. 151 ). As shown inFIG. 152 , themain body 2254 can also include a plurality of tubes (e.g., hypotubes), including anactuation tube 2268 and controlmember tubes 2270 that are disposed at least partially in the actuation element lumen or means ofactuating lumen 2262 and thecontrol member lumens 2264, respectively. Thetubes lumens - The proximal end of the actuation tube or
lumen 2268 can extend proximally from themain body 2256 and can be coupled to theknob 2226 and to theproximal end portion 512A of the actuation element or means of actuating 512. The proximal ends of thecontrol member tubes 2270 can extend proximally from themain body 2254 and can be coupled to the clasp controlmechanism 2250 and theclasp control members 537. - The distal ends of the
tubes flanges tubes flanges tubes lumens - The actuation tube or
lumen 2268 can be configured to receive and be coupled to the proximal end portion of the actuation element or means of actuating 512. Thecontrol member tubes 2270 can be configured to receive portions of theclasp control mechanism 2250, as further described below. Thetubes - In some embodiments, the
main body 2254 can include a plurality of seal members 2276 (e.g., O-rings) configured to prevent or reduce blood leakage through the lumens and around the shafts and/or tubes. The seal members can be secured relative to themain body 2254, for example, by fasteners 2278 (e.g., hollow-lock or socket-jam set screws). - As shown in
FIG. 152 , thenose portion 2256 of thehousing 2246 can comprise a plurality of lumens, including an actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2280 (e.g., an actuation shaft lumen, etc.), andcontrol member lumens 2282. The actuation element lumen or means of actuatinglumen 2280 of thenose portion 2256 can be extend coaxially with the actuation element lumen or means of actuatinglumen 2262 of themain body 2254. Proximal ends of thecontrol member lumens 2282 of thenose portion 2256 can be aligned with thecontrol member lumens 2264 of themain body 2254 at the proximal end of the nose portion 2256 (i.e., thelumens control member lumens 2282 can extend from the proximal ends at an angle (i.e., relative to thecontrol member lumens 2264 of the main body 2254), and distal ends of thecontrol member lumens 2282 can connect with the actuation element lumen or means of actuatinglumen 2280 of thenose portion 2256 at a location toward the distal end of thenose portion 2256. In other words, the proximal ends of thelumens 2282 are in a first plane (i.e., the plane of thecontrol member lumens 2264 of the main body 2254), and the distal ends of thelumens 2282 are in a second plane (i.e., the plane of the actuation shaft lumen or means of actuatinglumen 2262 of the main body 2254). - As shown in
FIG. 151 , the actuation element lumen or means of actuatinglumen 2280 of thenose portion 2256 can be configured to receive the proximal end portion of theouter shaft 2220. The proximal end portion of theouter shaft 2220 can be coupled to thenose portion 2256 in many ways such as with adhesive, fasteners, frictional fit, and/or other coupling means. - Referring still to
FIG. 151 , theactuation lock mechanism 2248 of thehandle 2222 can be coupled to the proximal end portion of themain body 2254 of thehousing 2246 and to theactuation tube 2268. Theactuation lock mechanism 2248 can be configured to selectively control relative movement between theactuation tube 2268 and thehousing 2246. This, in turn, selectively controls relative movement between the actuation element or means of actuating 512 (which is coupled to the actuation tube 2268) and the outer shaft 2220 (which is coupled to thenose portion 2256 of the housing 2246). - In some embodiments, the
actuation lock mechanism 2248 can comprise a lock configuration, which prevents relative movement between theactuation tube 2268 and thehousing 2246, and a release configuration, which allows relative movement between theactuation tube 2268 and thehousing 2246. In some embodiments, theactuation lock mechanism 2248 can be configured to include one or more intermediate configurations (i.e., in addition to the lock and release configuration) which allow relative movement between theactuation tube 2268 and thehousing 2246, but the force required to cause the relative movement is greater than when the actuation lock mechanism is in the release configuration. - As shown in
FIG. 151 of the illustrated embodiment, theactuation lock mechanism 2248 can comprise a lock (e.g., a Tuohy-Borst adapter) 2284 and a coupler (e.g., a female luer coupler) 2286. Thecoupler 2286 can be attached to the distal end of thelock 2284 and coupled to the proximal end of themain body 2254 of thehousing 2246. Theactuation tube 2268 can coaxially extend through thelock 2284 and thecoupler 2286. As such, rotating aknob 2288 of thelock 2284 in a first direction (e.g., clockwise) can increase the frictional engagement of thelock 2284 on theactuation tube 2268, thus making relative movement between theactuation tube 2268 and thehousing 2246 more difficult or preventing it altogether. Rotating aknob 2288 of thelock 2284 in a second direction (e.g., counterclockwise) can decrease the frictional engagement of thelock 2284 on theactuation tube 2268, thus making relative movement between theactuation tube 2268 and thehousing 2246 easier. - In other embodiments,
actuation lock mechanism 2248 can comprise other configurations configured for preventing relative movement between theactuation tube 2268 and thehousing 2246. For example, thelocking mechanism 2248 can include lock configured like a stopcock valve in which a plunger portion of valve selectively engages theactuation tube 2268. - The
clasp control mechanism 2250 can comprise anactuator member 2290 and one or more locking members 2292 (e.g., two in the illustrated embodiment). A distal end portion of theactuator member 2290 can be coupled to thecontrol member tubes 2270, which extend from the proximal end of themain body 2254 of thehousing 2246, as best shown inFIG. 151 . Thelocking members 2292 can be coupled to a proximal end portion of theactuator member 2290. - As shown in the illustrated embodiment, the
actuator member 2290 can, optionally, comprise afirst side portion 2294 and asecond side portion 2296 selectively coupled to thefirst side portion 2294 by a connectingpin 2298. Theactuator member 2290 can be configured such that the first andsecond side portions pin 2298 is inserted through the first andsecond side portions pin 2298 is withdrawn, the first andsecond side portions second side portions - The connection between the first and
second side portions second side portions pin 2298 is withdrawn. This can be accomplished, for example, by configuring thefirst side portion 2294 with keyed slot or groove and configuringsecond side portion 2296 with a keyed projection or tongue that corresponds to the keyed slot or groove of thefirst side portion 2294. This can, for example, prevent or reduce the likelihood that the clasp control members/lines 537 from twisting relative to theouter shaft 2220. - The first and
second side portions lumens 2201. Distal ends of thelumens 2201 can be configured to receive the proximal end portions of thecontrol member tubes 2270. Proximal ends of thelumens 2201 can be configured to receive portions of thelocking members 2292. - The
locking members 2292 can be configured to selectively control relative movement between a clasp control member 2224 and the respective first orsecond side portion actuator member 2290. Thelocking members 2292 can comprise a lock configuration, which prevents relative movement between a clasp control member 2224 and the respective first orsecond side portion second side portion locking members 2292 can also comprise one or more intermediate configurations (i.e., in addition to the lock and release configuration) which allows relative movement between a clasp control member 2224 and the respective first orsecond side portion locking members 2292 are in the release configuration. - As shown in the illustrated embodiment, the
locking members 2292 can be configured similar to stopcock valves. Thus, rotatingknobs 2203 in a first direction (e.g., clockwise) can increase the frictional engagement between thelocking members 2292 on the clasp control members/lines 537 and make relative movement between a clasp control member 2224 and the respective first orsecond side portion knobs 2203 in a second direction (e.g., counterclockwise) can decrease the frictional engagement between thelocking members 2292 on theclasp control members 537 and make relative movement between a clasp control member 2224 and the respective first orsecond side portion actuation locking members 2292 can comprise other configurations configured for preventing relative movement between thelocking members 2292 on theclasp control members 537. - The
flushing mechanism 2252 can comprise aflushing tube 2205 and a valve 2207 (e.g., a stopcock valve). A distal end of theflushing tube 2205 can be coupled to and in fluidic communication with the flushinglumen 2266 and thus with the actuation shaft lumen or means of actuatinglumen 2262 of themain body 2254. A proximal end of theflushing tube 2205 can be coupled to thevalve 2207. In this manner, theflushing mechanism 2252 can be configured for flushing (e.g., with a saline solution) theouter shaft 2220 prior to inserting theouter shaft 2220 into a patient's vasculature. - The
clasp control members 537 or actuation lines can be configured to manipulate the configuration of theclasps 530, as further described below. As shown inFIG. 148 , each of the clasp control members orlines 537 can be configured as a suture (e.g., wire, thread, etc.) loop. Proximal end portions of thecontrol members 537 can extend proximally from the proximal end portion of theclasp control mechanism 2250 and can be releasably coupled to thelocking mechanisms 2292 of theclasp control mechanism 2250. - From the
locking mechanisms 2292, the clasp control members oractuation lines 537 can form loops extending distally through thelumens 2201 of theclasp control mechanism 2250, through thecontrol member tubes 2270, thecontrol member lumens handle 2222, and through thecontrol member lumens 2240 of theouter shaft 2220. Theclasp control members 537 can extend radially outwardly from thelumens 2240, for example, through the ports 2233 (FIG. 146 ) of the coupler or means forcoupling 2214. Theclasp control members 537 can then extend throughopenings 535 of theclasps 530. Theclasp control members 537 can then extend proximally back to the coupler or means forcoupling 2214, radially inwardly through theports 2233 of the coupler or means for coupling 2214, and then proximally through theouter shaft 2220 and thehandle 2222, and to thelocking mechanisms 2292 of theclasp control mechanism 2250. - In
FIG. 148 , the clasp control members orlines 537 are shown slacken and theclasps 530 are partially open in order to illustrate theclasp control members 537 extending through theopenings 535 of theclasps 530. However, ordinarily when theclasp control members 537 are slacken, theclasps 530 would be in the closed configuration. - As shown in the illustrated embodiment, each of the clasp control members or
actuation lines 537 can extend throughmultiple lumens 2240 of theouter shaft 2220. For example, each of theclasp control members 537 can be looped through two of thelumens 2240. In other embodiments, each of theclasp control members 537 can be disposed in asingle lumen 2240. In yet other embodiments, multipleclasp control members 537 can be disposed in asingle lumen 2240. - With the clasp control members or
actuation lines 537 coupled to theclasps 530, theclasp control mechanism 2250 can be used to actuate theclasps 530 between open and closed configurations. Theclasps 530 can be opened by moving theactuator member 2290 proximally relative to theknob 2226 and thehousing 2246. This increases tension of theclasp control members 537 and causes theclasp 530 to move from the closed configuration to the open configuration. Theclasps 530 can be closed by moving theactuator member 2290 distally relative to theknob 2226 and thehousing 2246. This decreases tension on theclasp control members 537 and allows theclasp 530 to move from the open configuration to the closed configuration. Theclasps 530 can be individually actuated by removing thepin 2298 and moving the first orsecond side portions knob 2226, and thehousing 2246. - When the
handle 2222 is assembled as best shown inFIGS. 150-151 , the actuation element or means of actuating 512 can extend distally from theknob 2226, through theactuation tube 2268, through theactuation lumens housing 2246, through theactuation lumen 2238 of theouter shaft 2220, and through the coupler or means forcoupling 2214. - Referring now to
FIGS. 153-160 , thedelivery assembly 2200 is used, for example, to implant theprosthetic spacer device 500 in native mitral valve MV of a heart H using a transseptal delivery approach.FIGS. 153-160 are similar toFIGS. 15-20 , described above, that show the implantableprosthetic device 100 being implanted in the heart H andFIGS. 35-46 , described above, that show the implantableprosthetic device 500 being implanted in the heart H. The methods and steps shown and/or discussed can be performed on a living animal or on a simulation, such as on a cadaver, cadaver heart, simulator (e.g. with the body parts, heart, tissue, etc. being simulated), etc. - Although not shown, a guide wire can be inserted into the patient's vasculature (e.g., a femoral vein) through an introducer sheath. The guide wire can be advanced through the femoral vein, through the inferior vena cava, into the right atrium, through the interatrial septum IAS (e.g., via the fossa ovalis), and into the left atrium LA. The
first sheath 2216 of thefirst catheter 2204 can be advanced over the guide wire such that a distal end portion of thefirst sheath 2216 is disposed in the left atrium LA, as shown inFIG. 153 . - With the
prosthetic spacer device 500 coupled to the third catheter 2208 (e.g., as shown inFIG. 145 ) and configured in a radially compressed, delivery configuration, theprosthetic spacer device 500 can be loaded into thefirst sheath 2216 at a distal end of thesecond sheath 2218 of thesecond catheter 2206. Thefirst sheath 2216 retains theprosthetic spacer device 500 in the delivery configuration. In some embodiments, the radially compressed, delivery configuration can be an axially elongated configuration (e.g., like the configuration shown inFIG. 153 ). In other embodiments, the radially compressed, delivery configuration can be an axially foreshorten configuration (e.g., similar to the configuration shown inFIG. 155 ). Thesecond catheter 2206 along with theprosthetic spacer device 500 and thethird catheter 2208 can then be advanced together through thefirst catheter 2204 such that a distal end portion of thesheath 2218 exposed from the distal end portion of thefirst sheath 2216 and is disposed in the left atrium LA, as shown inFIG. 153 . - As shown in
FIG. 153 , theprosthetic spacer device 500 can be exposed from thefirst sheath 2216 by distally advancing theouter shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 of thethird catheter 2208 relative to thefirst sheath 2216 and/or retracting thefirst sheath 2216 relative to theouter shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512, thus forcing thepaddles anchors 508 out of thefirst sheath 2216. Once exposed from thefirst sheath 2216, thepaddles third catheter 2208 relative to theouter shaft 2220 of thethird catheter 2208 and/or by advancing theouter shaft 2220 relative to the actuation element or means of actuating 512, causing thepaddles FIG. 153 , to the configuration shown inFIG. 154 , and then to the configuration shown inFIG. 155 . This can be accomplished, for example, by placing theactuation lock mechanism 2248 in the release configuration (e.g., by rotating theknob 2288 counterclockwise relative to the handle 2222) and then moving theknob 2226 proximally relative to thehousing 2246. Another option is to set thelocking knob 2288 to maintain enough friction that you can actively slide the actuation element or means foractuation 512 but the actuation element or means for actuation will not move on its own. At any point in the procedure, the physician can lock the relative position of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 and theouter shaft 2220, and thus the position of thepaddles actuation locking mechanism 2248. - The
prosthetic spacer device 500 can then be positioned coaxial relative to the native mitral valve MV by manipulating (e.g., steering and/or bending) thesecond sheath 2218 of thesecond catheter 2206, as shown inFIG. 155 . Theprosthetic spacer device 500 can also be rotated (e.g., by rotating the housing 2246) relative to the native mitral valve MV such that thepaddles native leaflets - The
paddles prosthetic spacer device 500 can then be partially opened (i.e., moved radially outwardly relative to the coaption element 510) to the configuration shown inFIG. 156 by moving theknob 2226 distally relative to thehousing 2246. Theprosthetic spacer device 500 can then be advanced through the annulus of the native mitral valve MV and at least partially into the left ventricle LV. Theprosthetic spacer device 500 is then partially retracted such that thepaddles leaflets 20, 22 (e.g., at the A2/P2 positions) and thecoaption element 510 is disposed on the atrial side of theleaflets - In this configuration, the
native leaflets paddles clasps 530. Thenative leaflets actuator member 2290. For example,FIG. 157 shows separate leaflet grasping. This can be accomplished by removing thepin 2298 from theactuator member 2290 and moving the first orsecond side portions knob 2226, and thehousing 2246. Moving the first orsecond side portions knob 2226 and thehousing 2246 closes theclasps 530 on thenative leaflets 20, 22 (e.g., as shown by theleft clasp 530 as illustrated inFIG. 157 ). Moving the first orsecond side portions knob 2226 and thehousing 2246 opens the clasps 530 (e.g., as shown by theright clasp 530 as illustrated inFIG. 157 ). Once aclasp 530 is closed, a physician can re-open theclasp 530 to adjust the positioning of theclasp 530. - With both of the
native leaflets clasps 530, the physician can move theknob 2226 proximally relative to thehousing 2246. This pulls thepaddles native leaflets coaption element 510, as shown inFIG. 158 . The physician can then observe the positioning and/or reduction in regurgitation. If repositioning or removal is desired the physician can re-open thepaddles clasps 530. - Once the desired positioning and/or reduction in regurgitation is achieved, the physician can release the
prosthetic spacer device 500 from thedelivery apparatus 2202. Theclasps 530 can be released from thedelivery apparatus 2202 by releasing the clasp control members oractuation lines 537 from the lockingmembers 2292 and unthreading the clasp control members oractuation lines 537 from theopenings 535 of theclasps 530. Thecap 514 of theprosthetic spacer device 500 can be released from thedelivery apparatus 2202 by rotating theknob 2226 in the second direction relative to thehousing 2246 such that the actuation element or means of actuating 512 withdraws from thebore 516A. The actuation element or means of actuating 512 can then be retracted proximally through theprosthetic spacer device 500 by pulling theknob 2226 proximally relative to the housing 2224. Theproximal collar 511 of theprosthetic spacer device 500 can be released from thedelivery apparatus 2202 by retracting the actuation element or means of actuating 512 proximally relative to the coupler or means for coupling 2214 such that the distal end portion of the actuation element or means of actuating 512 withdraws from theeyelets 2234 of the coupler or means forcoupling 2214. This allows theflexible arms 2228 of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 to move radially outwardly away from theprojections 511A of theproximal collar 511. Thestabilizer members 2230 of the coupler or means for coupling 2214 can then be withdrawn from the guide openings 511B of theproximal collar 511 by pulling thehousing 2246 proximally, thereby releasing theprosthetic spacer device 500 from thedelivery apparatus 2202 as shown inFIG. 159 . - The
shafts third catheter 2208 can then be retracted proximally into thesecond sheath 2218 of thesecond catheter 2206, and thesecond sheath 2218 of thesecond catheter 2206 can be retracted proximally into thefirst sheath 2216 of thefirst catheter 2204. Thecatheters - With the
prosthetic spacer device 500 implanted at the A2/P2 position, the native mitral valve MV comprises a double orifice during ventricular diastole, as shown inFIG. 160 . During ventricular systole, the side surfaces of thenative leaflets prosthetic spacer device 500 to prevent or reduce mitral regurgitation. - Referring now to
FIGS. 161-162 , an example embodiment of ahandle 2300 for thedelivery apparatus 2200 is shown. Referring toFIG. 161 , thehandle 2300 can comprise ahousing 2302, anactuation control mechanism 2304, theclasp control mechanism 2250, and a flushing mechanism (not shown, but see, e.g., theflushing mechanism 2252 inFIG. 150 ). Thehousing 2302 can include amain body 2306 and thenose portion 2256. Thenose portion 2256 of thehousing 2302 can be coupled to a proximal end portion of theouter shaft 2220. Theactuation control mechanism 2304, theclasp control mechanism 2250, and aflushing mechanism 2252 can be coupled to a proximal end of themain body 2306 of thehousing 2302. - The
handle 2300 can be configured similar to thehandle 2222, except that thehandle 2300 is configured such that rotational movement of thefirst knob 2318 of theactuation control mechanism 2304 relative to thehousing 2302 causes axial movement of theactuation tube 2268 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512; whereas, thehandle 2222 is configured such that axial movement of theknob 2226 relative to thehousing 2246 causes axial movement of theactuation tube 2268 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512. - As mentioned above, the
housing 2302 can include amain body 2306 and thenose portion 2256. Referring toFIG. 162 , themain body 2306 of thehousing 2302 can comprise anactuation lumen 2308,control member lumens 2310, and aflange portion 2312. Theflange portion 2312 can extend axially from a proximal end portion of themain body 2306 and annularly around theactuation lumen 2308. - The
flange portion 2312 of themain body 2306 can comprise one or morecircumferential grooves 2314, a bore (not shown), and aguide pin 2316. Thegrooves 2314 can be configured to interact with theactuation control mechanism 2304, as further described below. The bore can extend radially inwardly from an outside diameter to an inside diameter of theflange portion 2312 and can be configured to receive theguide pin 2316. Theguide pin 2316 can be partially disposed in the bore and can extend radially inwardly from the bore such that theguide pin 2316 protrudes into theactuation lumen 2308. - Referring still to
FIG. 162 , theactuation control mechanism 2304 can comprise afirst knob 2318, attachment pins 2320, adrive screw 2322, acollet 2324, and asecond knob 2326. Thefirst knob 2318 can have adistal end portion 2328 and aproximal end portion 2330. Thefirst knob 2318 can be configured such that the inside diameter of thedistal end portion 2328 is relatively larger than the inside diameter of theproximal end portion 2330. Thedistal end portion 2328 can compriseopenings 2332 that extend radially inwardly from an outside diameter to the inside diameter of thedistal end portion 2328. - Referring again to
FIG. 161 , the inside diameter of thedistal end portion 2328 can be configured such that thedistal end portion 2328 of thefirst knob 2318 can extend over theflange portion 2312 of themain body 2306. The openings 2332 (FIG. 162 ) can be configured to axially align with thegrooves 2314 when thefirst knob 2318 is disposed over theflange 2312. The attachment pins 2320 can be configured so as to extend through theopenings 2332 of thefirst knob 2318 and intogrooves 2314 of theflange 2312. In this manner, the attachment pins 2320 allow relative rotational movement and prevent relative axial movement between thefirst knob 2318 and theflange 2312. - The inside diameter of the
proximal end portion 2330 of thefirst knob 2318 can have internal threads (not shown) configured to engage correspondingexternal threads 2334 of thedrive screw 2322. As shown inFIG. 162 , thedrive screw 2322 can have aslot 2336 that extends axially across theexternal threads 2334. Theslot 2336 can be configured to receive theguide pin 2316 of theflange portion 2312. As such, when thehandle 2300 is assembled (FIG. 161 ) and thefirst knob 2318 is rotated relative to theflange 2316, theguide pin 2316 prevents thedrive screw 2322 from rotating together with thefirst knob 2318 and causes thedrive screw 2322 to move axially relative to thefirst knob 2318 and theflange 2316. In this manner, rotating thefirst knob 2318 in a first direction (e.g., clockwise) moves the drive screw distally relative to thehousing 2306, and rotating thefirst knob 2318 in a second direction (e.g., counterclockwise) moves the drive screw proximally relative to thehousing 2306. - The
drive screw 2322 can also have alumen 2338, as shown inFIG. 162 . Thelumen 2338 can be configured such that theactuation tube 2268 can extend through thedrive screw 2322. Thelumen 2338 can be configured such that adistal end portion 2340 of thecollet 2324 can also be inserted into a proximal end portion of thelumen 2338. - The
second knob 2326 can comprise a first,distal portion 2342 and a second,proximal portion 2344. Thefirst portion 2342 can include internal threads (not shown) corresponding to theexternal threads 2334 of thedrive screw 2322. Thesecond portion 2344 can comprise a conical inside surface configured to engage a proximal end portion 2346 of thecollet 2324. - When assembled (
FIG. 161 ), theactuation tube 2268 can extend through thelumen 2338 of thedrive screw 2322, through thecollet 2324, and through thesecond knob 2326. Thesecond knob 2326 can be disposed over thecollet 2324 and the internal threads of thefirst portion 2342 of the second knob can threadedly engage theexternal threads 2334 of thedrive screw 2322. Accordingly, rotating thesecond knob 2326 in a first direction (e.g., clockwise) relative to thedrive screw 2322 causes thesecond portion 2344 of thesecond knob 2326 to move toward the proximal end portion 2346 of thecollet 2324 and thus urges thecollet 2324 radially inwardly against theactuation tube 2268. As a result, theactuation tube 2268 and thedrive screw 2322 move axially together when thefirst knob 2318 is rotated relative to thehousing 2306. Rotating thesecond knob 2326 in a second direction (e.g., counterclockwise) relative to thedrive screw 2322 causes thesecond portion 2344 of thesecond knob 2326 to move away from the proximal end portion 2346 of thecollet 2324 and thus allows thecollet 2324 to move radially outwardly relative to theactuation tube 2268. As a result, theactuation tube 2268 and thedrive screw 2322 can move relative to each other. - With the
prosthetic spacer device 500 coupled to the actuation element or means of actuating 512 and theouter shaft 2220 of thedelivery apparatus 2202, the physician can use theactuation control mechanism 2304 of thehandle 2300 to manipulate thepaddles prosthetic spacer device 500 relative to thespacer member 202 of theprosthetic spacer device 500. Theactuation control mechanism 2304 can be activated by rotating thesecond knob 2326 in the first direction relative to thedrive screw 2322 to secure theactuation tube 2268 and thus the actuation element or means of actuating 512 to thedrive screw 2322. The physician can then rotate thefirst knob 2318 relative to thehousing 2302, which causes thedrive screw 2322 and thus theactuation tube 2268 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 to move axially relative to thehousing 2302 and thus theouter shaft 2220. This, in turn, causes thepaddles 520, 522 (which are coupled to the actuation element or means of actuating 512 via the cap 514) to move relative to the coaption element 510 (which is coupled to theouter shaft 2220 via coupler or means forcoupling 2214 and the proximal collar 511). - The
prosthetic spacer device 500 can be released from thedelivery apparatus 2202 by rotating thesecond knob 2326 in the second direction relative to thedrive screw 2322. This allows theactuation tube 2268 and thus the actuation element or means of actuating 512 to move relative to thedrive screw 2322. Theshafts delivery apparatus 2202 can then be removed from the respective collars of theprosthetic spacer device 500, as described above. - Configuring a delivery apparatus with the
actuation control mechanism 2304 can provide several advantages. For example, the rotational forces required to actuate thefirst knob 2318 of thehandle 2300 can be less than the axial forces required to actuate theknob 2226 of thehandle 2300. - The
actuation control mechanism 2304 can also provide relatively more precise control of thepaddles first knob 2318 and the thread pitch of thedrive screw 2322 rather than be axial movement of theknob 2226. In other words, theactuation control mechanism 2304 can be configured, for example, such that one rotation of thefirst knob 2318 moves the actuation element or means of actuating 512 a small axial distance (e.g., 1 mm): whereas, it can be relatively more difficult to axially move theknob 2226 and thus theshaft 512 in small increments (e.g., 1 mm). - Additionally, the
actuation control mechanism 2304 can prevent or reduce inadvertent movement and release of the actuation element or means of actuating 512. For example, because theactuation control mechanism 2304 requires rotational movement of thefirst knob 2318 to move the actuation element or means of actuating 512, it can prevent or reduce the likelihood that the actuation element or means of actuating 512 will move if theknob 2226 is inadvertently contacted. Also, the physician has to rotate thesecond knob 2326 to release theactuation tube 2268 from thedrive screw 2322 before the physician can rotate theknob 2226 to release the actuation element or means of actuating 512 from thecap 514 of theprosthetic spacer device 500 and proximally retract the actuation element or means of actuating 512. This two-step release process could reduce the likelihood of a physician inadvertently releasing theprosthetic spacer device 500 from thedelivery apparatus 2202. -
FIGS. 163-164 show example embodiments of acoupler 2400 and aproximal collar 2402. Although not shown, thecoupler 2400 can be coupled to the distal end portion of the outer shaft 2220 (FIG. 149 ) in a manner similar to the coupler or means forcoupling 2214. As shown, theproximal collar 2402 can be coupled to a proximal end portion of thecoaption element 510 in a manner similar to the proximal collar 511 (FIG. 146 ). As such, thecoupler 2400 and theproximal collar 2402 can be used, for example, in lieu of the coupler or means forcoupling 2214 and theproximal collar 514 of thedelivery assembly 2200, respectively, to releasably couple theprosthetic spacer device 500 to the outer shaft 2220 (FIG. 149 ). - Referring to
FIG. 164 , thecoupler 2400 can comprise an axially-extendinglumen 2404 and a plurality of radially-extendingopenings 2406. Thelumen 2404 can be configured to receive the actuation element or means of actuating 512 (FIG. 163 ). Theopenings 2406 can be configured to receive theproximal collar 2402, as further described below. - The
proximal collar 2402 can comprise a plurality of proximally-extending tabs orfingers 2408.Free end portions 2410 of thefingers 2408 can have radially-extendingprojections 2412 formed thereon. Thefingers 2408 can be configured to move or pivot between a first or resting state (FIG. 164 ) and a second or deflected state (FIG. 163 ). In the first state, thefree end portions 2410 of thefingers 2408 press radially inwardly against each other. In the second state, thefree end portions 2410 of thefingers 2408 are radially spaced from each other. - Referring to
FIG. 163 , thecoupler 2400 and theproximal collar 2402 be releasably coupled together by positioning thefingers 2408 of theproximal collar 2402 within thecoupler 2400. The actuation element or means of actuating 512 can then be advanced through thelumen 2404 of thecoupler 2400 and through thefingers 2408 of theproximal collar 2400, thus causing the free ends 2410 of thefingers 2408 to move or pivot radially-outwardly from the first state to the second state. Theprojections 2412 of thefingers 2408 and theopenings 2406 of thecoupler 2400 can be rotationally aligned such that theprojections 2412 extend into theopenings 2406, thereby releasably coupling thecoupler 2400 to theproximal collar 2402. Thecoupler 2400 can be released from theproximal collar 2402 by retracting the actuation element or means of actuating 512 from thefinger 2408 of theproximal collar 2402. This allows thefree end portions 2410 of thefingers 2408 to move or pivot from the second state back to the first state and causes theprojections 2412 of thefingers 2408 to withdraw from theopenings 2406 of thecoupler 2402, thus releasing thecoupler 2400 from theproximal collar 2402. - In some embodiments, the
fingers 2408 of theproximal collar 2402 can be configured to create a hemostatic seal when thefingers 2408 are in the first state. This can, for example, prevent or reduce blood from flowing through theproximal collar 2402 when theprosthetic spacer device 500 is implanted in a patient. -
FIGS. 165-166 show example embodiments of acap 2500, an actuation element or means of actuating 2502 (e.g., actuation shaft, etc.), and a release member (e.g., wire) 2504, which can be used, for example, with thedelivery assembly 2200. Although not shown, thecap 2500 can be coupled to the distal portion of theprosthetic spacer device 500. A proximal portion (not shown) of the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can be coupled to theactuation tube 2268 and theknob 2226. From the proximal end portion, the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can extend distally through the handle 2222 (FIG. 150 ), through the outer shaft 2220 (FIG. 150 ), and into the prosthetic spacer device 500 (FIG. 145 ). A distal end portion of the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can be releasably coupled to thecap 2500 of theprosthetic spacer device 500. As such, thecap 2500 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can be used, for example, in lieu of thecap 514 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 of thedelivery assembly 2200, respectively. - Referring to
FIG. 166 , thecap 2500 can comprise acentral bore 2506 and a tongue ortab 2508 formed (e.g., laser cut) in aside surface 2510 of thecap 2500. Thetongue 2508 can have an opening 2512 formed (e.g., laser cut) therein. Thecentral bore 2506 can be configured to receive a distal end portion of the actuation element or means of actuating 2502. Thetongue 2508 can be movable or pivotable relative to theside surface 2508 of thecap 2500 from a first or resting configuration (FIG. 166 ) to a second or deflected configuration (FIG. 165 ). In the first configuration, thetongue 2508 can be flush with theside surface 2510. In the second configuration, thetongue 2508 can extend radially inwardly relative to theside surface 2510 to protrude into thecentral bore 2506. - The
tongue 2508 can be used, for example, to releasably couple thecap 2500 to the actuation element or means of actuating 2502, as shown inFIGS. 165 and 166 . For example, the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can be inserted into thecentral bore 2506 of thecap 2500. Thetongue 2508 can then be pushed radially inwardly from the first configuration to the second configuration such that thetongue 2508 presses against the actuation element or means of actuating 2502. Therelease member 2504 can then be advanced distally such that adistal end portion 2514 of therelease member 2504 extends through the opening 2512 of thetongue 2508. Thus, therelease member 2504 retains thetongue 2508 in the second configuration against the actuation element or means of actuating 2502, thereby releasably coupling thecap 2500 to the actuation element or means of actuating 2502. - The
cap 2500 can be released from the actuation element or means of actuating 2500 by retracting therelease member 2504 proximally such that thedistal end portion 2514 of therelease member 2504 withdraws from the opening 2512 of thetongue 2508. This allows the tongue to move radially outwardly from the second state back to the first state, thereby releasing thecap 2500 from the actuation element or means of actuating 2502. - This configuration can provide several advantages. For example, in some embodiments, the
cap 2500 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can be formed without threads. Removing the threads can make manufacturing thecap 2500 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 easier and/or less expensive. Removing the threads from the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 can also reduce the likelihood the actuation element or means of actuating 2502 could catch or snag on another component of thedelivery assembly 2200. -
FIGS. 167-168 show example embodiments of acoupler 2600, aproximal collar 2602, acap 2604, and an actuation element or means of actuating 2606 (e.g., actuation shaft, etc.), which can be used, for example, with thedelivery assembly 2200. Referring toFIG. 167 , thecoupler 2600 can be coupled to the distal end portion of theouter shaft 2220. Theproximal collar 2602 can be coupled to the proximal portion of the prosthetic spacer device 500 (shown schematically in partial cross-section), and thecap 2604 can be coupled to the distal portion of theprosthetic spacer device 500. A proximal portion (not shown) of the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can be coupled to theactuation tube 2268 and theknob 2226. From the proximal end portion, the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can extend distally through the handle 2222 (FIG. 150 ), through the outer shaft 2220 (FIG. 150 ), and into the prosthetic spacer device 200 (FIG. 145 ). A distal end portion of the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can be releasably coupled to thecap 2604 of theprosthetic spacer device 500. As such, thecoupler 2600, theproximal collar 2602, thecap 2604, and the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can be used, for example, in lieu of the coupler or means forcoupling 2214, theproximal collar 511, thecap 514, and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 of thedelivery assembly 2200, respectively. - Referring to
FIG. 168 , thecoupler 2600 can comprise aconnection portion 2608, a plurality of pins 2610 (e.g., three in the illustrated embodiment), and one or more securing members 2612 (e.g., three in the illustrated embodiment). Thepins 2610 and the securing members can be coupled to and extend distally from theconnection portion 2600. - The
connection portion 2608 can have an axially-extendinglumen 2614 configured to slidably receive the actuation element or means of actuating 2606. In some embodiments, theconnection portion 2608 can also have a recessed outwardly facingsurface 2615 configured to be inserted into the distal end portion of theouter shaft 2220, as shown inFIG. 167 . - As best shown in
FIG. 168 , thepins 2610 can be spaced circumferentially relative to each other and relative to the securingmembers 2612. The securingmembers 2612 can be spaced circumferentially relative to each other. In some embodiments, thepins 2610 and the securingmembers 2612 can be configured in an alternating type pattern (e.g., pin-securing member-pin and so on) on theconnection portion 2608. - Referring to
FIG. 167 , thepins 2610 can be configured to extend intoopenings 2616 of theproximal collar 2602. In certain embodiments, the securingmembers 2612 can be suture loops. The securingmembers 2612 can be configured to extend through theopenings 2616 of theproximal collar 2602 and around the actuation element or means of actuating 2606. For clarity, only one securingmember 2612 is shown extending around the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 inFIG. 167 . - Referring again to
FIG. 168 , in addition to theopenings 2616, theproximal collar 2602 can comprise acentral lumen 2618 disposed radially inward from theopenings 2616. Thecentral lumen 2618 can extend axially and can be configured to slidably receive the actuation element or means of actuating 2606, as shown inFIG. 167 . - The
cap 2604 can be configured in a sleeve-like manner such that the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can slidably extend through thecap 2604, as shown inFIG. 167 . - The actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can comprise a radially-
expandable portion 2620 disposed at or near the distal end portion 2622 of the actuation element or means of actuating 2606. The radially-expandable portion 2620 can be configured to be selectively expandable from a compressed configuration to an expanded configuration. The radially-expandable portion 2620 can be configured such that an outside diameter of the radially-expandable portion 2620 is less than the inside diameter of thecap 2604, thecentral lumen 2618 of theproximal collar 2602, and thelumen 2614 of thecoupler 2600 when the radially-expandable portion 2620 is in the compressed configuration. When the radiallyexpandable portion 2620 is in the expanded configuration, the outside diameter of the radially-expandable portion 2620 is greater than the inside diameter of thecap 2604. Thus, in the expanded configuration, the radially-expandable portion 2620 can prevent the distal end portion 2622 from moving proximally relative to thecap 2604. - As shown in
FIG. 167 , theprosthetic spacer device 500 can be releasably coupled to theouter shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 by inserting thepins 2610 and the securingmembers 2612 throughrespective openings 2616 in theproximal collar 2602. With the radially-expandable portion 2620 in the compressed configuration, the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can be advanced distally through thelumen 2614 of thecoupler 2600, through thelumen 2618 and the securingmembers 2612 of theproximal collar 2602, and through thecap 2604 such that the radially-expandable portion 2620 is disposed distal relative to thecap 2604. The radially-expandable portion 2620 of the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 can then be expanded from the compressed configuration to the expanded configuration, thus releasably coupling theprosthetic spacer device 500 to theouter shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2606. - The
prosthetic device 500 can be released from theouter shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 by compressing the radially-expandable portion 2620 of the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 and proximally retracting the actuation element or means of actuating 2606 through thecap 2604, through the securingmembers 2612 and thelumen 2618 of theproximal collar 2602. Theouter shaft 2220 can then be retracted proximally relative to theprosthetic spacer device 500 such that thepins 2610 and the securingmembers 2612 withdraw from theopenings 2616 in theproximal collar 2602, thus releasing theprosthetic spacer device 500 from theouter shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 2606. -
FIGS. 169-170 show an example embodiment of clasp control members 2700, which can be used, for example, in lieu of theclasp control members 537 of thedelivery assembly 2200. Referring toFIG. 170 , the clasp control members 2700 can comprisesleeves 2702, connectingmembers 2704, andrelease members 2706. The connectingmembers 2704 and therelease members 2706 can extend axially through and can be movable relative to thesleeves 2702. - Proximal end portions (not shown) of the
sleeves 2702 can be coupled to thecontrol member tubes 2270, and distal end portions of thesleeves 2708 can be releasable coupled to theclasps 530 of theprosthetic spacer device 500 by the connectingmembers 2704 and therelease members 2706, as further described below. - The connecting
members 2704 can, for example, be suture loops that extend distally from theclasp control mechanism 2250 of thedelivery apparatus 2202, through thecontrol member tubes 2270, through thesleeves 2702, and through theopenings 535 of theclasps 530. The connectingmembers 2704 can be releasably coupled to theclasps 530 theprosthetic spacer device 500 by therelease members 2706. - The
release members 2706 can, for example, be wires that extend distally from theclasp control mechanism 2250 of thedelivery apparatus 2202, through thecontrol member tubes 2270, through thesleeves 2702, and through the loops of the connectingmembers 2704. In this manner, therelease members 2706 releasably couple the connectingmembers 2704 and thus thesleeves 2702 to theclasps 530 by preventing theconnection members 2704 from withdrawing through theopenings 535 of theclasps 530. Theconnection members 2704 can be released from theclasps 530 by withdrawing therelease members 2706 from the loops of the connectingmembers 2704 and withdrawing the connectingmembers 2704 from theopenings 535 of theclasps 530. - With the
sleeves 2702 releasably coupled to theclasps 530 of theprosthetic spacer device 500 by the connectingmembers 2704 and therelease members 2706, theclasps 530 can be actuated (either together or separately) by moving thesleeves 2702 axially relative to theouter shaft 2220 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512. This can be accomplished, for example, by moving theactuator member 2290, which are coupled to thesleeves 2702 via thecontrol tubes 2268, relative to thehousing 2246 andactuation tube 2268. Moving theactuation member 2290 proximally relative to thehousing 2246 andactuation tube 2268 can open theclasps 530 and moving theactuation member 2290 distally relative to thehousing 2246 andactuation tube 2268 can close theclasps 530. - Because the
sleeves 2702 are relatively rigid (e.g., compared to the clasp control members 537), thesleeves 2702 can be used to push theclasps 530 closed (either in lieu of or in addition to the bias of theclasps 530 to the closed position). This pushability can help to ensure the native leaflets are grasped within theclasps 530 and thus secured to thepaddles -
FIG. 171 shows an example embodiment of a guide rail or means for guiding 2800. The guide rail or means for guiding 2800 can, for example, be coupled to theclasps 530 of theprosthetic spacer device 500. In some embodiments, the clasp control member 2700 can be releasably coupled to the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 in a snare-like manner similar to that described above with respect toFIG. 170 . - Coupling a clasp control member 2700 to the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 rather than directly to the
clasps 530 allows the clasp control member 2700 to slide longitudinally along the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 as theclasp 530 moves between the open and the closed configurations. This can, for example, allow the clasp control member 2700 to maintain a relatively constant angle relative to thepaddles clasps 530 are actuated. For example, the clasp control member 2700 can slide outwardly toward afirst side portion 2802 of the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 when theclasp 206 is pulled open, and the clasp control member 2700 can slide inwardly toward asecond side portion 2804 of the guide rail or means for guiding 2800 when theclasp 530 is pushed closed. This can therefore reduce the force required to actuate the clasp control member 2700. For example, thesleeves 2702 can remain more substantially straight as the movable portion of theclasp 530 swings through its full arc of motion. This is due to the sliding movement on the guide rail or means for guiding 2800. By sliding and remaining substantially straight, the amount of bending of the sleeves is limited. -
FIG. 172 shows an example embodiment of a shaft 2900. The shaft 2900 can be used, for example, with thedelivery apparatus 500 in lieu of theouter shaft 2220 of thethird catheter 508. The shaft 2900 can comprise a plurality of axially extending lumens, including an actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2902 (e.g., an actuation shaft lumen, actuation tube, etc.), and a plurality of control member lumens 2904 (e.g., four in the illustrated embodiment) disposed radially outwardly from the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2902. Thecontrol member lumens 2904 can be spaced relative to each other and can be evenly distributed circumferentially around the actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2902. For example, each of thecontrol member lumens 2904 can be located approximately 90 degrees from an adjacentcontrol member lumen 2904. - The actuation element lumen or means of actuating lumen 2902 can be configured to receive the actuation element or means of actuating 512, and the
control member lumens 2904 can be configured to receive the clasp control members oractuation lines 537. Thelumens 2902, 2904 can also be configured such that the actuation element or means of actuating 512 and clasp control members/lines 537 can be movable (e.g., axially and/or rotationally) relative to thelumens 2902, 2904, respectively. In particular embodiments, thelumens 2902, 2904 can comprise a liner or coating (e.g., PTFE, polymer, hydrogel, etc.) configured to reduce friction between thelumens 2902, 2904 and the actuation element or means of actuating 512 and clasp control members/lines 537, respectively. - The shaft 2900 can be formed from various materials, including metals and polymers. For example, in one particular embodiment, the shaft 2900 can comprise a
first portion 2906, asecond portion 2908, and athird portion 2910. Thefirst portion 2906 be the radially outermost portion, thethird portion 2910 can be the radially innermost portion, and thesecond portion 2908 can be disposed radially between the first andthird portions third portions second portion 2908 can be formed from a metallic material (e.g., braided stainless steel). - Configuring the shaft 2900 in this manner can, for example, further improve control of the distal end portion of the shaft 2900. For example, this configuration can prevent or reduce “whipping” (e.g., sudden or abrupt movement) at the distal end portion of the shaft 2900 when the shaft 2900 is rotated at the proximal end portion (e.g., by rotating the
housing 2246 of the handle 2222). As such, a physician can more precisely control the distal end portion of the shaft 2900 and thus more precisely control the prosthetic spacer device (e.g., the spacer device 500) during the implantation procedure such as when the physician rotates the prosthetic spacer device to align the anchors of the prosthetic spacer device with the native leaflets. - It should be noted that in certain embodiments the
housing 2246 of thehandle 2222 can comprise fourcontrol member lumens 2264, 2282 (i.e., four of each) that are coupled to thecontrol member lumens 2904. As such, each portion of the clasp control members orlines 537 can extend distally in a separate lumen from theclasp control mechanism 2250 of thehandle 2222 to theprosthetic spacer device 500. - Referring to
FIG. 173 , theactuation element 512 can be hollow so that a tethering line orsuture 3000 can be extended through theactuation element 512 to thedevice 500. Theactuation element 512 extends through thedevice 500 and is attached to thecap 514. Retracting thetethering line 3000 in the retraction direction X relative to a coupler of thedelivery assembly 2200 reduces the length of thetethering line 3000, thereby moving the coupler of thedelivery assembly 2200 toward thedevice 500 in a recapture direction Y. - Referring again to
FIG. 173 , thedevice 500 is shown in a closed position as if after delivery and implantation in a native valve. Once thedevice 500 is implanted, the coupler of thedelivery assembly 2200 is opened and moved away from the device in a retraction direction X so that the performance of thedevice 500 can be monitored to see if any adjustments may be desirable. If further adjustments to thedevice 500 are desired, thetethering line 3000 is retracted in the retraction direction X so that the coupler of thedelivery assembly 2200 moves in the recapture direction Y toward thedevice 500. - Referring now to
FIG. 174 , the coupler of thedelivery assembly 2200 has been moved into a suitable position to recapture thedevice 500. Once in position, theactuation lines 3002 for eachmoveable arm 2228 are retracted in an actuation direction A to cause themoveable arms 2228 to move in a closing direction B close around theproximal collar 511 of thedevice 500. In some embodiments, thetethering line 3000 is adjusted simultaneously with theactuation lines 3002 to aid in recapturing thedevice 500 which may be moving around as the native valve opens and closes. - Referring now to
FIG. 175 , themoveable arms 2228 are closed around theproximal collar 511. Theactuation element 512 is then moved in a distal direction C, through the securingportions 2234 of themoveable arms 2228 and into thedevice 500 along thetethering line 3000. To recapture and secure thedevice 500, a threadedend 512B of theactuation element 512 is threaded into a threadedreceptacle 516A of thecap 514 as shown inFIG. 176 . -
FIGS. 174A and 175A illustrate an example of a mechanism that can be used to recouple the coupler of thedelivery assembly 2200 to thecollar 511 of thedevice 500. In the example ofFIGS. 174A and 175A , theactuation element 512 can be hollow so that a tethering line orsuture 3000 can be extended through theactuation element 512 to thedevice 500. As in the embodiment illustrated byFIGS. 174 and 175 , retracting thetethering line 3000 in the retraction direction X moves the coupler of thedelivery assembly 2200 toward thedevice 500 in a recapture direction Y. - Referring now to
FIGS. 174A and 175A , the coupler of thedelivery assembly 2200 has been moved into a suitable position to recapture thedevice 500. Once in position, aclosing sleeve 3003 that fits around themoveable arms 2228 is advanced over the coupler of thedelivery assembly 2200 in a closing direction C to press themoveable arms 2228 inward in a closing direction D around theproximal collar 511 of thedevice 500. In some embodiments, thetethering line 3000 is adjusted simultaneously with theclosing sleeve 3003 to aid in recapturing thedevice 500 which may be moving around as the native valve opens and closes. - Referring now to
FIG. 175A , themoveable arms 2228 are closed around theproximal collar 511. Theactuation element 512 is then moved in a distal direction E and into thedevice 500 along thetethering line 3000. To recapture and secure thedevice 500, a threadedend 512B of theactuation element 512 is threaded into a threadedreceptacle 516A of thecap 514 as shown inFIG. 176 . - Referring now to
FIGS. 177-178 , an example implantableprosthetic device 3100 is shown. Thedevice 3100 includes an implantableprosthetic device 3110 and acoupler 3120. An actuation element or means of actuating orwire 3130 can extend through thecoupler 3120 to thedevice 3110 to open and close thedevice 3110. Thedevice 3110 is similar to example implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application and includes aproximal collar 3112 having anopening 3114 and radially disposedapertures 3116. Thecoupler 3120 has moveable arms orfingers 3122 that can be moved between open and closed positions. Themoveable arms 3122 includeprotrusions 3124 configured to engage theapertures 3116 of theproximal collar 3112 of thedevice 3110. Themoveable arms 3122 are biased inward so that moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3130 in a distal direction Y through thecoupler 3120 and between themoveable arms 3122 spreads themoveable arms 3122 outwards so that theprotrusions 3124 engage theapertures 3116. In the illustrated embodiment, theprotrusions 3124 andapertures 3116 are tapered to ease engagement of theprotrusions 3124 with theapertures 3116. Moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3130 in a retraction direction X allows themoveable arms 3122 to move inward so that theprotrusions 3124 disengage theapertures 3116. In this way thedevice 3110 can be released and recaptured by thecoupler 3120. - Referring now to
FIGS. 179-181 , an example implantableprosthetic device 3200 is shown. Thedevice 3200 includes an implantableprosthetic device 3210 and acoupler 3220. An actuation element or means of actuating orwire 3230 can extend through thecoupler 3220 to thedevice 3210 to open and close thedevice 3210. Thedevice 3210 is similar to example implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application and includes aproximal collar 3212 having anopening 3214 and radially disposedapertures 3216. - The
coupler 3220 has moveable arms orfingers 3222 that can be moved between open and closed positions. Themoveable arms 3222 includeprotrusions 3224 configured to engage theapertures 3216 of theproximal collar 3212 of thedevice 3210. Themoveable arms 3222 are biased inward so that moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3230 in a distal direction Y through thecoupler 3220 and between themoveable arms 3222 spreads themoveable arms 3222 outwards so that theprotrusions 3224 engage theapertures 3216. Moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3230 in a retraction direction X allows themoveable arms 3222 to move inward so that theprotrusions 3224 disengage theapertures 3216. In this way thedevice 3210 can be released and recaptured by thecoupler 3220. - The actuation element 3230 (e.g., actuation wire, shaft, tube, etc.) can be hollow so that a tethering line or
suture 3232 can be extended through theactuation element 3230 to thedevice 3210. Theactuation element 3230 extends through theopening 3214 of thedevice 3210 and is attached to securingportions 3218. Retracting thetethering line 3232 in the retraction direction X (FIG. 180 ) reduces the length of thetethering line 3232, thereby moving thecoupler 3220 toward thedevice 3210 such that themoveable arms 3222 are inserted into theopening 3214 of thedevice 3210 as shown inFIG. 180 . - Referring now to
FIG. 181 , once thecoupler 3220 has been moved into position to recapture thedevice 3210 theactuation element 3230 is moved in the distal direction Y to recouple thecoupler 3220 to thedevice 3210. Theactuation element 3230 engages themoveable arms 3222, thereby causing theprotrusions 3224 to move in an outward direction A to engage theapertures 3216 of thedevice 3210. In the illustrated embodiment, theprotrusions 3224 andapertures 3216 are tapered to ease engagement of theprotrusions 3224 with theapertures 3216. In some embodiments, thetethering line 3232 is adjusted simultaneously as the actuation element or means of actuating 3230 is extended to take up slack in the actuation line and maintain engagement between thecoupler 3220 anddevice 3210. - Referring now to
FIGS. 182-183 , an example implantableprosthetic device 3300 is shown. Thedevice 3300 includes an implantableprosthetic device 3310 and acoupler 3320. An actuation element or means of actuating orwire 3330 can extend through thecoupler 3320 to thedevice 3310 to open and close thedevice 3310. Thedevice 3310 is similar to example implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application and includes aproximal collar 3312 having anopening 3314 and radially disposedapertures 3316. - The
coupler 3320 has moveable arms orfingers 3322 that can be moved between open and closed positions. Themoveable arms 3322 includedistal protrusions 3324 configured to engage theapertures 3316 of theproximal collar 3312 of thedevice 3310. Themoveable arms 3324 also includeinternal protrusions 3326 havingapertures 3328 configured to receive the actuation element or means of actuating 3330. In the closed position, theinternal apertures 3328 are offset from the actuation element or means of actuating 3330. The actuation element or means of actuating 3330 has a taperedend 3332 to engage the offsetapertures 3328. Assuccessive apertures 3328 are engaged by thetapered end 3332 of the actuation element or means of actuating 3330, themoveable arms 3322 are moved outward to engage theopening 3314. - The
moveable arms 3322 are biased inward so that moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3330 in a distal direction Y through thecoupler 3320 and between themoveable arms 3322 spreads themoveable arms 3322 outwards so that theprotrusions 3324 engage theapertures 3316. Moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3330 in a retraction direction X allows themoveable arms 3322 to move inward so that theprotrusions 3324 disengage theapertures 3316. In this way thedevice 3310 can be released and recaptured by thecoupler 3320. In some embodiments, theprosthetic device 3300 is similar to thedevice 3200 and includes a tethering line (not shown) that allows thedevice 3300 to be recaptured. - Referring now to
FIGS. 184-185 , an example implantableprosthetic device 3400 is shown. Thedevice 3400 includes an implantableprosthetic device 3410 and acoupler 3420. An actuation element or means of actuating orwire 3430 can extend through thecoupler 3420 to thedevice 3410 to open and close thedevice 3410. Thedevice 3410 is similar to example implantable prosthetic devices described in the present application and includes aproximal collar 3412 having anopening 3414 and radially disposed apertures 3416. - The
coupler 3420 has moveable arms orfingers 3422 that can be moved between open and closed positions. Themoveable arms 3422 includedistal protrusions 3424 configured to engage the apertures 3416 of theproximal collar 3412 of thedevice 3410. Themoveable arms 3424 also includeinternal protrusions 3426 havingapertures 3428 configured to receive the actuation element or means of actuating 3430. In the closed position, theinternal apertures 3428 are offset from the actuation element or means of actuating 3430. The actuation element or means of actuating 3430 has a taperedend 3432 to engage the offsetapertures 3428. Assuccessive apertures 3428 are engaged by thetapered end 3432 of the actuation element or means of actuating 3430, themoveable arms 3422 are moved inward to engage theopening 3414. - The
moveable arms 3422 are biased outward so that moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3430 in a distal direction Y through thecoupler 3420 and between themoveable arms 3422 retracts themoveable arms 3422 inwards so that theprotrusions 3424 engage the apertures 3416. Moving the actuation element or means of actuating 3430 in a retraction direction X allows the moveable arms 4622 to spread outward so that theprotrusions 3424 disengage the apertures 3416. In this way thedevice 3410 can be released and recaptured by thecoupler 3420. In some embodiments, theprosthetic device 3400 is similar to thedevice 3200 and includes a tethering line (not shown) that allows thedevice 3400 to be recaptured. - Referring to
FIG. 186 , an actuation element or means of actuating 3500 for placing and actuating an implantable prosthetic device is shown. The actuation element or means of actuating 3500 includes ahollow positioning shaft 3510 and ahollow device shaft 3520 that fit over a retainingshaft 3530 that holds the hollow positioning anddevice shafts connection 3502. Thehollow positioning shaft 3510 extends from a delivery device 3504 and when coupled to thedevice shaft 3520 allows animplantable device 3506 to be placed in a suitable location for implantation. The location of theconnection 3502 between thehollow positioning shaft 3510 and thedevice shaft 3520 can be at a wide variety of different positions in an implantable device. For example, theconnection 3502 can be at a proximal portion of a device or can be at a distal portion of a device. - The
hollow positioning shaft 3510 can include a protrudingportion 3512 and a recessed receiving portion 3514. Thedevice shaft 3520 can also include a protrudingportion 3522 and a recessedreceiving portion 3524. When the hollow positioning anddevice shafts portion 3512 of thehollow positioning shaft 3510 is received by the receivingportion 3524 of thedevice shaft 3520, and the protrudingportion 3522 of thedevice shaft 3520 is received by the receiving portion 3514 of thehollow positioning shaft 3510. - The hollow positioning and
device shafts hollow positioning shaft 3510 can include a bore orchannel 3516 that is aligned with a bore orchannel 3526 of thehollow device shaft 3520 when the protrudingportions portions 3514, 3524, respectively. When theopenings shaft 3530 is placed into theopenings device shafts shaft 3530 is removed from theopenings portions portions 3514, 3524, such that thedevice 3506 is detached from thehollow positioning shaft 3510. - Still referring to
FIG. 186 , in some embodiments, when the hollow positioning anddevice shafts interface 3542 between the hollow positioning anddevice shafts device shafts device shafts device shafts implantable device 3506. The line 3544 can then be retracted into the catheter to release the clasps gripping members. - Referring now to
FIG. 187 , an actuation orcontrol mechanism 3600 is shown. Thecontrol mechanism 3600 can be used to open and close first and second clasps or grippingmembers control mechanism 3600 includes a firstgripper control member 3612 and a second gripper control member 3622. The firstgripper control member 3612 is configured to move the first grippingmember 3610 bi-directionally in the direction X, and the second gripper control member 3622 is configured to move the first grippingmember 3620 bi-directionally in the direction Z. Movement of the first grippingmember 3610 in the direction X adjusts the width W of afirst opening 3616 between the first grippingmember 3610 and afirst paddle 3614, and movement of the second grippingmember 3620 in the direction Z will adjust the width H of asecond opening 3626 between the second grippingmember 3620 and asecond paddle 3624. - In the illustrated embodiment, the
gripper control members pull links coupler pull link delivery device 3602 and is removably attached to the corresponding grippingmember 3612, 3622 by thecouplers link 3611 is configured to be pushed and pulled in the direction Y. Movement of thelink 3611 in the direction Y causes the grippingmember 3610 to move in the direction X. Similarly, thelink 3621 is configured to be pushed and pulled in the direction M, and movement of thelink 3621 in the direction M causes the grippingmember 3620 to move in the direction H. - Referring now to
FIGS. 188 and 188A , an actuation orcontrol mechanism 3700 for use in implantable prosthetic devices, such as the devices described in the present application, is shown. Theactuation mechanism 3700 allows for pushing and pulling of portions of an implantable device, such as the clasps or gripping members described above. Themechanism 3700 includes first andsecond control members delivery device 3702. Thedelivery device 3702 can be any suitable device, such as a sheath or catheter. The first andsecond control members second sutures flexible wires flexible wires delivery device 3702 and each include aloop second sutures second sutures delivery device 3702, through a one of the first andsecond loops delivery device 3702. In the example illustrated byFIG. 188 , eachsuture loops FIG. 188 , eachsuture loops second control members separate delivery devices 3702. Thesutures second loops respective wires sutures loops sutures wires wires wires wires sutures wires - In the examples of
FIGS. 188 and 188A , thewires - Referring now to
FIG. 189 , an example embodiment of an actuation orcontrol mechanism 3800 includes afirst catheter 3811, asecond catheter 3821, andsingle line 3830, such as a wire or suture. Thefirst catheter 3811 andline 3830 are configured to move a first grippingmember 3810 in the direction X, and thesecond catheter 3821 andline 3830 configured to move a second grippingmember 3820 in the direction Z. Movement of the grippingmember 3810 in the direction X will adjust the width W of afirst opening 3816 between the first grippingmember 3810 and afirst paddle 3814, and movement of the second grippingmember 3820 in the direction Z will adjust the width H of asecond opening 3826 between the second grippingmember 3820 and asecond paddle 3824. Theline 3830 extends from adelivery device 3802 through thecatheters member catheter member first catheter 3811 is configured to be pushed in the direction Y while theline 3830 is payed out of thesecond catheter 3821 or tension in theline 3830 is reduced. Thefirst catheter 3811 is configured to be pulled in the direction Y while theline 3830 is pulled into thefirst catheter 3811 or tension in the line is increased. Movement of thefirst catheter 3811 in the direction Y causes thefirst catheter 3811 to move the first grippingmember 3810 in the direction X. Similarly, thesecond catheter 3821 is configured to be pushed in the direction M while theline 3830 is payed out of thefirst catheter 3811 or tension in theline 3830 is reduced. Thesecond catheter 3821 is configured to be pulled in the direction M while theline 3830 is pulled into thesecond catheter 3821 or tension in theline 3830 is increased. Movement of thesecond catheter 3821 in the direction M causes thesecond catheter 3821 to move the second grippingmember 3820 in the direction H. In an alternative embodiment, thecontrol mechanism 3800 described above with reference toFIG. 189 can include a first flexible wire with a loop (e.g., theflexible wire 3714 with theloop 3716 shown inFIG. 188 ) and a second flexible wire with a loop (e.g., theflexible wire 3724 with theloop 3726 shown inFIG. 188 ), and thesingle line 3830 extends through theloop wires 3830. - Referring to
FIG. 190 , an example embodiment of an actuation orcontrol mechanism 3900 includes asingle line 3930, such as a suture or wire, that is removably attached to first and second clasps or grippingmembers positioning shaft 3904 and a shaft ordevice shaft 3906 of an implantable device. While described as twoshafts line 3930, e.g., and can be retractable from the loop to release the line. Theshafts device shafts single line 3930 is connected at aconnection 3908 between theshafts single line 3930 can separately control the grippingmembers first portion 3932 of theline 3930 in a direction Y will adjust a width W between the first grippingmember 3910 and afirst paddle 3914 but will not adjust a width H between the second grippingmember 3920 and asecond paddle 3924. Similarly, movement of asecond portion 3934 of theline 3930 in a direction M will adjust a width H between the second grippingmember 3920 and asecond paddle 3924 but will not adjust the width W between the first grippingmember 3910 and thefirst paddle 3914. After the valve repair device is in a closed position and secured to the native valve tissue, thepositioning shaft 3904 is detached from thedevice shaft 3906. Decoupling theshafts line 3930 from theconnection 3908. Theline 3930 can then be retracted into thecatheter 3902 to release thegripping members line 3930 into thecatheter 3902. Pulling one end of theline 3930 into thecatheter 3902 pulls the other end of theline 3930 through the grippingmembers catheter 3902. Any of the lines described herein can be retracted in this manner. While described here as a single line, a similar configuration could also be used whereline 3930 is two separate lines each connecting in a similar way to a respective clasp or grippingmember shafts - Referring now to
FIGS. 208A, 208B, 209A, and 209B , an example implantableprosthetic device 4100, such as the devices described in the present application, is shown anchored tonative leaflets device 4100 includes a coaption orspacer element 4102 and anchors 4104. Theanchors 4104 attach thedevice 4100 to theleaflets FIG. 208B , first andsecond gaps 26A, 26B remain between theclosed leaflets device 4100 is deployed. Thecoaption element 4102 includes first and second auxiliary, inflatable coaption orspacer elements FIGS. 208A and 208B . - Referring now to
FIGS. 209A, 209B , thedevice 4100 is shown with theauxiliary coaption elements auxiliary coaption elements second gaps 26A, 26B. Filling thegaps 26A, 26B allows theleaflets device 4100. Theauxiliary coaption elements auxiliary coaption element 4106 can be inflated to a different size than the secondauxiliary coaption element 4108 to filldifferent size gaps 26A, 26B. - Referring now to
FIGS. 210A and 210B , an example expandable coaption orspacer element 4200 for use with a prosthetic implantable device of the present disclosure is shown. Referring now toFIG. 210A , theexpandable coaption element 4200 is shown in a compressed condition. Theexpandable coaption element 4200 is formed from a coiledwire 4202 that is retained in the compressed condition by a retainingelement 4204. Once thecoaption element 4200 is in a desired location, an actuation line oractuation suture 4206 is used to pull theretaining element 4204 in anactuation direction 4208. Removing the retainingelement 4204 allows thecoaption element 4200 to expand in anexpansion direction 4210 to a larger, expanded size. Thecoaption element 4200 can be used as the auxiliary coaption element 4016, 4018 in the embodiment ofFIGS. 208A, 208B, 208C, and 208D . - Referring now to
FIGS. 211A and 211B , an example implantableprosthetic device 4300, such as the devices described in the present application, is shown. Thedevice 4300 extends from aproximal end 4301 to adistal end 4303. Like thedevice 4100 described above, thedevice 4300 includes a coaption orspacer element 4302 that has first and second auxiliary, inflatable coaption orspacer elements FIG. 211A . Eachauxiliary coaption element proximal end distal end 4306B, 4308B. Referring now toFIG. 211B , thedevice 4300 is shown with theauxiliary coaption elements distal end 4306B, 4308B have different sizes such that theauxiliary coaption elements distal ends 4306B, 4308B. In certain embodiments, the proximal ends are larger than the distal ends. The varying width of theauxiliary coaption elements device 4300 where the gaps between leaflets change in size from the proximal todistal ends device 4300. - Referring now to
FIGS. 212A, 212B, 213A, 213B, 214, 215A, 215B, 216A, 216B, 217A, 217B, and 218 an example implantableprosthetic device 4400, such as the devices described in the present application, is shown. Referring now toFIGS. 212A, 212B, 213A, 213B, and 214 , thedevice 4400 includes a coaption orspacer element 4402, anchors 4404, and anattachment portion 4406. Theattachment portion 4406 is a threaded rod that extends from thecoaption element 4402 to receive an auxiliary coaption orspacer element 4410. Theauxiliary coaption element 4410 has an inverted L-shape with anattachment opening 4412 and aspacer body 4414. Theattachment opening 4412 receives theattachment portion 4406 to attach theauxiliary coaption element 4410 to thedevice 4400. Thespacer body 4414 extends along one side of thecoaption element 4402 to fill a gap (e.g.,gaps 26A, 26B shown inFIG. 208B ) between the leaflets. Theauxiliary coaption element 4410 can have any suitable shape and can vary in width and size like theinflatable spacers - Referring now to
FIG. 214 , theauxiliary coaption element 4410 is shown being assembled to thedevice 4400. Theauxiliary coaption element 4410 can be attached to theattachment portion 4406 of thedevice 4400 after thedevice 4400 has been implanted between the native leaflets (not shown) and anchored in place via theanchors 4404. As can be seen inFIGS. 215A and 215B , theauxiliary coaption element 4410 is secured to theattachment portion 4406 with anut 4408 after being attached to thedevice 4400. In certain embodiments, theattachment opening 4412 in theauxiliary coaption element 4410 is a slot to allow for lateral adjustment of the position of theauxiliary coaption element 4410 without fully removing theauxiliary coaption element 4410 from thedevice 4400. That is, thenut 4408 can be loosened to allow the position of theauxiliary coaption element 4410 to be adjusted after assembly to thedevice 4400. - Referring now to
FIGS. 216A, 216B, 217A, 217B , thedevice 4400 and auxiliary coaption element orspacer 4410 are shown with different means of attaching theauxiliary coaption element 4410 to thedevice 4400 than the threaded rod andnut 4408 described above. Thedevice 4400 shown inFIGS. 216A and 216B includes acircular magnet 4407 surrounding theattachment portion 4406. Theauxiliary coaption element 4410 shown inFIGS. 217A and 217B includes a similarly shapedmagnet 4413 surrounding the attachment opening 4412 (which is shown as a hole, rather than a slot). When theauxiliary coaption element 4410 is assembled to thedevice 4400 opposite poles twomagnets auxiliary coaption element 4410 on thedevice 4400 by way of magnetic attractive forces. In some embodiments, a plurality of magnets are provided on thedevice 4400 and/or theauxiliary coaption element 4410. - Referring now to
FIG. 218 , a double-sidedauxiliary coaption element 4420 for attachment to thedevice 4400 is shown. Theauxiliary coaption element 4420 has an inverted U-shape with anattachment opening 4422 disposed between twocoaption portions 4424. Like theauxiliary coaption element 4410 described above, theattachment opening 4422 receives theattachment portion 4406 to attach theauxiliary coaption element 4420 to thedevice 4400. Thecoaption portions 4424 extend along both sides of thecoaption element 4402 to fill gaps (e.g.,gaps 26A, 26B shown inFIG. 208B ) between the leaflets. Theauxiliary coaption element 4420 can have any suitable shape and can vary in width and size like theinflatable spacers - Referring now to
FIGS. 219A, 219B , an example implantableprosthetic device 4500, such as the devices described in the present application, is shown. Thedevice 4500 includes a coaption orspacer element 4502 andattachment portions 4504 arranged on opposite sides of thecoaption element 4502. Theattachment portions 4504 are configured to receive auxiliary coaption or spacer elements of varying shapes and sizes (FIGS. 220A-220E ). In the illustrated embodiment, theattachment portions 4504 are shown as hoops that receive posts orpins 4512 of the auxiliary coaption elements (FIGS. 220A-220E ). Like thespacers 4410 shown above, theauxiliary coaption elements FIGS. 220A-220E extend along one or both sides of thecoaption element 4502 to fill a gap (e.g.,gaps 26A, 26B shown inFIG. 208B ) between the leaflets. To accommodate gaps of different sizes and shapes, the variety ofauxiliary coaption elements auxiliary coaption elements coaption element 4502 to accommodate gaps that are different shapes and sizes on opposite sides of thecoaption element 4502. - Referring now to
FIGS. 221-223 , an example implantableprosthetic device 4600 is shown. Referring now toFIG. 221 , thedevice 4600 is shown cut from a flat sheet ofmaterial 4602, such as Nitinol, into a lattice-like shape formed from a plurality of struts. Thecoaption portion 4604 of thedevice 4600 includesauxiliary coaption portions 4606 that expand outwards from thecoaption element 4602 when thedevice 4600 is formed into a three-dimensional shape. Theauxiliary coaption portions 4606 can be longer struts that are curved before the prosthetic device is expanded. Referring now toFIG. 223 , when the device is expanded, the longer curved struts expand to form theauxiliary coaption portions 4606. The expanded auxiliary coaption portions 4605 fill or partially fillgaps 26 between thenative leaflets device 4600 is implanted between thenative leaflets coaption portion 4604 of the device is covered with a cover (not shown) can be a cloth material such as polyethylene cloth of a fine mesh. The cloth cover can provide a blood seal on the surface of the spacer, and/or promote rapid tissue ingrowth. - Referring now to
FIGS. 224-225 , an example implantableprosthetic device 4700 is shown. Referring now toFIG. 224 , thedevice 4700 is shown cut from a flat sheet ofmaterial 4702, such as Nitinol. Thedevice 4700 includescoaption portions 4704,inner paddle portions 4706,outer paddle portions 4708, and amiddle portion 4710. Referring now toFIG. 225 , thedevice 4700 is shown folded into a three-dimensional shape. Thematerial 4702 is folded at themiddle portion 4710 so that the various portions of each side of thematerial 4702 align. When thecoaption portions 4704 are aligned, a matrix of cut-outs in thematerial 4702 form thecoaption portion 4704 into a three-dimensional shape similar to the shape of the coaption elements described above. - An example embodiment of an implantable
prosthetic device 23200 is illustrated inFIGS. 232A-232B . Thedevice 23200 can be the same as, substantially the same as, or similar to thedevice 500A, except thepaddles 23202 of thedevice 23200 are configured to form an area 23304 (SeeFIG. 233A ) where the paddles are parallel or substantially parallel to enhance leaflet engagement. Theimplantable device 23200 can include any other features for an implantable prosthetic device discussed in the present application, and thedevice 23200 can be positioned to engagevalve tissue - As shown in
FIGS. 232A and 232B , theprosthetic device 23200 comprises paddle frames 23202, acoaption element 23204,outer paddle portions 23206, andinner paddle portions 23208. The paddle frames 23202, the paddle portions (23206 & 23208), and thecoaption element 23204 work together to capture and secure the leaflets of a native valve. In addition to thepaddle portions coaption element 23204, aclasp 23210 is connected to eachinner paddle portion 23208 and serves to secure the leaflets during the installation of theprosthetic device 23200. In the cross-section view ofFIG. 232B , theouter paddle 23206 andinner paddle 23208 portions of thecoaption element 23204 are illustrated. Also visible are theclasp 23210 portions. In particular, the cross-section view ofFIG. 232B shows aflexible portion 23212 extending between fixed and movable portions of theclasp 23210. - As is annotated in
FIGS. 233A-233B , aportion 23302 of the paddle frames 23202 is configured to be parallel or substantially parallel between eachpaddle frame 23202 when in use. This forms anarea 23304 in which an enhanced level of leaflet tissue clamping is exhibited. In the illustrated example, thearea 23304 is rectangular or substantially rectangular. However, in some example embodiments thearea 23304 can have other shapes. For example, thearea 23304 can be somewhat tapered in other embodiments to correspond to a tapered shape of native valve leaflets. -
FIGS. 234A-234B illustrate an implantableprosthetic device 23200 which has captured native valve leaflets, such asnative valve leaflets Device 23200 can also be covered similar to other devices herein. As illustrated, theleaflets line 23408 to dashedline 23410 where the leaflets are pressed together at the sides of the coaption element, rather than at a single point. The distance where the leaflets are pressed together can be from 1-10 mm, such as from 2-5 mm, such as from 3-4 mm. The cross-section view ofFIG. 234B illustrates that theleaflets - An advantage of the embodiment illustrated by
FIGS. 234A-234B is illustrated inFIGS. 235A-235B . As shown at 23502, the first leaflet extends farther into theprosthetic device 23200 than thesecond leaflet 22. It should be noted, that the use of “first” and “second” is to simplify the explanation of the figure. As such, afirst leaflet 20 can be any leaflet (e.g., either an anterior or posterior leaflet, etc.) as is also the case with asecond leaflet 22. As was noted elsewhere herein, during the installation of theprosthetic device 23200, the leaflets (20, 22) can be captured individually before being clamped in place by the coaption element and paddle frame. The result may be a misalignment and/or difference in depth of insertion as illustrated at 23502. In some example embodiments, paddle frames may have a shorter parallel section or no parallel section, resulting in a narrower section of contact between the leaflets along the paddle frames. Because of the parallel or substantially parallel alignment of the example paddle frames (23202) the leaflets are still pressed together along the length of the paddle frames betweenlines lines FIG. 234A , but there is still an area where the leaflets are pressed together. The cross-section view ofFIG. 235B illustrates that theleaflets leaflets paddles 23202 as long as some portion of each leaflet is in the area 23304 (SeeFIG. 233A ) where the paddle frames 23302 are parallel and close enough to press the leaflets together (i.e. the distance between the paddle frames 23302 in thearea 23304 is less than or equal to the stacked thickness of the two leaflets). -
FIG. 236 illustrates an alternate view of theprosthetic device 23200 ofFIG. 233A . If the view ofFIG. 233A were to be considered a “front” view, the view ofFIG. 236 would be a side view. Because theprosthetic device 23200 is optionally symmetrical or substantially symmetrical from front to back and from side to side,FIG. 236 could represent either a left or right-side view of theprosthetic device 23200. Visible at the upper end of the figure is thecollar 23602 of theprosthetic device 23200. Theouter paddle 23206 is visible from top to bottom of the figure. Apaddle frame 23202 is also visible. As was noted inFIG. 234A , thepaddle frame 23202 has anarea 23406 along which the paddle frames of the prosthetic devices are parallel or substantially parallel. In the illustrated example embodiment, theouter edges 23604 of eachpaddle frame 23202 are parallel or substantially parallel to avertical axis 23606 of theprosthetic device 23200. This vertical extension of theouter edges 23604 of the paddle frames 23202 gives the paddle frames 23202 and the outside of the device a rectangular shape. This rectangular shape permits a plurality ofprosthetic devices 23200 to be placed adjacent to one another. - In certain circumstances, the repair of a valve, such as a mitral valve or tricuspid valve may require more than one
prosthetic device 23200. In such a case, a second (or more)prosthetic device 23200 can be installed. In certain circumstances, it may be desirable that this secondprosthetic device 23200 be installed adjacent to a firstprosthetic device 23200. The parallel configuration of theportions 23604 and the resulting generally rectangular shape of the device allows two (or more)prosthetic devices 23200 to be installed adjacent to one another with parallel or substantially parallelpaddle frame portions 23604 abutting or nearly abutting one another. This positioning is illustrated inFIG. 237 . InFIG. 237 , twoprosthetic devices 23200 are positioned adjacent to each other such that the paddle frames 23202 of each device are parallel or substantially parallel as illustrated inFIG. 237 . The close or abutting parallel paddles frames 23202 helps reduce or eliminate leakage or regurgitation between portions of leaflets that are between thedevices 23200 - A
prosthetic device 23200 installed onleaflets FIG. 238A . As shown, theprosthetic device 23200 is positioned at a location along the leaflets of the mitral valve MV.FIG. 238B shows a cross-section of afirst leaflet 20 and asecond leaflet 22. If a singleprosthetic device 23200, as illustrated, is insufficient to repair the native valve to reduce regurgitation to a desired level or eliminate regurgitation, asecond device 23200 can be installed. In an installation using a secondprosthetic device 23200, positioning the devices in close proximity can prevent regurgitation between leaflet portions that are between the two prosthetic devices. - Having a first
prosthetic device 23200 and a secondprosthetic device 23200, each configured with a parallel or substantially parallel portion of paddle frame permits a side-by-side installation as illustrated inFIG. 239A . As shown, theleaflets prosthetic devices 23200 positioned adjacent to one another such that the paddle frame of the firstprosthetic device 23200 is parallel or substantially parallel to the paddle frame of the secondprosthetic device 23200. Thus, the devices can be positioned very close to one another, minimizing anygap 23902 between the twoprosthetic devices 23200. As illustrated inFIG. 239B , the portions of theleaflets -
FIGS. 235A-235B and the corresponding description show and describe how sections ofpaddle frame 23202 that are parallel or substantially parallel cause coaption of a portion of a first leaflet with a portion of a second leaflet around the coaption element, even though thefirst leaflet 20 andsecond leaflet 22 are misaligned. In the embodiment ofFIGS. 235A and 235B , if any portion of theleaflets parallel area 23304, the leaflets will be pressed together by the paddle frames. In an example embodiment, this larger,parallel area 23304 can also be utilized to prevent regurgitation through leaflet portions that are between two adjacent devices. - The
prosthetic devices 23200 ofFIG. 239B are illustrated as vertically aligned such that the edges of theleaflets prosthetic devices 23200. However, such an installation could very difficult to achieve and/or confirm. -
FIG. 240A illustrates a vertical misalignment between twoprosthetic devices 23200 installed on a native valve, such as a mitral valve. As can be observed inFIG. 240A , a lower portion of theleaflets area 23304 of both devices, along which the paddle frames of the first prosthetic device are parallel or substantially parallel. As was noted earlier, thisarea 23304 provides a clamping action of the leaflets. Thus, as illustrated inFIG. 240B , thearea 23904 between theleaflets prosthetic devices 23200, even though the two valve leaflets are vertically misaligned on the valve. The path of the leaflets inFIGS. 239B and 240B remains the same or similar. - As illustrated in
FIGS. 8-12 , the corresponding description, and elsewhere herein, a clasp is used to secure valve leaflets during installation of the prosthetic devices disclosed herein, including theprosthetic device 23200. An example installation process is illustrated inFIGS. 15-20 and the accompanying written description. In that described process, a clasp associated with each paddle portion of the coaption element is used to capture a valve leaflet. In order to securely grasp the leaflet, the clasps are equipped with barbs which can partially or completely puncture the leaflet. Referring toFIGS. 241 and 242 , an example embodiment of the barbed portion of aclasp 24100 is illustrated. Shown is anoptional eyelet 24102 andbarbs 24104 which are located in abarb support portion 24106 of theclasp 24100. Visible in the figure are portions of theclasp 24100 that are configured to increase the flexibility of thebarb support portion 24106 of theclasp 24100. The increase of the flexibility of thebarb support portion 24106 of theclasp 24100 can be accomplished in a wide variety of different ways. In the illustrated embodiment,cutouts 24108 to increase the flexibility of thebarb support portion 24106 of theclasp 24100. However, in some example embodiments, the flexibility can be increased by reducing the thickness in a select area or areas, making portions of the clasp from different materials, heat and or chemical treatment of different portions of the clasps, etc. Any manner of increasing the barb support portion can be used. - In one example embodiment, the flexibility of the
barb support portion 24106 is configured such that the barbs rotate and pull out of the leaflet upon application of a predetermined pulling force. In one example embodiment, the predetermined pulling force is selected such that the barbs rotate and pull out of the leaflet before damage to the leaflet occurs. In one example embodiment the predetermined pulling force is selected such that the paddles and paddle frames first flex and open or partially open and then the barbs rotate and pull out of the leaflet.FIG. 241 illustrates the barb support in a “normal” or unflexed position whileFIG. 242 illustrates thebarb support portion 24106 of theclasp 24100 in a flexed position. -
FIGS. 243A-243H illustrate an example behavior of a clasp configured according toFIGS. 241 and 242 .FIGS. 243B-243H illustrate thebarb support portion 24106 as tension is applied between theclasp 24100 and theleaflet 20. The tension can be applied for a variety of different reasons. In one example embodiment, the tension results from capturing the leaflets with the clasps, manipulating one leaflet while a second leaflet is captured, closing of the paddles after the leaflet is grasped by the clasp and/or pressure applied to the device by blood due to the beating of the heart. - In
FIG. 243A , thebarbs 24104 of theclasp 24100 are embedded in a leaflet 20 (only a small portion of the leaflet is illustrated). In use with aprosthetic device 23200 as illustrated inFIGS. 18-20 , the clasp is affixed at the base of the paddle. As mentioned above, various situations can cause tension to be applied such that the barb of the clasp pulls against the leaflet. InFIG. 243A , this tension could be caused by theleaflet 20 moving upward and/or laterally while theclasp 24100 remains stationary, theleaflet 20 remaining stationary while theclasp 24100 moves downward and/or laterally, or a combination in which both theleaflet 20 and theclasp 24100 moves. In each instance, tension between theleaflet 20 and theclasp 24100 results. As the application of tension continues, pressure againstbarb 24104 causes thebarb support portion 24106 to begin to rotate away from theleaflet 20 in a clockwise motion relative to themoveable arm 134 of the clasp (as illustrated inFIG. 243B ). As the application of tension becomes greater, thebarb support portion 24106 continues to rotate away from theleaflet 20 as illustrated inFIG. 243C . As shown at 24306, thebarb 24104 begins to withdraw from theleaflet 20.FIG. 243D illustrates continued rotation of thebarb support portion 24106, allowing thebarb 24104 to further withdraw 24308 from theleaflet 20.FIG. 243E represents a continuation of this process, with the barb support portion rotated farther away from theleaflet 20 than was illustrated inFIG. 243D , and thebarb 24104 itself withdrawing even farther from theleaflet 20. This process continues as illustrated inFIG. 243F , which shows thebarb 24104 almost completely withdrawn from theleaflet 20. As shown inFIG. 243G , thebarb 24104 will eventually withdraw from theleaflet 20 and the barb support portion will return to its original or shape set position as illustrated inFIG. 243H , positioning thebarb 24104 to be aligned to re-engage theleaflet 20 as needed. -
FIGS. 244A-244E illustrate the process ofFIGS. 243A-243H with an example schematic illustration of aprosthetic device 24402 and leaflets (20 and 22) of a mitral valve. Manipulation of the device during the installation of theprosthetic device 24402 can causes theprosthetic device 24402 to be pushed deeper into the leaflets (20 and 22) as illustrated inFIG. 244B . As this happens, thebarbs 24104 of the clasps are pulled away from thecap 24410 portion of theprosthetic device 24402. This causes thepaddle assembly 24412 to flex and partially open away from thecoaption portion 24414 of theprosthetic device 24402. - As shown in
FIG. 244C , as theprosthetic device 24402 is pushed farther downward relative to the leaflets (20 and 22) of the mitral valve, thebarb portions 24104 of theclasps 24100 flex and start to be withdrawn from the leaflets (20 and 22). -
FIG. 244D illustrates the release of theprosthetic device 24402 from the leaflets (20 and 22) as the barbs 24416 are completely withdrawn from the leaflets (20 and 22). After the leaflets (20 and 22) are released, the paddles return to their original position as illustrated in 244E and 244A and thebarbs 24104 and clasps 24100 return to a position adjacent to the paddles as illustrated inFIG. 244E . -
FIGS. 245A-245E illustrate the process ofFIGS. 244A-244E using an exampleprosthetic device 24502,FIG. 245A illustrates theprosthetic device 24502 with thebarbs 24104 engaged in leaflets (20 and 22). With the exception of the flexible clasp and optionally paddle frames that provide parallel leaflet engagement areas, theprosthetic device 24502 can be the same as, substantially the same as, or similar to thedevice 500A.FIGS. 245B-245E demonstrate the process of releasing the leaflets (20 and 22) in the same manner as was described inFIGS. 244B-244E . -
FIGS. 244A-244E and 245A-245E demonstrate conditions in which a prosthetic device could be moved into the native valve and pull on the leaflets.FIGS. 16-20 show an installation process of the prosthetic devices disclosed herein.FIG. 18 shows that a first clasp can be engaged with a first leaflet, while a second clasp is not engaged with the second leaflet. - Referring to
FIG. 246 , in an attempt to capture a second leaflet with the second clasp, an installer may pull (indicated by arrow 24606) theprosthetic device 24502 with the attachedfirst leaflet 20 toward thesecond leaflet 22 to capture the second leaflet (The device illustrated byFIG. 246 is thedevice 24502, but can be any of the devices disclosed herein). In many cases, the second leaflet can be captured in this manner. In some cases, thefirst leaflet 20 could be pulled excessively to reach thefirst leaflet 22. Theclasp 24100 illustrated by Figures can be used to protect the first leaflet. In particular, theclasp 24100 will release from the first leaflet in the manner illustrated byFIGS. 243A-243H . The clasp will also open somewhat as the operator pulls the device and the first leaflet. This is illustrated inFIG. 246 . As illustrated byFIGS. 243A-243H , the barb support 24612 can bend away from the first leaflet 24610 and release the barb from the first leaflet 24610, when a predetermined tensile force is applied between the leaflet and the clasp. - While various inventive aspects, concepts and features of the disclosures may be described and illustrated herein as embodied in combination in the example embodiments, these various aspects, concepts, and features may be used in many alternative embodiments, either individually or in various combinations and sub-combinations thereof. Unless expressly excluded herein all such combinations and sub-combinations are intended to be within the scope of the present application. Still further, while various alternative embodiments as to the various aspects, concepts, and features of the disclosures—such as alternative materials, structures, configurations, methods, devices, and components, alternatives as to form, fit, and function, and so on—may be described herein, such descriptions are not intended to be a complete or exhaustive list of available alternative embodiments, whether presently known or later developed. Those skilled in the art may readily adopt one or more of the inventive aspects, concepts, or features into additional embodiments and uses within the scope of the present application even if such embodiments are not expressly disclosed herein.
- Additionally, even though some features, concepts, or aspects of the disclosures may be described herein as being a preferred arrangement or method, such description is not intended to suggest that such feature is required or necessary unless expressly so stated. Still further, example or representative values and ranges may be included to assist in understanding the present application, however, such values and ranges are not to be construed in a limiting sense and are intended to be critical values or ranges only if so expressly stated.
- Moreover, while various aspects, features and concepts may be expressly identified herein as being inventive or forming part of a disclosure, such identification is not intended to be exclusive, but rather there may be inventive aspects, concepts, and features that are fully described herein without being expressly identified as such or as part of a specific disclosure, the disclosures instead being set forth in the appended claims. Descriptions of example methods or processes are not limited to inclusion of all steps as being required in all cases, nor is the order that the steps are presented to be construed as required or necessary unless expressly so stated. Further, the treatment techniques, methods, operations, steps, etc. described or suggested herein can be performed on a living animal or on a non-living simulation, such as on a cadaver, cadaver heart, simulator (e.g. with the body parts, tissue, etc. being simulated), etc. The words used in the claims have their full ordinary meanings and are not limited in any way by the description of the embodiments in the specification.
Claims (25)
Priority Applications (2)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US16/847,577 US11766330B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2020-04-13 | Valve repair devices for repairing a native valve of a patient |
US18/449,659 US20230380971A1 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2023-08-14 | Valve repair devices for repairing a native valve of a patient |
Applications Claiming Priority (3)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US201862744031P | 2018-10-10 | 2018-10-10 | |
PCT/US2019/055320 WO2020076898A1 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-10-09 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/847,577 US11766330B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2020-04-13 | Valve repair devices for repairing a native valve of a patient |
Related Parent Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
PCT/US2019/055320 Continuation WO2020076898A1 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-10-09 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
Related Child Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US18/449,659 Continuation US20230380971A1 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2023-08-14 | Valve repair devices for repairing a native valve of a patient |
Publications (2)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20200237512A1 true US20200237512A1 (en) | 2020-07-30 |
US11766330B2 US11766330B2 (en) | 2023-09-26 |
Family
ID=68425266
Family Applications (13)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US16/191,336 Active 2039-01-28 US10945844B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2018-11-14 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/194,785 Active 2039-06-01 US11083582B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2018-11-19 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/204,355 Active 2039-05-04 US11202710B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2018-11-29 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/207,693 Active 2039-04-25 US10987221B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2018-12-03 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/218,060 Active 2039-04-25 US11000375B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2018-12-12 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/276,501 Active 2039-07-30 US11234823B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-02-14 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/280,807 Active 2040-05-20 US11344415B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-02-20 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/280,638 Active 2039-08-04 US10993809B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-02-20 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/282,844 Active 2039-11-28 US11129717B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-02-22 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/290,572 Active 2040-02-27 US11278409B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-03-01 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/299,763 Active 2039-09-19 US11147672B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-03-12 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/847,577 Active 2040-12-21 US11766330B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2020-04-13 | Valve repair devices for repairing a native valve of a patient |
US18/449,659 Pending US20230380971A1 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2023-08-14 | Valve repair devices for repairing a native valve of a patient |
Family Applications Before (11)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US16/191,336 Active 2039-01-28 US10945844B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2018-11-14 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/194,785 Active 2039-06-01 US11083582B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2018-11-19 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/204,355 Active 2039-05-04 US11202710B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2018-11-29 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/207,693 Active 2039-04-25 US10987221B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2018-12-03 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/218,060 Active 2039-04-25 US11000375B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2018-12-12 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/276,501 Active 2039-07-30 US11234823B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-02-14 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/280,807 Active 2040-05-20 US11344415B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-02-20 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/280,638 Active 2039-08-04 US10993809B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-02-20 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/282,844 Active 2039-11-28 US11129717B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-02-22 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/290,572 Active 2040-02-27 US11278409B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-03-01 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US16/299,763 Active 2039-09-19 US11147672B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2019-03-12 | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
Family Applications After (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US18/449,659 Pending US20230380971A1 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2023-08-14 | Valve repair devices for repairing a native valve of a patient |
Country Status (16)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (13) | US10945844B2 (en) |
EP (1) | EP3863568A1 (en) |
JP (2) | JP7447103B2 (en) |
KR (1) | KR20210074296A (en) |
CN (2) | CN112955097A (en) |
AU (2) | AU2019357479B2 (en) |
BR (2) | BR112020023021A2 (en) |
CA (1) | CA3116025A1 (en) |
CO (1) | CO2021006055A2 (en) |
CR (1) | CR20210230A (en) |
DE (1) | DE112019005088T5 (en) |
IL (2) | IL315326A (en) |
MX (1) | MX2021002827A (en) |
SG (1) | SG11202102714RA (en) |
TW (1) | TWI840422B (en) |
WO (1) | WO2020076898A1 (en) |
Cited By (44)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US11083582B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2021-08-10 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11096784B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2021-08-24 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11109964B2 (en) | 2010-03-10 | 2021-09-07 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Axially-shortening prosthetic valve |
US11110251B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2021-09-07 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Multi-direction steerable handles for steering catheters |
US11135059B2 (en) | 2013-01-24 | 2021-10-05 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve and upstream support therefor |
US11141268B2 (en) | 2009-12-08 | 2021-10-12 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve with upper and lower skirts |
US11160657B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2021-11-02 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11166778B2 (en) | 2017-04-28 | 2021-11-09 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Medical device stabilizing apparatus and method of use |
US11207181B2 (en) | 2018-04-18 | 2021-12-28 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11219746B2 (en) | 2016-03-21 | 2022-01-11 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Multi-direction steerable handles for steering catheters |
US11246704B2 (en) | 2017-08-03 | 2022-02-15 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve |
US11259927B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2022-03-01 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US11298228B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2022-04-12 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US11298117B2 (en) | 2016-02-16 | 2022-04-12 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Techniques for providing a replacement valve and transseptal communication |
US11304804B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2022-04-19 | Cardiovalve, Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with connecting struts of variable size and tissue anchoring legs of variable size that extend from junctions |
US11382746B2 (en) | 2017-12-13 | 2022-07-12 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve and delivery tool therefor |
US11389297B2 (en) | 2018-04-12 | 2022-07-19 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Mitral valve spacer device |
US11426155B2 (en) | 2010-07-21 | 2022-08-30 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Helical anchor implantation |
US11517436B2 (en) | 2011-08-05 | 2022-12-06 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Implant for heart valve |
US11517718B2 (en) | 2016-11-07 | 2022-12-06 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Apparatus for the introduction and manipulation of multiple telescoping catheters |
US11547564B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2023-01-10 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US11571298B2 (en) | 2017-08-03 | 2023-02-07 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with appendages |
US11612485B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2023-03-28 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US11653910B2 (en) | 2010-07-21 | 2023-05-23 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Helical anchor implantation |
US11660185B2 (en) | 2009-12-04 | 2023-05-30 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Ventricular anchors for valve repair and replacement devices |
US11672658B2 (en) | 2015-02-05 | 2023-06-13 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with aligned inner and outer frames |
US11690712B2 (en) | 2011-08-05 | 2023-07-04 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Clip-secured implant for heart valve |
US11690621B2 (en) | 2014-12-04 | 2023-07-04 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Percutaneous clip for repairing a heart valve |
US11701225B2 (en) | 2014-07-30 | 2023-07-18 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Delivery of a prosthetic valve |
US11717406B2 (en) | 2019-05-22 | 2023-08-08 | TriFlo Cardiovascular Inc. | Heart valve support device |
US11730598B2 (en) | 2017-09-07 | 2023-08-22 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Prosthetic device for heart valve |
US11779458B2 (en) | 2016-08-10 | 2023-10-10 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with leaflet connectors |
US11793635B2 (en) | 2015-02-05 | 2023-10-24 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with angularly offset frames |
US11793642B2 (en) | 2015-05-14 | 2023-10-24 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11793633B2 (en) | 2017-08-03 | 2023-10-24 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve |
US11839544B2 (en) | 2019-02-14 | 2023-12-12 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11918469B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2024-03-05 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US11951263B2 (en) | 2016-03-21 | 2024-04-09 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Multi-direction steerable handles |
US11969346B2 (en) | 2017-01-05 | 2024-04-30 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve coaptation device |
US12029646B2 (en) | 2017-08-03 | 2024-07-09 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve |
US12048625B2 (en) | 2017-05-10 | 2024-07-30 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Valve repair delivery handle |
US12053379B2 (en) | 2016-08-01 | 2024-08-06 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Minimally-invasive delivery systems |
US12083010B2 (en) | 2013-02-04 | 2024-09-10 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Method of implanting a spacer body in a mitral valve |
US12090052B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2024-09-17 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
Families Citing this family (52)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
WO2013021375A2 (en) | 2011-08-05 | 2013-02-14 | Mitraltech Ltd. | Percutaneous mitral valve replacement and sealing |
US8945177B2 (en) | 2011-09-13 | 2015-02-03 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems Inc. | Gripper pusher mechanism for tissue apposition systems |
US9011468B2 (en) | 2011-09-13 | 2015-04-21 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems Inc. | Independent gripper |
US11963712B2 (en) | 2016-06-20 | 2024-04-23 | Evalve, Inc. | Transapical removal device |
US9895226B1 (en) | 2017-10-19 | 2018-02-20 | Mitral Tech Ltd. | Techniques for use with prosthetic valve leaflets |
GB201800399D0 (en) | 2018-01-10 | 2018-02-21 | Mitraltech Ltd | Temperature-control during crimping of an implant |
CN111902103A (en) * | 2018-02-08 | 2020-11-06 | 因威尔乌治疗公司 | Method, apparatus and device for treating heart valves |
US10779946B2 (en) | 2018-09-17 | 2020-09-22 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Leaflet-testing apparatus |
JP7483757B2 (en) | 2019-05-20 | 2024-05-15 | エドワーズ ライフサイエンシーズ コーポレイション | HEART VALVE SEALING DEVICE, DELIVERY DEVICE AND RETRIEVAL DEVICE THEREFOR - Patent application |
US11534303B2 (en) | 2020-04-09 | 2022-12-27 | Evalve, Inc. | Devices and systems for accessing and repairing a heart valve |
CN114302698A (en) | 2019-07-15 | 2022-04-08 | 埃瓦尔维公司 | Proximal element actuator securing and releasing mechanism |
JP7566004B2 (en) | 2019-07-15 | 2024-10-11 | エバルブ,インコーポレイティド | Wide clip with non-deforming wings |
WO2021011653A1 (en) | 2019-07-15 | 2021-01-21 | Evalve, Inc. | Independent proximal element actuation methods |
US11707228B2 (en) | 2019-09-26 | 2023-07-25 | Evalve, Inc. | Systems and methods for intra-procedural cardiac pressure monitoring |
US11464636B2 (en) | 2019-10-11 | 2022-10-11 | Evalve, Inc. | Repair clip for variable tissue thickness |
WO2021092107A1 (en) | 2019-11-06 | 2021-05-14 | Evalve, Inc. | Stabilizer for a medical delivery system |
WO2021092460A1 (en) | 2019-11-08 | 2021-05-14 | Evalve, Inc. | Medical device delivery system with locking system |
WO2021097124A1 (en) | 2019-11-14 | 2021-05-20 | Evalve, Inc. | Catheter assembly with coaptation aid and methods for valve repair |
WO2021097089A1 (en) | 2019-11-14 | 2021-05-20 | Evalve, Inc. | Kit with coaptation aid and fixation system and methods for valve repair |
EP4076285A1 (en) | 2019-12-18 | 2022-10-26 | Evalve, Inc. | Wide clip with deformable width |
CN111281606A (en) * | 2020-03-31 | 2020-06-16 | 上海纽脉医疗科技有限公司 | Tissue clamping device |
CN111265340A (en) * | 2020-03-31 | 2020-06-12 | 上海纽脉医疗科技有限公司 | Tissue clamping device and clamp main body thereof |
WO2021202130A1 (en) | 2020-03-31 | 2021-10-07 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | High flexibility implant catheter with low compression |
CN111281607A (en) * | 2020-03-31 | 2020-06-16 | 上海纽脉医疗科技有限公司 | Barb clamping piece and tissue clamping device |
JP2023538879A (en) | 2020-08-14 | 2023-09-12 | エドワーズ ライフサイエンシーズ コーポレイション | Valve repair implant with leaflet tension indication |
CA204308S (en) * | 2020-12-21 | 2023-08-21 | Hoffmann La Roche | Display screen with graphical user interface |
CA3175545A1 (en) | 2020-12-23 | 2022-06-30 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices and delivery devices therefor |
CA3208330A1 (en) | 2021-01-15 | 2022-07-21 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
KR20240004597A (en) | 2021-04-28 | 2024-01-11 | 에드워즈 라이프사이언시스 코포레이션 | Delivery device for heart valve therapy device |
WO2023278663A2 (en) | 2021-07-01 | 2023-01-05 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices and delivery devices therefor |
JP2024529371A (en) | 2021-07-20 | 2024-08-06 | エドワーズ ライフサイエンシーズ コーポレイション | Sensing heart valve repair device |
IL309677A (en) | 2021-07-23 | 2024-02-01 | Edwards Lifesciences Corp | Heart valve repair devices |
CN113413245B (en) * | 2021-07-30 | 2024-01-16 | 上海纽脉医疗科技股份有限公司 | Tissue clamping device and tissue repair equipment |
CN113907918B (en) * | 2021-09-30 | 2023-02-28 | 杭州端佑医疗科技有限公司 | Valve clamping system |
EP4429596A1 (en) * | 2021-11-12 | 2024-09-18 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
EP4432981A1 (en) | 2021-11-19 | 2024-09-25 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices |
WO2023107296A1 (en) * | 2021-12-09 | 2023-06-15 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
MX2024008045A (en) | 2022-01-26 | 2024-08-06 | Edwards Lifesciences Corp | Delivery devices for heart valve repair and replacement devices. |
WO2023158593A1 (en) | 2022-02-15 | 2023-08-24 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices and delivery devices therefor |
WO2023158592A1 (en) | 2022-02-15 | 2023-08-24 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices |
WO2023167825A1 (en) | 2022-03-02 | 2023-09-07 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices and delivery devices therefor |
AU2023238718A1 (en) | 2022-03-21 | 2024-09-05 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices and delivery devices therefor |
WO2023196183A1 (en) | 2022-04-04 | 2023-10-12 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices and delivery devices therefor |
WO2023200706A1 (en) | 2022-04-15 | 2023-10-19 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Methods and apparatus for removal of valve repair devices |
WO2023249858A1 (en) | 2022-06-22 | 2023-12-28 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices and delivery devices therefor |
WO2024020182A1 (en) | 2022-07-22 | 2024-01-25 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Bioimpedance-based feedback for medical procedures |
WO2024049852A1 (en) | 2022-09-02 | 2024-03-07 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices and delivery devices therefor |
WO2024091681A1 (en) | 2022-10-28 | 2024-05-02 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices and methods |
WO2024091585A1 (en) | 2022-10-28 | 2024-05-02 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Extendable leaflet-grasping device |
US11654024B1 (en) | 2022-10-31 | 2023-05-23 | Capstan Medical Inc. | Heart valve clip |
CN118267160A (en) * | 2022-12-29 | 2024-07-02 | 杭州德晋医疗科技有限公司 | Tissue clamping device and tissue clamping system |
WO2024151584A2 (en) | 2023-01-11 | 2024-07-18 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Methods and systems for repairing a native valve |
Citations (3)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20060020275A1 (en) * | 1999-04-09 | 2006-01-26 | Evalve, Inc. | Locking mechanisms for fixation devices and methods of engaging tissue |
US20100022823A1 (en) * | 2005-09-27 | 2010-01-28 | Evalve, Inc. | Methods and devices for tissue grasping and assessment |
US10993809B2 (en) * | 2018-10-10 | 2021-05-04 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
Family Cites Families (470)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US3029518A (en) | 1957-01-25 | 1962-04-17 | Electronique & Automatisme Sa | Relative motion electrical measuring apparatus |
DE2232914A1 (en) | 1971-07-12 | 1973-02-08 | Jeanette Lois Rubricius | SURGICAL CLAMP |
US3874388A (en) | 1973-02-12 | 1975-04-01 | Ochsner Med Found Alton | Shunt defect closure system |
US3874368A (en) | 1973-04-19 | 1975-04-01 | Manfred Asrican | Impedance plethysmograph having blocking system |
US4340091A (en) | 1975-05-07 | 1982-07-20 | Albany International Corp. | Elastomeric sheet materials for heart valve and other prosthetic implants |
JPS5936A (en) | 1982-06-24 | 1984-01-05 | オリンパス光学工業株式会社 | Flexible tube of endoscope |
US4506669A (en) | 1982-09-22 | 1985-03-26 | Blake Joseph W Iii | Skin approximator |
US4693248A (en) | 1983-06-20 | 1987-09-15 | Ethicon, Inc. | Two-piece tissue fastener with deformable retaining receiver |
US4590937A (en) | 1985-01-07 | 1986-05-27 | American Cyanamid Company | Nonmetallic surgical clip |
US5125895A (en) | 1986-07-22 | 1992-06-30 | Medtronic Versaflex, Inc. | Steerable catheter |
US4803983A (en) | 1987-03-23 | 1989-02-14 | Siegel Irwin M | Muscle biopsy clamp |
US5478353A (en) | 1987-05-14 | 1995-12-26 | Yoon; Inbae | Suture tie device system and method for suturing anatomical tissue proximate an opening |
CA1330285C (en) | 1987-12-22 | 1994-06-21 | Geoffrey S. Martin | Triple lumen catheter |
US5411552A (en) | 1990-05-18 | 1995-05-02 | Andersen; Henning R. | Valve prothesis for implantation in the body and a catheter for implanting such valve prothesis |
US5370665A (en) | 1990-08-10 | 1994-12-06 | Medtronic, Inc. | Medical stimulator with multiple operational amplifier output stimulation circuits |
CA2049123C (en) | 1990-09-13 | 2002-01-15 | David T. Green | Apparatus and method for subcuticular stapling of body tissue |
US5611794A (en) | 1990-10-11 | 1997-03-18 | Lasersurge, Inc. | Clamp for approximating tissue sections |
US5171252A (en) | 1991-02-05 | 1992-12-15 | Friedland Thomas W | Surgical fastening clip formed of a shape memory alloy, a method of making such a clip and a method of using such a clip |
US5370685A (en) | 1991-07-16 | 1994-12-06 | Stanford Surgical Technologies, Inc. | Endovascular aortic valve replacement |
US5363861A (en) | 1991-11-08 | 1994-11-15 | Ep Technologies, Inc. | Electrode tip assembly with variable resistance to bending |
US5327905A (en) | 1992-02-14 | 1994-07-12 | Boaz Avitall | Biplanar deflectable catheter for arrhythmogenic tissue ablation |
WO1994018893A1 (en) | 1993-02-22 | 1994-09-01 | Valleylab, Inc. | A laparoscopic dissection tension retractor device and method |
US6010531A (en) | 1993-02-22 | 2000-01-04 | Heartport, Inc. | Less-invasive devices and methods for cardiac valve surgery |
US5797960A (en) | 1993-02-22 | 1998-08-25 | Stevens; John H. | Method and apparatus for thoracoscopic intracardiac procedures |
US5389077A (en) | 1993-03-03 | 1995-02-14 | Uresil Corporation | Minimally invasive body cavity penetrating instruments |
NL9300572A (en) | 1993-03-31 | 1994-10-17 | Cordis Europ | Method for manufacturing an extrusion profile with length-varying properties and catheter manufactured therewith. |
US5456400A (en) | 1993-04-22 | 1995-10-10 | United States Surgical Corporation | Apparatus and clip for fastening body tissue |
US5450860A (en) | 1993-08-31 | 1995-09-19 | W. L. Gore & Associates, Inc. | Device for tissue repair and method for employing same |
US5607462A (en) | 1993-09-24 | 1997-03-04 | Cardiac Pathways Corporation | Catheter assembly, catheter and multi-catheter introducer for use therewith |
US5487746A (en) | 1994-11-23 | 1996-01-30 | Yu; George W. | Surgical clip having a longitudinal opening through which clamped tissue protrudes |
US5609598A (en) | 1994-12-30 | 1997-03-11 | Vnus Medical Technologies, Inc. | Method and apparatus for minimally invasive treatment of chronic venous insufficiency |
US5695504A (en) | 1995-02-24 | 1997-12-09 | Heartport, Inc. | Devices and methods for performing a vascular anastomosis |
US5626607A (en) | 1995-04-03 | 1997-05-06 | Heartport, Inc. | Clamp assembly and method of use |
US5888247A (en) | 1995-04-10 | 1999-03-30 | Cardiothoracic Systems, Inc | Method for coronary artery bypass |
US5891112A (en) | 1995-04-28 | 1999-04-06 | Target Therapeutics, Inc. | High performance superelastic alloy braid reinforced catheter |
US5565004A (en) | 1995-05-30 | 1996-10-15 | Christoudias; George C. | Christoudias twin forceps approximator |
US5716417A (en) | 1995-06-07 | 1998-02-10 | St. Jude Medical, Inc. | Integral supporting structure for bioprosthetic heart valve |
WO1996041654A1 (en) | 1995-06-12 | 1996-12-27 | Cordis Webster, Inc. | Catheter with an electromagnetic guidance sensor |
US5836311A (en) | 1995-09-20 | 1998-11-17 | Medtronic, Inc. | Method and apparatus for temporarily immobilizing a local area of tissue |
CN1142351A (en) | 1996-01-09 | 1997-02-12 | 郑宏 | Closing device for atrial septal defect |
US5782746A (en) | 1996-02-15 | 1998-07-21 | Wright; John T. M. | Local cardiac immobilization surgical device |
US6182664B1 (en) | 1996-02-19 | 2001-02-06 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Minimally invasive cardiac valve surgery procedure |
US5727569A (en) | 1996-02-20 | 1998-03-17 | Cardiothoracic Systems, Inc. | Surgical devices for imposing a negative pressure to fix the position of cardiac tissue during surgery |
US5894843A (en) | 1996-02-20 | 1999-04-20 | Cardiothoracic Systems, Inc. | Surgical method for stabilizing the beating heart during coronary artery bypass graft surgery |
US6132370A (en) | 1996-04-26 | 2000-10-17 | Genzyme Corporation | Retractor-mounted coronary stabilizer |
DE19627992A1 (en) | 1996-07-11 | 1998-01-22 | Storz Karl Gmbh & Co | Instrument with two independent jaws |
US5741297A (en) | 1996-08-28 | 1998-04-21 | Simon; Morris | Daisy occluder and method for septal defect repair |
US5921979A (en) | 1996-12-18 | 1999-07-13 | Guidant Corporation | Apparatus and method for tissue and organ stabilization |
US5891017A (en) | 1997-01-31 | 1999-04-06 | Baxter Research Medical, Inc. | Surgical stabilizer and method for isolating and immobilizing cardiac tissue |
US5938616A (en) | 1997-01-31 | 1999-08-17 | Acuson Corporation | Steering mechanism and steering line for a catheter-mounted ultrasonic transducer |
US5972020A (en) | 1997-02-14 | 1999-10-26 | Cardiothoracic Systems, Inc. | Surgical instrument for cardiac valve repair on the beating heart |
US6508825B1 (en) | 1997-02-28 | 2003-01-21 | Lumend, Inc. | Apparatus for treating vascular occlusions |
US5885271A (en) | 1997-03-14 | 1999-03-23 | Millennium Cardiac Strategies, Inc. | Device for regional immobilization of a compliant body |
US6017358A (en) | 1997-05-01 | 2000-01-25 | Inbae Yoon | Surgical instrument with multiple rotatably mounted offset end effectors |
US5957835A (en) | 1997-05-16 | 1999-09-28 | Guidant Corporation | Apparatus and method for cardiac stabilization and arterial occlusion |
US6004329A (en) | 1997-05-29 | 1999-12-21 | Baxter International Inc. | Shape-adjustable surgical implement handle |
EP0930845B1 (en) | 1997-06-27 | 2009-10-14 | The Trustees Of Columbia University In The City Of New York | Apparatus for circulatory valve repair |
FR2768324B1 (en) | 1997-09-12 | 1999-12-10 | Jacques Seguin | SURGICAL INSTRUMENT FOR PERCUTANEOUSLY FIXING TWO AREAS OF SOFT TISSUE, NORMALLY MUTUALLY REMOTE, TO ONE ANOTHER |
US6120496A (en) | 1998-05-05 | 2000-09-19 | Scimed Life Systems, Inc. | Surgical method and apparatus for positioning a diagnostic or therapeutic element within the body and coupling device for use with same |
US6086600A (en) | 1997-11-03 | 2000-07-11 | Symbiosis Corporation | Flexible endoscopic surgical instrument for invagination and fundoplication |
US6200315B1 (en) | 1997-12-18 | 2001-03-13 | Medtronic, Inc. | Left atrium ablation catheter |
US6193734B1 (en) | 1998-01-23 | 2001-02-27 | Heartport, Inc. | System for performing vascular anastomoses |
US5944738A (en) | 1998-02-06 | 1999-08-31 | Aga Medical Corporation | Percutaneous catheter directed constricting occlusion device |
US6949106B2 (en) | 1998-02-24 | 2005-09-27 | Endovia Medical, Inc. | Surgical instrument |
US6165183A (en) | 1998-07-15 | 2000-12-26 | St. Jude Medical, Inc. | Mitral and tricuspid valve repair |
US7569062B1 (en) | 1998-07-15 | 2009-08-04 | St. Jude Medical, Inc. | Mitral and tricuspid valve repair |
US6468285B1 (en) | 1998-09-03 | 2002-10-22 | The Cleveland Clinic Foundation | Surgical instruments and procedures |
US6544215B1 (en) | 1998-10-02 | 2003-04-08 | Scimed Life Systems, Inc. | Steerable device for introducing diagnostic and therapeutic apparatus into the body |
US5980534A (en) | 1998-10-07 | 1999-11-09 | Gimpelson; Richard J. | Cervical clamp |
AU5924099A (en) | 1998-12-31 | 2000-07-24 | Jeffrey E. Yeung | Tissue fastening devices and delivery means |
US6193732B1 (en) | 1999-01-08 | 2001-02-27 | Cardiothoracic System | Surgical clips and apparatus and method for clip placement |
US10327743B2 (en) | 1999-04-09 | 2019-06-25 | Evalve, Inc. | Device and methods for endoscopic annuloplasty |
US7226467B2 (en) | 1999-04-09 | 2007-06-05 | Evalve, Inc. | Fixation device delivery catheter, systems and methods of use |
DE60045096D1 (en) | 1999-04-09 | 2010-11-25 | Evalve Inc | METHOD AND DEVICE FOR HEART LAPSE REPERATION |
US20040044350A1 (en) | 1999-04-09 | 2004-03-04 | Evalve, Inc. | Steerable access sheath and methods of use |
US8216256B2 (en) | 1999-04-09 | 2012-07-10 | Evalve, Inc. | Detachment mechanism for implantable fixation devices |
WO2006116558A2 (en) | 1999-04-09 | 2006-11-02 | Evalve, Inc. | Device and methods for endoscopic annuloplasty |
US6752813B2 (en) | 1999-04-09 | 2004-06-22 | Evalve, Inc. | Methods and devices for capturing and fixing leaflets in valve repair |
US7811296B2 (en) | 1999-04-09 | 2010-10-12 | Evalve, Inc. | Fixation devices for variation in engagement of tissue |
WO2000067641A1 (en) | 1999-05-11 | 2000-11-16 | Williamson Warren P Iv | Surgical clamp devices and methods especially useful in cardiac surgery |
US6241743B1 (en) | 1999-05-13 | 2001-06-05 | Intellicardia, Inc. | Anastomosis device and method |
US6312447B1 (en) | 1999-10-13 | 2001-11-06 | The General Hospital Corporation | Devices and methods for percutaneous mitral valve repair |
US6626930B1 (en) | 1999-10-21 | 2003-09-30 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Minimally invasive mitral valve repair method and apparatus |
US7083628B2 (en) | 2002-09-03 | 2006-08-01 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Single catheter mitral valve repair device and method for use |
KR100818903B1 (en) | 2000-07-14 | 2008-04-04 | 쿡 인코포레이티드 | Medical device with braid and coil |
SE0002878D0 (en) | 2000-08-11 | 2000-08-11 | Kimblad Ola | Device and method of treatment of atrioventricular regurgitation |
US7510572B2 (en) | 2000-09-12 | 2009-03-31 | Shlomo Gabbay | Implantation system for delivery of a heart valve prosthesis |
US7381220B2 (en) | 2000-09-20 | 2008-06-03 | Ample Medical, Inc. | Devices, systems, and methods for supplementing, repairing, or replacing a native heart valve leaflet |
US20060106456A9 (en) | 2002-10-01 | 2006-05-18 | Ample Medical, Inc. | Devices, systems, and methods for reshaping a heart valve annulus |
US7527646B2 (en) | 2000-09-20 | 2009-05-05 | Ample Medical, Inc. | Devices, systems, and methods for retaining a native heart valve leaflet |
US6269829B1 (en) | 2000-09-29 | 2001-08-07 | Industrial Technology Research Institute | Integrated gas meter |
US6723038B1 (en) | 2000-10-06 | 2004-04-20 | Myocor, Inc. | Methods and devices for improving mitral valve function |
US6508806B1 (en) | 2000-12-13 | 2003-01-21 | Advanced Cardiovascular Systems, Inc. | Catheter with multi-layer wire reinforced wall construction |
US20020107531A1 (en) | 2001-02-06 | 2002-08-08 | Schreck Stefan G. | Method and system for tissue repair using dual catheters |
US6537290B2 (en) | 2001-03-05 | 2003-03-25 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Sealing access cannula system |
US6837867B2 (en) | 2001-04-30 | 2005-01-04 | Biosense Webster, Inc. | Steerable catheter with reinforced tip |
US20020173811A1 (en) | 2001-05-21 | 2002-11-21 | Hosheng Tu | Apparatus and methods for valve removal |
US7338514B2 (en) | 2001-06-01 | 2008-03-04 | St. Jude Medical, Cardiology Division, Inc. | Closure devices, related delivery methods and tools, and related methods of use |
FR2828263B1 (en) | 2001-08-03 | 2007-05-11 | Philipp Bonhoeffer | DEVICE FOR IMPLANTATION OF AN IMPLANT AND METHOD FOR IMPLANTATION OF THE DEVICE |
EP1432369B1 (en) | 2001-08-31 | 2008-02-27 | Mitral Interventions | Apparatus for valve repair |
US20030050693A1 (en) | 2001-09-10 | 2003-03-13 | Quijano Rodolfo C. | Minimally invasive delivery system for annuloplasty rings |
US6575971B2 (en) | 2001-11-15 | 2003-06-10 | Quantum Cor, Inc. | Cardiac valve leaflet stapler device and methods thereof |
US20070198038A1 (en) | 2001-12-03 | 2007-08-23 | Cohen Adam L | Microdevices for Tissue Approximation and Retention, Methods for Using, and Methods for Making |
JP4116567B2 (en) | 2001-12-13 | 2008-07-09 | 住友ベークライト株式会社 | Endoscope clip device and endoscope clip used therefor |
US20030144573A1 (en) | 2001-12-19 | 2003-07-31 | Heilman Marlin S. | Back-flow limiting valve member |
US6764510B2 (en) | 2002-01-09 | 2004-07-20 | Myocor, Inc. | Devices and methods for heart valve treatment |
US7048754B2 (en) | 2002-03-01 | 2006-05-23 | Evalve, Inc. | Suture fasteners and methods of use |
US6855137B2 (en) | 2002-03-07 | 2005-02-15 | Visionary Biomedical, Inc. | Catheter shaft with coextruded stiffener |
US20070185376A1 (en) | 2002-03-11 | 2007-08-09 | Wilson Roger F | System and method for positioning a laparoscopic device |
US7094244B2 (en) | 2002-03-26 | 2006-08-22 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Sequential heart valve leaflet repair device and method of use |
AU2003247526A1 (en) | 2002-06-12 | 2003-12-31 | Mitral Interventions, Inc. | Method and apparatus for tissue connection |
US8348963B2 (en) | 2002-07-03 | 2013-01-08 | Hlt, Inc. | Leaflet reinforcement for regurgitant valves |
US8172856B2 (en) | 2002-08-02 | 2012-05-08 | Cedars-Sinai Medical Center | Methods and apparatus for atrioventricular valve repair |
CA2496007C (en) | 2002-08-13 | 2013-02-05 | The General Hospital Corporation | Cardiac devices and uses thereof for percutaneous repair of atrioventricular valves |
US20040034365A1 (en) | 2002-08-16 | 2004-02-19 | Lentz David J. | Catheter having articulation system |
US7727247B2 (en) | 2002-08-21 | 2010-06-01 | Olympus Corporation | Living tissue ligation device |
WO2004023976A2 (en) | 2002-09-13 | 2004-03-25 | Damage Control Surgical Technologies, Inc. | Method and apparatus for vascular and visceral clipping |
US8454628B2 (en) | 2002-09-20 | 2013-06-04 | Syntheon, Llc | Surgical fastener aligning instrument particularly for transoral treatment of gastroesophageal reflux disease |
US20040097979A1 (en) | 2002-11-14 | 2004-05-20 | Oleg Svanidze | Aortic valve implantation device |
AU2003290979A1 (en) | 2002-11-15 | 2004-06-15 | The Government Of The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of Health And Human Services | Method and device for catheter-based repair of cardiac valves |
WO2004058079A2 (en) | 2002-12-17 | 2004-07-15 | Applied Medical Resources Corporation | Surgical staple-clip and applier |
US6945956B2 (en) | 2002-12-23 | 2005-09-20 | Medtronic, Inc. | Steerable catheter |
US20070156197A1 (en) | 2005-12-15 | 2007-07-05 | Cardiac Pacemakers, Inc. | Method and apparatus for improved medical device profile |
JP4145149B2 (en) | 2003-01-17 | 2008-09-03 | オリンパス株式会社 | Biological tissue clip device |
US7250041B2 (en) | 2003-03-12 | 2007-07-31 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems Inc. | Retrograde pressure regulated infusion |
US6987995B2 (en) | 2003-03-12 | 2006-01-17 | Biosense Webster, Inc. | Multifunctional catheter handle |
US7381210B2 (en) | 2003-03-14 | 2008-06-03 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Mitral valve repair system and method for use |
US7175656B2 (en) | 2003-04-18 | 2007-02-13 | Alexander Khairkhahan | Percutaneous transcatheter heart valve replacement |
US20040220593A1 (en) | 2003-05-01 | 2004-11-04 | Secant Medical, Llc | Restraining clip for mitral valve repair |
US6913614B2 (en) | 2003-05-08 | 2005-07-05 | Cardia, Inc. | Delivery system with safety tether |
US10667823B2 (en) | 2003-05-19 | 2020-06-02 | Evalve, Inc. | Fixation devices, systems and methods for engaging tissue |
US7972347B2 (en) | 2003-06-27 | 2011-07-05 | Surgical Security, Llc | Device for surgical repair, closure, and reconstruction |
ATE442107T1 (en) | 2003-07-21 | 2009-09-15 | Univ Pennsylvania | PERCUTANE HEART VALVE |
US7452363B2 (en) | 2003-09-30 | 2008-11-18 | Ethicon Endo-Surgery, Inc. | Applier for fastener for single lumen access anastomosis |
US7824443B2 (en) | 2003-12-23 | 2010-11-02 | Sadra Medical, Inc. | Medical implant delivery and deployment tool |
US7381219B2 (en) | 2003-12-23 | 2008-06-03 | Sadra Medical, Inc. | Low profile heart valve and delivery system |
US20050137686A1 (en) | 2003-12-23 | 2005-06-23 | Sadra Medical, A Delaware Corporation | Externally expandable heart valve anchor and method |
US8328868B2 (en) | 2004-11-05 | 2012-12-11 | Sadra Medical, Inc. | Medical devices and delivery systems for delivering medical devices |
US7780725B2 (en) | 2004-06-16 | 2010-08-24 | Sadra Medical, Inc. | Everting heart valve |
US7748389B2 (en) | 2003-12-23 | 2010-07-06 | Sadra Medical, Inc. | Leaflet engagement elements and methods for use thereof |
US7959666B2 (en) | 2003-12-23 | 2011-06-14 | Sadra Medical, Inc. | Methods and apparatus for endovascularly replacing a heart valve |
US8840663B2 (en) | 2003-12-23 | 2014-09-23 | Sadra Medical, Inc. | Repositionable heart valve method |
US20050165429A1 (en) | 2004-01-23 | 2005-07-28 | Peter Douglas | Surgical clamp possessing a combined parallel and scissor style clamp head |
US8337545B2 (en) | 2004-02-09 | 2012-12-25 | Cook Medical Technologies Llc | Woven implantable device |
US7753932B2 (en) | 2004-03-25 | 2010-07-13 | Boston Scientific Scimed, Inc. | Medical device and related methods of packaging |
NL1025830C2 (en) | 2004-03-26 | 2005-02-22 | Eric Berreklouw | Prosthesis e.g. heart valve secured in place by ring with shape memory material anchor, includes anchor temperature control system |
US20050240219A1 (en) | 2004-04-22 | 2005-10-27 | Henry Kahle | Peripheral vascular occlusion devices |
US7704268B2 (en) | 2004-05-07 | 2010-04-27 | Nmt Medical, Inc. | Closure device with hinges |
US7645285B2 (en) | 2004-05-26 | 2010-01-12 | Idx Medical, Ltd | Apparatus and methods for occluding a hollow anatomical structure |
US9061120B2 (en) | 2004-08-05 | 2015-06-23 | Oscor Inc. | Catheter control mechanism and steerable catheter |
CA2580053C (en) | 2004-09-14 | 2014-07-08 | Edwards Lifesciences Ag. | Device and method for treatment of heart valve regurgitation |
US8764848B2 (en) | 2004-09-24 | 2014-07-01 | W.L. Gore & Associates, Inc. | Occluder device double securement system for delivery/recovery of such occluder device |
JP5124274B2 (en) | 2004-09-27 | 2013-01-23 | エヴァルヴ インコーポレイテッド | Method and apparatus for grasping and evaluating tissue |
WO2006064490A1 (en) | 2004-12-15 | 2006-06-22 | Mednua Limited | A medical device suitable for use in treatment of a valve |
JP4758173B2 (en) | 2004-12-24 | 2011-08-24 | オリンパス株式会社 | Ligation device |
US7691095B2 (en) | 2004-12-28 | 2010-04-06 | St. Jude Medical, Atrial Fibrillation Division, Inc. | Bi-directional steerable catheter control handle |
EP1855623B1 (en) | 2005-02-07 | 2019-04-17 | Evalve, Inc. | Devices for cardiac valve repair |
US8470028B2 (en) | 2005-02-07 | 2013-06-25 | Evalve, Inc. | Methods, systems and devices for cardiac valve repair |
US20100298929A1 (en) | 2005-02-07 | 2010-11-25 | Thornton Troy L | Methods, systems and devices for cardiac valve repair |
US7585308B2 (en) | 2005-03-30 | 2009-09-08 | Ethicon Endo-Surgery, Inc. | Handle system and method for use in anastomotic procedures |
WO2006127509A2 (en) | 2005-05-20 | 2006-11-30 | Mayo Foundation For Medical Education And Research | Devices and methods for reducing cardiac valve regurgitation |
US7780723B2 (en) | 2005-06-13 | 2010-08-24 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve delivery system |
US7618413B2 (en) | 2005-06-22 | 2009-11-17 | Boston Scientific Scimed, Inc. | Medical device control system |
EP1910343B1 (en) | 2005-07-29 | 2014-10-29 | Krka | Process for the preparation of olmesartan medoxomil |
US8147506B2 (en) | 2005-08-05 | 2012-04-03 | Ethicon Endo-Surgery, Inc. | Method and clamp for gastric reduction surgery |
US7972359B2 (en) * | 2005-09-16 | 2011-07-05 | Atritech, Inc. | Intracardiac cage and method of delivering same |
ATE453728T1 (en) | 2005-09-29 | 2010-01-15 | Keygene Nv | HIGH-THROUGHPUT SCREENING OF MUTAGENIZED POPULATIONS |
US8167932B2 (en) | 2005-10-18 | 2012-05-01 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve delivery system with valve catheter |
US8778017B2 (en) | 2005-10-26 | 2014-07-15 | Cardiosolutions, Inc. | Safety for mitral valve implant |
US8449606B2 (en) | 2005-10-26 | 2013-05-28 | Cardiosolutions, Inc. | Balloon mitral spacer |
US9259317B2 (en) | 2008-06-13 | 2016-02-16 | Cardiosolutions, Inc. | System and method for implanting a heart implant |
US8092525B2 (en) | 2005-10-26 | 2012-01-10 | Cardiosolutions, Inc. | Heart valve implant |
EP1945110A2 (en) | 2005-10-26 | 2008-07-23 | The Brigham and Women's Hospital, Inc. | Devices and methods for treating mitral valve regurgitation |
US9681948B2 (en) | 2006-01-23 | 2017-06-20 | V-Wave Ltd. | Heart anchor device |
US20070191154A1 (en) | 2006-02-10 | 2007-08-16 | Genereux Dana A | Racquet sport apparatus & method |
EP1988851A2 (en) | 2006-02-14 | 2008-11-12 | Sadra Medical, Inc. | Systems and methods for delivering a medical implant |
EP1991168B1 (en) | 2006-02-16 | 2016-01-27 | Transcatheter Technologies GmbH | Minimally invasive heart valve replacement |
US20140066736A1 (en) | 2006-03-31 | 2014-03-06 | Abbott Diabetes Care Inc. | Analyte Sensor Calibration Management |
US8518024B2 (en) | 2006-04-24 | 2013-08-27 | Transenterix, Inc. | System and method for multi-instrument surgical access using a single access port |
US20080234660A2 (en) | 2006-05-16 | 2008-09-25 | Sarah Cumming | Steerable Catheter Using Flat Pull Wires and Method of Making Same |
US20080091169A1 (en) | 2006-05-16 | 2008-04-17 | Wayne Heideman | Steerable catheter using flat pull wires and having torque transfer layer made of braided flat wires |
US8052731B2 (en) | 2006-06-02 | 2011-11-08 | Cardiac Pacemakers, Inc. | Medical electrical lead with expandable fixation features |
IE20070428A1 (en) | 2006-06-15 | 2007-12-21 | Mednua Ltd | A medical device suitable for use in treatment of a valve |
US8529597B2 (en) | 2006-08-09 | 2013-09-10 | Coherex Medical, Inc. | Devices for reducing the size of an internal tissue opening |
US8167894B2 (en) | 2006-08-09 | 2012-05-01 | Coherex Medical, Inc. | Methods, systems and devices for reducing the size of an internal tissue opening |
US9138208B2 (en) | 2006-08-09 | 2015-09-22 | Coherex Medical, Inc. | Devices for reducing the size of an internal tissue opening |
US8894682B2 (en) | 2006-09-11 | 2014-11-25 | Boston Scientific Scimed, Inc. | PFO clip |
US7713284B2 (en) | 2006-09-13 | 2010-05-11 | Crofford Theodore W | Self-opening skin staple |
US8834564B2 (en) | 2006-09-19 | 2014-09-16 | Medtronic, Inc. | Sinus-engaging valve fixation member |
US8052750B2 (en) | 2006-09-19 | 2011-11-08 | Medtronic Ventor Technologies Ltd | Valve prosthesis fixation techniques using sandwiching |
US7749235B2 (en) | 2006-10-20 | 2010-07-06 | Ethicon Endo-Surgery, Inc. | Stomach invagination method and apparatus |
JP2010508093A (en) | 2006-11-07 | 2010-03-18 | セラマジャー,デイヴィッド,スティーヴン | Apparatus and method for treating heart failure |
US20110257723A1 (en) | 2006-11-07 | 2011-10-20 | Dc Devices, Inc. | Devices and methods for coronary sinus pressure relief |
US8585716B2 (en) | 2006-12-13 | 2013-11-19 | Boston Scientific Scimed, Inc. | Apparatus for applying hemostatic clips |
US20080177389A1 (en) | 2006-12-21 | 2008-07-24 | Rob Gene Parrish | Intervertebral disc spacer |
US7731706B2 (en) | 2006-12-29 | 2010-06-08 | St. Jude Medical, Atrial Fibrillation Division, Inc. | True angular catheter shaft deflection apparatus |
US9192471B2 (en) | 2007-01-08 | 2015-11-24 | Millipede, Inc. | Device for translumenal reshaping of a mitral valve annulus |
US7552853B2 (en) | 2007-01-24 | 2009-06-30 | Medtronic Vascular, Inc. | Low-profile vascular closure systems and methods of using same |
WO2008090978A1 (en) | 2007-01-26 | 2008-07-31 | Olympus Medical Systems Corp. | Holding device and holding tool |
US7753949B2 (en) | 2007-02-23 | 2010-07-13 | The Trustees Of The University Of Pennsylvania | Valve prosthesis systems and methods |
US8070802B2 (en) | 2007-02-23 | 2011-12-06 | The Trustees Of The University Of Pennsylvania | Mitral valve system |
US8979872B2 (en) | 2007-03-13 | 2015-03-17 | Longevity Surgical, Inc. | Devices for engaging, approximating and fastening tissue |
US8480730B2 (en) | 2007-05-14 | 2013-07-09 | Cardiosolutions, Inc. | Solid construct mitral spacer |
US9533122B2 (en) | 2007-05-18 | 2017-01-03 | Boston Scientific Scimed, Inc. | Catheter drive system with control handle rotatable about two axes separated from housing by shaft |
EP2148623A1 (en) | 2007-05-21 | 2010-02-03 | Epitek, Inc. | Left atrial appendage closure |
US20080294247A1 (en) | 2007-05-25 | 2008-11-27 | Medical Entrepreneurs Ii, Inc. | Prosthetic Heart Valve |
AU2008260444B2 (en) | 2007-06-04 | 2014-09-11 | St. Jude Medical, Inc. | Prosthetic heart valves |
US7771416B2 (en) | 2007-06-14 | 2010-08-10 | Ethicon Endo-Surgery, Inc. | Control mechanism for flexible endoscopic device and method of use |
US7914515B2 (en) | 2007-07-18 | 2011-03-29 | St. Jude Medical, Atrial Fibrillation Division, Inc. | Catheter and introducer catheter having torque transfer layer and method of manufacture |
JP5329542B2 (en) | 2007-08-23 | 2013-10-30 | ダイレクト フロウ メディカル、 インク. | Transluminally implantable heart valve with in-place forming support |
EP2205784A4 (en) | 2007-11-05 | 2010-12-01 | Ibco Srl | Antislip sheet material having tapes and monofilaments |
US8431057B2 (en) | 2007-12-30 | 2013-04-30 | St. Jude Medical, Atrial Fibrillation Division, Inc. | Catheter shaft and method of its manufacture |
US8968393B2 (en) | 2008-02-28 | 2015-03-03 | Medtronic, Inc. | System and method for percutaneous mitral valve repair |
CN101959478B (en) | 2008-02-29 | 2013-12-18 | 爱德华兹生命科学公司 | Expandable member for deploying prosthetic device |
US8048024B2 (en) | 2008-03-17 | 2011-11-01 | Boston Scientific Scimed, Inc. | Steering mechanism |
US8313525B2 (en) | 2008-03-18 | 2012-11-20 | Medtronic Ventor Technologies, Ltd. | Valve suturing and implantation procedures |
US8262725B2 (en) | 2008-04-16 | 2012-09-11 | Cardiovascular Technologies, Llc | Transvalvular intraannular band for valve repair |
US8128642B2 (en) | 2008-05-02 | 2012-03-06 | Tyco Healthcare Group Lp | Fluid delivery system for surgical instruments |
EP2288402A4 (en) | 2008-05-07 | 2011-10-05 | Guided Delivery Systems Inc | Deflectable guide |
US20090287304A1 (en) | 2008-05-13 | 2009-11-19 | Kardium Inc. | Medical Device for Constricting Tissue or a Bodily Orifice, for example a mitral valve |
US8652202B2 (en) | 2008-08-22 | 2014-02-18 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Prosthetic heart valve and delivery apparatus |
US8137308B2 (en) | 2008-09-16 | 2012-03-20 | Biosense Webster, Inc. | Catheter with adjustable deflection sensitivity |
US9119715B2 (en) | 2008-10-30 | 2015-09-01 | St. Jude Medical, Inc. | Collapsible/expandable prosthetic heart valve delivery system and methods |
JP2010125200A (en) | 2008-11-28 | 2010-06-10 | Mizutec:Kk | Medical grasping device |
US8147542B2 (en) | 2008-12-22 | 2012-04-03 | Valtech Cardio, Ltd. | Adjustable repair chords and spool mechanism therefor |
US8366767B2 (en) | 2009-03-30 | 2013-02-05 | Causper Medical Inc. | Methods and devices for transapical delivery of a sutureless valve prosthesis |
US20100249497A1 (en) | 2009-03-30 | 2010-09-30 | Peine William J | Surgical instrument |
AU2010242820B2 (en) | 2009-05-01 | 2014-12-11 | Cayenne Medical, Inc. | Meniscal repair systems and methods |
EP2477555B1 (en) | 2009-09-15 | 2013-12-25 | Evalve, Inc. | Device for cardiac valve repair |
EP2810604B1 (en) | 2009-09-25 | 2016-07-06 | Boston Scientific Scimed, Inc. | Devices for approximating tissue |
WO2011041571A2 (en) | 2009-10-01 | 2011-04-07 | Kardium Inc. | Medical device, kit and method for constricting tissue or a bodily orifice, for example, a mitral valve |
US20130190861A1 (en) | 2012-01-23 | 2013-07-25 | Tendyne Holdings, Inc. | Prosthetic Valve for Replacing Mitral Valve |
US8449599B2 (en) | 2009-12-04 | 2013-05-28 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Prosthetic valve for replacing mitral valve |
US8870950B2 (en) | 2009-12-08 | 2014-10-28 | Mitral Tech Ltd. | Rotation-based anchoring of an implant |
JP5588711B2 (en) | 2010-03-30 | 2014-09-10 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Ligation device |
US8579964B2 (en) | 2010-05-05 | 2013-11-12 | Neovasc Inc. | Transcatheter mitral valve prosthesis |
EP4098227A1 (en) | 2010-07-23 | 2022-12-07 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Retaining mechanisms for prosthetic valves |
DE102010039304A1 (en) | 2010-08-13 | 2012-02-16 | Siemens Aktiengesellschaft | Fastening device for a mitral valve and method |
US10076327B2 (en) | 2010-09-14 | 2018-09-18 | Evalve, Inc. | Flexible actuator mandrel for tissue apposition systems |
US8104149B1 (en) | 2010-09-22 | 2012-01-31 | Geraghty, Llc | Money clip |
WO2012047603A1 (en) | 2010-09-28 | 2012-04-12 | Williams Robotics Llc | Automated apparatus for constructing assemblies of building components |
EP2438954B1 (en) | 2010-10-08 | 2016-12-28 | Greatbatch Ltd. | Bi-directional catheter steering handle |
JP5676772B2 (en) | 2010-10-11 | 2015-02-25 | クック メディカル テクノロジーズ エルエルシーCook Medical Technologies Llc | Medical device with removable and pivotable jaws |
JP5989653B2 (en) | 2010-11-03 | 2016-09-07 | バイオカーディア, インコーポレイテッドBiocardia, Inc. | Steerable introducer sheath system |
EP2637577B1 (en) | 2010-11-09 | 2017-10-18 | Cook Medical Technologies LLC | Clip system having tether segments for closure |
US9072517B2 (en) | 2010-11-15 | 2015-07-07 | Wake Forest University Health Sciences | Natural orifice transluminal endoscopic devices for closure of luminal perforations and associated methods |
WO2012078067A1 (en) | 2010-12-07 | 2012-06-14 | Globetek 2000 Pty Ltd | Method of a hemostasis creation with restoration possibility of blood- flow in tubular elastic structures of an organism and device for its realization |
US10398445B2 (en) | 2011-01-11 | 2019-09-03 | Amsel Medical Corporation | Method and apparatus for clamping tissue layers and occluding tubular body structures |
EP2478868A1 (en) | 2011-01-25 | 2012-07-25 | The Provost, Fellows, Foundation Scholars, and the other Members of Board, of the College of the Holy and Undivided Trinity of Queen Elizabeth | Implant device |
US9155619B2 (en) | 2011-02-25 | 2015-10-13 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Prosthetic heart valve delivery apparatus |
US9554897B2 (en) | 2011-04-28 | 2017-01-31 | Neovasc Tiara Inc. | Methods and apparatus for engaging a valve prosthesis with tissue |
MX339355B (en) | 2011-05-23 | 2016-05-18 | Univ Southern California | Accommodating intraocular lens. |
EP2723273B1 (en) | 2011-06-21 | 2021-10-27 | Twelve, Inc. | Prosthetic heart valve devices |
WO2013003228A1 (en) | 2011-06-27 | 2013-01-03 | University Of Maryland, Baltimore | Transapical mitral valve repair device |
US9039732B2 (en) | 2011-07-11 | 2015-05-26 | Covidien Lp | Surgical forceps |
US9161837B2 (en) | 2011-07-27 | 2015-10-20 | The Cleveland Clinic Foundation | Apparatus, system, and method for treating a regurgitant heart valve |
US20140324164A1 (en) | 2011-08-05 | 2014-10-30 | Mitraltech Ltd. | Techniques for percutaneous mitral valve replacement and sealing |
WO2013021375A2 (en) | 2011-08-05 | 2013-02-14 | Mitraltech Ltd. | Percutaneous mitral valve replacement and sealing |
US8852272B2 (en) | 2011-08-05 | 2014-10-07 | Mitraltech Ltd. | Techniques for percutaneous mitral valve replacement and sealing |
WO2013021374A2 (en) | 2011-08-05 | 2013-02-14 | Mitraltech Ltd. | Techniques for percutaneous mitral valve replacement and sealing |
US20130041314A1 (en) | 2011-08-11 | 2013-02-14 | Cook Medical Technologies Llc | Steerable Catheters |
EP2747709A4 (en) | 2011-09-09 | 2015-04-15 | Univ Emory | Systems, devices and methods for repair of heart valve lesions |
US9387075B2 (en) | 2011-09-12 | 2016-07-12 | Highlife Sas | Transcatheter valve prosthesis |
US8945177B2 (en) | 2011-09-13 | 2015-02-03 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems Inc. | Gripper pusher mechanism for tissue apposition systems |
US9011468B2 (en) | 2011-09-13 | 2015-04-21 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems Inc. | Independent gripper |
JP5343113B2 (en) | 2011-09-15 | 2013-11-13 | 富士フイルム株式会社 | Clip unit and ligating apparatus using the same |
WO2013131069A1 (en) | 2012-03-02 | 2013-09-06 | Mehr Medical Llc | Prostheses |
US9039757B2 (en) | 2011-10-19 | 2015-05-26 | Twelve, Inc. | Prosthetic heart valve devices, prosthetic mitral valves and associated systems and methods |
WO2013085934A1 (en) | 2011-12-05 | 2013-06-13 | Pi-R-Squared Ltd. | Fracturing calcifications in heart valves |
US20150094802A1 (en) | 2012-02-28 | 2015-04-02 | Mvalve Technologies Ltd. | Single-ring cardiac valve support |
US20130304197A1 (en) | 2012-02-28 | 2013-11-14 | Mvalve Technologies Ltd. | Cardiac valve modification device |
US9474605B2 (en) | 2012-05-16 | 2016-10-25 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Devices and methods for reducing cardiac valve regurgitation |
CA2872611C (en) | 2012-05-16 | 2020-09-15 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Systems and methods for placing a coapting member between valvular leaflets |
US10327810B2 (en) | 2016-07-05 | 2019-06-25 | Mainstay Medical Limited | Systems and methods for enhanced implantation of electrode leads between tissue layers |
US20150157268A1 (en) | 2012-07-04 | 2015-06-11 | Vectorious Medical Technologies Ltd | Organ wall retention mechanism for implants |
US9662205B2 (en) | 2012-08-02 | 2017-05-30 | St. Jude Medical, Cardiology Division, Inc. | Apparatus and method for heart valve repair |
EP2695586B1 (en) | 2012-08-10 | 2019-05-08 | Sorin Group Italia S.r.l. | A valve prosthesis and kit |
US9468525B2 (en) | 2012-08-13 | 2016-10-18 | Medtronic, Inc. | Heart valve prosthesis |
WO2014034254A1 (en) | 2012-08-30 | 2014-03-06 | オリンパスメディカルシステムズ株式会社 | Opening closer |
US20140067048A1 (en) | 2012-09-06 | 2014-03-06 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart Valve Sealing Devices |
US9282972B1 (en) | 2012-10-14 | 2016-03-15 | Innovative Urololy, Llc | Surgical clips with penetrating locking mechanism and non-slip clamping surfaces |
US9220507B1 (en) | 2012-10-14 | 2015-12-29 | Manoj B. Patel | Tissue spreading vascular clips with locking mechanism and non-slip clamping surfaces |
US10029073B2 (en) | 2012-11-13 | 2018-07-24 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems, Inc. | Steerable assembly for surgical catheter |
FR2999069B1 (en) | 2012-12-06 | 2016-03-11 | In2Bones | COMPRESSION STAPLE WITH CONVERGENT LEGS |
US8986371B2 (en) | 2013-01-08 | 2015-03-24 | Medtronic CV Luxembourg S.a.r.l. | Method of treating paravalvular leakage after prosthetic valve implantation |
US20140200662A1 (en) | 2013-01-16 | 2014-07-17 | Mvalve Technologies Ltd. | Anchoring elements for intracardiac devices |
EP4166111A1 (en) | 2013-01-24 | 2023-04-19 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Ventricularly-anchored prosthetic valves |
US9439763B2 (en) | 2013-02-04 | 2016-09-13 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Prosthetic valve for replacing mitral valve |
US9926719B2 (en) | 2013-02-13 | 2018-03-27 | Nabors Drilling Technologies Usa, Inc. | Slingshot side saddle substructure |
US10105221B2 (en) | 2013-03-07 | 2018-10-23 | Cedars-Sinai Medical Center | Method and apparatus for percutaneous delivery and deployment of a cardiovascular prosthesis |
EP2967281B1 (en) | 2013-03-11 | 2019-03-06 | Boston Scientific Scimed, Inc. | Deflection mechanism |
US20140277427A1 (en) | 2013-03-14 | 2014-09-18 | Cardiaq Valve Technologies, Inc. | Prosthesis for atraumatically grasping intralumenal tissue and methods of delivery |
US9232998B2 (en) | 2013-03-15 | 2016-01-12 | Cardiosolutions Inc. | Trans-apical implant systems, implants and methods |
JP6221300B2 (en) | 2013-03-28 | 2017-11-01 | 住友ベークライト株式会社 | Catheter and catheter operation part |
WO2014179763A1 (en) | 2013-05-03 | 2014-11-06 | Medtronic Inc. | Valve delivery tool |
US9763781B2 (en) | 2013-05-07 | 2017-09-19 | George Kramer | Inflatable transcatheter intracardiac devices and methods for treating incompetent atrioventricular valves |
US10149759B2 (en) | 2013-05-09 | 2018-12-11 | Mitrassist Medical Ltd. | Heart valve assistive prosthesis |
JP2016523606A (en) | 2013-05-29 | 2016-08-12 | ムバルブ・テクノロジーズ・リミテッド | Heart valve support device with leaflets attached |
CA2915073A1 (en) | 2013-06-14 | 2014-12-18 | Cardiosolutions, Inc. | Mitral valve spacer and system and method for implanting the same |
JP6329256B2 (en) | 2013-06-19 | 2018-05-23 | エルジー・ケム・リミテッド | Encapsulant film |
US9393111B2 (en) | 2014-01-15 | 2016-07-19 | Sino Medical Sciences Technology Inc. | Device and method for mitral valve regurgitation treatment |
US20150100116A1 (en) | 2013-10-07 | 2015-04-09 | Medizinische Universitat Wien | Implant and method for improving coaptation of an atrioventricular valve |
JP6554094B2 (en) | 2013-10-28 | 2019-07-31 | テンダイン ホールディングス,インコーポレイテッド | Prosthetic heart valve and system and method for delivering an artificial heart valve |
US9622863B2 (en) | 2013-11-22 | 2017-04-18 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Aortic insufficiency repair device and method |
WO2015079443A1 (en) | 2013-11-28 | 2015-06-04 | Mvalve Technologies Ltd. | Intracardiac devices comprising stabilizing elements having improved fatigue resistance |
EP4400061A3 (en) | 2014-02-14 | 2024-09-25 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Percutaneous leaflet augmentation |
CN106068108B (en) | 2014-02-21 | 2019-03-01 | 米特拉尔维尔福科技有限责任公司 | For delivering the devices, systems, and methods of artificial mitral valve and anchor |
US20150257756A1 (en) | 2014-03-13 | 2015-09-17 | Lsi Solutions, Inc. | Surgical clamping device and methods thereof |
JP6358532B2 (en) | 2014-03-13 | 2018-07-18 | パナソニックIpマネジメント株式会社 | Massage measuring device and massage measuring method |
WO2015138890A1 (en) | 2014-03-14 | 2015-09-17 | Boston Scientific Scimed, Inc. | Methods and apparatus for clipping tissue |
US10390943B2 (en) | 2014-03-17 | 2019-08-27 | Evalve, Inc. | Double orifice device for transcatheter mitral valve replacement |
US9572666B2 (en) | 2014-03-17 | 2017-02-21 | Evalve, Inc. | Mitral valve fixation device removal devices and methods |
US9532870B2 (en) | 2014-06-06 | 2017-01-03 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Prosthetic valve for replacing a mitral valve |
US10111749B2 (en) | 2014-06-11 | 2018-10-30 | Medtronic Vascular, Inc. | Prosthetic valve with flow director |
EP3157469B2 (en) | 2014-06-18 | 2024-10-02 | Polares Medical Inc. | Mitral valve implants for the treatment of valvular regurgitation |
CA2955389C (en) | 2014-07-23 | 2023-04-04 | Corvia Medical, Inc. | Devices and methods for treating heart failure |
US10016272B2 (en) | 2014-09-12 | 2018-07-10 | Mitral Valve Technologies Sarl | Mitral repair and replacement devices and methods |
FR3027212A1 (en) | 2014-10-16 | 2016-04-22 | Seguin Jacques | INTERVALVULAR IMPLANT FOR MITRAL VALVE |
US10105225B2 (en) | 2014-10-22 | 2018-10-23 | Medtronic, Inc. | Devices, systems and methods for tissue approximation, including approximating mitral valve leaflets |
US9750605B2 (en) | 2014-10-23 | 2017-09-05 | Caisson Interventional, LLC | Systems and methods for heart valve therapy |
US9700445B2 (en) | 2014-11-04 | 2017-07-11 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems, Inc. | One-way actuator knob |
CN106102599B (en) | 2014-12-12 | 2020-04-17 | 阿特瑞克尔公司 | Plugging clamp |
US10188392B2 (en) | 2014-12-19 | 2019-01-29 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems, Inc. | Grasping for tissue repair |
WO2016110760A1 (en) | 2015-01-05 | 2016-07-14 | Strait Access Technologies Holdings (Pty) Ltd | Heart valve leaflet capture device |
CN107427305B (en) | 2015-01-05 | 2020-03-17 | 海峡接入控股(私人)有限公司 | Heart valve leaflet capturing device |
KR101653481B1 (en) | 2015-01-16 | 2016-09-01 | 엘지전자 주식회사 | Vacuum cleaner and dust collecting apparatus |
US10188833B2 (en) | 2015-01-21 | 2019-01-29 | Medtronic Vascular, Inc. | Guide catheter with steering mechanisms |
US10105226B2 (en) | 2015-02-10 | 2018-10-23 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Offset cardiac leaflet coaptation element |
US10869756B2 (en) * | 2015-03-12 | 2020-12-22 | Cedars-Sinai Medical Center | Devices, systems, and methods to optimize annular orientation of transcatheter valves |
US10524912B2 (en) | 2015-04-02 | 2020-01-07 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems, Inc. | Tissue fixation devices and methods |
WO2016183485A1 (en) | 2015-05-14 | 2016-11-17 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US10376673B2 (en) | 2015-06-19 | 2019-08-13 | Evalve, Inc. | Catheter guiding system and methods |
US10238494B2 (en) | 2015-06-29 | 2019-03-26 | Evalve, Inc. | Self-aligning radiopaque ring |
US10667815B2 (en) | 2015-07-21 | 2020-06-02 | Evalve, Inc. | Tissue grasping devices and related methods |
JP7068161B2 (en) | 2015-07-23 | 2022-05-16 | セダーズ-シナイ メディカル センター | Device for fixing the apex of the heart |
US10413408B2 (en) | 2015-08-06 | 2019-09-17 | Evalve, Inc. | Delivery catheter systems, methods, and devices |
CA2995603C (en) | 2015-08-14 | 2023-10-31 | Caisson Interventional Llc | Systems and methods for heart valve therapy |
CN106491245B (en) | 2015-09-06 | 2018-08-07 | 先健科技(深圳)有限公司 | Valve clamping device |
US10456243B2 (en) | 2015-10-09 | 2019-10-29 | Medtronic Vascular, Inc. | Heart valves prostheses and methods for percutaneous heart valve replacement |
US10238495B2 (en) | 2015-10-09 | 2019-03-26 | Evalve, Inc. | Delivery catheter handle and methods of use |
USD809139S1 (en) | 2015-10-09 | 2018-01-30 | Evalve, Inc. | Handle for a medical device |
US10226309B2 (en) | 2015-10-09 | 2019-03-12 | Evalve, Inc. | Devices, systems, and methods to support, stabilize, and position a medical device |
FR3043907A1 (en) | 2015-11-23 | 2017-05-26 | Alain Dibie | ASSEMBLY FOR REPLACING THE TRICUSPID ATRIO-VENTRICULAR VALVE |
US10111660B2 (en) | 2015-12-03 | 2018-10-30 | Covidien Lp | Surgical stapler flexible distal tip |
US10099050B2 (en) | 2016-01-21 | 2018-10-16 | Medtronic, Inc. | Interventional medical devices, device systems, and fixation components thereof |
US10675442B2 (en) | 2016-02-08 | 2020-06-09 | Nextern, Inc. | Robotically augmented catheter manipulation handle |
US10299924B2 (en) | 2016-02-10 | 2019-05-28 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems Inc. | System and method for implant delivery |
DE102016103320A1 (en) | 2016-02-25 | 2017-08-31 | Hicat Gmbh | System for intraoral measurement of jaw dislocations |
WO2017153603A1 (en) | 2016-03-11 | 2017-09-14 | Cerus Endovascular Limited | Occlusion device |
US10799675B2 (en) | 2016-03-21 | 2020-10-13 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Cam controlled multi-direction steerable handles |
US10307243B2 (en) | 2016-03-29 | 2019-06-04 | Spiration, Inc. | Dual membrane airway valve |
CN105726072B (en) | 2016-04-14 | 2018-02-27 | 江苏大学 | A kind of bicuspid valve air bag closure plate occluder and method for implantation being implanted into through the apex of the heart |
US11185413B2 (en) | 2016-07-13 | 2021-11-30 | Medfree, Inc. | Tissue grasping devices and related methods |
EP3484375A4 (en) | 2016-07-13 | 2020-07-22 | Medfree, Inc. | Tissue grasping devices and related methods |
US10478304B2 (en) | 2016-07-20 | 2019-11-19 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems Inc. | Independent system for tricuspid valve repair |
US10350062B2 (en) | 2016-07-21 | 2019-07-16 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Replacement heart valve prosthesis |
CN106175986B (en) | 2016-07-26 | 2017-12-01 | 复旦大学附属中山医院 | A kind of valve clamping machine |
US11504064B2 (en) | 2016-07-28 | 2022-11-22 | Evalve, Inc. | Systems and methods for intra-procedural cardiac pressure monitoring |
CN106175845B (en) | 2016-08-01 | 2019-01-15 | 上海纽脉医疗科技有限公司 | A kind of mitral leaflet reparation closing device |
CR20190069A (en) * | 2016-08-26 | 2019-05-14 | Edwards Lifesciences Corp | Heart valve docking coils and systems |
CN107789017B (en) | 2016-08-31 | 2020-12-01 | 上海锦葵医疗器械股份有限公司 | Mitral valve clip |
WO2018050200A1 (en) | 2016-09-16 | 2018-03-22 | Coramaze Technologies Gmbh | Heart implant |
WO2018050203A1 (en) | 2016-09-16 | 2018-03-22 | Coramaze Technologies Gmbh | Heart implant |
US10420574B2 (en) | 2016-09-19 | 2019-09-24 | Richard Devere Thrasher, III | Double forceps |
US11071564B2 (en) | 2016-10-05 | 2021-07-27 | Evalve, Inc. | Cardiac valve cutting device |
US10653862B2 (en) | 2016-11-07 | 2020-05-19 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Apparatus for the introduction and manipulation of multiple telescoping catheters |
US10575841B1 (en) * | 2016-11-29 | 2020-03-03 | The Lonnie and Shannon Paulos Trust | Soft locking suture anchor assembly and methods of use |
US10548614B2 (en) | 2016-11-29 | 2020-02-04 | Evalve, Inc. | Tricuspid valve repair system |
US10420565B2 (en) | 2016-11-29 | 2019-09-24 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems Inc. | Cinch and post for tricuspid valve repair |
CA3033084C (en) | 2016-12-06 | 2021-02-23 | Boston Scientific Scimed, Inc. | Compressive coupler for reloadable hemostasis clipping device |
US10779837B2 (en) | 2016-12-08 | 2020-09-22 | Evalve, Inc. | Adjustable arm device for grasping tissues |
CN110290764B (en) | 2016-12-21 | 2022-04-29 | 特里弗洛心血管公司 | Heart valve support devices and methods for making and using the same |
US11013600B2 (en) | 2017-01-23 | 2021-05-25 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Covered prosthetic heart valve |
WO2018145055A1 (en) | 2017-02-06 | 2018-08-09 | Caisson Interventional Llc | Systems and methods for heart valve therapy |
US10675439B2 (en) | 2017-02-21 | 2020-06-09 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems Inc. | High torsion delivery catheter element |
US10952852B2 (en) | 2017-02-24 | 2021-03-23 | Abbott Cardiovascular Systems Inc. | Double basket assembly for valve repair |
SI3682854T1 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2022-04-29 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11224511B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2022-01-18 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US10959846B2 (en) | 2017-05-10 | 2021-03-30 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Mitral valve spacer device |
EP3621529A1 (en) | 2017-05-12 | 2020-03-18 | Evalve, Inc. | Long arm valve repair clip |
US10779829B2 (en) | 2017-06-07 | 2020-09-22 | Evalve, Inc. | Tissue compression device for cardiac valve repair |
EP3417831B2 (en) | 2017-06-19 | 2023-05-24 | HVR Cardio Oy | Delivery device for an annuloplasty implant |
WO2018236843A2 (en) | 2017-06-19 | 2018-12-27 | Harpoon Medical, Inc. | Method and apparatus for cardiac procedures |
JP7134229B2 (en) | 2017-07-06 | 2022-09-09 | ラグビア バスデ, | Tissue grasping device and related method |
US20190021652A1 (en) | 2017-07-19 | 2019-01-24 | International Business Machines Corporation | Monitoring the posture of a user |
US20190030285A1 (en) | 2017-07-27 | 2019-01-31 | Evalve, Inc. | Intravascular delivery system with centralized steering |
PL422397A1 (en) | 2017-07-29 | 2019-02-11 | Endoscope Spółka Z Ograniczoną Odpowiedzialnością | System for controlling the medical probe tip, preferably the endoscope probe and the endoscope handle |
US10856984B2 (en) | 2017-08-25 | 2020-12-08 | Neovasc Tiara Inc. | Sequentially deployed transcatheter mitral valve prosthesis |
US11173032B2 (en) | 2017-08-28 | 2021-11-16 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Transcatheter device for treating mitral regurgitation |
US11051940B2 (en) | 2017-09-07 | 2021-07-06 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Prosthetic spacer device for heart valve |
GB2581718B (en) | 2017-10-19 | 2022-08-31 | Shanghai Hanyu Medical Tech Co Ltd | Valve clamping device |
CN111246816B (en) | 2017-10-24 | 2023-07-14 | 圣犹达医疗用品心脏病学部门有限公司 | System for measuring impedance between multiple electrodes of medical device |
WO2019097510A1 (en) | 2017-11-15 | 2019-05-23 | Tel Hashomer Medical Research, Infrastructure And Services Ltd. | Mitral brace |
US20190159782A1 (en) | 2017-11-28 | 2019-05-30 | Covidien Lp | Surgical ligation clip with tissue stop member |
CN109953779B (en) | 2017-12-26 | 2021-08-31 | 先健科技(深圳)有限公司 | Clamping device and system for fixing tissue |
US10159570B1 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2018-12-25 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US10238493B1 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2019-03-26 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
SG11202006509SA (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2020-08-28 | Edwards Lifesciences Corp | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US10123873B1 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2018-11-13 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US10130475B1 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2018-11-20 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US10507109B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2019-12-17 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US10111751B1 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2018-10-30 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US10231837B1 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2019-03-19 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US10105222B1 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2018-10-23 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US10136993B1 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2018-11-27 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US10076415B1 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2018-09-18 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
CN111902103A (en) | 2018-02-08 | 2020-11-06 | 因威尔乌治疗公司 | Method, apparatus and device for treating heart valves |
US11389297B2 (en) | 2018-04-12 | 2022-07-19 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Mitral valve spacer device |
EP3784173A4 (en) | 2018-04-24 | 2021-12-15 | Raghuveer Basude | Retrievable tissue grasping devices, spacers, artificial valves and related methods |
CN110495972A (en) | 2018-05-17 | 2019-11-26 | 杭州德晋医疗科技有限公司 | Valve clamping machine and valve clamping system |
JP7488810B2 (en) | 2018-07-29 | 2024-05-22 | クスパ リミテッド | Transcatheter artificial cusps for valvular regurgitation |
US11364117B2 (en) | 2018-10-15 | 2022-06-21 | St. Jude Medical, Cardiology Division, Inc. | Braid connections for prosthetic heart valves |
CN209996540U (en) | 2018-11-04 | 2020-01-31 | 上海汇挚医疗科技有限公司 | Clamp, valve annulus clamp assembly and valve annulus repair system |
CN113226223A (en) | 2018-11-20 | 2021-08-06 | 爱德华兹生命科学公司 | Deployment tools and methods for delivering devices to native heart valves |
JP2022509627A (en) | 2018-11-21 | 2022-01-21 | エドワーズ ライフサイエンシーズ コーポレイション | Heart valve sealing device, delivery device for it, and recovery device |
SG11202105391SA (en) | 2018-11-29 | 2021-06-29 | Edwards Lifesciences Corp | Catheterization method and apparatus |
AU2020221912A1 (en) | 2019-02-11 | 2021-08-19 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
EP4223258A1 (en) | 2019-02-14 | 2023-08-09 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
CA3130335A1 (en) | 2019-02-20 | 2020-08-27 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Counterflexing steerable catheter for transcatheter heart valve therapy |
CA3131522A1 (en) | 2019-02-25 | 2020-09-03 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices |
JP2022524124A (en) | 2019-03-12 | 2022-04-27 | ハーフ ムーン メディカル インコーポレイテッド | Heart valve repair devices with annuloplasty features, as well as related systems and methods |
CN113873972B (en) | 2019-04-22 | 2024-08-06 | 爱德华兹生命科学公司 | Heart valve repair |
JP7271710B2 (en) | 2019-05-17 | 2023-05-11 | ボストン サイエンティフィック サイムド,インコーポレイテッド | A device that accesses the peripheral regions of the lung for direct visualization with tooling |
JP7483757B2 (en) | 2019-05-20 | 2024-05-15 | エドワーズ ライフサイエンシーズ コーポレイション | HEART VALVE SEALING DEVICE, DELIVERY DEVICE AND RETRIEVAL DEVICE THEREFOR - Patent application |
EP3972534A4 (en) | 2019-05-22 | 2023-08-02 | Triflo Cardiovascular Inc. | Heart valve support device |
WO2021018250A1 (en) | 2019-07-31 | 2021-02-04 | 杭州德晋医疗科技有限公司 | Valve clamp having membrane and valve clamping system |
CN110338857B (en) | 2019-08-02 | 2024-03-29 | 上海纽脉医疗科技有限公司 | Clamp holder for repairing valve leaflet |
CN211723546U (en) | 2019-08-06 | 2020-10-23 | 上海捍宇医疗科技有限公司 | Valve clamping device and clamping system thereof |
CN211243911U (en) | 2019-08-12 | 2020-08-14 | 杭州德晋医疗科技有限公司 | Recoverable valve clamping device and valve clamping device recovery system |
WO2021027588A1 (en) | 2019-08-13 | 2021-02-18 | 杭州德晋医疗科技有限公司 | Adjustable valve clamping device and valve clamping system |
US11497506B2 (en) | 2019-08-28 | 2022-11-15 | Shanghai Huihe Healthcare Technology Co., Ltd. | Clamping instrument and clamping assembly |
CN110537946B (en) | 2019-09-26 | 2024-07-26 | 上海纽脉医疗科技有限公司 | Tissue clamping device and application method thereof |
CN114173716A (en) | 2019-09-30 | 2022-03-11 | 爱德华兹生命科学公司 | Heart valve sealing device and delivery device thereof |
WO2021071682A1 (en) | 2019-10-09 | 2021-04-15 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
KR20220084010A (en) | 2019-10-15 | 2022-06-21 | 에드워즈 라이프사이언시스 코포레이션 | Heart valve sealing device and delivery device therefor |
CN110664515A (en) | 2019-10-15 | 2020-01-10 | 北京航天卡迪技术开发研究所 | Transverse and vertical clamping mitral valve clamp and conveying system |
CN212346813U (en) | 2019-10-31 | 2021-01-15 | 杭州德晋医疗科技有限公司 | Valve clamping device capable of detecting clamping state of valve and valve clamping system |
WO2021098371A1 (en) | 2019-11-19 | 2021-05-27 | 杭州德晋医疗科技有限公司 | Independently controllable valve clamping system |
EP4076285A1 (en) | 2019-12-18 | 2022-10-26 | Evalve, Inc. | Wide clip with deformable width |
KR20220121773A (en) | 2019-12-23 | 2022-09-01 | 에드워즈 라이프사이언시스 코포레이션 | Heart valve sealing device and delivery device therefor |
CN111904660B (en) | 2020-03-18 | 2023-03-31 | 杭州德晋医疗科技有限公司 | Valve clamping device and valve clamping system |
EP4110231A4 (en) | 2020-03-31 | 2023-08-09 | Shanghai Newmed Medical Co., Ltd. | Tissue clamping devices |
WO2021202130A1 (en) | 2020-03-31 | 2021-10-07 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | High flexibility implant catheter with low compression |
CN212415988U (en) | 2020-04-02 | 2021-01-29 | 科凯(南通)生命科学有限公司 | Valve repair clamp |
KR20230003165A (en) | 2020-05-11 | 2023-01-05 | 상하이 뉴메드 메디컬 씨오., 엘티디. | Mitral valve repair mechanism and its control handle |
US20210401434A1 (en) | 2020-06-24 | 2021-12-30 | Medtronic Vascular, Inc. | Apparatus and methods for removal of heart valve ligation clip |
WO2022006087A2 (en) | 2020-06-30 | 2022-01-06 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Systems and methods for heart valve leaflet repair |
JP2023538879A (en) | 2020-08-14 | 2023-09-12 | エドワーズ ライフサイエンシーズ コーポレイション | Valve repair implant with leaflet tension indication |
CN212490263U (en) | 2020-08-17 | 2021-02-09 | 杭州德晋医疗科技有限公司 | Valve clamping device with adjustable supporting force and valve clamping system |
EP4208118A1 (en) | 2020-09-01 | 2023-07-12 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Medical device stabilizing systems |
CN111870398A (en) | 2020-09-07 | 2020-11-03 | 上海捍宇医疗科技有限公司 | Valve clamping device |
CN111870399A (en) | 2020-09-07 | 2020-11-03 | 上海捍宇医疗科技有限公司 | Valve clamping device with plugging function |
CN111920549A (en) | 2020-09-10 | 2020-11-13 | 上海纽脉医疗科技有限公司 | Clip body of mitral valve clamping device, mitral valve clamping device and repair equipment |
CN112120831A (en) | 2020-09-25 | 2020-12-25 | 上海捍宇医疗科技有限公司 | Clamping device with expandable arm |
JP7432796B2 (en) | 2020-09-29 | 2024-02-16 | 上海捍宇医療科技股▲ふん▼有限公司 | Clamping device |
CN112168427A (en) | 2020-11-02 | 2021-01-05 | 上海竑宇医疗科技有限公司 | Heart apex implantation cusp clamping device and heart apex implantation cusp clamping method |
EP4243703A2 (en) | 2020-11-13 | 2023-09-20 | Edwards Lifesciences Innovation (Israel) Ltd. | Valve leaflet treatment systems and methods |
CA3175545A1 (en) | 2020-12-23 | 2022-06-30 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices and delivery devices therefor |
EP4277572A1 (en) | 2021-01-15 | 2023-11-22 | Edwards Lifesciences Innovation (Israel) Ltd. | Intercommissural leaflet support |
CA3208330A1 (en) | 2021-01-15 | 2022-07-21 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
WO2022157592A1 (en) | 2021-01-21 | 2022-07-28 | Edwards Lifesciences Innovation (Israel) Ltd. | Fasteners for percutaneous devices |
US20220257196A1 (en) | 2021-02-18 | 2022-08-18 | St. Jude Medical, Cardiology Division, Inc. | Contact Quality System and Method |
JP2024513410A (en) | 2021-03-30 | 2024-03-25 | エドワーズ ライフサイエンシーズ コーポレイション | Medical device support and method of use |
CN215019733U (en) | 2021-04-02 | 2021-12-07 | 上海汇禾医疗科技有限公司 | Clamping apparatus |
WO2023278663A2 (en) | 2021-07-01 | 2023-01-05 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve repair devices and delivery devices therefor |
CA3224357A1 (en) | 2021-07-16 | 2023-01-19 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Devices and methods for addressing valve leaflet problems |
JP2024529371A (en) | 2021-07-20 | 2024-08-06 | エドワーズ ライフサイエンシーズ コーポレイション | Sensing heart valve repair device |
IL309677A (en) | 2021-07-23 | 2024-02-01 | Edwards Lifesciences Corp | Heart valve repair devices |
CN113476182B (en) | 2021-09-06 | 2021-11-19 | 上海汇禾医疗器械有限公司 | Conveying interface of human heart implantation instrument and using method |
CN113855328A (en) | 2021-09-30 | 2021-12-31 | 宁波健世科技股份有限公司 | Transcatheter heart valve replacement system |
-
2018
- 2018-11-14 US US16/191,336 patent/US10945844B2/en active Active
- 2018-11-19 US US16/194,785 patent/US11083582B2/en active Active
- 2018-11-29 US US16/204,355 patent/US11202710B2/en active Active
- 2018-12-03 US US16/207,693 patent/US10987221B2/en active Active
- 2018-12-12 US US16/218,060 patent/US11000375B2/en active Active
-
2019
- 2019-02-14 US US16/276,501 patent/US11234823B2/en active Active
- 2019-02-20 US US16/280,807 patent/US11344415B2/en active Active
- 2019-02-20 US US16/280,638 patent/US10993809B2/en active Active
- 2019-02-22 US US16/282,844 patent/US11129717B2/en active Active
- 2019-03-01 US US16/290,572 patent/US11278409B2/en active Active
- 2019-03-12 US US16/299,763 patent/US11147672B2/en active Active
- 2019-10-09 SG SG11202102714RA patent/SG11202102714RA/en unknown
- 2019-10-09 IL IL315326A patent/IL315326A/en unknown
- 2019-10-09 AU AU2019357479A patent/AU2019357479B2/en active Active
- 2019-10-09 JP JP2021520176A patent/JP7447103B2/en active Active
- 2019-10-09 EP EP19797422.3A patent/EP3863568A1/en active Pending
- 2019-10-09 TW TW108136507A patent/TWI840422B/en active
- 2019-10-09 BR BR112020023021-9A patent/BR112020023021A2/en unknown
- 2019-10-09 DE DE112019005088.5T patent/DE112019005088T5/en active Pending
- 2019-10-09 MX MX2021002827A patent/MX2021002827A/en unknown
- 2019-10-09 CA CA3116025A patent/CA3116025A1/en active Pending
- 2019-10-09 CR CR20210230A patent/CR20210230A/en unknown
- 2019-10-09 KR KR1020217010879A patent/KR20210074296A/en not_active Application Discontinuation
- 2019-10-09 IL IL282031A patent/IL282031B1/en unknown
- 2019-10-09 CN CN201980067067.8A patent/CN112955097A/en active Pending
- 2019-10-09 CN CN201921675171.9U patent/CN211884155U/en active Active
- 2019-10-09 WO PCT/US2019/055320 patent/WO2020076898A1/en active Application Filing
- 2019-10-09 BR BR122021007274-4A patent/BR122021007274A2/en unknown
-
2020
- 2020-04-13 US US16/847,577 patent/US11766330B2/en active Active
-
2021
- 2021-05-10 CO CONC2021/0006055A patent/CO2021006055A2/en unknown
-
2022
- 2022-09-13 AU AU2022231690A patent/AU2022231690B2/en active Active
-
2023
- 2023-08-14 US US18/449,659 patent/US20230380971A1/en active Pending
-
2024
- 2024-02-28 JP JP2024028761A patent/JP2024071392A/en active Pending
Patent Citations (6)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20060020275A1 (en) * | 1999-04-09 | 2006-01-26 | Evalve, Inc. | Locking mechanisms for fixation devices and methods of engaging tissue |
US20100022823A1 (en) * | 2005-09-27 | 2010-01-28 | Evalve, Inc. | Methods and devices for tissue grasping and assessment |
US10993809B2 (en) * | 2018-10-10 | 2021-05-04 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11129717B2 (en) * | 2018-10-10 | 2021-09-28 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11147672B2 (en) * | 2018-10-10 | 2021-10-19 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11202710B2 (en) * | 2018-10-10 | 2021-12-21 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
Cited By (85)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US12115062B2 (en) | 2009-12-04 | 2024-10-15 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Prosthetic valve having multi-part frame |
US11911264B2 (en) | 2009-12-04 | 2024-02-27 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Valve repair and replacement devices |
US11660185B2 (en) | 2009-12-04 | 2023-05-30 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Ventricular anchors for valve repair and replacement devices |
US11141268B2 (en) | 2009-12-08 | 2021-10-12 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve with upper and lower skirts |
US11839541B2 (en) | 2009-12-08 | 2023-12-12 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve with upper skirt |
US11351026B2 (en) | 2009-12-08 | 2022-06-07 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Rotation-based anchoring of an implant |
US11109964B2 (en) | 2010-03-10 | 2021-09-07 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Axially-shortening prosthetic valve |
US11426155B2 (en) | 2010-07-21 | 2022-08-30 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Helical anchor implantation |
US11969163B2 (en) | 2010-07-21 | 2024-04-30 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Valve prosthesis configured for deployment in annular spacer |
US11653910B2 (en) | 2010-07-21 | 2023-05-23 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Helical anchor implantation |
US11690712B2 (en) | 2011-08-05 | 2023-07-04 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Clip-secured implant for heart valve |
US11517436B2 (en) | 2011-08-05 | 2022-12-06 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Implant for heart valve |
US11135059B2 (en) | 2013-01-24 | 2021-10-05 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve and upstream support therefor |
US11844691B2 (en) | 2013-01-24 | 2023-12-19 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Partially-covered prosthetic valves |
US12083010B2 (en) | 2013-02-04 | 2024-09-10 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Method of implanting a spacer body in a mitral valve |
US11701225B2 (en) | 2014-07-30 | 2023-07-18 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Delivery of a prosthetic valve |
US11872130B2 (en) | 2014-07-30 | 2024-01-16 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve implant |
US12053380B2 (en) | 2014-07-30 | 2024-08-06 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Anchoring of a prosthetic valve |
US11690621B2 (en) | 2014-12-04 | 2023-07-04 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Percutaneous clip for repairing a heart valve |
US11793638B2 (en) | 2015-02-05 | 2023-10-24 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with pivoting tissue anchor portions |
US11672658B2 (en) | 2015-02-05 | 2023-06-13 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with aligned inner and outer frames |
US11801135B2 (en) | 2015-02-05 | 2023-10-31 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Techniques for deployment of a prosthetic valve |
US11793635B2 (en) | 2015-02-05 | 2023-10-24 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with angularly offset frames |
US11793642B2 (en) | 2015-05-14 | 2023-10-24 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US12011353B2 (en) | 2015-05-14 | 2024-06-18 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11298117B2 (en) | 2016-02-16 | 2022-04-12 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Techniques for providing a replacement valve and transseptal communication |
US11937795B2 (en) | 2016-02-16 | 2024-03-26 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Techniques for providing a replacement valve and transseptal communication |
US11219746B2 (en) | 2016-03-21 | 2022-01-11 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Multi-direction steerable handles for steering catheters |
US11951263B2 (en) | 2016-03-21 | 2024-04-09 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Multi-direction steerable handles |
US12097337B2 (en) | 2016-03-21 | 2024-09-24 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Multi-direction steerable handles for steering catheters |
US12053379B2 (en) | 2016-08-01 | 2024-08-06 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Minimally-invasive delivery systems |
US11779458B2 (en) | 2016-08-10 | 2023-10-10 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with leaflet connectors |
US11517718B2 (en) | 2016-11-07 | 2022-12-06 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Apparatus for the introduction and manipulation of multiple telescoping catheters |
US11969346B2 (en) | 2017-01-05 | 2024-04-30 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve coaptation device |
US11224511B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2022-01-18 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11234822B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2022-02-01 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11850153B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2023-12-26 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11096784B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2021-08-24 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11723772B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2023-08-15 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11602431B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2023-03-14 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11160657B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2021-11-02 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11179240B2 (en) | 2017-04-18 | 2021-11-23 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11406468B2 (en) | 2017-04-28 | 2022-08-09 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Medical device stabilizing apparatus and method of use |
US11166778B2 (en) | 2017-04-28 | 2021-11-09 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Medical device stabilizing apparatus and method of use |
US12048625B2 (en) | 2017-05-10 | 2024-07-30 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Valve repair delivery handle |
US12064347B2 (en) | 2017-08-03 | 2024-08-20 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve |
US11246704B2 (en) | 2017-08-03 | 2022-02-15 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve |
US11793633B2 (en) | 2017-08-03 | 2023-10-24 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve |
US11571298B2 (en) | 2017-08-03 | 2023-02-07 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with appendages |
US12090048B2 (en) | 2017-08-03 | 2024-09-17 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve |
US12029646B2 (en) | 2017-08-03 | 2024-07-09 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic heart valve |
US11730598B2 (en) | 2017-09-07 | 2023-08-22 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Prosthetic device for heart valve |
US11304804B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2022-04-19 | Cardiovalve, Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with connecting struts of variable size and tissue anchoring legs of variable size that extend from junctions |
US11318014B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2022-05-03 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve delivery system with multi-planar steering |
US11110251B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2021-09-07 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Multi-direction steerable handles for steering catheters |
US12023243B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2024-07-02 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with protective fabric covering around tissue anchor bases |
US11304806B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2022-04-19 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with atrial tissue anchors having variable flexibility and ventricular tissue anchors having constant flexibility |
US11819405B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2023-11-21 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with inflatable cuff configured for radial extension |
US11304805B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2022-04-19 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with inflatable cuff configured to fill a volume between atrial and ventricular tissue anchors |
US11337804B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2022-05-24 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with radially-deformable tissue anchors configured to restrict axial valve migration |
US11337803B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2022-05-24 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with inner and outer frames connected at a location of tissue anchor portion |
US11318015B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2022-05-03 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve configured to fill a volume between tissue anchors with native valve tissue |
US11944762B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2024-04-02 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Multi-direction steerable handles for steering catheters |
US11864996B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2024-01-09 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve with protective sleeve around an outlet rim |
US11337802B2 (en) | 2017-09-19 | 2022-05-24 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Heart valve delivery systems and methods |
US11872131B2 (en) | 2017-12-13 | 2024-01-16 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve and delivery tool therefor |
US11382746B2 (en) | 2017-12-13 | 2022-07-12 | Cardiovalve Ltd. | Prosthetic valve and delivery tool therefor |
US11850154B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2023-12-26 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US11298228B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2022-04-12 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US12090052B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2024-09-17 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US11918469B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2024-03-05 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US11259927B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2022-03-01 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US11547564B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2023-01-10 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US11612485B2 (en) | 2018-01-09 | 2023-03-28 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Native valve repair devices and procedures |
US11389297B2 (en) | 2018-04-12 | 2022-07-19 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Mitral valve spacer device |
US11207181B2 (en) | 2018-04-18 | 2021-12-28 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11083582B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2021-08-10 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11278409B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2022-03-22 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11234823B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2022-02-01 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11766330B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2023-09-26 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Valve repair devices for repairing a native valve of a patient |
US11147672B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2021-10-19 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11344415B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2022-05-31 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11129717B2 (en) | 2018-10-10 | 2021-09-28 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11839544B2 (en) | 2019-02-14 | 2023-12-12 | Edwards Lifesciences Corporation | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
US11717406B2 (en) | 2019-05-22 | 2023-08-08 | TriFlo Cardiovascular Inc. | Heart valve support device |
Also Published As
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US20200237512A1 (en) | Valve repair devices for repairing a native valve of a patient | |
US20210361416A1 (en) | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor | |
US20220287841A1 (en) | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor | |
US20220226108A1 (en) | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor | |
US20210186686A1 (en) | Heart valve sealing devices and delivery devices therefor |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
FEPP | Fee payment procedure |
Free format text: ENTITY STATUS SET TO UNDISCOUNTED (ORIGINAL EVENT CODE: BIG.); ENTITY STATUS OF PATENT OWNER: LARGE ENTITY |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: DOCKETED NEW CASE - READY FOR EXAMINATION |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: EDWARDS LIFESCIENCES CORPORATION, CALIFORNIA Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:MCCANN, ALEX PHILIP;STEARNS, GRANT MATTHEW;DIXON, ERIC ROBERT;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20200319 TO 20200403;REEL/FRAME:055343/0857 |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: NON FINAL ACTION MAILED |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: RESPONSE TO NON-FINAL OFFICE ACTION ENTERED AND FORWARDED TO EXAMINER |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: NOTICE OF ALLOWANCE MAILED -- APPLICATION RECEIVED IN OFFICE OF PUBLICATIONS |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: EDWARDS LIFESCIENCES CORPORATION, CALIFORNIA Free format text: CHANGE OF NAME;ASSIGNOR:COONEY, RACHEL ANN;REEL/FRAME:064250/0975 Effective date: 20230713 |
|
STPP | Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general |
Free format text: PUBLICATIONS -- ISSUE FEE PAYMENT VERIFIED |
|
STCF | Information on status: patent grant |
Free format text: PATENTED CASE |